Lincoln 2014 Navigator

Product's Documents

Below are documents related to this product, you can read online or download:

User Manual

This is the main product document for model LINCOLN 2014 NAVIGATOR.

The file format is pdf, 506 pages, you can download this manual here .

background
July 2013
First Printing
Owner’s Manual
Lincoln Navigator
Litho in U.S.A.
EL7J 19A321 AA
Owner’s Manual
2014 NAVIGATOR
Owner’s Manual
2014
NAVIGATOR
lincolnowner.com lincolncanada.com
background
Introduction 9
Child Safety 18
Child seat positioning ...................................20
Booster seats .........................................22
Installing child seats ....................................25
Child safety locks ......................................37
Safety Belts 38
Fastening the safety belts ................................40
Safety belt height adjustment .............................43
Safetybeltwarninglightandindicatorchime..................44
Safety belt-minder .....................................45
Child restraint and safety belt maintenance ...................47
Supplementary Restraints System 48
Driver and passenger airbags .............................51
Side airbags ..........................................53
Safety canopy curtain airbags .............................54
Crash sensors and airbag indicator .........................56
Airbag disposal........................................57
Keys and Remote Control 58
General information on radio frequencies.....................58
Remote control .......................................58
Keys ...............................................58
Replacing a lost key or remote control.......................61
MyKey 62
Settings, MyKey .......................................62
Creating.............................................63
Clearing.............................................64
System status.........................................64
Remote start, MyKey ...................................64
Troubleshooting, MyKey .................................67
Table of Contents 1
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Locks 69
Locking and unlocking ..................................69
SecuriCode™ keyless entry keypad .........................77
Security 80
SecuriLock® passive anti-theft system.......................80
Anti-theft alarm .......................................82
Steering Wheel 84
Adjusting the steering wheel ..............................84
Steering wheel controls .................................84
Pedals 86
Adjustable pedals ......................................86
Wipers and Washers 87
Windshield wipers .....................................87
Rain-sensing wipers ....................................87
Windshield washers ....................................88
Rear-window wiper and washer ............................88
Lighting 89
Lighting control .......................................89
Autolamps ...........................................90
Daytime running lamps ..................................91
Front fog lamps.......................................91
Directionindicators ....................................91
Interior lamps ........................................92
Windows and Mirrors 94
Power windows .......................................94
Exteriormirrors.......................................95
Interiormirrors .......................................98
Sunvisors...........................................99
Moonroof ...........................................100
2 Table of Contents
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Instrument Cluster 102
Gauges.............................................102
Warning lamps and indicators ............................103
Audible warnings and indicators ..........................108
Information Displays 109
Controls............................................109
Information messages ..................................115
Climate Control 119
Dual automatic temperature control........................119
Rear window defroster .................................125
Seats 126
Sitting in the correct position ............................126
Head restraints.......................................127
Power seats .........................................129
Memory function .....................................131
Rear seats ..........................................134
Universal Garage Door Opener (If Equipped) 145
Car2U® home automation system .........................145
HomeLink® wireless control system .......................150
Auxiliary Power Points 155
Storage Compartments 158
Center console .......................................158
Overhead console .....................................158
Starting and Stopping the Engine 159
Ignition switch .......................................160
Engine block heater ...................................163
Fuel and Refueling 165
Fuel quality .........................................166
Refueling...........................................169
Fuel consumption .....................................171
Table of Contents 3
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Transmission 176
Four-Wheel Drive (If Equipped) 182
Four wheel drive .....................................182
Brakes 190
Brakes .............................................190
Hints on driving with anti-lock brakes ......................191
Parking brake........................................191
Traction Control 192
TractionControl....................................192
Stability Control 193
AdvanceTrac® .......................................194
Parking Aids 195
Sensing system.......................................195
Rear-view camera system ...............................198
Cruise Control 201
Usingcruisecontrol...................................201
Driving Aids 203
Steering............................................203
Auto leveling suspension ................................204
Load Carrying 205
Roof racks and load carriers .............................205
Vehicle loading .......................................206
Cargo management system ..............................213
Towing 216
Trailertowing........................................216
Wrecker towing ......................................226
Recreational towing ...................................227
4 Table of Contents
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Driving Hints 228
Economical driving ....................................228
Floormats..........................................230
Roadside Emergencies 232
Getting roadside assistance ..............................232
Hazard warning flashers ................................233
Fuel pump shut-off switch...............................234
Jump-starting the vehicle ...............................235
Customer Assistance 238
Reporting safety defects (U.S. only) .......................245
Reporting safety defects (Canada only) .....................245
Fuses 246
Changing a fuse ......................................246
Fuse specification chart ................................247
Maintenance 255
General information ...................................255
Opening and closing the hood ............................256
Under hood overview ..................................257
Engine oil dipstick ....................................258
Engine oil check......................................258
Engine coolant check ..................................259
Automatic transmission fluid check ........................263
Brake fluid check .....................................264
Fuel filter...........................................264
Washer fluid check ....................................265
Battery ............................................265
Checking the wiper blades ..............................267
Changing the wiper blades ..............................267
Air filter(s) .........................................268
Table of Contents 5
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Adjusting the headlamps ................................271
Changing a bulb ......................................272
Removing a headlamp ..................................273
Vehicle Care 278
Cleaning products.....................................278
Cleaning the exterior ..................................278
Waxing.............................................280
Repairing minor paint damage ............................280
Cleaning the engine ...................................281
Cleaning the windows and wiper blades .....................281
Cleaning the interior ...................................282
Cleaning the instrument panel and instrument cluster lens .......283
Cleaning leather seats ..................................284
Cleaning the alloy wheels ...............................284
Vehicle storage .......................................285
Wheels and Tires 287
Tirecare...........................................289
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) ...................305
Changing a road wheel .................................310
Technical specifications.................................318
Wheel lug nut torque ..................................318
Capacities and Specifications 319
Engine specifications ..................................319
Part numbers ........................................324
Vehicle identification number ............................324
Vehicle certification label ...............................325
Transmission code designation............................326
Accessories 327
Accessories .........................................327
6 Table of Contents
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Ford Extended Service Plan 329
Audio System 332
AM/FM/CD with SYNC .................................334
Rear seat controls.....................................337
Satellite radio information ...............................340
Auxiliary input jack ...................................342
USBport...........................................344
Rear seat entertainment system...........................344
SYNC® 364
Pairing your phone for the first time .......................370
911 Assist™ .........................................384
Vehicle Health Report ..................................386
Navigation System (If Equipped) 412
Statusbars..........................................415
Loading pictures......................................416
Voice recognition .....................................417
Accessing media features ...............................423
Jukebox features .....................................441
Recording (saving) music to your jukebox ...................441
Accessing the music in your jukebox .......................441
Creating a playlist.....................................443
Where am I?.........................................444
Accessing the help screen ...............................447
Navigation features ....................................448
Table of Contents 7
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Appendices 468
Navigation end user license agreement......................475
Scheduled Maintenance 481
Normal scheduled maintenance and log .....................486
Index 498
The information contained in this publication was correct at the time of going to
print. In the interest of continuous development, we reserve the right to change
specifications, design or equipment at any time without notice or obligation.
No part of this publication may be reproduced, transmitted, stored in a retrieval
system or translated into any language in any form by any means without our
written permission. Errors and omissions excepted.
© Ford Motor Company 2013
8 Table of Contents
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ABOUT THIS MANUAL
Thank you for choosing Ford. We recommend that you take some time to
get to know your vehicle by reading this manual. The more that you know
about it, the greater the safety and pleasure you will get from driving it.
WARNING: Always drive with due care and attention when
using and operating the controls and features on your vehicle.
Note: This manual describes product features and options available
throughout the range of available models, sometimes even before they
are generally available. It may describe options not fitted to your vehicle.
Note: Some of the illustrations in this manual may be used for different
models, so may appear different to you on your vehicle. However, the
essential information in the illustrations is always correct.
Note: Always use and operate your vehicle in line with all applicable
laws and regulations.
Note: Pass on this manual when selling your vehicle. It is an integral
part of the vehicle.
This manual may qualify the location of a component as left-hand side or
right-hand side. The side is determined when facing forward in the seat.
A. Right-hand side
B. Left-hand side
Protecting the Environment
You must play your part in protecting the environment. Correct
vehicle usage and the authorized disposal of waste, cleaning
and lubrication materials are significant steps toward this aim.
SYMBOL GLOSSARY
WARNING: You risk death or serious injury to yourself and
others if you do not follow the instruction highlighted by the
warning symbol.
A
B
Introduction 9
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
These are some of the symbols you may see on your vehicle.
Symbol Description Symbol Description Symbol Description
Safety alert See Owner’s
Manual
Anti-lock
braking
system
Avoid
smoking,
flames, or
sparks
Battery Battery acid
Brake
fluid non
petroleum
base
Brake
system
Cabin air
filter
Check fuel
cap
Child Safety
Door Lock
and Unlock
Child seat
lower anchor
Child seat
tether
anchor
Cruise
control
Do not open
when hot
Engine air
filter
Engine
coolant
Engine
coolant
temperature
Engine oil Explosive
gas
Fan warning
Fasten
safety belt
Front airbag Front fog
lamps
Fuel pump
reset
Fuse
compartment
Hazard
warning
flasher
Heated rear
window
Interior
luggage
compartment
release
Jack
10 Introduction
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Symbol Description Symbol Description Symbol Description
Lighting
control
Low tire
pressure
warning
Maintain
correct fluid
level
Panic alarm Parking aid
system
Parking
brake system
Power
steering fluid
Power
windows
front and
rear
Power
window
lockout
Service
engine soon
Side airbag Stability
control
Windshield
defrost and
demist
Windshield
washer and
wiper
Introduction 11
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
DATA RECORDING
Service Data Recording
Service data recorders in your vehicle are capable of collecting and
storing diagnostic information about your vehicle. This potentially
includes information about the performance or status of various systems
and modules in the vehicle, such as engine, throttle, steering or brake
systems. In order to properly diagnose and service your vehicle, Ford
Motor Company, Ford of Canada, and service and repair facilities may
access or share among them vehicle diagnostic information received
through a direct connection to your vehicle when diagnosing or servicing
your vehicle. Additionally, when your vehicle is in for service or repair,
Ford Motor Company, Ford of Canada, and service and repair facilities
may access or share among them data for vehicle improvement purposes.
For U.S. only (if equipped), if you choose to use the SYNC® Vehicle
Health Report, you consent that certain diagnostic information may also
be accessed electronically by Ford Motor Company and Ford authorized
service facilities, and that the diagnostic information may be used for any
purpose. See the SYNC® chapter for more information.
Event Data Recording
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR).
The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near
crash-like situations, such as an airbag deployment or hitting a
road obstacle; this data will assist in understanding how a
vehicle’s systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data
related to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period
of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is
designed to record such data as:
How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were
buckled/fastened;
How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator
and/or the brake pedal;
How fast the vehicle was travelling;
Where the driver was positioning the steering wheel.
This data can help provide a better understanding of the
circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.
12 Introduction
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: EDR data is recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial
crash situation occurs; no data is recorded by the EDR under
normal driving conditions and no personal data or information
(e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location) is recorded (see
limitations regarding 911 Assist and Traffic, Directions and
Information privacy below). However, parties, such as law
enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of
personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash
investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required,
and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the
vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that
have such special equipment, can read the information if they have
access to the vehicle or the EDR. Ford Motor Company and Ford
of Canada do not access event data recorder information without
obtaining consent, unless pursuant to court order or where
required by law enforcement, other government authorities or
other third parties acting with lawful authority. Other parties may
seek to access the information independently of Ford Motor
Company and Ford of Canada.
Note: Including to the extent that any law pertaining to Event
Data Recorders applies to SYNC® or its features, please note
the following: Once 911 Assist (if equipped) is enabled (set ON),
911 Assist may, through any paired and connected cell phone,
disclose to emergency services that the vehicle has been in a
crash involving the deployment of an airbag or, in certain
vehicles, the activation of the fuel pump shut-off. Certain
versions or updates to 911 Assist may also be capable of being
used to electronically or verbally provide to 911 operators the
vehicle location (such as latitude and longitude), and/or other
details about the vehicle or crash or personal information about
the occupants to assist 911 operators to provide the most
appropriate emergency services. If you do not want to disclose
this information, do not activate the 911 Assist feature. See your
SYNC® chapter for more information.
Introduction 13
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Additionally, when you connect to Traffic, Directions and
Information (if equipped, U.S. only), the service uses GPS
technology and advanced vehicle sensors to collect the vehicle’s
current location, travel direction, and speed (“vehicle travel
information”), only to help provide you with the directions,
traffic reports, or business searches that you request. If you do
not want Ford or its vendors to receive this information, do not
activate the service. Ford Motor Company and the vendors it uses
to provide you with this information do not store your vehicle
travel information. For more information, see Traffic, Directions
and Information, Terms and Conditions. See your SYNC® chapter
for more information.
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65
WARNING: Some constituents of engine exhaust, certain vehicle
components, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain
products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known to
the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other
reproductive harm.
PERCHLORATE MATERIAL
Note: Certain components in your vehicle, such as airbag modules,
safety belt pretensioners, and remote control batteries, may contain
perchlorate material. Special handling may apply for service or vehicle
end of life disposal. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate for
more information.
FORD CREDIT (U.S. ONLY)
Ford Credit offers a full range of financing and lease plans to help you
acquire your vehicle. If you have financed or leased your vehicle through
Ford Credit, thank you for your business.
For your convenience, we offer a number of ways to contact us, as well
as help manage your account.
Phone: 1-800-727-7000
For more information regarding Ford Credit, as well as access to
Account Manager, please go to www.fordcredit.com.
14 Introduction
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
REPLACEMENT PARTS RECOMMENDATION
Your vehicle has been built to the highest standards using quality parts. We
recommend that you demand the use of genuine Ford and Motorcraft parts
whenever your vehicle requires scheduled maintenance or repair. You can
clearly identify genuine Ford and Motorcraft parts by looking for the Ford,
FoMoCo or Motorcraft branding on the parts or their packaging.
Scheduled Maintenance and Mechanical Repairs
One of the best ways for you to make sure that your vehicle provides years
of service is to have it maintained in line with our recommendations using
parts that conform to the specifications detailed in this owner’s manual.
Genuine Ford and Motorcraft parts meet or exceed these specifications.
Collision Repairs
We hope that you never experience a collision, but accidents do
happen. Genuine Ford replacement collision parts meet our stringent
requirements for fit, finish, structural integrity, corrosion protection and
dent resistance. During vehicle development, we validate that these parts
deliver the intended level of protection as a whole system. A great way
to know for sure you are getting this level of protection is to use genuine
Ford replacement collision parts.
Warranty on Replacement Parts
Genuine Ford and Motorcraft replacement parts are the only
replacement parts that benefit from a Ford Warranty. Damage caused
to your vehicle as a result of the failure of non-Ford parts may not be
covered by the Ford Warranty. For additional information, see the terms
and conditions of the Ford Warranty.
SPECIAL NOTICES
New Vehicle Limited Warranty
For a detailed description of what is covered and what is not covered
by your vehicle’s New Vehicle Limited Warranty, see the warranty
information that is provided to you along with your owner’s manual.
Introduction 15
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Special Instructions
For your added safety, your vehicle is fitted with sophisticated electronic
controls.
WARNING: Please read the Supplementary Restraints System
chapter. Failure to follow the specific warnings and instructions
could result in personal injury.
WARNING: Front seat mounted rear-facing child or infant seats
should NEVER be placed in front of an active passenger airbag.
Using your vehicle with a snowplow
Do not use this vehicle for snowplowing.
Your vehicle is not equipped with a snowplowing package.
Using your vehicle as an ambulance
Do not use this vehicle as an ambulance.
Your vehicle is not equipped with the Ford Ambulance Preparation
Package.
MOBILE COMMUNICATIONS EQUIPMENT
Using mobile communications equipment is becoming increasingly
important in the conduct of business and personal affairs. However, you
must not compromise your own or others’ safety when using such
equipment. Mobile communications can enhance personal safety and
security when appropriately used, particularly in emergency situations.
Safety must be paramount when using mobile communications
equipment to avoid negating these benefits.
Mobile communication equipment includes, but is not limited to, cellular
phones, pagers, portable email devices, text messaging devices and
portable two-way radios.
16 Introduction
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle
control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use
extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off
the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your
vehicle. We recommend against the use of any handheld device while
driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible.
Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the
use of electronic devices while driving.
EXPORT UNIQUE (NON–UNITED STATES/CANADA) VEHICLE
SPECIFIC INFORMATION
For your particular global region, your vehicle may be equipped with
features and options that are different from the features and options that
are described in this owner’s manual. A market unique supplement may
be supplied that complements this book. By referring to the market
unique supplement, if provided, you can properly identify those features,
recommendations and specifications that are unique to your vehicle.
This owner’s manual is written primarily for the U.S. and Canadian
Markets. Features or equipment listed as standard may be different
on units built for Export. See this owner’s manual for all other
required information and warnings.
Introduction 17
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL INFORMATION
See the following sections for directions on how to properly use safety
restraints for children.
WARNING: Always make sure your child is secured properly in a
device that is appropriate for their height, age and weight. Child
safety restraints must be bought separately from your vehicle. Failure
to follow these instructions and guidelines may result in an increased
risk of serious injury or death to your child.
WARNING:
All children are shaped differently. The
recommendations for safety restraints are based on probable
child height, age and weight thresholds from NHTSA and other safety
organizations, or are the minimum requirements of law. Ford recommends
checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger Safety Technician
(CPST) and consulting your pediatrician to make sure your child seat is
appropriate for your child, and is compatible with and properly installed
in your vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station and CPST, contact
the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or on the internet at
http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov. In Canada, check with your local St. John
Ambulance office for referral to a CPST or for further information,
contact your provincial ministry of transportation, or locate your local
St. John Ambulance office by searching for St. John Ambulance on the
internet, or Transport Canada at 1–800–333–0371 (http://www.tc.gc.ca).
Failure to properly restrain children in safety seats made especially for
their height, age, and weight may result in an increased risk of serious
injury or death to your child.
Recommendations for Safety Restraints for Children
Child size, height, weight, or age
Recommended
restraint type
Infants or
toddlers
Children weighing 40 lb (18 kg) or less
(generally age four or younger).
Use a child safety
seat (sometimes
called an infant
carrier, convertible
seat, or toddler
seat).
18 Child Safety
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Recommendations for Safety Restraints for Children
Child size, height, weight, or age
Recommended
restraint type
Small
children
Children who have outgrown or no
longer properly fit in a child safety
seat (generally children who are less
than 4 ft. 9 in. (1.45 m) tall, are
greater than age four (4) and less than
age twelve (12), and between 40 lb
(18 kg) and 80 lb (36 kg) and upward
to 100 lb (45 kg) if recommended by
your child restraint manufacturer).
Use a
belt-positioning
booster seat.
Larger
children
Children who have outgrown or no
longer properly fit in a belt-positioning
booster seat (generally children who
are at least 4 ft. 9 in. (1.45 m) tall or
greater than 80 lb (36 kg) or 100 lb
(45 kg) if recommended by child
restraint manufacturer).
Use a vehicle
safety belt having
the lap belt snug
and low across the
hips, shoulder belt
centered across
the shoulder and
chest, and seat
back upright.
You are required by law to properly use safety seats for infants and
toddlers in the U.S. and Canada.
Many states and provinces require that small children use approved
booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 feet 9 inches
(1.45 meters) tall, or 80 pounds (36 kilograms). Check your local and
state or provincial laws for specific requirements about the safety of
children in your vehicle.
When possible, always properly restrain children twelve (12) years of
age and under in a rear seating position of your vehicle. Accident
statistics suggest that children are safer when properly restrained in
the rear seating positions than in a front seating position.
Child Safety 19
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CHILD SEAT POSITIONING
WARNING: Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.
Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag.
If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the
vehicle seat upon which the child seat is installed all the way back.
When possible, all children age 12 and under should be properly
restrained in a rear seating position. If all children cannot be seated and
restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the
largest child in the front seat.
WARNING: Always carefully follow the instructions and
warnings provided by the manufacturer of any child restraint to
determine if the restraint device is appropriate for your child’s size,
height, weight, or age. Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s
instructions and warnings provided for installation and use in
conjunction with the instructions and warnings provided by your
vehicle manufacturer. A safety seat that is improperly installed or
utilized, is inappropriate for your child’s height, age or weight, or does
not properly fit the child, may increase the risk of serious injury or
death.
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap
while your vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the
child from injury in a crash, which may result in serious injury or death.
WARNING: Never use pillows, books, or towels to boost a child.
They can slide around and increase the likelihood of injury or
death in a crash.
WARNING: Always restrain an unoccupied child seat or booster
seat. These objects may become projectiles in a crash or sudden
stop, which may increase the risk of serious injury.
20 Child Safety
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk
of injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: To avoid risk of injury, do not leave children or pets
unattended in your vehicle.
Restraint
Type
Combined
weight of
child and
child
restraint
seat
Use any attachment method as indicated
below by X.
LATCH
(lower
anchors
and top
tether
anchor)
LATCH
(lower
anchors
only)
Safety
belt
and
top
tether
anchor
Safety
belt
and
LATCH
(lower
anchors
and top
tether
anchor)
Safety
belt
only
Rear-
facing
child seat
Up to 65 lb
(29.5 kg) XX
Rear-
facing
child seat
Over 65 lb
(29.5 kg) X
Forward-
facing
child seat
Up to 65 lb
(29.5 kg) XXX
Forward-
facing
child seat
Over 65 lb
(29.5 kg) XX
Note: The child seat must rest tightly against the vehicle seat upon
which it is installed. It may be necessary to lift or remove the head
restraint. See the Seats chapter for information on head restraints.
Child Safety 21
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
BOOSTER SEATS
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk
of injury or death in a crash.
Use a belt-positioning booster seat for children who have outgrown or no
longer properly fit in a child safety seat (generally children who are less
than 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall, are greater than age four (4) and
less than age twelve (12), and between 40 pounds (18 kilograms) and
80 pounds (36 kilograms) and upward to 100 pounds (45 kilograms) if
recommended by your child restraint manufacturer). Many state and
provincial laws require that children use approved booster seats until
they reach age eight (8), a height of 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall,
or 80 pounds (36 kilograms).
Booster seats should be used until you can answer YES to ALL of these
questions when the child is seated without a booster seat.
Can the child sit all the way
back against their vehicle seat
with knees bent comfortably at
the edge of the seat cushion?
Can the child sit without
slouching?
Does the lap belt rest low across the hips?
Is the shoulder belt centered on the shoulder and chest?
Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?
Always use booster seats in conjunction with your vehicle lap and
shoulder belt.
22 Child Safety
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Types of Booster Seats
Backless booster seats
If your backless booster seat has a removable shield, remove the shield.
If a vehicle seating position has a low seat back or no head restraint, a
backless booster seat may place your child’s head (as measured at the
tops of the ears) above the top of the seat. In this case, move the
backless booster to another seating position with a higher seat back or
head restraint and lap and shoulder belts, or consider using a high back
booster seat.
High back booster seats
If, with a backless booster seat, you cannot find a seating position that
adequately supports your child’s head, a high back booster seat would be
a better choice.
Child Safety 23
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Children and booster seats vary in size and shape. Choose a booster that
keeps the lap belt low and snug across the hips, never up across the
stomach, and lets you adjust the shoulder belt to cross the chest and rest
snugly near the center of the shoulder. The following drawings compare
the ideal fit (center) to a shoulder belt uncomfortably close to the neck
and a shoulder belt that could slip off the shoulder. The drawings also
show how the lap belt should be low and snug across the child’s hips.
If the booster seat slides on the vehicle seat upon which it is being used,
placing a rubberized mesh sold as shelf or carpet liner under the booster
seat may improve this condition. Do not introduce any item thicker than
this under the booster seat. Check with the booster seat manufacturer’s
instructions.
24 Child Safety
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
INSTALLING CHILD SEATS
Child Seats
Use a child safety seat (sometimes
called an infant carrier, convertible
seat, or toddler seat) for infants,
toddlers or children weighing
40 pounds (18 kilograms) or less
(generally age four or younger).
Using Lap and Shoulder Belts
WARNING: Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.
Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag.
If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the
seat upon which the child seat is installed all the way back.
WARNING: Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.
Children 12 and under should be properly restrained in the rear
seat whenever possible.
WARNING: Depending on where you secure a child restraint,
and depending on the child restraint design, you may block
access to certain safety belt buckle assemblies or LATCH lower
anchors, rendering those features potentially unusable. To avoid risk of
injury, occupants should only use seating positions where they are able
to be properly restrained.
When installing a child safety seat with combination lap/shoulder belts:
Use the correct safety belt buckle for that seating position.
Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle until you hear a snap
and feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened in the
buckle.
Child Safety 25
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Keep the buckle release button pointing up and away from the safety
seat, with the tongue between the child seat and the release button,
to prevent accidental unbuckling.
Place the vehicle seat upon which the child seat will be installed in
the upright position.
Put the safety belt in the automatic locking mode. See Step 5. This
vehicle does not require the use of a locking clip.
Perform the following steps when installing the child seat with
combination lap and shoulder belts:
Note: Although the child seat illustrated is a forward facing child seat,
the steps are the same for installing a rear facing child seat.
1. Position the child safety seat in a
seat with a combination lap and
shoulder belt.
2. Pull down on the shoulder belt
and then grasp the shoulder belt
and lap belt together.
26 Child Safety
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
3.
While holding the shoulder
and lap belt portions together,
route the tongue through the child
seat according to the child seat
manufacturer’s instructions. Be sure
the belt webbing is not twisted.
4. Insert the belt tongue into the
proper buckle (the buckle closest to
the direction the tongue is coming
from) for that seating position until
you hear a snap and feel the latch
engage. Make sure the tongue is
latched securely by pulling on it.
5. To put the retractor in the
automatic locking mode, grasp the
shoulder portion of the belt and pull
downward until all of the belt is
pulled out.
Note: The automatic locking mode is available on the front passenger
and rear seats. This vehicle does not require the use of a locking clip.
6. Allow the belt to retract to remove slack. The belt will click as it
retracts to indicate it is in the automatic locking mode.
7. Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is
in the automatic locking mode (you should not be able to pull more belt
out). If the retractor is not locked, unbuckle the belt and repeat Steps 5
and 6.
Child Safety 27
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
8. Remove remaining slack from the
belt. Force the seat down with extra
weight, for example, by pressing
down or kneeling on the child
restraint while pulling up on the
shoulder belt in order to force slack
from the belt.
This is necessary to remove the remaining slack that will exist once the
extra weight of the child is added to the child restraint. It also helps to
achieve the proper snugness of the child seat to your vehicle.
Sometimes, a slight lean toward the buckle will provide extra help to
remove remaining slack from the belt.
9. Attach the tether strap (if the child seat is equipped). See Using
Tether Straps in this chapter.
10. Before placing the child in the
seat, forcibly move the seat forward
and back to make sure the seat is
securely held in place.
To check this, grab the seat at the belt path and attempt to move it side
to side and forward and back. There should be no more than 1 inch
(2.5 centimeters) of movement for proper installation.
Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger
Safety Technician to make certain the child restraint is properly installed.
In Canada, check with your local St. John Ambulance office for referral
to a Child Passenger Safety Technician.
28 Child Safety
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Using Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren (LATCH)
WARNING: Never attach two child safety seats to the same
anchor. In a crash, one anchor may not be strong enough to hold
two child safety seat attachments and may break, causing serious injury
or death.
The LATCH system is composed of three vehicle anchor points: two
lower anchors located where the vehicle seat back and seat cushion meet
(called the seat bight) and one top tether anchor located behind that
seating position.
Child Safety 29
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
LATCH compatible child safety seats have two rigid or webbing mounted
attachments that connect to the two lower anchors at the LATCH equipped
seating positions in your vehicle. This type of attachment method
eliminates the need to use safety belts to attach the child seat, however
the safety belt can still be used to attach the child seat. For forward-facing
child seats, the top tether strap must also be attached to the proper top
tether anchor, if a top tether strap has been provided with your child seat.
Ford Motor Company recommends the use of a child safety seat having a
top tether strap. See Using Tether Straps in this chapter.
Your vehicle has LATCH lower anchors for child seat installation at the
seating positions marked with the child seat symbol.
30 Child Safety
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
The LATCH anchors are located at the rear section of the rear seat
between the cushion and seat back, below the locator symbols on the
seat back. Follow the child seat manufacturer’s instructions to properly
install a child seat with LATCH attachments.
The locator symbols are on round plastic buttons for the center seat and
on rectangular tags for the outboard seats.
Follow the instructions on attaching child safety seats with tether straps.
See Using Tether Straps in this chapter.
Attach LATCH lower attachments of the child seat only to the anchors
shown.
Each time you use the safety seat, check that the seat is properly
attached to the lower anchors and tether anchor, if applicable. Tug the
child seat from side to side and forward and back where it is secured to
the vehicle. The seat should move less than one inch when you do this
for a proper installation.
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being
injured in a crash greatly increases.
Combining Safety Belt and LATCH Lower Anchors for Attaching
Child Safety Seats
When used in combination, either the safety belt or the LATCH lower
anchors may be attached first, provided a proper installation is achieved.
Attach the tether strap afterward, if included with the child seat.
Using Tether Straps
Many forward-facing child safety seats include a tether strap
which extends from the back of the child safety seat and hooks
to an anchoring point called the top tether anchor.
Tether straps are available as an accessory for many older safety seats.
Contact the manufacturer of your child seat for information about
Child Safety 31
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ordering a tether strap, or to obtain a longer tether strap if the tether
strap on your safety seat does not reach the appropriate top tether
anchor in the vehicle.
Some of the rear seats of your vehicle are equipped with built-in tether
strap anchors located behind the seats as described below.
In the third row center seating position, the tether anchor is a loop at
the bottom of the seat back.
The tether strap anchors in your vehicle are in the following positions
(shown from top view).
Second row bench seat
Second row bucket seats
Attach the tether strap only to the appropriate tether anchor as shown.
The tether strap may not work properly if attached somewhere other
than the correct tether anchor.
Once the child safety seat has been installed using either the safety belt,
the lower anchors of the LATCH system, or both, you can attach the top
tether strap.
If you install a child seat with rigid LATCH attachments, and have
attached the top tether strap to the proper top tether anchor, do not
tighten the tether strap enough to lift the child seat off the vehicle seat
cushion when the child is seated in it. Keep the tether strap just snug
without lifting the front of the child seat. Keeping the child seat just
touching the vehicle seat gives the best protection in a severe crash.
32 Child Safety
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Perform the following steps to install a child safety seat with tether
anchors:
Second row seating positions
1. For center seating positions, route the child safety seat tether strap
over the back of the seat.
For outboard seating positions, route the tether strap under the head
restraint and between the head restraint posts. If the top of the safety
seat hits the head restraint, recline the seat back slightly to obtain
proper fit.
2. Locate the correct anchor for the selected seating position.
Second row outboard seating
positions
Second row center seating
position (if equipped)
Child Safety 33
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
3. Grasp the tether strap and
position it to the seat frame.
4. Rotate the tether strap, and clip
the tether strap to the anchor on
the seat frame.
5. Rotate the tether strap clip.
6. Tighten the child safety seat tether strap according to the
manufacturer’s instructions.
34 Child Safety
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Third row center seating position
1. Route the child safety seat tether strap over the back of the seat.
2. Locate the anchor webbing loop for the seating position.
You may need to pull back the top of the hinged panel along the
bottom of the seat back to access the tether anchor.
Child Safety 35
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
3. Clip the tether strap through the anchor loop as shown. If the tether
strap is clipped incorrectly, the child safety seat may not be retained
properly in the event of a crash.
4. Tighten the child safety seat
tether strap according to the
manufacturer’s instructions. If the
safety seat is not anchored properly,
the risk of a child being injured in a
crash greatly increases.
If your child restraint system is equipped with a tether strap, and the
child restraint manufacturer recommends its use, Ford also recommends
its use.
36 Child Safety
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CHILD SAFETY LOCKS
When these locks are set, the rear doors cannot be opened from the
inside.
The childproof locks are located on
the rear edge of each rear door and
must be set separately for each
door.
Move the lock control up to engage
the childproof lock.
Move it down to disengage the lock.
Child Safety 37
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
WARNING: Always drive and ride with your seat back upright
and the lap belt snug and low across the hips.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of injury, make sure children sit
where they can be properly restrained.
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the
child from injury in a crash.
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an
airbag supplemental restraint system is provided. Failure to properly
wear your safety belt could seriously increase the risk of injury or
death.
WARNING: It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a crash, people riding in these
areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed. Do not allow
people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with
seats and safety belts. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a safety belt properly.
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a safety
belt.
WARNING: Each seating position in your vehicle has a specific
safety belt assembly which is made up of one buckle and one
tongue that are designed to be used as a pair. 1) Use the shoulder belt
on the outside shoulder only. Never wear the shoulder belt under the
arm. 2) Never swing the safety belt around your neck over the inside
shoulder. 3) Never use a single belt for more than one person.
38 Safety Belts
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WARNING: When possible, all children 12 years old and under
should be properly restrained in a rear seating position. Failure
to follow this could seriously increase the risk of injury or death.
WARNING: Safety belts and seats can become hot in a vehicle
that has been closed up in sunny weather; they could burn a
small child. Check seat covers and buckles before you place a child
anywhere near them.
WARNING: Front and rear seat occupants, including pregnant
women, should wear safety belts for optimum protection in an
accident.
All seating positions in this vehicle have lap and shoulder safety belts. All
occupants of the vehicle should always properly wear their safety belts,
even when an airbag supplemental restraint system is provided.
The safety belt system consists of:
lap and shoulder safety belts.
shoulder safety belt with automatic locking mode, (except driver
safety belt).
height adjuster at the front outboard seating positions
safety belt pretensioner at the front outboard seating positions.
safety belt warning light and chime. See Safety Belt
Warning Light and Indicator Chime later in this chapter.
crash sensors and monitoring system with readiness
indicator. See Crash Sensors and Airbag Indicator in the
Supplemental Restraints System chapter.
The safety belt pretensioners are designed to activate in frontal,
near-frontal and side crashes, and in rollovers. The safety belt
pretensioners at the front seating positions are designed to tighten the
safety belts firmly against the occupant’s body when activated. This helps
increase the effectiveness of the safety belts. In frontal crashes, the
safety belt pretensioners can be activated alone or, if the crash is of
sufficient severity, together with the front airbags.
Safety Belts 39
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
FASTENING THE SAFETY BELTS
The front outboard and rear safety restraints in your vehicle are
combination lap and shoulder belts.
1. Insert the belt tongue into the
proper buckle (the buckle closest to
the direction the tongue is coming
from) until you hear a snap and feel
it latch. Make sure the tongue is
securely fastened in the buckle.
2. To unfasten, press the release
button and remove the tongue from
the buckle.
Restraint of Pregnant Women
WARNING: Always ride and drive with your seatback upright
and the safety belt properly fastened. The lap portion of the
safety belt should fit snug and be positioned low across the hips.
The shoulder portion of the safety belt should be positioned across
the chest. Pregnant women should also follow this practice. See the
following figure.
40 Safety Belts
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Pregnant women should always
wear their safety belts. The lap belt
portion of a combination lap and
shoulder belt should be positioned
low across the hips below the belly
and worn as tight as comfort will
allow. The shoulder belt should be
positioned to cross the middle of
the shoulder and the center of the
chest.
Safety Belt Locking Modes
WARNING: After any vehicle crash, the safety belt system at all
passenger seating positions must be checked by an authorized
dealer to verify that the automatic locking retractor feature for child
seats is still functioning properly. In addition, all safety belts should be
checked for proper function.
WARNING: The belt and retractor assembly must be replaced if
the safety belt assembly automatic locking retractor feature or
any other safety belt function is not operating properly when checked
by an authorized dealer. Failure to replace the belt and retractor
assembly could increase the risk of injury in crashes.
All safety restraints in the vehicle are combination lap and shoulder
belts. The driver safety belt has the first type of locking mode, and the
front outboard passenger and rear seat safety belts have both types of
locking modes described as follows:
Vehicle Sensitive Mode
This is the normal retractor mode, which allows free shoulder belt length
adjustment to your movements and locking in response to vehicle
movement. For example, if the driver brakes suddenly or turns a corner
sharply, or the vehicle receives an impact of about 5 mph (8 km/h) or
more, the combination safety belts will lock to help reduce forward
movement of the driver and passengers.
In addition, the retractor is designed to lock if the webbing is pulled out
too quickly. If this occurs, let the belt retract slightly and pull webbing
out again in a slow and controlled manner.
Safety Belts 41
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Automatic Locking Mode
In this mode, the shoulder belt is automatically pre-locked. The belt will
still retract to remove any slack in the shoulder belt. The automatic
locking mode is not available on the driver safety belt.
When to Use the Automatic Locking Mode
This mode should be used any time a child safety seat, except a booster,
is installed in passenger front or rear seating positions. Children 12 years
old and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating position
whenever possible. See the Child Safety chapter.
How to Use the Automatic Locking Mode
1. Buckle the combination lap and shoulder
belt.
2. Grasp the shoulder portion and pull
downward until the entire belt is pulled out.
3. Allow the belt to retract. As the belt
retracts, you will hear a clicking sound.
This indicates the safety belt is now in the
automatic locking mode.
How to Disengage the Automatic Locking Mode
Unbuckle the combination lap and shoulder belt and allow it to retract
completely to disengage the automatic locking mode and activate the
vehicle sensitive (emergency) locking mode.
Safety Belt Extension Assembly
WARNING: Do not use extensions to change the fit of the
shoulder belt across the torso.
If the safety belt is too short when fully extended, you can obtain a
safety belt extension assembly from an authorized dealer.
Use only extensions manufactured by the same supplier as the safety
belt. Manufacturer identification is located at the end of the webbing on
the label. Also, use the safety belt extension only if the safety belt is too
short for you when fully extended.
42 Safety Belts
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SAFETY BELT HEIGHT ADJUSTMENT
WARNING: Position the safety belt height adjusters so that the
belt rests across the middle of your shoulder. Failure to adjust
the safety belt properly could reduce the effectiveness of the seat belt
and increase the risk of injury in a crash.
Adjust the height of the shoulder belt so the belt rests across the middle
of your shoulder.
To adjust the shoulder belt height:
1. Squeeze the side release buttons
and slide the height adjuster up or
down.
2. Pull down on the height adjuster
to make sure it is locked in place.
Second Row Comfort Guide
WARNING: Position the safety belt comfort guide so that the
belt rests across the middle of your shoulder. Failure to adjust
the safety belt properly could reduce the effectiveness of the safety belt
and increase the risk of injury in a crash.
The second row outboard lap and
shoulder belt is equipped with a belt
comfort guide. This guide is attached
to the quarter trim panel. Use it to
adjust the comfort of the shoulder belt
for smaller occupants in the outboard
second row seats.
Safety Belts 43
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
To adjust the comfort guide:
1. Slip the shoulder belt into the
belt guide (the portion of the belt
between the latch tongue and the
D-ring, not the portion where the
belt exits from the quarter trim
panel).
2. Slide the guide up or down along the webbing so that the belt is
centered on the occupant’s shoulder.
SAFETY BELT WARNING LIGHT AND INDICATOR CHIME
This lamp illuminates and an audible warning will sound if the
driver’s safety belt has not been fastened when the vehicle’s
ignition is turned on.
Conditions of Operation
If... Then...
The driver’s safety belt is not
buckled before the ignition
switch is turned to the on
position...
The safety belt warning light
illuminates 1-2 minutes and the
warning chime sounds 4-8 seconds.
The driver’s safety belt is
buckled while the indicator
light is illuminated and the
warning chime is sounding...
The safety belt warning light and
warning chime turn off.
The driver’s safety belt is
buckled before the ignition
switch is turned to the on
position...
The safety belt warning light and
indicator chime remain off.
44 Safety Belts
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SAFETY BELT-MINDER®
This feature supplements the safety belt warning function by providing
additional reminders by intermittently sounding a chime and illuminating
the safety belt warning light when the driver’s seat is occupied and the
safety belt is unbuckled.
If... Then...
The driver’s safety belt is
buckled before the ignition
switch is turned to the on
position or less than
1-2 minutes have elapsed since
the ignition switch has been
turned to on...
The Belt-Minder feature will not
activate.
The driver’s safety belt is not
buckled when the vehicle has
reached at least 6 mph
(9.7 km/h) and 1-2 minutes
have elapsed since the ignition
switch has been turned to on...
The Belt-Minder feature is activated -
the safety belt warning light
illuminates and the warning chime
sounds for six seconds every
25 seconds, repeating for about five
minutes or until the safety belts are
buckled.
The driver’s safety belt
becomes unbuckled for about
one minute while the vehicle
is traveling at least 6 mph
(9.7 km/h) and more than
1-2 minutes have elapsed since
the ignition switch has been
turned to on...
The Belt-Minder feature is activated -
the safety belt warning light
illuminates and the warning chime
sounds for six seconds every
25 seconds, repeating for about five
minutes or until the safety belts are
buckled.
Safety Belts 45
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Deactivating and Activating the Belt-Minder® Feature
WARNING: While the design allows you to deactivate your
Belt-Minder, this system is designed to improve your chances of
being safely belted and surviving an accident. We recommend you leave
the Belt-Minder system activated for yourself and others who may use
the vehicle. To reduce the risk of injury, do not deactivate or activate
the Belt-Minder feature while driving the vehicle.
Read Steps1-4thoroughly before proceeding with the programming
procedure.
The Belt-Minder feature can be deactivated or activated by performing
the following procedure.
Before following the procedure, make sure that:
the parking brake is set.
the transmission selector lever is in position P.
the ignition is off.
all vehicle doors are closed.
the driver’s safety belt is unbuckled.
1. Switch the ignition on. Do not start the engine.
2. Wait until the safety belt warning light turns off
(about 1 to 2 minutes).
Steps 3 and 4 must be completed within 60 seconds or the procedure
will have to be repeated.
3. Buckle then unbuckle the safety belt three times, ending with the
safety belt unbuckled. The safety belt warning light will come on for
about three seconds.
4. Within seven seconds of the safety belt warning light turning off,
buckle then unbuckle the safety belt. The safety warning light will flash.
This will disable Belt-Minder if it is currently enabled, or enable
Belt-Minder if it is currently disabled.
46 Safety Belts
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CHILD RESTRAINT AND SAFETY BELT MAINTENANCE
Inspect the vehicle safety belts and child safety seat systems periodically
to make sure they work properly and are not damaged. Inspect the
vehicle and child seat safety belts to make sure there are no nicks, tears
or cuts. Replace if necessary. All vehicle safety belt assemblies, including
retractors, buckles, front safety belt buckle assemblies, buckle support
assemblies (slide bar-if equipped), shoulder belt height adjusters
(if equipped), shoulder belt guide on seat back (if equipped), child
safety seat LATCH and tether anchors, and attaching hardware, should
be inspected after a crash. Read the child restraint manufacturer’s
instructions for additional inspection and maintenance information
specific to the child restraint.
Ford Motor Company recommends that all safety belt assemblies in use
in vehicles involved in a crash be replaced. However, if the crash was
minor and an authorized dealer finds that the belts do not show damage
and continue to operate properly, they do not need to be replaced.
Safety belt assemblies not in use during a crash should also be inspected
and replaced if either damage or improper operation is noted.
For proper care of soiled safety belts, see Cleaning the Interior in the
Vehicle Care chapter.
Safety Belts 47
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
WARNING: Airbags do not inflate slowly or gently, and the risk
of injury from a deploying airbag is the greatest close to the trim
covering the airbag module.
WARNING: All occupants of your vehicle, including the driver,
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an
airbag supplemental restraint system is provided. Failure to properly
wear your safety belt could seriously increase the risk of injury or
death.
WARNING: Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.
Always transport children 12 years old and under in the back
seat and always properly use appropriate child restraints.
WARNING: Never place your arm over the airbag module, as a
deploying airbag can result in serious arm fractures or other
injuries.
WARNING: Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.
Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag.
If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the
seat upon which the child seat is installed all the way back.
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the
airbag supplemental restraint systems or its fuses as you could be
seriously injured or killed. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as
possible.
WARNING: Several airbag system components get hot after
inflation. Do not touch them after inflation as this may result in
serious injury.
48 Supplementary Restraints System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WARNING: If the airbag has deployed, the airbag will not
function again and must be replaced immediately. If the airbag is
not replaced, the unrepaired area will increase the risk of injury in a
crash.
The airbags are a supplemental restraint system and are designed to
work with the safety belts to help protect the driver and right front
passenger from certain upper body injuries. Airbags do not inflate slowly;
there is a risk of injury from a deploying airbag.
Note: You will hear a loud bang and see a cloud of harmless powdery
residue if an airbag deploys. This is normal.
The airbags inflate and deflate rapidly upon activation. After airbag
deployment, it is normal to notice a smoke-like, powdery residue or smell
the burnt propellant. This may consist of cornstarch, talcum powder (to
lubricate the bag) or sodium compounds (for example, baking soda) that
result from the combustion process that inflates the airbag. Small amounts
of sodium hydroxide may be present which may irritate the skin and eyes,
but none of the residue is toxic.
While the system is designed to help reduce serious injuries, contact with a
deploying airbag may also cause abrasions or swelling. Temporary hearing
loss is also a possibility as a result of the noise associated with a deploying
airbag. Because airbags must inflate rapidly and with considerable force,
there is the risk of death or serious injuries, such as fractures, facial and
eye injuries or internal injuries, particularly to occupants who are not
properly restrained or are otherwise out of position at the time of airbag
deployment. Thus, it is extremely important that occupants be properly
restrained as far away from the airbag module as possible while maintaining
vehicle control.
Routine maintenance of the airbags is not required.
RESTRAINT SAFETY SYSTEM
The Restraint Safety System provides an improved overall level of frontal
crash protection to front seat occupants and is designed to help further
reduce the risk of airbag-related injuries. The system is able to analyze
different occupant conditions and crash severity before activating the
appropriate safety devices to help better protect a range of occupants in
a variety of frontal crash situations.
Supplementary Restraints System 49
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Your vehicle’s Restraint Safety System consists of:
driver and passenger dual-stage airbag supplemental restraints.
front outboard safety belts with pretensioners, energy management
retractors (first row only), and safety belt usage sensors.
driver’s seat position sensor.
front crash severity sensors.
restraints control module with impact and safing sensors.
restraint system warning light and backup tone.
the electrical wiring for the airbags, crash sensor(s), safety belt
pretensioners, front safety belt usage sensors, driver seat position
sensor, and indicator lights.
How does the Restraint Safety System work?
The Restraint Safety System can adapt the deployment strategy of
your vehicle’s safety devices according to crash severity and occupant
conditions. A collection of crash and occupant sensors provides
information to the restraints control module. During a crash, the
restraints control module may activate the safety belt pretensioners
and/or either one or both stages of the dual-stage airbag supplemental
restraints based on crash severity and occupant conditions.
SOS POST-CRASH ALERT SYSTEM™
The system flashes the turn signal lamps and sounds the horn
(intermittently) in the event of a serious impact that deploys an airbag
equipped on your vehicle, such as front, side, side curtain or Safety
Canopy.
The horn and lamps will turn off when:
you press the hazard control button
you press the panic button (if equipped) on the remote entry
transmitter, or
your vehicle runs out of power.
50 Supplementary Restraints System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
DRIVER AND PASSENGER AIRBAGS
WARNING: Never place your arm or any objects over an airbag
module. Placing your arm over a deploying airbag can result in
serious arm fractures or other injuries. Objects placed on or over the
airbag inflation area may cause those objects to be propelled by the
airbag into your face and torso causing serious injury.
WARNING: Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.
Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag.
If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the
seat upon which the child seat is installed all the way back.
The driver and front passenger
airbags will deploy during significant
frontal and near frontal crashes.
The driver and passenger front airbag system consists of:
driver and passenger airbag modules
crash sensors and monitoring system with readiness
indicator. See Crash Sensors and Airbag Indicator later in
this chapter.
Supplementary Restraints System 51
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Proper Driver and Front Passenger Seating Adjustment
WARNING: The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
recommends a minimum distance of at least 10 inches
(25 centimeters) between an occupant’s chest and the driver airbag
module. Failure to follow this could seriously increase the risk of injury
or death.
To properly position yourself away from the airbag:
Move your seat to the rear as far as you can while still reaching the
pedals comfortably.
Recline the seat slightly (one or two degrees) from the upright
position.
After all occupants have adjusted their seats and put on safety belts,
it is very important that they continue to sit properly. Properly seated
occupants sit upright, lean against the seat back, and center themselves
on the seat cushion, with their feet comfortably extended on the floor.
Sitting improperly can increase the chance of injury in a crash event. For
example, if an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward,
leans forward or sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of
injury during a crash is greatly increased.
Children and Airbags
WARNING: Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.
Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag.
If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the
seat upon which the child seat is installed all the way back.
Children must always be properly
restrained. Accident statistics
suggest that children are safer when
properly restrained in the rear
seating positions than in the front
seating position. Failure to follow
these instructions may increase the
risk of injury in a crash.
52 Supplementary Restraints System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SIDE AIRBAGS
WARNING: Do not place objects or mount equipment on or near
the airbag cover, on the side of the seat backs (of the front
seats), or in front seat areas that may come into contact with a
deploying airbag. Failure to follow these instructions may increase the
risk of personal injury in the event of a crash.
WARNING: Do not use accessory seat covers. The use of
accessory seat covers may prevent the deployment of the side
airbags and increase the risk of injury in an accident.
WARNING: Do not lean your head on the door. The side airbag
could injure you as it deploys from the side of the seat back.
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the
airbag, its fuses or the seat cover on a seat containing an airbag,
as you could be seriously injured or killed. Contact your authorized
dealer as soon as possible.
WARNING: If the side airbag has deployed, the airbag will not
function again. The side airbag system (including the seat) must
be inspected and serviced by an authorized dealer. If the airbag is not
replaced, the unrepaired area will increase the risk of injury in a crash.
The side airbags are located on the outboard side of the seat backs of
the front seats. In certain sideways crashes, the airbag on the side
affected by the crash will be inflated. The airbag was designed to inflate
between the door panel and occupant to further enhance the protection
provided occupants in side impact crashes.
Supplementary Restraints System 53
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
The system consists of the
following:
a label or embossed side panel
indicating that side airbags are
found on your vehicle
side airbags located inside the
seat back of the driver and front
passenger seats
crash sensors and monitoring system with readiness
indicator. See Crash Sensors and Airbag Indicator later in
this chapter.
The design and development of the side airbag system included
recommended testing procedures that were developed by a group of
automotive safety experts known as the Side Airbag Technical Working
Group. These recommended testing procedures help reduce the risk of
injuries related to the deployment of side airbags.
SAFETY CANOPY® CURTAIN AIRBAGS
WARNING: Do not place objects or mount equipment on or near
the headliner at the siderail that may come into contact with a
deploying curtain airbag. Failure to follow these instructions may
increase the risk of personal injury in the event of a crash.
WARNING: Do not lean your head on the door. The curtain
airbag could injure you as it deploys from the headliner.
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the
curtain airbags, its fuses, the A, B, or C pillar trim, or the
headliner on a vehicle containing curtain airbags, as you could be
seriously injured or killed. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as
possible.
54 Supplementary Restraints System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WARNING: All occupants of your vehicle including the driver
should always wear their safety belts even when an airbag
supplemental restraint system and curtain airbag is provided. Failure to
properly wear your safety belt could seriously increase the risk of injury
or death.
WARNING: To reduce risk of injury, do not obstruct or place
objects in the deployment path of the curtain airbag.
WARNING: If the curtain airbags have deployed, the curtain
airbags will not function again. The curtain airbags (including the
A, B and C pillar trim and headliner) must be inspected and serviced
by an authorized dealer. If the curtain airbag is not replaced, the
unrepaired area will increase the risk of injury in a crash.
The Safety Canopy will deploy during significant side crashes or when a
certain likelihood of a rollover event is detected by the rollover sensor.
The Safety Canopy is mounted to the roof side-rail sheet metal, behind
the headliner, above each row of seats. In certain sideways crashes or
rollover events, the Safety Canopy will be activated, regardless of which
seats are occupied. The Safety Canopy is designed to inflate between the
side window area and occupants to further enhance protection provided
in side impact crashes and rollover events.
The system consists of:
safety canopy curtain airbags
located above the trim panels
over the front and rear side
windows identified by wording
on the B-pillar trim.
a flexible headliner which opens above the side doors to allow air
curtain deployment.
crash sensors and monitoring system with readiness
indicator. See Crash Sensors and Airbag Indicator
in this chapter.
Supplementary Restraints System 55
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Children 12 years old and under should always be properly restrained
in the rear seats. The Safety Canopy will not interfere with children
restrained using a properly installed child or booster seat because it is
designed to inflate downward from the headliner above the doors along
the side window opening.
The design and development of the Safety Canopy included
recommended testing procedures that were developed by a group of
automotive safety experts known as the Side Airbag Technical Working
Group. These recommended testing procedures help reduce the risk of
injuries related to the deployment of side airbags (including the Safety
Canopy).
CRASH SENSORS AND AIRBAG INDICATOR
WARNING: Modifying or adding equipment to the front end of
your vehicle (including frame, bumper, front end body structure
and tow hooks) may affect the performance of the airbag system,
increasing the risk of injury. Do not modify the front end of your
vehicle.
Your vehicle has a collection of crash and occupant sensors which
provide information to the restraints control module. The restraints
control module deploys (activates) the front safety belt pretensioners,
driver airbag, passenger airbag, seat mounted side airbags, and the
Safety Canopy. Based on the type of accident (frontal impact, side
impact or rollover) the restraints control module will deploy the
appropriate safety devices.
The restraints control module also monitors the readiness of the above
safety devices plus the crash and occupant sensors. The readiness of the
safety system is indicated by a warning indicator light in the instrument
cluster or by a backup tone if the warning light is not working. See the
Instrument Cluster chapter. Routine maintenance of the airbag is not
required.
A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or more of the following:
The readiness light will either flash or stay lit.
The readiness light will not illuminate immediately after the
ignition is turned on.
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat
periodically until the problem or light are repaired.
56 Supplementary Restraints System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, have the supplemental
restraint system serviced at an authorized dealer immediately. Unless
serviced, the system may not function properly in the event of a crash.
The safety belt pretensioners and the airbag supplemental restraint
system are designed to activate when the vehicle sustains frontal or
sideways deceleration sufficient to cause the restraints control module to
deploy a safety device or when a certain likelihood of a rollover event is
detected by the rollover sensor.
The fact that the safety belt pretensioners or airbags did not activate for
both front seat occupants in a crash does not mean that something is
wrong with the system. Rather, it means the restraints control module
determined the accident conditions (for example, crash severity, belt
usage) were not appropriate to activate these safety devices.
The design of the front airbags is to activate only in frontal and
near-frontal crashes (not rollovers, side impacts or rear impacts)
unless the crash causes sufficient frontal deceleration.
The design of the safety belt pretensioners is to activate in frontal,
near-frontal and side crashes, and in rollovers.
The design of the side airbags is to inflate in certain side impact
crashes. Side airbags may activate in other types of crashes if the
vehicle experiences sufficient sideways motion or deformation.
The design of the Safety Canopy is to inflate in certain side impact
crashes or rollover events. The Safety Canopy may activate in other
types of crashes if the vehicle experiences sufficient sideways motion
or deformation, or a certain likelihood of rollover.
AIRBAG DISPOSAL
Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. Airbags must be
disposed of by qualified personnel.
Supplementary Restraints System 57
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL INFORMATION ON RADIO FREQUENCIES
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules and with Industry
Canada license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the
following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Note: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the
equipment. The term IC before the radio certification number only
signifies that Industry Canada technical specifications were met.
The typical operating range for your transmitter is approximately 33 feet
(10 meters). Vehicles with the remote start feature will have a greater
range. A decrease in operating range could be caused by:
weather conditions
nearby radio towers
structures around your vehicle
other vehicles parked next to your vehicle.
The radio frequency used by your remote control can also be used by
other short-distance radio transmissions, for example amateur radios,
medical equipment, wireless headphones, remote controls and alarm
systems. If the frequencies are jammed, you will not be able to use your
remote control. You can lock and unlock the doors with the key.
Note: Make sure your vehicle is locked before leaving it unattended.
Note: If you are in range, the remote control will operate if you press
any button unintentionally.
REMOTE CONTROL
Integrated Keyhead Transmitters
Your vehicle may be equipped
with two integrated keyhead
transmitters. The key blade is used
to start the vehicle and unlock or
lock the driver’s door from outside
the vehicle. The transmitter portion
functions as the remote control.
58 Keys and Remote Control
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: Your vehicle’s keys were
issued with a security label that
provides important vehicle key cut
information. Keep the label in a safe
place for future reference.
Replacing the Battery
Note: Refer to local regulations when disposing of transmitter batteries.
Note: Do not wipe off any grease on the battery terminals or on the
back surface of the circuit board.
Note: Replacing the battery will not delete the transmitter from your
vehicle. The transmitter should operate normally.
The remote control uses one coin-type three-volt lithium battery CR2032
or equivalent.
Integrated Keyhead Transmitter
1. Twist a thin coin in the slot near the key
ring to remove the battery cover (1).
2. Carefully peel up the rubber gasket (2)
from the transmitter if it does not come off
with the battery cover.
3. Remove the old battery (3).
4. Insert the new battery. Refer to the instructions inside the integrated
keyhead transmitter for the correct orientation of the battery. Press the
battery down to ensure that the battery is fully seated in the battery
housing cavity.
5. Reinstall the rubber gasket.
6. Snap the battery cover back onto the key.
3
2
1
Keys and Remote Control 59
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Memory Feature
The feature allows the remote control to recall the driver seat, power
mirrors, steering column and power adjustable foot pedals memory
positions.
Press the unlock button on the remote control to recall the memory
positions. If the easy entry and exit feature is enabled, the seat will move
to the easy entry position. The seat will move to the driver memory
position when the key is put in the ignition.
Programming Memory to the Remote Control
1. Switch on the ignition.
2. Move the memory features to the desired positions using the
associated controls.
3.
Press and hold memory button 1
on the side of the driver seat for five
seconds. You will hear two tones.
4. Within three seconds press the
lock button on the remote control.
Repeat this procedure for memory
button 2 and a second remote
control if desired.
Deactivating Memory from the Remote Control
1. Switch on the ignition.
2. Press and hold the desired memory button for five seconds. You will
hear two tones.
3. Within three seconds press the unlock button on the remote control.
Repeat this procedure for each additional remote control if desired.
2
1
60 Keys and Remote Control
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Car Finder
Press the button twice within three seconds. The horn will sound
and the turn signals will flash. We recommend you use this
method to locate your vehicle, rather than using the panic alarm.
Sounding a Panic Alarm
Press the button to activate the alarm. Press the button again
or switch the ignition on to deactivate.
Note: The panic alarm will only operate when the ignition is off.
REPLACING A LOST KEY OR REMOTE CONTROL
You can purchase replacement or additional keys or remote controls from
an authorized dealer. A dealer can program the transmitters to your
vehicle or you may be able to program them yourself. See the Security
chapter for information on programming your transmitters.
Keys and Remote Control 61
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
MyKey allows you to program keys with restricted driving modes to
promote good driving habits. You can use all but one of the keys
programmed to your vehicle with these restricted modes.
Any keys that have not been programmed are referred to as
administrator keys or admin keys. These can be used to:
create a restricted key
program optional MyKey settings
clear all MyKey features.
When you have programmed a MyKey, you can access the following
information using the information display:
The number of admin keys and MyKeys are programmed to your
vehicle.
The total distance your vehicle has traveled using a MyKey.
Note: Switch the ignition on to use the system.
Note: All MyKeys are programmed to the same settings. You cannot
program them individually.
Non-configurable Settings
The following settings cannot be changed by an admin key user:
Belt-Minder. You cannot disable this feature. The audio system will
mute when the front seat occupants’ safety belts are not fastened.
Early low fuel. The low-fuel warning activates earlier, giving the
MyKey user more time to refuel.
Driver assist features, if equipped on your vehicle, are forced on:
parking aid, blind spot information system (BLIS) with cross traffic
alert, lane departure warning and the forward collision warning
system.
Configurable Settings
With an admin key, you can configure certain MyKey settings when you
first create a MyKey and before you recycle the key or restart the
vehicle. You can also change the settings afterward with an admin key.
A vehicle speed limit can be set. Warnings will be shown in the display
followed by an audible tone when your vehicle reaches the set speed.
You cannot override the set speed by fully depressing the accelerator
pedal or by setting cruise control.
Vehicle speed minders of 45, 55 or 65 mph (75, 90 or 105 km/h). Once
you select a speed, it will be shown in the display, followed by an
audible tone when the preselected vehicle speed is exceeded.
62 MyKey
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Audio system maximum volume of 45%. A message will be shown in
the display when you attempt to exceed the limited volume. Also, the
speed-sensitive or compensated automatic volume control will be
disabled.
Always on setting. When this is selected, you will not be able to turn
off AdvanceTrac (if your vehicle is equipped with this feature).
CREATING A MYKEY
Use the information display to create a MyKey.
1. Insert the key you want to program into the ignition.
2. Switch the ignition on.
3. Access the main menu on the information display. Press SETUP
using the information display buttons until PRESS RESET TO
CREATE MYKEY is displayed.
4. Press and release the RESET button. HOLD RESET TO
CONFIRM MYKEY will be displayed.
5. Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds until MARK
THIS AS RESTRICTED is displayed Wait until KEY
RESTRICTED AT NEXT START is displayed.
MyKey is successfully created. Make sure you label it so you can
distinguish it from the admin keys.
You can also program configurable settings for the key(s). Refer to
Programming/Changing Configurable Settings.
Programming/Changing Configurable Settings
Use the Information display to access your configurable MyKey settings:
1. Switch the ignition on with an admin key.
2. Access the main menu on the information display controls and press
SETUP until you see RESET FOR MYKEY SETTINGS in the
display.
3. Press and release the RESET button to display the MyKey setup
menus.
4. Press the SETUP button to display the next menu and scroll through
your choices.
5. Within any of the menus, press RESET to highlight your choice.
Use the arrow buttons to make a selection.
6. Press SETUP to enter your choice. The next configurable setting will
be displayed.
7. Repeat Steps 4 and 5 until you are done changing the configurable
settings.
MyKey 63
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CLEARING ALL MYKEYS
You can clear all MyKeys within the same key cycle as you created the
MyKey. If you switch your ignition off, however, you will need to use an
admin key to clear your MyKeys.
Note: When you clear your MyKeys, you remove all restrictions and
return all MyKeys to their original admin key status at once.
To clear all MyKeys of all MyKey settings, use the information display to
do the following:
1. Press SETUP until you see PRESS RESET TO CLEAR MYKEY in
the display.
2. Press and release the RESET button. You will see HOLD RESET
TO CONFIRM CLEAR in the display.
3. Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds until you see
ALL MYKEYS CLEARED in the display.
CHECKING MYKEY SYSTEM STATUS
You can find information about your programmed MyKeys by using the
information display.
MYKEY DISTANCE
Tracks the distance when drivers use a MyKey. The only way to delete
the accumulated distance is by using an admin key to clear your MyKey.
If the distance does not accumulate as expected, then the intended user
is not using the MyKey, or an admin key user recently cleared and then
recreated a MyKey.
NUMBER OF MYKEY(S)
Indicates the number of MyKeys programmed to your vehicle. Use this
feature to detect how many MyKeys you have for your vehicle and
determine when a MyKey has been deleted.
NUMBER OF ADMIN KEY(S)
Indicates how many admin keys are programmed to your vehicle. Use
this feature to determine how many unrestricted keys you have for your
vehicle, and detect if an additional MyKey has been programmed.
USING MYKEY WITH REMOTE START SYSTEMS
MyKey is not compatible with non-Ford-approved aftermarket remote
start systems. If you choose to install a remote start system, please see
your Ford authorized dealer for a Ford-approved remote start system .
64 MyKey
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Vehicles With Ford-approved Aftermarket Remote Start Systems
When using a Ford-approved aftermarket remote start system, the
vehicle recognizes the remote start system as an additional admin key.
It is the vehicle’s default setting. You can also program the remote start
as a MyKey. As a result, the MyKey system status menu display includes
the remote start system as an additional key in the total count of
MYKEY(S) PROGRAMMED or ADMIN KEYS PROGRAMMED.
See Checking MyKey System Status.
When you start your vehicle with a Ford-approved aftermarket remote
start system, the system stalls the vehicle after you open the door or
shift the vehicle into gear. This is intentional. When you restart your
vehicle, it reads your real key’s status instead of the remote start
system’s status.
As an added precaution, owners may want to program the remote start
system as a MyKey, if the MyKey driver uses the remote start fob. That
way, when the MyKey driver starts the vehicle with the remote start
system, the MyKey restrictions remain active.
With a Ford-approved aftermarket remote start system, it is possible to
program all real keys as MyKeys unintentionally. If this happens, then the
remote start fob is the admin key. If you want to have only one real key
as a MyKey, or do not want to have any MyKeys, then you need to use
your remote start to clear all MyKeys. In that case, follow these steps:
Enter the vehicle and close all doors.
Remote start the vehicle using your remote start fob.
See Clearing All MyKeys. Follow Steps 1-3.
After clearing your MyKeys, you can create a new MyKey. See Creating
a MyKey.
Vehicles With Non-Ford-approved Aftermarket Remote Start
Systems
MyKey is not compatible with non-Ford-approved aftermarket remote
start systems. If you choose to install a remote start system, please see a
Ford authorized dealer for a Ford-approved system.
The following information may help customers who choose to install a
non-Ford-approved remote start system. The actions provided below
do not make MyKey compatible with non-Ford-approved remote start
systems, but may help you retain some MyKey functions.
MyKey 65
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When using a non-Ford-approved remote start system, the vehicle may
recognize the remote start system as an additional admin key with its
associated privileges. If you restart the vehicle by inserting a key into the
ignition cylinder and recycling the ignition completely, then you may
retain some MyKey functions. This action forces your vehicle to read the
traditional key instead of the remote start fob and then uses the key’s
associated privileges.
Note: The MyKey system status menu display may include the remote
start system as an additional key in the total count of MYKEY(S)
PROGRAMMED or ADMIN KEYS PROGRAMMED. See Checking
MyKey System Status.
As an added precaution, owners may want to program the remote start
system as a MyKey, if the MyKey driver uses the remote start fob. That
way, when the MyKey driver starts the vehicle with the remote start
system, the MyKey restrictions will be remain active.
With a non-Ford-approved aftermarket remote start system, it is possible
to program all real keys as MyKeys unintentionally. If this happens, then
the remote start fob is the admin key. If you want to have only one real
key as a MyKey, or do not want to have any MyKeys, then you need to
use your remote start to clear all MyKeys. In that case, follow these
steps:
Enter the vehicle and close all doors.
Remote start the vehicle using your remote start fob.
See Clearing All MyKeys. Follow Steps 1-3.
After clearing your MyKeys, you can create a new MyKey. See Creating
a MyKey.
66 MyKey
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
MYKEY TROUBLESHOOTING
Condition Potential causes
I cannot create a
MyKey.
The key to start the vehicle does not have
admin privileges.
The key used to start the vehicle is the only
admin key (there always has to be at least one
admin key).
SecuriLock passive anti-theft system is
disabled or in unlimited mode.
The vehicle has been started using a remote
start system that is not programmed with
admin privileges. See Using MyKey With
Remote Start Systems.
I cannot program the
configurable settings.
The key used to start the vehicle does not
have admin privileges.
No MyKeys are created. See Creating a
MyKey.
The vehicle has been started using a remote
start system that is not programmed with
admin privileges. See Using MyKey With
Remote Start Systems.
I cannot clear the
MyKeys.
The key used to start the vehicle does not
have admin privileges.
No MyKeys are created. See Creating a
MyKey.
The vehicle has been started using a remote
start system that is not programmed with
admin privileges. See Using MyKey With
Remote Start Systems
I lost the only admin
key.
Purchase a new key from your authorized
dealer.
I lost a key. Program a spare key. See SecuriLock in the
Security.
MyKey 67
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Condition Potential causes
I accidentally
programmed all keys
as MyKeys.
The vehicle has a remote start system that
is recognized as an admin key. Clear all
MyKeys by using remote start. See Using
MyKey With Remote Start Systems.
Your vehicle’s system does not recognize any
MyKeys. See Creating a MyKey.
MyKey total includes
one additional key.
An unknown key has been created as a
MyKey.
The vehicle has a remote start system.
See Using MyKey With Remote Start
Systems.
Admin key total
includes one additional
key.
An unknown key has been programmed to
the vehicle as an admin key.
The vehicle has a remote start system.
See Using MyKey With Remote Start
Systems.
MyKey distances do
not accumulate.
The MyKey user is not using the
programmed MyKey.
An admin key holder cleared the MyKeys
and created new MyKeys.
The key system has been reset.
68 MyKey
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
LOCKING AND UNLOCKING
You can use the power door lock control or the remote control to lock
and unlock your vehicle.
Power Door Locks
The power door lock control is located on the driver and front passenger
door panels.
A. Unlock
B. Lock
Remote Control
You can use the remote control anytime your vehicle is not running.
Unlocking the Doors (Two-Stage Unlock)
Press the button to unlock the driver’s door.
Press the button again within three seconds to unlock all doors.
The turn signals will flash.
Press and hold both the lock and unlock buttons on the remote control
for four seconds to disable or enable two-stage unlocking. Disabling
two-stage unlocking allows all vehicle doors to unlock with one press of
the button. The turn signals will flash twice to indicate the unlocking
mode was changed. The unlocking mode will be applied to the remote
control and keyless entry keypad.
Locking the Doors
Press the button to lock all the doors. The turn signals will
illuminate.
Press the button again within three seconds to confirm that all the doors
are closed. The doors will lock again, the horn will sound and the turn
signals will illuminate if all the doors and the luggage compartment are
closed.
Note: If any door or the luggage compartment is open, or if the hood is
open on vehicles with an anti-theft alarm or remote start, the horn
sounds twice and the lamps will not flash.
A B
Locks 69
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Power Liftgate
WARNING: Make sure all persons are clear of the liftgate area
before using power liftgate control.
WARNING: Make sure to close and latch the liftgate to prevent
drawing exhaust fumes into your vehicle. This will also prevent
passengers and cargo from falling out. If you must drive with the
liftgate open, keep the vents or windows open so outside air comes into
your vehicle. Failure to follow this warning could result in serious
personal injury.
Note: Be careful when opening or closing the liftgate in a garage or
other enclosed area to avoid damaging the liftgate.
Press twice within three seconds to open or close the liftgate,
or to reverse the movement.
Smart Unlocks
This feature helps to prevent you from locking yourself out of your
vehicle if your key is still in the ignition.
When you open one of the front doors or the liftgate and lock your
vehicle with the power door lock control, all the doors will lock then
unlock if your key is still in the ignition.
Your vehicle can still be locked with the key in the ignition by:
locking the driver door with a key
using the lock control on the remote control
using the keyless entry keypad.
If both front doors and the liftgate are closed, your vehicle can be locked
from any method, regardless of whether the key is in the ignition or not.
70 Locks
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Autolock and Unlock
The autolock feature will lock all the doors, the liftgate and the liftgate
window when:
all doors are closed,
the ignition is on,
you shift into any gear putting the vehicle in motion, and
the vehicle attains a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h).
If the vehicle was autolocked, the autounlock feature will unlock all
doors when the driver’s door is opened within 10 minutes of switching
the ignition off.
Enabling or Disabling Autolock and Autounlock
These features can be enabled or disabled:
by your authorized dealer
through the information display
using the power door lock procedure.
To enable or disable using the power door locks, do the following:
Note: You will have 30 seconds to complete the procedure.
1. Switch the ignition on.
2. Press the power door unlock button three times.
3. Switch the ignition off.
4. Press the power door unlock button three times.
5. Switch the ignition on. The horn will chirp indicating the programming
mode has been entered.
Autolock: Once in programming mode, press the power door unlock
button then the lock button. The horn will chirp once if autolock was
deactivated or twice (one short and one long chirp) if autolock was
activated.
Autounlock: Once in programming mode, press the power door lock
button then the unlock button. The horn will chirp once if autounlock
was deactivated or twice (one short and one long chirp) if autounlock
was activated.
6. Turn the ignition off. The horn will chirp once to confirm the
procedure is complete.
Note: The autounlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently
of the autolock feature.
Locks 71
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Illuminated Entry
The interior lamps and parking lamps illuminate when the remote entry
system is used to unlock the door(s).
The system will turn off the lights if:
the ignition is turned on
the lock button on the remote control is pressed
the vehicle is locked using the keyless entry keypad
after 25 seconds of illumination.
The dome lamp control (if equipped) must not be set to the off position
for the illuminated entry system to operate.
The lights will not turn off if:
they have been turned on with the dimmer control
any door is open.
Illuminated Exit
The interior lamps and parking lamps illuminate when doors are closed
and the key is removed from the ignition.
The lamps will turn off if all the doors remain closed and:
25 seconds elapse
the key is inserted in the ignition.
Battery Saver
If you leave the courtesy lamps, dome lamps or headlamps on, the
battery saver shuts them off 10 minutes after you switch the ignition off.
LIFTGATE
WARNING: It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a crash, people riding in these
areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed. Do not allow
people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with
seats and safety belts. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a safety belt properly.
72 Locks
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Power Liftgate
WARNING: Make sure to close and latch the liftgate to prevent
drawing exhaust fumes into your vehicle. This will also prevent
passengers and cargo from falling out. If you must drive with the
liftgate open, keep the vents or windows open so outside air comes
into your vehicle. Failure to follow this warning could result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Make sure all persons are clear of the power liftgate
area before using the power liftgate control.
WARNING: Keep keys out of the reach of children. Do not allow
children to operate the power liftgate, or to play near to an open
or moving power liftgate.
Note: Cycling the ignition prior to completely latching the liftgate could
result in damage to the liftgate or its power components. Make sure the
liftgate is fully latched before operating the vehicle.
If the ignition is cycled during a liftgate power close cycle and the
liftgate is 6-10 inches (15-24 centimeters) from being latched, the liftgate
may reverse to the full open position. Verify that the liftgate is closed
before operating or moving the vehicle, especially in an enclosure, like
a garage or a parking structure. The liftgate or it components could be
damaged in an enclosure, if the liftgate is open.
When power operating the liftgate at temperatures below 32°F (0°C),
the liftgate may stop about 5 inches (13 centimeters) from the full open
position. The liftgate can be fully opened by pushing it upward to the
maximum open position.
Opening and Closing the Power Liftgate
Note: The liftgate can be reversed with a second press on a control
button or transmitter and can be manually closed at any time.
The liftgate will only operate with your vehicle in P. The chime will beep
once if conditions are not correct to start an operation. These conditions
include:
The ignition is in on and the transmission is not in P.
The battery voltage is below the minimum operating voltage.
The vehicle speed is at or above 3 mph (5 km/h).
Locks 73
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If the liftgate reverses and starts to close after a open request, a fast
continuous chime indicates excessive load on the liftgate or a possible
strut failure. If any excessive load is removed and you still have a faster
chime, have the system serviced immediately by your authorized dealer.
Do not attempt to manually force the liftgate to travel faster than the
power system will permit. This will activate the obstacle detection
feature.
To open or close from the instrument panel:
Press the instrument panel button.
To open or close with the remote control:
Press the remote control button twice within three seconds.
To open with the outside liftgate
button (manual actuation):
1. Unlock the liftgate with the
remote entry transmitter or power
door unlock control.
2. Press the control button located
in the top of the liftgate pull cup
handle.
Note: Let the power system open the liftgate after releasing the control
button. Continued upward force after unlatching may activate the
obstacle detection feature and stop the power operation.
Note: If weight is added to the liftgate (bike rack, snow, etc.) it may
start a power close event immediately after a power open. If this
happens, a unique continuous chime will sound.
74 Locks
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
To close with the rear cargo area button:
WARNING: Keep clear of the liftgate when activating the rear
switch.
Note: The rear cargo area control button is disabled when the liftgate is
latched.
Press and release the control on the
left rear quarter panel. A chime will
beep once if conditions are not
correct to start an operation (i.e., the
vehicle is out of park). In a normal
close, the chime will begin just
before the gate starts to move and
continue for a total of three seconds.
To manually operate the liftgate:
Note: Manual operation is suggested on extreme inclines or in extreme
cold -40°F (-40°C).
Note: In the event of a power failure, the latch can be accessed and
released from the inside using the access panel on the liftgate trim.
1. Disable the liftgate power function in the information display. See the
Information Displays chapter.
2. Push the control button located
in the top of the liftgate pull cup
handle to unlatch the liftgate, then
pull on the outside handle.
Locks 75
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Obstacle Detection
Note: Entering your vehicle while the liftgate is closing can cause it to
bounce and activate obstacle detection. To prevent this, let the power
liftgate fully close before entering the vehicle.
The power liftgate system is equipped with an obstacle detection feature.
If the power liftgate is closing, the system is designed to reverse to full
open when it encounters a solid obstacle. A three second chime is also
sounded when an obstacle is detected. Once the obstacle is removed, the
liftgate can be closed under power.
If the power liftgate is opening, the system is designed to stop when it
encounters a solid obstacle. A chime will sound for three seconds while
the obstacle is present.
Resetting the Power Liftgate
If any of these conditions occur, the power liftgate may not operate and
must be reset:
A low voltage or dead battery
Disconnected battery
The liftgate is manually closed and left ajar (unlatched)
To reset the power liftgate:
1. Disconnect the battery for 20 seconds then, reconnect the battery.
2. Manually close and fully latch the liftgate.
3. Power open the liftgate by using the remote entry transmitter or
instrument panel button.
Note: If the power liftgate system is turned off in the message center,
the system cannot be activated with the outside release handle or rear
cargo area control button. The system will need to be turned on to
resume operation with the outside release handle or rear cargo area
control button. The power liftgate is still operational through the use of
the remote entry transmitter and instrument panel button when the
power liftgate is turned off in the message center.
Liftgate Ajar Signal
If the liftgate or liftgate glass are not fully latched, you will receive a
message on the instrument panel. If you see this message, check both
the liftgate glass and liftgate door to ensure they are fully latched.
76 Locks
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Liftgate Window
To open the liftgate window, press
the button in the center of the
liftgate above the license plate.
SECURICODE™ KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD
You can use the keyless entry
keypad to lock or unlock the doors
or release the liftgate glass without
using a key.
The keypad can be operated with the factory-set 5-digit entry code; this
code is located on the owner’s wallet card in the glove box and is
available from your authorized dealer. You can also create up to five of
your own 5-digit personal entry codes.
Programming a Personal Entry Code
You can store up to three personal entry codes.
To create your own personal entry code:
1. Enter the factory-set code.
2. Press the 1 2 on the keypad within five seconds. The doors will lock
and then unlock to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
3. Enter your personal 5-digit code. You must enter each number within
five seconds of each other.
4. Press 1 2 on the keypad to save personal entry code 1.
The doors will lock and then unlock to confirm that programming is
complete.
To program additional personal entry codes, repeat Steps 1–3, then for
Step 4:
press 34 to save personal entry code 2, or
press 56, 78,or90 to save personal entry code 3.
Locks 77
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Tips:
Do not set a code that uses five of the same number.
Do not use five numbers in sequential order.
The factory-set code will work even if you have set your own personal
code.
Programming Memory to a Personal Entry Code
To program a personal entry code to recall a driver memory setting,
repeat Steps 1–4 above.
Pressing 12 on the keypad in Step 4 will program the code to driver
memory setting 1.
Pressing 34 in Step 4 will program the code to driver memory
setting 2.
Note: Pressing 56 , 78,or90 keypad numbers in Step 4 will not
program the code to recall a driver memory setting.
Note: The factory-set code cannot be associated with a memory setting.
Erasing a Personal Code
1. Enter the factory-set 5-digit code.
2. Press and release the 12 on the keypad within five seconds.
The doors will lock and then unlock to confirm that the system is in
programming mode.
3. Press and hold the 12 for two seconds. You must do this within five
seconds of completing Step 2.
All personal codes are now erased and only the factory-set 5-digit code
will work.
78 Locks
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Anti-Scan Feature
The keypad will go into an anti-scan mode if you enter the wrong code
seven times (35 consecutive button presses). This mode disables the
keypad for one minute and the keypad lamp will flash.
The anti-scan feature will turn off after:
one minute of keypad inactivity
pressing the unlock button on the remote control
the ignition is turned on.
Unlocking and Locking the Doors and Liftgate
To unlock the driver door: Enter the factory-set 5-digit code or your
personal code. You must press each number within five seconds of each
other. The interior lamps will illuminate.
To unlock all doors and liftgate: Enter the factory-set 5-digit code or
your personal code, then press 34 within five seconds.
To lock all doors and liftgate: Press and hold 7 8 and 90 at the
same time with the driver door closed. You do not need to enter the
keypad code first.
To open the liftgate glass: Enter the factory-set 5-digit code or your
personal code, then press 56.
Locks 79
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SECURILOCK® PASSIVE ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM
Note: The system is not compatible with non-Ford aftermarket remote
start systems. Use of these systems may result in vehicle starting
problems and a loss of security protection.
Note: Metallic objects, electronic devices or a second coded key on the
same key chain may cause vehicle starting issues if they are too close to
the key when starting your vehicle. Prevent these objects from touching
the coded key while starting the engine. Switch the ignition off, move
all objects on the key chain away from the coded key and restart your
vehicle if a problem occurs.
Note: Do not leave a duplicate coded key in your vehicle. Always take
your keys and lock all doors when leaving your vehicle.
The system helps prevent the engine from starting unless you use a
coded key programmed to your vehicle. Using the wrong key may
prevent your vehicle from starting. A message may appear in the
information display.
If you are unable to start your vehicle with a correctly coded key, a
malfunction has occurred. A message may appear in the information
display.
Automatic Arming
Your vehicle arms immediately after you switch the ignition off.
Anti-Theft Indicator
The anti-theft indicator is located in the instrument cluster.
When the ignition is off, the indicator will flash once every
two seconds to indicate the SecuriLock system is functioning
as a theft deterrent.
When the ignition is on, the indicator will glow for three seconds, then
turn off to indicate normal system functionality.
If a problem occurs with the SecuriLock system, the indicator will flash
rapidly or glow steadily when the ignition is on. If this occurs, switch the
ignition off then back on to make sure there was no electronic interference
with the programmed key. If your vehicle does not start, try to start it with
the second programmed key and if successful contact your authorized
dealership for key replacement. If the indicator still flashes rapidly or glows
steadily, your vehicle will not start. Contact your authorized dealer as soon
as possible for service.
80 Security
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Automatic Disarming
Your vehicle disarms when you switch the ignition on with a coded key.
Replacement Keys
Note: Your vehicle may come with two integrated keyhead transmitters.
The integrated keyhead transmitter functions as a programmed ignition
key that operates all the locks and starts the vehicle, as well as a remote
control.
If your programmed transmitters or standard SecuriLock coded keys are
lost or stolen and you do not have an extra coded key, you will need to
have your vehicle towed to an authorized dealer. The key codes need
to be erased from your vehicle and new coded keys will need to be
programmed.
Store an extra programmed key away from the vehicle in a safe place to
help prevent any inconveniences. See an authorized dealer to purchase
additional spare or replacement keys.
Programming a Spare Key
Note: A maximum of eight coded keys can be programmed to your
vehicle. Only four of these eight can be integrated keyhead transmitters.
You can program your own integrated keyhead transmitters or standard
SecuriLock coded keys to your vehicle. This procedure will program both
the engine immobilizer key code and the remote entry portion of the
remote control to your vehicle.
Only use integrated keyhead transmitters or standard SecuriLock keys.
You must have two previously programmed coded keys and the new
unprogrammed key readily accessible. See your authorized dealer to have
the spare key programmed if two previously programmed coded keys are
not available.
Read and understand the entire procedure before you begin.
1. Insert the first previously programmed coded key into the ignition.
2. Turn the ignition from off to on. Keep the ignition on for at least three
seconds, but no more than 10 seconds.
3. Turn the ignition off and remove the first coded key from the ignition.
4. After three seconds but within 10 seconds of turning the ignition off,
insert the second previously coded key into the ignition.
5. Turn the ignition from off to on. Keep the ignition on for at least three
seconds, but no more than 10 seconds.
Security 81
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
6. Turn the ignition off and remove the second previously programmed
coded key from the ignition.
7. After three seconds but within 20 seconds of turning the ignition off
and removing the previously programmed coded key, insert the new
unprogrammed key into the ignition.
8. Turn the ignition from off to on. Keep the ignition on for at least six
seconds.
9. Remove the newly programmed coded key from the ignition.
The key will start the vehicle’s engine and will operate the remote entry
system (if the new key is an integrated keyhead transmitter) if it has
been successfully programmed. The theft indicator light will illuminate
for three seconds and then go out to indicate successful programming.
If the key was not successfully programmed, the theft indicator light may
flash on and off. Wait 20 seconds and repeat Steps 1 through 8. Take
your vehicle to your authorized dealer to have the new key programmed
if you are still unsuccessful.
Wait 20 seconds and then repeat this procedure from Step 1 to program
an additional key.
ANTI-THEFT ALARM
The system will warn you of unauthorized entry to your vehicle.
The turn signal lamps will flash and the horn will sound when:
any door or the hood is opened without using the key or the remote
control
the ignition is turned on with an invalid key.
Take all keys and remote controls to your authorized dealer if there is
any potential alarm problem with your vehicle.
Arming the Alarm
The system is ready to arm whenever the ignition is off. Lock the vehicle
to arm the alarm.
The turn signal lamps will flash once after locking the vehicle to indicate
the alarm is in the pre-armed mode and will become fully armed in
20 seconds.
82 Security
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Disarming the Alarm
To disarm the alarm, do any of the following:
Press the power door unlock button within the 20-second pre-armed
mode.
Press the unlock button on the remote control.
Unlock the doors with the keyless entry pad.
Turn the ignition on with a valid key.
Press the panic button on the remote control. The alarm system will
still be armed, but this shuts off the horn and turn lamps when the
alarm is sounding.
Note: If the driver’s door is unlocked with a key, a chime will sound
when you open the door. You will have 12 seconds to disarm the alarm
using any of the actions above, otherwise the alarm will trigger.
Security 83
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ADJUSTING THE STEERING WHEEL
WARNING: Do not adjust the steering wheel when your vehicle
is moving.
Note: Make sure that you are sitting in the correct position. Refer to
Sitting in the Correct Position in the Seats chapter.
Use the control on the side of the
steering column to tilt the position.
Memory Feature
The steering column positions are saved and recalled with the memory
feature. Refer to the Seats chapter.
Pressing the adjustment control during memory recall will cancel the
operation. The column will respond to the adjustment control.
Easy Entry and Exit Feature
The column will move to the full up position when the ignition is switched
off. It will return to the previous position when the ignition is switched on.
This feature can be switched on or off in the information display.
AUDIO CONTROL
A. Volume up
B. Seek up or next
C. Media
D. Seek down or previous
E. Volume down
TILT
M
EDIA
- VO
L +
OK
E
D
B
A
C
84 Steering Wheel
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Media
Press the media button repeatedly to scroll through available audio
modes.
Seek, Next or Previous
Press the seek button to:
tune the radio to the next or previous stored preset
play the next or previous track.
Press and hold the seek button to:
tune the radio to the next station up or down the frequency band
seek through a track.
VOICE CONTROL (IF EQUIPPED)
A. Voice recognition
B. Phone mode
C. Confirm selection
See the SYNC or Navigation
System chapter.
CRUISE CONTROL
See the Cruise Control chapter.
M
EDIA
- VO
L +
OK
A
B
C
RESUME
S
E
T
+
OFF ON
S
E
T
-
Steering Wheel 85
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ADJUSTABLE PEDALS (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING: Never adjust the accelerator and brake pedal with
feet on the pedals while the vehicle is moving.
The control is located to the left of the steering column. Press and hold
the appropriate control to move the pedals.
A. Closer
B. Farther
The pedal positions are saved and recalled with the memory feature
(if equipped). Refer to the Seats chapter.
The pedals should only be adjusted when the vehicle is parked.
A
B
86 Pedals
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WINDSHIELD WIPERS
Note: Fully defrost the windshield before turning on the windshield
wipers.
Note: Make sure the windshield wipers are turned off before entering a
car wash.
Note: Clean the windshield and wiper blades if they begin to leave
streaks or smears. If that does not resolve the issue, install new wiper
blades.
Note: Do not operate the wipers on a dry windshield. This may scratch
the glass, damage the wiper blades or cause the wiper motor to bun out.
Always use the windshield washers before wiping a dry windshield.
Rotate the end of the control:
away from you to increase the
wiper speed
toward you to decrease the wiper
speed.
Speed Dependent Wipers
When your vehicle speed increases, the interval between wipes will
decrease when intermittent wipe is selected.
RAIN-SENSING WIPERS
Note: Wet road conditions may result in inconsistent or unexpected
wiping or smearing. Lower the sensitivity, switch to normal or high-speed
wiping or turn the wipers off to reduce smearing.
Note: Turn off the wipers before entering a car wash.
Use the rotary control to adjust the
sensitivity to one of the interval
moisture settings. The wipers will not
cycle until moisture is detected on
the windshield. The wiper speed
will vary based on the amount of
moisture detected on the windshield
and the sensitivity setting.
The wipers will continue to wipe as long as moisture is detected.
1
2
1
2
Wipers and Washers 87
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Keep the outside of the windshield clean, especially the area around the
interior mirror where the sensor is located, or sensor performance may
be affected.
WINDSHIELD WASHERS
Note: Do not operate the wipers on a dry windshield. This may scratch
the glass, damage the wiper blades or cause the wiper motor to burn out.
Always use the windshield washer before wiping a dry windshield.
Note: Do not operate the washer when the washer reservoir is empty.
This may cause the washer pump to overheat.
Press the end of the stalk to
activate the washer.
A brief press causes a single wipe without washer fluid.
A quick press and hold causes the wipers to swipe three times with
washer fluid.
A long press and hold will activate the wipers and washer fluid for up
to 10 seconds.
A wipe will occur a few seconds after washing to clear any remaining
washer fluid.
REAR-WINDOW WIPER AND WASHERS
Rotate the control to select:
2 Intermittent operation
(shortest pause between wipes).
1 Intermittent operation (longest
pause between wipes).
0 Off.
Rotate and hold the control to either the top or bottom position to
activate the rear washer. The control will return to the 2 or 0 position
when you release it.
1
2
1
2
88 Wipers and Washers
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
LIGHTING CONTROL
Rotate the control clockwise to the
first position to turn on the parking
lamps.
Rotate the control clockwise to the
second position to turn on the
headlamps.
Rotate the control to the vertical
position to turn the headlamps off.
High Beams
Push the lever toward the
instrument panel to switch on the
high beams.
Pull the lever toward you to
switch of the high beams.
Headlamp Flasher
Pull the lever toward you slightly
and release it to flash the
headlamps.
1
2
0
1
2
0
Lighting 89
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
AUTOLAMPS
The autolamp system provides light
sensitive automatic on/off control of
the exterior lights normally
controlled by the headlamp control.
The autolamp system also keeps
the lights on for approximately
20 seconds or, if equipped with a
message center, you can select a
delay from 0–180 seconds after the
ignition switch is turned off. See
Message center in the Instrument
Cluster chapter.
To turn autolamps on, rotate the control counterclockwise one
position.
To turn autolamps off, rotate the control to the off position.
INSTRUMENT LIGHTING DIMMER
Use to adjust the brightness of the
instrument panel when exterior
lights are on.
Rotate the control from left to
right to brighten the instrument
panel.
Rotate the control from right to
left to dim the instrument panel.
Rotate the control fully to the right (past detent) to turn on interior
lamps.
Rotate the control to the left position (past detent) to turn off the
interior lamps and to disable the illuminated entry feature. When the
control is in the far left position, it acts as a dome lamp
defeat/override.
Note: If the battery is disconnected, discharged, or a new battery is
installed, the instrument lighting dimmer requires re-calibration. Rotate
the control from the full dim position to the full dome/on position to
reset. This will ensure that your displays are visible under all lighting
conditions.
90 Lighting
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
DAYTIME RUNNING LAMPS (DRL) (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING: Always remember to turn on your headlamps at
dusk or during inclement weather. The Daytime Running Lamp
(DRL) system does not activate the tail lamps and generally may not
provide adequate lighting during these conditions. Failure to activate
your headlamps under these conditions may result in a collision.
Turns the fog lamps on at full intensity output. To activate:
the ignition must be in the on position and
the headlamp control must be in the off, parking lamps or autolamp
position.
FRONT FOG LAMPS
The control also operates the fog
lamps. The fog lamps can be turned
on when the control is in the
parking lamps on, headlamps on, or
autolamps positions and the high
beams are not turned on.
Pull the control towards you to turn
the fog lamps on. The fog lamp
indicator light will illuminate.
DIRECTION INDICATORS
Push down to activate the left
turn signal.
Push up to activate the right turn
signal.
1
2
0
Lighting 91
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
INTERIOR LAMPS
Front Row Map Lamps
To turn on the map lamps, press the
outer edge of the clear lens. The
front row map lamp lights when:
any door is opened.
the instrument panel dimmer
switch is rotated until the courtesy
lamps come on.
the remote entry controls are pressed and the ignition is off.
Second Row Map Lamps
The second row map lamps are
located in the headliner above the
second row seats.
The second row map lamp lights
when:
any door is opened,
the instrument panel dimmer
switch is rotated until the
courtesy lamps come on, and
any of the remote entry controls are pressed and the ignition is off.
Press the controls to activate the lamps.
Rear Cargo Lamp
The rear cargo lamp lights when:
any door is opened, and the
switch is in the middle position.
the instrument panel dimmer
switch is rotated until the
courtesy lamps come on.
any of the remote entry controls
are pressed and ignition is off
(and switch is in the middle
position).
92 Lighting
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
With the ignition key in the accessory or on position, the rear cargo lamp
can be turned on or off by sliding the control.
Battery saver
The battery saver will shut off the exterior lamps and interior lamps,
except the hazard warning lamps if activated, 10 minutes after the
ignition control has been turned off. The system will not turn off the
parking lamps if the lighting control is in the parking lamps on position.
Lighting 93
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
POWER WINDOWS
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in your vehicle
and do not let them play with the power windows. They may
seriously injure themselves.
WARNING: When closing the power windows, you should verify
they are free of obstructions and make sure that children and
pets are not in the proximity of the window openings.
Note: You may hear a pulsing noise when just one of the windows is
open. Lower the opposite window slightly to reduce this noise.
Press the switch to open the
window.
Lift the switch to close the window.
One-Touch Down (If Equipped)
Press the switch fully and release it. Press again or lift it to stop the
window.
One-Touch Up (If Equipped)
Lift the switch fully and release it. Press or lift it again to stop the
window.
Bounce-Back (If Equipped)
The window will stop automatically while closing and reverse some
distance if there is an obstacle in the way.
Overriding the Bounce-Back Feature
WARNING: When you override the bounce-back feature the
window will not reverse if it detects an obstacle. Take care when
closing the windows to avoid personal injury or damage to your vehicle.
AUTO
AUTO
94 Windows and Mirrors
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Pull up the window switch and hold within two seconds of the window
reaching the bounce-back position. The window will travel up with no
bounce-back protection. The window will stop if your release the switch
before the window is fully closed.
Window Lock
A. Unlock
B. Lock
Press the control to lock or unlock the rear window controls.
Accessory Delay
You can use the window switches for several minutes after you switch
the ignition off, or until you open either front door.
EXTERIOR MIRRORS
Power Exterior Mirrors
WARNING: Do not adjust the mirror while your vehicle is in
motion.
A. Left mirror
B. Off
C. Right mirror
To adjust your mirrors:
1. Select the mirror you want to adjust.
2. Move the control in the direction you want to tilt the mirror.
3. Return the control to the center position to lock mirrors in place.
A
B
B
A
C
Windows and Mirrors 95
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Power-Folding Mirrors
Note: Activating the mirrors 10 or more times within one minute, or
repeated folding and unfolding of the mirrors while holding the control
down during full travel, may disable the system to protect motors from
overheating. Wait approximately three minutes with the vehicle running,
and up to 10 minutes with the vehicle off, for the system to reset and for
function to return to normal.
Pull the control back to fold the
mirrors in or out.
Loose Mirror
A mirror may also be manually folded by pulling it toward the door
window glass. This may cause the mirror to appear loose and it will need
to be re-synchronized. Pull and hold the control to fold the mirrors in
until movement stops. A click will be heard indicating re-synchronization.
If the click is not heard, use the control to fold the mirrors all the way
out, then in again. Once the click is heard the mirrors will operate
normally until they are again manually folded.
Heated Exterior Mirror
The heated exterior mirrors switch on with the heated rear window. See
Heated Windows and Mirrors in the Climate Control chapter.
Memory Mirrors
You can save and recall the mirror positions through the memory
function. See Memory function in the Seats chapter.
Auto-Dimming Feature
The driver’s side exterior mirror will automatically dim when the interior
auto-dimming mirror is activated.
Signal Indicator Mirrors
The rear-facing portion of the appropriate mirror housing will blink when
the turn signal is activated.
96 Windows and Mirrors
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Integrated Blind Spot Mirrors
WARNING: Objects in the blind spot mirror are closer than they
appear.
Blind spot mirrors have an integrated convex mirror built into the upper
outboard corner of the exterior mirrors. They are designed to assist you
by increasing visibility along the side of your vehicle.
Check the main mirror first before a lane change, then check the blind
spot mirror. If no vehicles are present in the blind spot mirror and the
traffic in the adjacent lane is at a safe distance, signal that you are going
to change lanes. Glance over your shoulder to verify traffic is clear, and
carefully change lanes.
The image of the approaching
vehicle is small and near the inboard
edge of the main mirror when it is
at a distance. The image becomes
larger and begins to move outboard
across the main mirror as the vehicle
approaches (A). The image will
transition from the main mirror and
begin to appear in the blind spot
mirror as the vehicle approaches
(B). The vehicle will transition to
your peripheral field of view as it
leaves the blind spot mirror (C).
A
B
C
Windows and Mirrors 97
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
INTERIOR MIRROR
WARNING: Do not adjust the mirror when your vehicle is
moving.
Note: Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum or ammonia based cleaning products.
You can adjust the interior mirror to your preference. Some mirrors also
have a second pivot point. This lets you move the mirror head up or
down and from side to side.
Auto-Dimming Mirror
Note: Do not block the sensors on the front and back of the mirror.
Mirror performance may be affected. A rear center passenger or raised
rear center head restraint may also block light from reaching the sensor.
The mirror will dim automatically to reduce glare when bright lights are
detected from behind your vehicle. It will automatically return to normal
reflection when you select reverse gear to make sure you have a clear
view when backing up.
CHILDMINDER MIRROR (IF EQUIPPED)
On double bin overhead consoles, the conversation mirror allows the
driver to view the rear seating area.
WARNING: Do not use the childminder mirror to view rearward
traffic, do not allow rear passengers to distract you from the
driving task, and make sure the rear view mirror has a clear view of
rearward traffic. Failure to do so could increase the risk of a crash from
an unseen vehicle, which may result in serious injury.
Press the release area on the rear
edge of the bin door to open the
childminder mirror. The door will
open to full open position.
The rear view mirror may have to
be adjusted to its lower arm
position to prevent interference
when the childminder mirror is
extended down.
98 Windows and Mirrors
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
REAR QUARTER WINDOWS
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and
do not let children play with the power rear quarter windows.
They may seriously injure themselves.
WARNING: When closing the power rear quarter windows, you
should verify that it is free of obstructions and ensure that
children and/or pets are not in the proximity of the window opening.
Press and hold the VENT control to
open the windows.
Pull and hold the VENT control to
close the windows.
Note: Vehicles without a moonroof will only have the VENT button.
SUN VISORS
Rotate the visor toward the side
window and extend it rearward for
extra sunlight coverage.
SLIDETILT
VENT
Windows and Mirrors 99
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Illuminated Visor Vanity Mirror
Lift the cover to switch on the
lamp.
MOONROOF (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING: Do not let children play with the moonroof or leave
children unattended in the vehicle. They may seriously hurt
themselves.
WARNING: When closing the moonroof, you should verify that it
is free of obstructions and ensure that children and/or pets are
not in the proximity of the moonroof opening.
The sliding shade can be manually opened or closed when the moonroof
is closed. Pull the shade toward the front of the vehicle to close it.
The moonroof control is located on the overhead console.
The moonroof has a one-touch open and close feature. To stop its motion
during the one-touch operation, press the control a second time.
100 Windows and Mirrors
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Opening and Closing the Moonroof
Press and release the SLIDE control to
open the moonroof. The moonroof will
stop short of the fully opened position.
Note: This position helps to reduce
rumbling wind noise which may happen
with the moonroof fully open. Press and
release the control again to fully open the
moonroof.
Pull and release the SLIDE control to
close the moonroof.
Bounce-Back
The moonroof will stop automatically while closing and reverse some
distance if there is an obstacle detected.
Pull and hold the SLIDE control within two seconds of a bounce-back
event to override the function. While bounce-back is active, the closing
force increases for each of the next three times the moonroof is closed.
Venting the Moonroof
Press and release the TILT control to move the moonroof to the vent
position. Pull and hold the TILT control to close the moonroof.
Windows and Mirrors 101
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GAUGES
Cluster shown in standard measure. Metric similar.
A. Battery voltage gauge
B. Fuel gauge
C. Engine coolant temperature gauge
D. Engine oil pressure gauge
E. Speedometer
F. Information display. See Information displays for more information.
G. Tachometer
Battery Voltage Gauge
Indicates the battery voltage when the ignition is in the on position.
If the pointer moves and stays outside the normal operating range, have
the vehicle’s electrical system checked by your authorized dealer as soon
as possible.
A B C D
EFG
102 Instrument Cluster
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Fuel Gauge
Indicates approximately how much fuel is left in the fuel tank (when the
ignition is on). The fuel gauge may vary slightly when the vehicle is in
motion or on a grade. The fuel icon and arrow indicates which side of
the vehicle the fuel filler door is located.
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
Indicates engine coolant temperature. At normal operating temperature,
the level indicator will be in the normal range. If the engine coolant
temperature exceeds the normal range, stop the vehicle as soon as safely
possible, switch off the engine and let the engine cool.
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the
engine is running or hot.
Engine Oil Pressure Gauge
Indicates engine oil pressure. The needle should stay in the normal
operating range. If the needle falls below the normal range, stop the
vehicle, turn off the engine and check the engine oil level. Add oil if
needed. If the oil level is correct, have your vehicle checked at your
authorized dealer.
Information Display
Odometer
Located in the bottom of the information display Registers the
accumulated distance your vehicle has travelled.
Trip Computer
See Trip A/B in Information Displays.
Vehicle Settings and Personalization
See Information Displays.
WARNING LAMPS AND INDICATORS
The following warning lamps and indicators will alert you to a vehicle
condition that may become serious. Some lamps will illuminate when you
start your vehicle to make sure they work. If any lamps remain on after
starting your vehicle, refer to the respective system warning lamp for
further information.
Note: Some warning indicators appear in the information display and
function the same as a warning lamp but do not display when you start
your vehicle.
Instrument Cluster 103
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Airbag Front
If it fails to illuminate on startup, continues to flash or remains
on, it indicates a malfunction. Have the system checked by
your authorized dealer. A chime will sound when there is a
malfunction in the indicator light.
Anti-Lock Braking System
If it illuminates when you are driving, this indicates a
malfunction. You will continue to have the normal braking
system (without ABS) unless the brake warning lamp is also
illuminated. Have the system checked by your authorized dealer.
Battery
If it illuminates while driving, it indicates a malfunction. Switch
off all unnecessary electrical equipment and have the system
checked by your authorized dealer
Brake System
It will illuminate when the parking brake is engaged and the
ignition is on.
If it illuminates when you are driving, check that the parking brake is not
engaged. If the parking brake is not engaged, this indicates low brake
fluid level or a brake system malfunction. Have the system checked
immediately by your authorized dealer.
WARNING: Driving a vehicle with the brake system warning
light on is dangerous. A significant decrease in braking
performance may occur. It will take you longer to stop the vehicle.
Have the vehicle checked by your authorized dealer as soon as possible.
Driving extended distances with the parking brake engaged can cause
brake failure and the risk of personal injury.
Charging System
It will illuminate when the 12–volt battery is not charging
properly. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.
This indicates a problem with the electrical system or a related
component.
104 Instrument Cluster
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Check 4X4
Displays with the message CHECK 4X4 when a four-wheel drive
fault is present. Refer to the Information Displays chapter for
more information.
Cruise Control
It will illuminate when you switch this feature on.
Direction Indicator
Illuminates when the left or right turn signal or the hazard
warning flasher is switched on. If the indicators stay on or flash
faster, check for a burned out bulb.
Door Ajar
Displays when the ignition is on and any door is not completely
closed.
Engine Oil
If it illuminates with the engine running or when you are
driving, this indicates a malfunction. Stop your vehicle as soon
as it is safe to do so and switch the engine off. Check the
engine oil level.
Note: Do not resume your journey if it illuminates despite the level
being correct. Have the system checked by your authorized dealer.
Engine Coolant Temperature
Illuminates when the engine coolant temperature is high. Stop
the vehicle as soon as possible, switch off the engine and let
cool.
Fasten Safety belt
It will illuminate and a chime will sound to remind you to fasten
your safety belt.
High Beam
It will illuminate when the headlamp high beam is switched on.
It will flash when you use the headlamp flasher.
Instrument Cluster 105
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Low Fuel Level
It will illuminate when the fuel level is low or near empty.
Refuel as soon as possible.
Low Tire Pressure Warning
It will illuminate when your tire pressure is low. If the lamp
remains on with the engine running or when driving, check
your tire pressure as soon as possible.
The lamp also illuminates momentarily when you switch the ignition on
to confirm the lamp is functional. If it does not illuminate when you
switch the ignition on, or begins to flash at any time, have the system
checked by your authorized dealer.
Low Washer Fluid
It will illuminate when the windshield washer fluid is low.
Powertrain Malfunction/Reduced Power
Illuminates when a powertrain fault has been detected. Contact
your authorized dealer as soon as possible.
Security/Anti-Theft System
Flashes when the SecuriLock® passive anti-theft system has
been activated.
Service Engine Soon
The service engine soon indicator light illuminates when the
ignition is first turned to the on position to check the bulb and to
indicate whether the vehicle is ready for Inspection/Maintenance
(I/M) testing. Normally, the “service engine soon” light will stay on until the
engine is cranked, then turn itself off if no malfunctions are present.
However, if after 15 seconds the “service engine soon” light blinks eight
times, it means that the vehicle is not ready for I/M testing. See the
Readiness for inspection/maintenance (I/M) testing in the Fuel and
Refueling chapter.
106 Instrument Cluster
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Solid illumination after the engine is started indicates the on-board
diagnostics system (OBD-II) has detected a malfunction. Refer to
On-board diagnostics (OBD-II) in the Fuel and Refueling chapter. If
the light is blinking, engine misfire is occurring which could damage your
catalytic converter. Drive in a moderate fashion (avoid heavy acceleration
and deceleration) and have your vehicle serviced immediately by your
authorized dealer.
WARNING: Under engine misfire conditions, excessive exhaust
temperatures could damage the catalytic converter, the fuel
system, interior floor coverings or other vehicle components, possibly
causing a fire.
Stability Control System
Displays when the AdvanceTrac®/Traction control is active.
If the light remains on, have the system serviced immediately.
Stability Control System Off
Illuminates when AdvanceTrac®/Traction control has been
disabled by the driver.
Transmission Tow/Haul
Illuminates when the Tow/Haul feature has been activated.
Refer to the Transmission chapter for transmission function
and operation. If the light flashes steadily, have the system
serviced immediately, damage to the transmission could occur.
4X4
Illuminates when four-wheel drive high is engaged. If the light
fails to display when the ignition is turned on, or remains on,
have the system serviced immediately by your authorized dealer.
4X4 AUTO
Displays when using the 4x4 system.
Instrument Cluster 107
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
AUDIBLE WARNINGS AND INDICATORS
Key In Ignition Warning Chime
Sounds when the key is left in the ignition in the off or accessory
position and the driver’s door is opened.
Headlamps On Warning Chime
Sounds when the headlamps or parking lamps are on, the ignition is off
(the key is not in the ignition) and the driver’s door is opened.
Parking Brake On Warning Chime
Sounds when you have left the parking brake on and drive your vehicle.
If the warning chime remains on after you have released the parking
brake, have the system checked by your authorized dealer immediately.
Turn Signal Chime
Sounds when the direction indicator has been activated to signal a turn
and not turned off after the vehicle is driven more than 1.5 miles
(2.4 km).
108 Instrument Cluster
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL INFORMATION
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle
control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use
extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off
the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your
vehicle. We recommend against the use of any handheld device while
driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible.
Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the
use of electronic devices while driving..
Various systems on your vehicle can be controlled using the information
display controls on the steering wheel. Corresponding information is
displayed in the information display.
Information Display Controls
Press the INFO button to scroll
through trip, fuel usage, and
MyKey® information.
Press the SETUP button to scroll
through various vehicle feature
settings.
Press the RESET button to
choose settings, reset information
and confirm messages.
Info
Press the INFO button repeatedly to cycle through the following
features:
Note: Some options may appear slightly different or not at all if the
items are optional.
INFO
SETUP
RESET
Information Displays 109
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
INFO
TRIP A/B
MYKEY MILES (km) (if programmed)
MILES (km) TO E
AVG MPG (L/100km)
MPG (L/km)
TBC GAIN = XX.X (if equipped)
TIMER
TRIP A/B: Registers the distance of individual journeys. Press and
release INFO button until the A or B trip appears in the display (this
represents the trip mode). Press the RESET button to reset. Refer
to UNITS later in this section to switch the display from metric to
English.
MYKEY MILES (km) (if programmed): For more information, refer to
the MyKey® chapter.
MILES (km) TO E: This displays an estimate of approximately how
far you can drive with the fuel remaining in your tank under normal
driving conditions. Remember to turn the ignition off when refueling
to allow this feature to correctly detect the added fuel. Distance to
empty is calculated using a running average fuel economy, which is
based on your recent driving history of 500 miles (800 km). This value
is not the same as the average fuel economy display. The running
average fuel economy is re-initialized to a factory default value if the
battery is disconnected.
AVG MPG (L/100km): Average fuel economy displays your average fuel
economy in miles/gallon or liters/100 km.
MPG (L/km): This displays instantaneous fuel economy as a bar graph.
Your vehicle must be moving to calculate instantaneous fuel economy.
Instantaneous fuel economy cannot be reset.
TBC GAIN (if equipped): Displays the level of trailer brake gain or if
the trailer is not connected.
TIMER: Displays the trip elapsed drive time. Press and release RESET
to pause the timer. Press and hold RESET to reset the timer.
110 Information Displays
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
System Check and Vehicle Feature Customization
Press the SETUP button repeatedly
to cycle the message center through
the following features:
SETUP
RESET FOR
SYSTEM CHECK
press the
RESET button
OIL LIFE
CHARGING SYSTEM
WASHER FLUID LEVEL
DOOR AJAR STATUS
LIFTGATE/GLASS AJAR STATUS
BRAKE SYSTEM
MYKEY MILES (if programmed)
MYKEY(S) PROGRAMMED
ADMIN KEYS PROGRAMMED
MILES TO EMPTY
TBC GAIN = XX.X (if equipped)
INFO
SETUP
RESET
Information Displays 111
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SETUP
OIL LIFE
UNITS press the
RESET button
English or Metric
AUTOLAMP
(SEC)
0 to 180 seconds
AUTOLOCK On or Off
AUTOUNLOCK On or Off
RUNNING
BOARDS (if
equipped)
Auto / Off / Out
POWER
LIFTGATE (if
equipped)
On or Off
EASY ENTRY On or Off
REAR PARK AID
(if equipped)
On or Off
FRONT PARK
AID (if
equipped)
On or Off
TRAILER SWAY
(if equipped)
On or Off
TBC MODE (if
equipped)
CREATE MYKEY / MYKEY SETUP / CLEAR MYKEY
COMPASS
ENGLISH /
FRENCH /
SPANISH RESET
FOR NEW
press the
RESET button
English / Spanish / French (press
and hold to set)
RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK: The message center will begin to cycle
through the vehicle systems and provide a status of the item if needed.
Some systems show a message only if a condition is present.
OIL LIFE: This displays the remaining oil life. An oil change is required
whenever indicated by the message center and according to the
recommended maintenance schedule. USE ONLY RECOMMENDED
ENGINE OILS.
112 Information Displays
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
To reset the oil monitoring system to 100% after each oil change,
perform the following:
1. Press and release the SETUP button to display “OIL LIFE XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW”.
2. Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds and release to reset
the oil life to 100%.
Note: To change oil life 100% value (if equipped with this feature) to
another value, proceed to Step 3.
3. Once “OIL LIFE SET TO XXX%” is displayed, release and press the
RESET button to change the Oil Life Start Value. Each release and press
will reduce the value by 10%.
UNITS: Displays the current units in English or Metric.
AUTOLAMP (SEC): This feature keeps your headlights on for up to
three minutes after the ignition is switched off.
AUTOLOCK: This feature automatically locks all vehicle doors when
the vehicle is shifted into any gear, putting the vehicle in motion.
AUTOUNLOCK: This feature automatically unlocks all vehicle doors
when the driver’s door is opened within 10 minutes of the ignition
being turned off.
RUNNING BOARDS (if equipped): This feature automatically deploys
the side running boards for easy entry/exit from the vehicle or for
cleaning.
Auto: The running boards will automatically deploy when a door is
opened and automatically retract when the door is closed
Out: The running boards will remain deployed regardless of the doors
being open/closed. This setting can be used when washing the vehicle,
or accessing the roof rack. The running boards will stow and enter
AUTO mode when the vehicle speed exceeds 5 mph (8 km/h).
Off: The running boards will remain in regardless of the doors being
open/closed.
POWER LIFTGATE (if equipped): This feature allows users to
open/close the rear liftgate at the touch of a button. If disabled, the
outside release handle and the rear cargo area control button are off.
The instrument panel button will continue to function the liftgate in
power mode.
EASY ENTRY / EXIT: This feature automatically moves the driver’s
seat rearward and adjusts the steering column for easy exit/entry from
the vehicle.
Information Displays 113
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
REAR PARK AID (if equipped): This feature sounds a tone to warn
the driver of obstacles near the rear bumper, and functions only when
R (Reverse) gear is selected.
FRONT PARK AID (if equipped): This feature sounds a warning tone
to warn the driver of obstacles near the front bumper.
TRAILER SWAY (if equipped): This feature uses the electronic
stability control to mitigate trailer sway.
TBC MODE (if equipped): Allows you to choose the trailer brake
mode.
CREATE MYKEY / MYKEY SETUP / CLEAR MYKEY: For more
information refer to the MyKey® chapter.
COMPASS: Displays the vehicle’s heading direction.
The compass reading may be affected when you drive near large
buildings, bridges, power lines and powerful broadcast antenna. Magnetic
or metallic objects placed in, on or near the vehicle may also affect
compass accuracy. If the compass appears to be inaccurate, a manual
calibration may be necessary. Refer to Compass zone adjustment
Compass zone adjustment
1. Determine which magnetic zone
you are in for your geographic
location by referring to the zone
map.
2. Start the engine.
3. Press SETUP to reach the reset
for zone setting screen.
4. Press and hold RESET until the
message center display prompts you
to reset the current zone setting.
Press RESET.
5. Press and release RESET until the message center display changes to
show the current zone setting (XX).
6. Press and release the RESET button repeatedly until the correct zone
setting for your geographic location is displayed on the message center.
7. Press and release SETUP and allow the setup timer to expire to exit
the procedure or press INFO to exit.
123
4
5
6 7 8 9 1011
12
13
14
15
114 Information Displays
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Compass calibration adjustment
Note: For optimum calibration, drive to an open, level location away
from large metallic objects or structures. Switch off all non-essential
electrical accessories (heated rear window, heater, A/C, map lamps,
wiper, etc.) and make sure all the doors are closed
Note: If the RESET button is pressed or three minutes has expired, the
display will go back to the INFO menu and will show CAL instead of the
compass heading until the compass is calibrated.
1. Press RESET to start the compass calibration function.
2. Slowly drive the vehicle in a circle (less than 3 mph [5 km/h]) until
the CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE display changes to CALIBRATION
COMPLETED. It will take up to five circles to complete calibration.
3. The compass is now calibrated.
ENGLISH / FRENCH / SPANISH RESET FOR NEW: Allows you to
choose which language the message center will display in.
Press RESET to cycle through each of the language choices.
Press and hold RESET for two seconds to set the language choice.
INFORMATION MESSAGES
Note: Depending on the vehicle options equipped with your vehicle, not
all of the messages will display or be available. Certain messages may be
abbreviated or shortened depending upon which cluster type you have.
Press the RESET button for Type 1 displays or the OK button for
Type 2 displays to acknowledge and remove some messages from the
information display. Other messages will be removed automatically after
a short time. Certain messages need to be confirmed before you can
access the menus.
AdvanceTrac® /
Traction Control
Messages
Action / Description
SERVICE
ADVANCETRAC
Displayed when the AdvanceTrac® system has
detected a condition that requires service.
Contact your authorized dealer as soon as
possible.
Information Displays 115
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Battery and Charging
System Messages
Action / Description
CHECK CHARGING
SYSTEM
Displayed when the charging system needs
servicing. If the warning stays on or continues to
come on, contact your authorized dealer as soon
as possible.
Brake System
Messages
Action / Description
BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL LOW
Indicates the brake fluid level is low and the brake
system should be inspected immediately. Refer to
Brake fluid in the Maintenance chapter.
CHECK BRAKE
SYSTEM
Displayed when the brake system needs
servicing. If the warning stays on or continues to
come on, contact your authorized dealer as soon
as possible.
PARK BRAKE
ENGAGED
Displayed when the parking brake is set and the
vehicle is in motion.
Door Messages Action / Description
DOOR AJAR
Displayed when a door is not completely closed.
LIFTGATE / GLASS
AJAR
Displayed when the liftgate or liftgate glass is
not completely closed.
Fuel Messages Action / Description
CHECK FUEL FILL
INLET
Displayed when the fuel fill inlet may not be
properly closed.
XXX MILES TO E
FUEL LEVEL LOW
Displayed as an early reminder of a low fuel
condition.
Maintenance
Messages
Action / Description
ENGINE OIL
CHANGE SOON
Displayed when the engine oil life is nearing
its end.
OIL CHANGE
REQUIRED
Displayed when the oil life left reaches 0%.
WASHER FLUID
LEVEL LOW
Indicates the washer fluid reservoir is less than
one quarter full. Check the washer fluid level.
116 Information Displays
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
MyKey® Messages Action / Description
MYKEY ACTIVE
DRIVE SAFELY
Displayed when MyKey® is active.
VEHICLE NEAR
TOP SPEED
Displayed when a MyKey® is in use and the
MyKey speed limit is on and the vehicle speed
is approaching 80 mph (130 km/h).
VEHICLE AT TOP
SPEED - MYKEY
SETTING
Displayed when a MyKey® is in use and the
MyKey speed limit is on and the vehicle speed
is 80 mph (130 km/h).
TOP SPEED MYKEY
SETTING
Displayed when a MyKey® is in use and the
MyKey speed limit is on and the vehicle speed
is 80 mph (130 km/h).
SPEED LIMITED TO
80 MPH
Displayed when starting the vehicle and
MyKey® is in use and the MyKey speed limit
is on.
VEHICLE SPEED
80 MPH MAX
Displayed when a MyKey® is in use and the
Admin has enabled the MyKey speed limit and
the vehicle speed is 80 mph (130 km/h).
CHECK SPEED
DRIVE SAFELY
Displayed when a MyKey® is in use and the
optional setting is on and the vehicle exceeds
a preselected speed.
BUCKLE UP TO
UNMUTE AUDIO
Displayed when a MyKey® is in use and
Belt-Minder® is activated.
KEY COULD NOT
PROGRAM
Displayed when an attempt is made to
program a spare key using two existing
MyKeys.
ADVTRAC ON
MYKEY SETTING
Displayed when a MyKey® is in use when
trying to disable the AdvanceTrac® system
and the optional setting is on.
Park Aid Messages Action / Description
CHECK PARK AID
Displayed when the transmission is in R
(Reverse).
Information Displays 117
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Tire Messages Action / Description
LOW TIRE
PRESSURE
Displays when one or more tires on your
vehicle have low tire pressure.
TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR FAULT
Displays when the tire pressure monitoring
system is malfunctioning. If the warning stays
on or continues to come on, contact your
authorized dealer.
TIRE PRESSURE
SENSOR FAULT
Displayed when a tire pressure sensor is
malfunctioning, or your spare tire is in use.
For more information on how the system
operates under these conditions refer to the
Tire Pressure Monitoring System in the
Wheels and Tires chapter for more
information. If the warning stays on or
continues to come on, contact your authorized
dealer as soon as possible.
Trailer Messages Action / Description
TRAILER SWAY
REDUCE SPEED
Displayed when the trailer sway control has
detected trailer sway.
4WD Messages Action / Description
4X4 SHIFT IN
PROGRESS
Displayed when the 4X4 system is making a
shift.
CLOCK
Press A to move the time display
backwards.
Press B to move the time display
forwards.
A B
LINCOLN
118 Information Displays
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
DUAL AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL SYSTEM WITHOUT
HEATED AND COOLED SEATS
A. AUTO: Press to turn on fully automatic operation. Select the desired
temperature using the temperature control. The system automatically
determines fan speed, air distribution, A/C operation, and outside or
recirculated air, to heat or cool the vehicle to maintain the selected
temperature.
B. EXT: Press to display the outside temperature. Press again to display
the interior temperature.
Note: The exterior temperature reading is more accurate when the
vehicle is moving.
C. REAR (on/off): Press to turn on the auxiliary climate controls in the
rear of the floor console. Press again to turn the auxiliary system off.
When this button is pressed, the display only shows the rear temperature
setting. After the rear setting changes are completed on the front
control, the display automatically shows both climate settings.
D. Defrost: Distributes air through the windshield defroster vents and
demister vents. This setting can also be used to defog and clear the
windshield of a thin covering of ice.
AUTO
OFF
EXT REAR
F
A/C
R
R
R
R
O
A
P N M L K J I H
D E
F
G
R
Q
B C
Climate Control 119
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
E. REAR (temperature control): Press to turn on the auxiliary
climate control system and to set the desired rear temperature with the
front control. The rear temperature is the same as the front temperature
when only the center rear temperature bar is lit. The rear temperature is
different from the front temperature when more than one rear
temperature bar is lit.
When this button is pressed, the display only shows the rear temperature
setting. After the rear setting changes are completed on the front
control, the display automatically shows both climate settings.
F. Passenger temperature control: Press and turn to increase or
decrease the air temperature on the passenger side of the vehicle.
G. Rear defrost: Press to turn the heated windows and mirrors off and
on. See Heated windows and mirrors later in this chapter for more
information.
H. Auxiliary climate control fan speed: Press to turn on the auxiliary
climate control system or to adjust the rear fan speed from the front
control.
I. Recirculated air: Press to switch between outside air and
recirculated air. Using recirculated air can reduce the time needed to
cool the interior and reduce unwanted odors from entering your vehicle.
J. A/C: Press to turn air conditioning off and on. Air conditioning cools
the vehicle using outside air. To improve air conditioning when starting
your vehicle, drive with the windows slightly open for two to three
minutes.
K. Floor/Defrost: Distributes air through the windshield defroster vents,
demister vents and floor vents.
L. Floor: Distributes air through the floor vents.
M. Instrument panel/Floor: Distributes air through the instrument
panel vents, floor vents, and demister vents.
N. Instrument panel: Distributes air through the instrument panel
vents.
O. Manual override controls: Press buttons I through P to override
automatic control (AUTO). To return to automatic operation, press
AUTO.
P. Front fan speed control: Controls the volume of air circulated in
your vehicle. Press to increase or decrease fan speed.
Q. OFF: Turn the climate control system off. When the system is off,
outside air cannot enter the vehicle.
120 Climate Control
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
R. Driver temperature control: Press to turn the climate control
system off and on. Turn to increase or decrease the air temperature for
the driver side of the vehicle.
This control also adjusts the passenger side temperature when dual zone
operation is disengaged.
DUAL AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL SYSTEM WITH
HEATED AND COOLED SEATS
A. AUTO: Press to turn on fully automatic operation. Select the desired
temperature using the temperature control. The system automatically
determines fan speed, air distribution, A/C operation, and outside or
recirculated air, to heat or cool the vehicle to maintain the selected
temperature.
B. A/C: Press to turn air conditioning off and on. Air conditioning cools
the vehicle using outside air. To improve air conditioning when starting
your vehicle, drive with the windows slightly open for two to three
minutes.
C. EXT: Press to display the outside temperature. Press again to display
the interior temperature.
Note: The exterior temperature reading is more accurate when the
vehicle is moving.
AUTO
OFF
A/C EXT
F
REAR
R
R
R
R
A
P O N M L K J I
E F
G
H
R
Q
B DC
Climate Control 121
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
D. Recirculated air: Press to switch between outside air and
recirculated air. Using recirculated air can reduce the time needed to
cool the interior and reduce unwanted odors from entering your vehicle.
E. Defrost: Distributes air through the windshield defroster vents and
demister vents. This setting can also be used to defog and clear the
windshield of a thin covering of ice.
F. REAR (temperature control): Press to turn on the auxiliary climate
control system and to set the desired rear temperature with the front
control. The rear temperature is the same as the front temperature when
only the center rear temperature bar is lit. The rear temperature is
different from the front temperature when more than one rear
temperature bar is lit.
When this button is pressed, the display only shows the rear temperature
setting. After the rear setting changes are completed on the front
control, the display automatically shows both climate settings.
G. Passenger temperature control: Press and turn to increase or
decrease the air temperature on the passenger side of the vehicle.
H. Rear defrost: Press to turn the heated windows and mirrors off and
on. See Heated windows and mirrors later in this chapter for more
information.
I. Auxiliary climate control fan speed: Press to turn on the auxiliary
climate control system or to adjust the rear fan speed from the front
control.
J. Passenger heated seat control: Press to switch the passenger
heated seat off and on. See Heated seats in the Seats chapter for more
information.
K. Passenger cooled seat control: Press to switch the passenger
cooled seat off and on. See Heated and cooled seats in the Seats
chapter for more information.
L. REAR (on/off): Press to turn on the auxiliary climate controls in the
rear of the floor console. Press again to turn the auxiliary system off.
When this button is pressed, the display only shows the rear temperature
setting. After the rear setting changes are completed on the front
control, the display automatically shows both climate settings.
122 Climate Control
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
M. Air distribution control: Turn to set the air distribution to a
position listed below:
Distributes air through the instrument panel vents.
Distributes air through the instrument panel vents, floor vents,
and demister vents.
Distributes air through the floor vents.
Distributes air through the windshield defroster vents, demister
vents and floor vents.
N. Driver heated seat control: Press to switch the driver heated seat
off and on. See Heated seats in the Seats chapter for more information.
O. Driver cooled seat control: Press to switch the driver cooled seat
off and on. See Heated and cooled seats in the Seats chapter for more
information.
P. Front fan speed control: Controls the volume of air circulated in
your vehicle. Press to increase or decrease fan speed.
Q. OFF: Turn the climate control system off. When the system is off,
outside air cannot enter the vehicle.
R. Driver temperature control: Press to turn the climate control
system off and on. Turn to increase or decrease the air temperature for
the driver side of the vehicle.
This control also adjusts the passenger side temperature when dual zone
operation is disengaged.
Climate Control 123
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
AUXILIARY CLIMATE CONTROL (IF EQUIPPED)
Your auxiliary climate controls are located on the rear of the center
console and can be used when REAR has been pressed on the front
climate control system. The temperature is set by the front controls.
Use the rear control to adjust the fan speed or turn the auxiliary controls
off (O).
A. Fan speed control: Turn to select the desired fan speed.
B. Temperature and air distribution control: The distribution of air
is based on the temperature selected. Adjust for comfort.
GENERAL OPERATING TIPS
To reduce fog build-up on the windshield during humid weather,
select Defrost. Temperature and fan speed can also be increased to
improve clearing.
To reduce humidity build-up inside the vehicle, do not drive with the
system off or with recirculated air engaged.
Do not put objects under the front seats that will interfere with the
airflow to the back seats.
Remove any snow, ice or leaves from the air intake area at the base
of the windshield.
Cooling the interior quickly:
1. Adjust the fan speed to the highest speed setting initially and then
adjust it to suit the desired comfort level.
2. Adjust the temperature control to the lowest temperature setting.
3. Adjust the air distribution control to MAX A/C.
Recommended settings for cooling:
Adjust the air distribution control to A/C.
If your vehicle stationary for extended periods during extreme high
ambient temperatures
Select MAX A/C.
1
2
3
4
A
B
124 Climate Control
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
For maximum cooling performance in manual override control:
1. Choose Panel, A/C, and recirc controls.
2. Set the temperature to LO.
3. Set the fan to the highest blower setting.
To aid in side window defogging and demisting in cold or humid weather:
1. Select Floor/Panel.
2. Select A/C.
3. Adjust the temperature control to maintain comfort.
4. Set the fan speed to the highest setting.
5. Direct the outer instrument panel vents toward the side windows.
6. To increase airflow to the outer instrument panel vents, close the
vents located in the middle of the instrument panel.
HEATED WINDOWS AND MIRRORS (IF EQUIPPED)
Heated Rear Window
Note: The vehicle must be running to use this feature.
Press the control to clear the rear window of thin ice and fog. Press the
control again within 15 minutes to switch it off. It turns off automatically
after approximately 15 minutes, or when you switch off the ignition.
Do not use razor blades or other sharp objects to clean the inside
of the rear window or to remove decals from the inside of the
rear window. This may cause damage to the heated grid lines.
Your warranty does not cover this damage.
Heated Exterior Mirrors (If Equipped)
Note: Do not remove ice from the mirrors with a scraper or attempt to
readjust the mirror glass that has frozen in place. These actions could
cause damage to the glass and mirrors.
Note: Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum-based cleaning products.
Both mirrors heat to remove ice, mist and fog when you switch on the
heated rear window.
Climate Control 125
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SITTING IN THE CORRECT POSITION
WARNING:
Sitting improperly out of position or with the seatback
reclined too far can take off weight from the seat cushion and
affect the passenger sensing system, resulting in serious injury or death in
a crash. Always sit upright against your seatback, with your feet on the
floor.
WARNING: Do not recline the seatback as this can cause the
occupant to slide under the seat’s safety belt, resulting in severe
personal injury in the event of a crash.
WARNING: Do not place objects higher than the seatbacks to
reduce the risk of injury in a crash or during heavy braking or
when stopping suddenly.
When you use them properly, the
seat, head restraint, safety belt and
airbags will provide optimum
protection in the event of a crash.
We recommend that you follow
these guidelines:
Do not recline the seatback more than 30 degrees from vertical.
Sit in an upright position with the base of your spine as far back as
possible.
Adjust the head restraint so that the top of it is level with the top of
your head and as far forward as possible, remaining comfortable.
Keep sufficient distance between yourself and the steering wheel.
We recommend a minimum of 10 inches (25 centimeters) between
your breastbone and the airbag cover.
Hold the steering wheel with your arms slightly bent.
Bend your legs slightly so that you can press the pedals fully.
Position the shoulder strap of the safety belt over the center of your
shoulder and position the lap strap tightly across your hips.
126 Seats
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Make sure that your driving position is comfortable and that you can
maintain full control of your vehicle.
HEAD RESTRAINTS
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a
crash, you and the passenger occupants should not sit in or
operate the vehicle, until the head restraint is placed in its proper
position. Never adjust the head restraint while the vehicle is in motion.
WARNING: The adjustable head restraint is a safety device.
Whenever possible it should be installed and properly adjusted
when the seat is occupied.
WARNING: Install the head restraint properly to minimize the
risk of neck injury in the event of a crash.
Note: Adjust the seat back to an upright driving position before
adjusting any head restraint. Properly adjust the head restraint so that
the top of the head restraint is even with the top of your head and
positioned as close as possible to the back of your head. For occupants
of extremely tall stature, adjust the head restraint to its full up position.
Front Seat Head Restraints
The head restraints consist of :
A. An energy absorbing head restraint
B. Two steel stems
C. Guide sleeve adjust and release button
D. Guide sleeve unlock and remove button
Seats 127
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Adjusting the Head Restraint
Raise: Pull up the head restraint.
Lower:
1. Press and hold button C.
2. Push down on the head restraint.
Remove:
1. Pull up the head restraint until it reaches the highest adjustment
position.
2. Press and hold buttons C and D.
3. Pull up the head restraint.
Reinstall Align the steel stems into the guide sleeves and push the head
restraint down until it locks.
Second row outboard seat head restraints The outboard head
restraints are non-adjustable, but you can fold them.
The non-adjustable head restraints
consist of:
a trimmed energy absorbing foam
and structure (A),
and a fold strap (B).
1. Pull the fold strap to fold the outboard head restraint.
2. Pull up on the head restraint to place the head restraint back to the
upright position.
Second row center seat head restraint The center rear head
restraint is fixed and non-adjustable. The head restraint consists of a
trimmed foam covering over the upper structure of the seat back.
A
B
128 Seats
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Third row head restraints The third row head restraints are non
adjustable, but you can fold them.
The non-adjustable head restraints
consist of:
a trimmed energy absorbing foam
and structure (A),
and a fold strap (B).
1. Pull the fold strap to fold the head restraint.
2. Pull up on the head restraint to place the head restraint back to the
upright position.
POWER SEATS
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original position,
make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped behind the
seatback.
WARNING: Never adjust the driver’s seat or seatback when the
vehicle is moving.
The control is located on the
outboard side of the seat. Move the
switch in the direction of the arrow
to raise or lower the seat cushion or
to move the seat forward, backward,
up or down.
A
B
Seats 129
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Power Recline
Move the switch to recline the seat
back forward or rearward.
Note: On vehicles with memory seats, to prevent damage to the seat,
the power seats are designed to set a stopping position just short of the
end of the seat track. If the seat encounters an object while moving
forward or backward, a new stopping position will be set.
To reset the seat to its normal stopping position:
1. After encountering the new stopping position, press the power seat
control again to override.
2. Continue pressing the control until it reaches the end of the seat
track.
3. Continue pressing the control for about two seconds. You will feel the
seat bounce back slightly.
Power Lumbar
The control is located on the
outboard side of the seat. Press the
forward or rearward side of the
control for more or less support.
130 Seats
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
MEMORY FUNCTION
This feature will save and recall the positions of the driver seat, power
mirrors, adjustable pedals, and steering column.
The memory seat control is located
on left side of the driver’s seat.
Programming Memory Positions
1. Turn the ignition on.
2. To program position 1, move the memory features to their desired
position using the associated controls.
3. Press and hold button 1 for about two seconds. A chime will sound
confirming that a memory position has been set.
To program position 2, repeat the previous procedure using button 2.
You can program a memory position at any time.
To program the memory feature to a remote control transmitter, see the
Keys and Remote Control chapter.
Recalling Saved Memory Positions
To recall position 1 settings, press and release memory button 1.
The memory features will move to the saved memory 1 position.
You can also recall the memory positions when you:
press your remote control transmitter unlock button (if the remote
control is programmed to a memory position) or,
enter a valid Securicode personal entry code that is programmed to a
memory position.
If the easy entry and exit feature is on, the mirrors and pedals will move
to the programmed memory position and the seat will move to the easy
entry position. The seat will move to the driving memory position when
the ignition is activated.
2
1
Seats 131
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
You can recall a programmed memory position:
in any gearshift position if the ignition is not on.
only in position P or N if the ignition is on.
Easy Entry and Exit Feature
If you enable the easy entry and exit feature, it automatically moves the
driver’s seat 2 inches (5 centimeters) rearward when the transmission
selector lever is in position P and the key is removed from the ignition.
Note: If the seat is located less than 2 inches (5 centimeters) from
the rear of the seat track, the seat travel will be less than 2 inches
(5 centimeters) rearward.
The driver’s seat will return to the previous position when the key is put
in the ignition.
Enable or disable this feature through the information display. See the
Information Displays chapter for more information.
Climate Controlled Seats (If Equipped)
Heated Seats
WARNING: Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes, spinal cord
injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion, or other physical conditions,
must exercise care when using the seat heater. The seat heater may
cause burns even at low temperatures, especially if used for long
periods of time. Do not place anything on the seat that insulates against
heat, such as a blanket or cushion, because this may cause the seat
heater to overheat. Do not puncture the seat with pins, needles, or
other pointed objects because this may damage the heating element
which may cause the seat heater to overheat. An overheated seat may
cause serious personal injury.
Note: Do not do the following:
Place heavy objects on the seat
Operate the seat heater if water or any other liquid is spilled on the
seat. Allow the seat to dry thoroughly.
The heated seats will only function when the engine is running.
132 Seats
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
To operate the heated seats:
Press the heated seat symbol to cycle through the various
heat settings and off. Warmer settings are indicated by
more indicator lights.
Ventilated Seats
The ventilated seats will only function when the engine is running.
To operate the ventilated seats:
Press the ventilated seat symbol to cycle through the
various cooling settings and off. Cooler settings are
indicated by more indicator lights.
If the engine falls below 350 RPMs while the ventilated seats are on, the
feature will turn itself off and you will need to reactivate it.
Heated and Ventilated Seats Air Filter Replacement (If Equipped)
The heated and ventilated seat system includes air filters. You must
replace them periodically. See scheduled maintenance information for
more information.
There is a filter located under each front seat. You can access the filter
from the second row seat. Move the front seats all the way forward and
up to ease access.
To remove a filter:
1. Remove the key from the
ignition.
2. Press up on the outside rigid
edge of the filter and rotate
counterclockwise once the tabs
are released.
3. Remove the filter.
A/C
Seats 133
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
To install a filter:
1. First, position the filter in its
housing making sure that the far
forward end is all the way up in the
housing.
2. Then, push in on the center of
the outside edge of the filter and
rotate up into the housing until it
clips into position.
REAR SEATS
Folding Down the 2nd Row 40% Seat System
WARNING: Use caution when folding the seat back to the flat
back position as the system will move forward when you lift the
release handle.
WARNING: Before returning the seat back to its original
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped
behind the seat back. After returning the seat back to its original
position, pull on the seat back to make sure that it has fully latched.
An unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden
stop or crash .
Make sure that the head restraint is in the down position and no objects
such as books, purses or briefcases are on the floor in front of the
second row seats before folding them down.
134 Seats
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Move the front passenger seat forward so that the second row seat
headrest clears the front seat.
1. Lower the head restraints by
pulling on the strap.
2. Locate handle on the side of the
seat cushion by the door.
3. Pull up on the handle and push
the seat back forward toward the
front of the vehicle.
To return the seat to the upright position:
1. Lift the seat back toward the rear
of the vehicle.
2. Rotate the seat back until you
hear a click, locking it in the upright
position.
Seats 135
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
3. Lift up on the head restraint until
it locks into its original position.
Placing the Second Row Outboard 40% Seats in Cargo Mode
WARNING: Use caution when folding the seatback to the flat
back position as the system will move forward when you lift the
release handle.
WARNING: Always return the seat from the kneel position prior
to raising the seatback. Failure to do so could result in personal
injury.
Place the second-row seats in a kneel down load floor position to allow
more cargo space.
To place the seats in the cargo mode:
1. Fold down the second row seat.
2. Pull the cargo mode lever up to
release the seat into a kneel down
load floor position.
136 Seats
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Returning to the upright position from full lowered load floor
position
You cannot return the seatback to the upright position until the seat is
returned from the kneel down position. To return the seat to the upright
position:
1. Push the seat rearward until the
latch is engaged.
2. Return the seatback to the
upright position.
Adjusting the Second Row Outboard 40% Seat for E-Z Entry
WARNING: Always latch the vehicle seat to the floor, whether
the seat is occupied or empty. If not latched, the seat may cause
injury during a sudden stop.
WARNING: After using the E-Z Entry feature make sure there
are not any objects, cargo or the feet of a third row occupant
under the second row seat when latching the seat to the floor. Injury to
the third row occupants feet or damage to the seat may occur.
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original position,
make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped behind the
seatback. After returning the seatback to its original position, pull on
the seatback to make sure that it has fully latched. An unlatched seat
may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or crash .
The E-Z entry seat allows for easier entry and exit to and from the third
row seat.
Seats 137
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
To enter the third row seat:
1. Fold down the second row seat
and release the handle.
2. Pull the handle up again until the
seat releases from the floor.
3. Push the seat upward and fold it
away from the third row.
To return the seat to a seating position:
1. Push the seat down and latch to
the floor.
2. Bring the seatback to an upright
position. The seatback should lock
into position.
Note: If the seatback will not return to the upright position, tumble the
seat again and re-latch it to the floor. Be sure that cargo or other objects
are not trapped underneath the seatback.
Note: If a squeak is heard from the
latch area, the latch striker pin
should be wiped clean of dust or
debris.
138 Seats
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Exiting the Third Row
1. Pull the strap located at the
bottom outboard of the seat back to
release the seat from the floor, and
rotate the seat up towards the front
seat.
2. Follow the directions above to
return the seat from the E-Z entry
and to the upright position.
Reclining the Second-Row Outboard 40% Seat Back
WARNING: Reclining the seat back can cause an occupant to
slide under the seat’s safety belt, resulting in severe personal
injuries in the event of a crash.
The release handle is located on the
outboard side of the seat cushion.
Lift it to allow the seat back to be
adjusted to the desired location.
Folding the Second-Row Center 20% Seat System (If Equipped)
WARNING: To prevent possible damage to the seat or safety
belts, make sure that the safety belts are not buckled when
moving the seat to the load floor position.
Seats 139
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original position,
make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped underneath
the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original position, pull
on the seatback to make sure that it has fully latched. An unlatched
seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or crash.
1. Locate the release handle located
in the upper left seatback, and pull
the handle to release the folding
seat latch.
2. With the latch released the
seatback can be lowered into the
load floor position.
3. To return the seat to the upright
position, lift the seat back until the
latch is fully engaged.
140 Seats
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Adjusting the Second-Row Center 20% Seat (If Equipped)
Note: Move this seat forward to keep a child in a child restraint close to
the front seat occupants. Move the seat to the full rearward position
when it is occupied by older children or adults, including children in
booster seats.
Lift the handle to move the seat
forward or backward.
Rear Heated Seats (If Equipped)
WARNING: Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes, spinal cord
injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion, or other physical conditions,
must exercise care when using the seat heater. The seat heater may
cause burns even at low temperatures, especially if used for long
periods of time. Do not place anything on the seat that insulates against
heat, such as a blanket or cushion, because this may cause the seat
heater to overheat. Do not puncture the seat with pins, needles, or
other pointed objects because this may damage the heating element
which may cause the seat heater to overheat. An overheated seat may
cause serious personal injury.
Note: Do not do the following:
Place heavy objects on the seat
Operate the seat heater if water or any other liquid is spilled on the
seat. Allow the seat to dry thoroughly.
The rear seat heat controls are located on the rear of the center console.
Seats 141
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
The heated seats only operate when the ignition is on. To operate the
heated seats:
Press the heated seat button to cycle through the various
heat settings and off. Warmer settings are indicated by
more indicator lights.
Third Row Seats
Make sure that no objects are on the floor in front of the third row seats
or on the seat cushion before lowering them. Make sure that the head
restraints are lowered and the second row seats are not reclined.
Folding Down the Third Row Seats to the Load Floor
WARNING: To prevent possible damage to the seat or safety
belts, make sure that the safety belts are not buckled when
moving the seat to the load floor position.
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original position,
make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped behind the
seatback. After returning the seat back to its original position, pull on
the seatback to make sure that it has fully latched. An unlatched seat
may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or crash.
Before folding the third row seats,
fold the head restraints down by
pulling on the strap located at the
bottom of the restraint.
142 Seats
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Pull up on the handle located
behind the seatback while pushing
the seat back forward and down
into the seat cushion.
To return the seat back to its original position, lift the seat back until it
latches into place.
PowerFold® Third-Row Seat (If Equipped)
Note: The power fold down seats will operate for 10 minutes after the
ignition switch is in off. The transmission must be in position P and the
liftgate, or liftgate glass must be open. Similar to the battery saver
feature, the power third row seat will be disabled 10 minutes after
turning the vehicle off.
Note: Be sure that the head restraints are folded down before powering
the third row seat down.
The control buttons are located on
the right-hand rear quarter trim
panel (accessible from the liftgate
area).
Seats 143
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Press B to lower the desired
seatback. Press A to return the
seatback to its original position.
If the power third row seat is disabled after 10 minutes, you can enable
the seat by:
opening any door
pressing the unlock button on the key fob
pressing any keyless entry keypad button
or turning the ignition key.
B
A A
B
UP
FOLD
UP
FOLD
144 Seats
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
UNIVERSAL GARAGE DOOR OPENER
The appearance of your vehicle’s universal garage door opener will vary
according to your option package. Before programing, make sure you
identify which transmitter you have by comparing it to the graphics below.
HomeLink®
Car2U® Home Automation
System
Note: The programming of the two types of universal garage door
openers are different and have different instructions. Identify your
package and refer to the instructions listed in this chapter.
CAR2U® HOME AUTOMATION SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING: Make sure that the garage door and security device
are free from obstruction when you are programming. Do not
program the system with the vehicle in the garage.
WARNING: Do not use the system with any garage door opener
that does not have the safety stop and reverse feature as
required by U.S. Federal Safety Standards (this includes any garage
door opener manufactured before April 1, 1982).
Note: Before you begin the programming process, park your vehicle in
front of the garage door opener motor or other device you want to
program.
Note: Make sure you keep the original remote control transmitter for
use in other vehicles as well as for future system programming.
Universal Garage Door Opener (If Equipped) 145
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: We recommend that upon the sale or lease termination of your
vehicle, you erase the programmed function buttons for security reasons.
See Erasing the Function Button Codes later in this section.
Note: You can program a maximum of three devices. To change or
replace any of the three devices after it has been initially programmed,
you must first erase the current settings. See Erasing the Function
Button Codes later in this section.
Note: Programming the system to a community gate will require a
unique set of instructions depending on the gate system model. Contact
the help line at 1-866-572-2728 for further information.
Note: If you accidently enter the program mode by pressing and
releasing the outer two buttons or all three buttons simultaneously, do
not press any button until the module times out after a few seconds and
resets to normal mode. When the module has timed out, all three LED
lamps will flash rapidly for a few seconds then turn off. Any settings
should remain as previously set.
The universal garage door opener
replaces the common hand-held
garage door opener with a
three-button transmitter that is
integrated into the driver’s sun
visor.
The system includes two primary features, a garage door opener and a
platform for remote activation of devices with the home. As well as
being programmed for garage doors, the system transmitter can be
programmed to operate security devices and home lighting systems.
Additional system information can be found on-line at
www.learcar2U.com or by calling the toll-free help line 1-866-572-2728.
146 Universal Garage Door Opener (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Rolling Code Programming
Note: If you do not follow the time-sensitive instructions, the device will
time out and you will have to repeat the complete procedure.
Note: It may be helpful to have another person assist you in
programming the transmitter.
1. Switch the ignition on.
2. Press and hold the outer two
buttons for 1–2 seconds, then
release.
Note: You may need a ladder to
reach the unit and you may need to
remove the cover or lamp lens.
Note: If you cannot locate the learn
button, see the Owner’s Manual for
your garage door opener or call the
toll-free help line at 1-866-572-2728.
3. Press the learn button on the
garage door opener motor.
Note: You will have 10–30 seconds
to complete the following steps.
4. Return to your car.
5. Press and hold the function
button you would like to use to
control the garage door. You may
need to hold the button from
5–20 seconds, during which time
the selected button LED lamp will flash slowly.
6. When the garage door moves, release the button within one second.
The LED lamp will flash rapidly until programming is complete.
7. Press and release the button again. The garage door should move,
confirming that programming is successful. If your garage door does not
operate, repeat the previous steps.
The LED lamp above the selected button will illuminate to confirm that
the system is responding to the button command.
To program another rolling code device, repeat Steps 1 through 6,
substituting a different function button in Step 5.
Universal Garage Door Opener (If Equipped) 147
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Fixed Code Programming
Note: It may be helpful to have another person assist you in
programming the transmitter.
To program units with fixed code
DIP switches, you will need the
garage door hand-held transmitter,
paper and a pen or pencil.
1. Switch the ignition on.
2. Open the battery cover and note
all the switch settings from left to
right.
When the switch is in the up, on, or + position, mark down “left button”.
When the switch is in the middle, neutral, or 0 position, mark down
“middle button”.
When the switch is in the down, off, or position, mark down “right
button”.
3. Press all three function buttons
simultaneously for a few seconds
and then release. The LED lamps
will flash slowly.
Note: The following step must be
completed within 2.5 minutes.
4. Enter the corresponding DIP switch settings from left to right into
the system by pressing and releasing the buttons corresponding to the
settings you noted.
5. Simultaneously press and release all three function buttons. The LED
lamps will illuminate.
6. Press and hold the function
button you would like to use to
control the garage door.
Note: You may need to hold the
button from 5–55 seconds before
observing movement of the garage
door.
7. When the garage door moves, release the button within one second.
When the button is released, the LED lamp will flash slowly.
148 Universal Garage Door Opener (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
8. The LED lamp will begin to flash rapidly until programming is
complete. If your garage door does not operate, repeat the previous
steps. Otherwise, call the toll-free help line at 1-866-572-2728.
The LED lamp above the selected button will illuminate to confirm that
the system is responding to the button command.
Erasing the Function Button Codes
Note: You cannot erase individual
buttons.
1. Press and hold the outer two
function buttons simultaneously for
approximately 20 seconds until the
LED lamps above the buttons flash
rapidly.
2. When the LED lamps flash, release the buttons. The codes for all
buttons are erased.
FCC and RSS-210 Industry Canada Compliance
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and with RSS-210 of
Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
(1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device
must accept any interference received, including interference that may
cause undesired operation.
Changes or modifications to your device not expressly approved by the
party responsible for compliance can void the user’s authority to operate
the equipment.
HOMELINK® WIRELESS CONTROL SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING: Make sure that the garage door and security device
are free from obstruction when you are programming. Do not
program the system with the vehicle in the garage.
WARNING: Do not use the system with any garage door opener
that does not have the safety stop and reverse feature as
required by U.S. Federal Safety Standards (this includes any garage
door opener manufactured before April 1, 1982).
Note: Make sure you keep the original remote control transmitter for
use in other vehicles as well as for future system programming.
Universal Garage Door Opener (If Equipped) 149
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: We recommend that upon the sale or lease termination of your
vehicle, you erase the programmed function buttons for security reasons.
See Erasing the function button codes later in this section.
Note: You can program a maximum of three devices. To change or
replace any of the three devices after it has been initially programmed,
you must first erase the current settings. See Erasing the function
button codes later in this section.
The universal garage door opener
replaces the common hand-held garage
door opener with a three-button
transmitter that is integrated into the
driver’s sun visor.
The system includes two primary features, a garage door opener and a
platform for remote activation of devices with the home. As well as being
programmed for garage doors, the system transmitter can be programmed
to operate entry gate operators, security systems, entry door locks, and
home or office lighting.
Additional system information can be found online at www.homelink.com
or by calling the toll-free help line on 1-800-355-3515.
Programming
Note: Put a new battery in the hand-held transmitter. This will ensure
quicker training and accurate transmission of the radio-frequency signal.
1. With your vehicle parked outside of the garage and your key in the
ignition, turn the key so that the ignition is in the on position.
2. Hold your hand-held, garage door
transmitter 1–3 inches (2–8 centimeters)
away from the HomeLink button you want
to program.
3. Using both hands, simultaneously press and hold the desired
HomeLink button and the hand-held transmitter button. DO NOT release
either one until the HomeLink indicator light flashes slowly and then
rapidly. When the indicator light flashes rapidly, both buttons may be
released. The rapid flashing indicates successful training.
150 Universal Garage Door Opener (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
4. Press and hold the HomeLink button you programmed for five
seconds, then release. You may need to do this twice to activate the
door. If your garage door does not operate, watch the HomeLink
indicator light.
If the indicator light stays on, the programming is complete. Press and
release the programmed HomeLink button, and then begin programming
your garage door opener. See below for Steps5–7.
If the indicator light flashes rapidly for two seconds and then turns to a
constant light, the HomeLink button is not programmed yet. Do the
following:
Press and hold the HomeLink button while you press and release
the hand-held transmitter button every two seconds. The HomeLink
indicator light will flash slowly and then rapidly once the HomeLink
function button recognizes and accepts the hand-held transmitter’s radio
frequency signal.
After programming the HomeLink button, follow Steps5–7aslisted
below to program your garage door opener.
Note: You may need a ladder to reach the unit
and you may need to remove the cover or
lamp lens on your garage door opener.
5. Press the learn button on the garage door
opener motor, and then you have 30 seconds
to complete the next step.
6. Return to your car.
7. Press and hold the function button you
want to program for two seconds, then
release. Repeat this step. Depending on
your brand of garage door opener, you
may need to repeat this sequence a third
time.
To program additional buttons, repeat Steps1–4.
For questions or comments, please contact HomeLink® at
www.homelink.com or 1-800-355-3515.
Universal Garage Door Opener (If Equipped) 151
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Erasing the Function Button Codes
Note: You cannot erase individual
buttons.
1. Press and hold the outer two function
buttons simultaneously for approximately
20 seconds until the indicator lights above
the buttons flash rapidly.
2. When the indicator lights flash, release
the buttons. The codes for all buttons are
erased.
Reprogramming a single button
To program a device to a previously trained button, follow these steps:
1. Press and hold the desired button. Do NOT release the button.
2. The indicator light will begin to flash after 20 seconds. Without
releasing the button, follow Step 1 in the Programming section.
For questions or comments, contact HomeLink® at www.homelink.com
or 1-800-355-3515.
Programming HomeLink to a Genie Intellicode 2 garage door
opener
Note: The Genie Intellicode 2 transmitter must already be programmed
to operate with the garage door opener.
Programing the transmitters
To program HomeLink to the transmitter you must first put the
transmitter into programming mode. To do this:
A. Red LED
B. Green LED
1. Press and hold one of the buttons on the hand-held transmitter
for 10 seconds. The LED light will change from green to green and red.
BA
152 Universal Garage Door Opener (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
2. Press the same button twice to confirm the change to Programming
mode. If done properly the LED light will appear red.
3. Hold the transmitter within 1–3 inches (2–8 centimeters) of the
button on the sun visor you want to program.
4. Press and hold both the programmed Genie button on the hand-held
transmitter and the button on the sun visor you want to program.
The indicator light on the sun visor will flash rapidly when the
programming is successful.
Note: the Genie transmitter will transmit for up to 30 seconds.
If HomeLink does not program within 30 seconds the Genie transmitter
will need to be pressed again. If the Genie transmitter LED displays
green and red, release the button until the LED turns off before pressing
the button again.
Once HomeLink has been programmed successfully, the Genie
transmitter must be changed out of program mode. To do this:
1. Press and hold the previously programmed Genie button on the
hand-held transmitter for 10 seconds. The indicator light will change
from red to red and green.
2. Press the same button twice to confirm the change. If done correctly
the LED will turn green.
Programming HomeLink to the Genie Intellicode garage door
opener motor
Note: You may need a ladder to access the garage door opener motor.
To program HomeLink to the garage
door opener motor:
1. Press and hold the PROGRAM
button on the garage door opener
motor until both blue LED’s turn on.
2. Release the PROGRAM button.
Only the smaller round LED should
be on.
3. Press and release the program button. The larger purple LED will
flash
Universal Garage Door Opener (If Equipped) 153
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: The next two steps must be completed in 30 seconds.
4. Press and release the Genie Intellicode 2 hand-held transmitter’s
previously programmed button. Both indicator lights on the garage door
opener motor unit should now flash purple.
5. Press and hold the previously programmed button on the sun visor for
two seconds. Repeat this step up to 3 times until the garage door moves.
Programming is now complete.
Clearing a HomeLink device
To erase programming from the three HomeLink buttons, press and hold
the two outer HomeLink buttons until the indicator light begins to flash.
The LED will begin flashing in 10 to 20 seconds, at which time both
buttons should be released. Programming has now been erased, and the
LED should blink slowly to indicate the device is in train mode when any
one of the three HomeLink buttons is pressed.
FCC and RSS-210 Industry Canada Compliance
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and with RSS-210 of
Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
(1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device
must accept any interference received, including interference that may
cause undesired operation.
Changes or modifications to your device not expressly approved by the
party responsible for compliance can void the user’s authority to operate
the equipment.
154 Universal Garage Door Opener (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
AUXILIARY POWER POINTS
WARNING: Do not plug optional electrical accessories into the
cigarette lighter socket (if equipped). Improper use of the lighter
can cause damage not covered by your warranty, and can result in fire
or serious injury.
Note: If used when the engine is not running, the battery will discharge.
There may be insufficient power to restart your engine.
Note: Do not insert objects other than an accessory plug into the power
point. This will damage the outlet and blow the fuse.
Note: Do not hang any type of accessory or accessory bracket from the
plug.
Note: Do not use the power point over the vehicle capacity of 12 volt
DC 180 watts or a fuse may blow.
Note: Do not use the power point for operating a cigarette lighter
element.
Note: Improper use of the power outlet can cause damage not covered
by your warranty.
Note: Always keep the power point caps closed when not in use.
Run the engine for full capacity use of the power point. To prevent the
battery from being discharged:
Do not use the power point longer than necessary when the engine is
not running.
Do not leave devices plugged in overnight or when the vehicle is
parked for extended periods.
Locations
Power points may be found:
by the passenger’s ankle near the floor on the front console
on the rear of the center console
on the right rear quarter panel.
Auxiliary Power Points 155
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
110 Volt AC Power Point (If Equipped)
WARNING: Do not keep electrical devices plugged in the power
point whenever the device is not in use. Do not use any
extension cord with the 110 volt AC power point, since it will defeat
the safety protection design. Doing so may cause the power point to
overload due to powering multiple devices that can reach beyond the
150–watt load limit and could result in fire or serious injury.
Note: The cap should always be closed whenever the power point outlet
is not in use.
Note: The power point will turn off after 13 minutes if the ignition is on
without the engine running. Keep the engine running to use the power
point.
The 110–volt AC power point outlet is used for powering electrical
devices that require up to 150 watts. Exceeding the 150–watt limit will
cause the power point to cut off the power temporarily to provide
overload protection.
The power point is located on the
back of the center console.
The power point is not designed for the following electric appliances;
they may not work properly:
Cathode-ray, tube-type televisions
Motor loads, such as vacuum cleaners, electric saws and other electric
power tools, compressor-driven refrigerators, etc.
156 Auxiliary Power Points
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Measuring devices that process precise data, such as medical
equipment, measuring equipment, etc.
Other appliances requiring an extremely stable power supply:
microcomputer-controlled electric blankets, touch sensor lamps, etc.
The power point can switch to a fault mode when it is overloaded,
overheated or shorted. Unplug your device and turn the ignition off then
on for overloading and shorting conditions. Let the system cool off, then
turn the ignition off then on for an overheating condition.
The power point can provide power whenever the ignition is on and the
indicator light is on. The indicator light is located in the top left corner
of the power point.
When the indicator light is:
on power point is ready to supply power
off power point power supply is off; ignition is not on
blinking power point is in fault mode
Auxiliary Power Points 157
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CENTER CONSOLE
Stow items in the cupholder carefully as items may become loose during
hard braking, acceleration or collisions, including hot drinks which may
spill.
Available console features include:
A. Cupholders
B. Utility compartment, coin holder
slots, tissue box holder, audio input
jack and USB port
C. Power point, rear climate
controls, rear audio controls, rear
heated seat controls and 110-volt
AC power point
D. Rear cupholders
E. Side storage
OVERHEAD CONSOLE (IF EQUIPPED)
The appearance of the overhead console will vary according to your
option package.
Press near the rear edge of the door
to open it.
A
B
C
D
E
158 Storage Compartments
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL INFORMATION
WARNING: Extended idling at high engine speeds can produce
very high temperatures in the engine and exhaust system,
creating the risk of fire or other damage.
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle on dry grass
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.
WARNING: Do not start your vehicle in a closed garage or in
other enclosed areas. Exhaust fumes can be toxic. Always open
the garage door before you start the engine.
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle,
have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer immediately.
Do not drive if you smell exhaust fumes.
If you disconnect the battery, your vehicle may exhibit some unusual
driving characteristics for approximately 5 miles (8 kilometers) after
you connect it. This is because the engine management system must
realign itself with the engine. You may disregard any unusual driving
characteristics during this period.
The powertrain control system meets all Canadian interference-causing
equipment standard requirements regulating the impulse electrical field
or radio noise.
Do not press the accelerator pedal while starting the engine. If you have
difficulty starting the engine, see Failure to start later in this section.
Starting and Stopping the Engine 159
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
IGNITION SWITCH
Note: Do not store the key in the ignition after the vehicle is turned off
and you have left the vehicle. This could cause a drain on the battery.
A. Off: The ignition is off.
B. Accessory: Allows the electrical accessories, such as the radio, to
operate while the engine is not running.
C. On: All the electrical circuits are operational. Warning lights are
illuminated. This is the key position when driving.
D. Start: Cranks the engine. Release the key as soon as the engine
starts.
STARTING A GASOLINE ENGINE
When you start the engine, the idle speed increases, this helps to warm
up the engine. If the engine idle speed does not slow down automatically,
have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer.
Before starting the engine:
Make sure all occupants have fastened their safety belts.
Make sure the headlamps and electrical accessories are off.
Make sure the parking brake is on.
Move the transmission selector lever to position P.
Turn the ignition key to the on position.
Some warning lights briefly illuminate.
Note: Do not touch the accelerator pedal.
1. Fully press the brake pedal.
2. Turn the key to the start position to start the engine. Release the key
when the engine starts.
Note: The engine may continue cranking for up to 15 seconds or until it
starts.
C
D
B
A
160 Starting and Stopping the Engine
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: If you cannot start the engine on the first try, wait for a short
period and try again.
If you have difficulty starting the engine when the temperature is below
-13°F (-25°C), press the accelerator pedal slightly and try again.
Failure to Start
If you cannot start the engine after three attempts, wait 10 seconds and
follow this procedure:
1. Fully press the brake pedal.
2. Fully press the accelerator pedal and hold it there.
3. Start the engine.
Stopping the Engine When Your Vehicle is Stationary
1. Move the transmission selector lever to position P.
2. Turn the key to the off position.
Stopping the Engine When Your Vehicle is Moving
WARNING: When you switch off the engine when your vehicle is
still moving, this results in a loss of brake and steering assistance.
The steering does not lock, but higher effort is required. When you
switch off the ignition, some electrical circuits, warning lamps and
indicators may also be off.
1. Move the transmission selector lever to position N and use the brakes
to bring your vehicle to a safe stop.
2. When your vehicle has stopped, move the transmission selector lever
to position P and turn the key to the off position.
Cold Weather Starting (Flexible Fuel Vehicles Only)
The starting characteristics of all grades of E-85 ethanol make it
unsuitable for use when ambient temperatures fall below 0°F (-18°C).
Consult your fuel distributor for the availability of winter grade ethanol.
As the outside temperature approaches freezing, ethanol fuel distributors
should supply winter grade ethanol (same as with unleaded gasoline). If
summer grade ethanol is used in cold weather conditions, 0°F to 32°F
(-18°C to 0°C), you may experience increased cranking times, rough idle
or hesitation until the engine has warmed up.
You may experience a decrease in peak performance when the engine is
cold when operating on E-85 ethanol.
Starting and Stopping the Engine 161
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Do not crank the engine for more than 10 seconds at a time as starter
damage may occur. If the engine fails to start, turn the key to off and
wait 30 seconds before trying again.
Do not use starting fluid such as ether in the air intake system. Such
fluid could cause immediate explosive damage to the engine and possible
personal injury.
If you should experience cold weather starting problems on E-85
ethanol, and neither an alternative brand of E-85 ethanol nor an engine
block heater is available, the addition of unleaded gasoline to your tank
improves cold starting performance. Your vehicle is designed to operate
on E-85 ethanol alone, unleaded gasoline alone, or any mixture of the
two.
If the Engine Fails to Start Using the Preceding Instructions
(Flexible Fuel Vehicles Only)
1. Press and hold down the accelerator 1/3 to 1/2 way to floor, then
crank the engine.
2. When the engine starts, release the key, then gradually release the
accelerator pedal as the engine speeds up. If the engine still fails to
start, repeat Step 1.
Guarding Against Exhaust Fumes
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have
this checked immediately. Do not drive your vehicle if you smell
exhaust fumes. Carbon monoxide is present in exhaust fumes. Take
precautions to avoid its dangerous effects.
Important Ventilating Information
If you stop your vehicle and leave the engine idling for long periods, we
recommend that you do one of the following:
Open the windows at least 1 inch (2.5 centimeters).
Set your climate control to outside air.
162 Starting and Stopping the Engine
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING: Failure to follow engine block heater instructions
could result in property damage or physical injury.
WARNING: Do not use your heater with ungrounded electrical
systems or two-pronged (cheater) adapters. There is a risk of
electrical shock.
Note: The heater is most effective when outdoor temperatures are below
0°F (-18°C).
The heater acts as a starting aid by warming the engine coolant. This
allows the climate control system to respond quickly. The equipment
includes a heater element (installed in the engine block) and a wire
harness. You can connect the system to a grounded 120–volt A/C
electrical source.
We recommend that you do the following for safe and correct operation:
Use a 16-gauge outdoor extension cord that is product certified
by Underwriter’s Laboratory or Canadian Standards Association.
This extension cord must be suitable for use outdoors, in cold
temperatures, and be clearly marked Suitable for Use with Outdoor
Appliances. Never use an indoor extension cord outdoors; it could
result in an electric shock or become a fire hazard.
Use as short an extension cord as possible.
Do not use multiple extension cords.
Make sure that when in operation, the extension cord plug and the
heater cord plug connections are free and clear of water. This could
cause an electric shock or fire.
Make sure your vehicle is parked in a clean area, clear of
combustibles.
Make sure the heater, heater cord and extension cord are firmly
connected.
Starting and Stopping the Engine 163
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Check for heat anywhere in the electrical hookup once the system has
been operating for approximately 30 minutes.
Make sure the system is unplugged and properly stowed before driving
your vehicle. Make sure the protective cover seals the prongs of the
block heater cord plug when not in use.
Keep plug terminals clean and free of dirt and corrosion.
Make sure the heater system is checked for proper operation before
winter.
Using the Engine Block Heater
Make sure the receptacle terminals are clean and dry before use.
To clean them, use a dry cloth.
The heater uses 0.4 to 1.0 kilowatt-hours of energy per hour of use.
The system does not have a thermostat. It achieves maximum
temperature after approximately three hours of operation. Using the
heater longer than three hours does not improve system performance
and unnecessarily uses electricity.
164 Starting and Stopping the Engine
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
WARNING: Do not overfill the fuel tank. The pressure in an
overfilled tank may cause leakage and lead to fuel spray and fire.
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If you hear
a hissing sound near the fuel filler inlet, do not refuel until the
sound stops. Otherwise, fuel may spray out, which could cause serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Automotive fuels can cause serious injury or death if
misused or mishandled.
WARNING: The flow of fuel through a fuel pump nozzle can
produce static electricity, which can cause a fire if fuel is pumped
into an ungrounded fuel container.
WARNING: Fuel ethanol and gasoline may contain benzene,
which is a cancer-causing agent.
WARNING: When refueling always shut the engine off and never
allow sparks or open flames near the filler neck. Never smoke
while refueling. Fuel vapor is extremely hazardous under certain
conditions. Care should be taken to avoid inhaling excess fumes.
Observe the following guidelines when handling automotive fuel:
Extinguish all smoking materials and any open flames before refueling
your vehicle.
Always turn off the vehicle before refueling.
Automotive fuels can be harmful or fatal if swallowed. Fuel, such as
gasoline, is highly toxic and if swallowed can cause death or
permanent injury. If fuel is swallowed, call a physician immediately,
even if no symptoms are immediately apparent. The toxic effects of
fuel may not be visible for hours.
Avoid inhaling fuel vapors. Inhaling too much fuel vapor of any kind
can lead to eye and respiratory tract irritation. In severe cases,
excessive or prolonged breathing of fuel vapor can cause serious
illness and permanent injury.
Fuel and Refueling 165
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Avoid getting fuel liquid in your eyes. If fuel is splashed in the eyes,
remove contact lenses (if worn), flush with water for 15 minutes and
seek medical attention. Failure to seek proper medical attention could
lead to permanent injury.
Fuels can also be harmful if absorbed through the skin. If fuel is
splashed on the skin or clothing, promptly remove contaminated
clothing and wash skin thoroughly with soap and water. Repeated or
prolonged skin contact with fuel liquid or vapor causes skin irritation.
Be particularly careful if you are taking Antabuse or other forms of
disulfiram for the treatment of alcoholism. Breathing gasoline vapors,
or skin contact could cause an adverse reaction. In sensitive
individuals, serious personal injury or sickness may result. If fuel is
splashed on the skin, promptly wash skin thoroughly with soap and
water. Consult a physician immediately if you experience an adverse
reaction.
FUEL QUALITY
Note: Use of any fuel other than those recommended may cause
powertrain damage and a loss of vehicle performance; repairs may not be
covered under warranty. The use of leaded fuel is prohibited by law.
Your vehicle was not designed to use fuel or fuel additives with metallic
compounds, including manganese-based additives.
Choosing the Right Fuel (Gasoline Vehicles)
Use only UNLEADED gasoline or UNLEADED gasoline blended with a
maximum of 15% ethanol in your gasoline vehicle. If your vehicle is a
Flex Fuel Vehicle (FFV), it will have a yellow bezel placed over the fuel
fill inlet.
Do not use:
fuels containing more than 15% ethanol or E-85 fuel
fuels containing methanol
fuels containing metallic based additives, including manganese-based
compounds
fuels containing the octane booster additive, methylcyclopentadienyl
manganese tricarbonyl (MMT)
leaded-fuel (The use of leaded fuel is prohibited by law)
166 Fuel and Refueling
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: Use of any fuel other than recommended fuel can cause
powertrain damage, impair the emission control system or cause loss of
vehicle performance. Any damage to the vehicle that is caused by the
use of fuel not recommended will not be covered under warranty.
Choosing the Right Fuel With a Flex Fuel Vehicle (If Equipped)
Use only UNLEADED gasoline or UNLEADED gasoline blended with
a maximum of 85% ethanol (E-85) in your Flex Fuel Vehicle (FFV).
If your vehicle is flex fuel capable, it will have a yellow bezel placed over
the fuel fill inlet.
Do not use:
fuels containing more than 85% ethanol or E-100 fuel
fuels containing methanol
fuels containing metallic based additives, including manganese-based
compounds
fuels containing the octane booster additive, methylcyclopentadienyl
manganese tricarbonyl (MMT)
leaded-fuel (The use of leaded fuel is prohibited by law)
Use of any fuel other than recommended fuel can cause powertrain
damage, impair the emission control system or cause loss of vehicle
performance. Any damage to a vehicle that is caused by use of fuel not
recommended will not be covered under warranty.
Octane Recommendations
Regular unleaded gasoline with a
pump (R+M)/2 octane rating of 87 is
recommended. Some stations offer
fuels posted as Regular with an
octane rating below 87, particularly
in high altitude areas. Fuels with octane levels below 87 are not
recommended. Premium fuel will provide improved performance and is
recommended for severe duty usage such as trailer tow.
Do not be concerned if your engine sometimes knocks lightly. However, if
it knocks heavily under most driving conditions while you are using fuel
with the recommended octane rating, see your authorized dealer to
prevent any engine damage.
87
(R+M)/2 METHOD
Fuel and Refueling 167
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
Avoid running out of fuel because this situation may have an adverse
effect on powertrain components.
If you have run out of fuel:
You may need to cycle the ignition from off to on several times after
refueling to allow the fuel system to pump the fuel from the tank to
the engine. On restarting, cranking time will take a few seconds longer
than normal.
Normally, adding 1 gallon (3.8L) of fuel is enough to restart the
engine. If the vehicle is out of fuel and on a steep grade, more than
1 gallon (3.8L) may be required.
The service engine soon indicator may come on. For more information
on the service engine soon indicator, refer to the Instrument Cluster
chapter.
See Settings in the Instrument Cluster chapter for information on
calculating DTE (Distance to empty).
Refilling With a Portable Fuel Container
WARNING: Do not insert the nozzle of portable fuel containers
or aftermarket funnels into the Easy Fuel® system. This could
damage the fuel system and its seal, and may cause fuel to run onto the
ground instead of filling the tank, which could result in serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Do not try to pry open or push open the Easy Fuel®
system with foreign objects. This could damage the fuel system
and its seal and cause injury to you or others.
168 Fuel and Refueling
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
With the Easy Fuel® “no cap” fuel system, use the following directions
when filling from a portable fuel container:
When filling the vehicle’s fuel tank from a portable fuel container, use the
funnel included with the vehicle.
1. The white plastic funnel is located under the
spare tire tool panel located in the floor
compartment behind the rear seat.
2. Unlatch and remove the spare tire tool panel. Remove the white
plastic funnel.
3. Slowly insert the funnel into the Easy Fuel system.
4. Fill the vehicle with fuel from the portable fuel container.
5. Clean the funnel or properly dispose of it. Extra funnels can be
purchased from your authorized dealer if you choose to dispose of the
funnel. Do not use aftermarket funnels; they will not work and can
damage the Easy Fuel system. The included funnel has been specially
designed to work safely with your vehicle.
REFUELING
WARNING: Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can cause
severe injuries. To help avoid injuries to you and others:
Read and follow all the instructions on the pump island.
Turn off your engine when you are refueling.
Do not smoke if you are near fuel or refueling your vehicle.
Keep sparks, flames and smoking materials away from fuel.
Stay outside your vehicle and do not leave the fuel pump unattended
when refueling your vehicle - this is against the law in some places.
Keep children away from the fuel pump; never let children pump
fuel.
Do not use personal electronic devices while refueling.
Fuel and Refueling 169
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Use the following guidelines to avoid electrostatic charge build-up when
filling an ungrounded fuel container:
Place approved fuel container on the ground.
DO NOT fill a fuel container while it is in the vehicle (including the
cargo area).
Keep the fuel pump nozzle in contact with the fuel container while
filling.
DO NOT use a device that would hold the fuel pump handle in the fill
position.
Easy Fuel® “No Cap” Fuel System
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If you hear
a hissing sound near the fuel filler door, do not refuel until the
sound stops. Otherwise, fuel may spray out, which could cause serious
personal injury.
When fueling your vehicle:
1. Turn the engine off.
2. Open the fuel door by pulling the indent on the door.
3. Insert the fuel plug key (if equipped) into the locking plug and turn it
counterclockwise to unlock it.
4. Slowly insert the fuel filler nozzle fully into the fuel system, and leave
the nozzle fully inserted until you are done pumping.
5. After you are done pumping fuel, slowly remove the fuel filler
nozzle—allow about ten seconds after pumping fuel before removing the
fuel filler nozzle. This allows residual fuel to drain back into the fuel tank
and not spill onto the vehicle.
6. Reinstall the plug (if equipped) into the fuel fill inlet and turn the key
clockwise to lock.
Note: Do not overfill the tank or fuel spillage will occur.
If the fuel fill inlet was not properly closed, a Check Fuel Fill Inlet
message may appear on the information display. See the Information
Displays chapter for more information.
At the next opportunity, do the following:
1. Safely pull off the road.
2. Turn off the engine.
170 Fuel and Refueling
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
3. Open the fuel filler door and remove any visible debris from the fuel
fill opening.
4. Insert either the fuel fill nozzle or the fuel fill funnel provided with the
vehicle several times to dislodge any debris and/or allow the inlet to
close properly.
If this action corrects the problem, the message may not reset
immediately. It may take several driving cycles for the message to turn
off. A driving cycle consists of an engine start-up (after four or more
hours with the engine off) followed by city/highway driving. Continuing
to drive with the message on may cause the service engine soon lamp to
turn on as well.
FUEL CONSUMPTION
Filling the Tank
The advertised capacity is the indicated capacity and the empty reserve
combined. Indicated capacity is the difference in the amount of fuel in a
full tank and a tank when the fuel gauge indicates empty. Empty reserve
is the amount of fuel in the tank after the fuel gauge indicates empty.
Note: The amount of usable fuel in the empty reserve varies and should
not be relied upon to increase driving range. When refueling your vehicle
after the fuel gauge indicates empty, you might not be able to refuel the
full amount of the advertised capacity of the fuel tank due to the empty
reserve still present in the tank.
For consistent results when filling the fuel tank:
Turn the ignition off before fueling; an inaccurate reading results if the
engine is left running.
Use the same fill rate (low–medium–high) each time the tank is filled.
Allow no more than two automatic click–offs when filling.
Results are most accurate when the filling method is consistent.
Fuel and Refueling 171
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Calculating Fuel Economy
Do not measure fuel economy during the first 1000 miles
(1600 kilometers) of driving (this is your engine’s break-in period); a
more accurate measurement is obtained after 2000 miles–3000 miles
(3200 kilometers–4800 kilometers). Also, fuel expense, frequency of
fill-ups or fuel gauge readings are not accurate ways to measure fuel
economy.
1. Fill the fuel tank completely and record the initial odometer reading.
2. Each time you fill the tank, record the amount of fuel added.
3. After at least three to five tank fill-ups, fill the fuel tank and record
the current odometer reading.
4. Subtract your initial odometer reading from the current odometer
reading.
5. Calculate fuel economy as follows:
Standard: Divide miles traveled by gallons used.
Metric: Multiply liters used by 100, then divide by kilometers traveled.
Keep a record for at least one month and record the type of driving (city
or highway). This provides an accurate estimate of the vehicle’s fuel
economy under current driving conditions. Additionally, keeping records
during summer and winter show how temperature impacts fuel economy.
In general, lower temperatures mean lower fuel economy.
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.
WARNING: Exhaust leaks may result in entry of harmful and
potentially lethal fumes into the passenger compartment. If you
smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have your dealer inspect your
vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you smell exhaust fumes.
172 Fuel and Refueling
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Your vehicle is equipped with various emission control components
and a catalytic converter which will enable your vehicle to comply with
applicable exhaust emission standards. To make sure that the catalytic
converter and other emission control components continue to work
properly:
Use only the specified fuel listed.
Avoid running out of fuel.
Do not turn off the ignition while your vehicle is moving, especially at
high speeds.
Have the items listed in Scheduled Maintenance Information
performed according to the specified schedule.
The scheduled maintenance items listed in Scheduled Maintenance
Information are essential to the life and performance of your vehicle
and to its emissions system.
If other than Ford, Motorcraft® or Ford-authorized parts are used
for maintenance replacements or for service of components affecting
emission control, such non-Ford parts should be equivalent to genuine
Ford Motor Company parts in performance and durability.
Illumination of the service engine soon indicator, charging system
warning light or the temperature warning light, fluid leaks, strange odors,
smoke or loss of engine power could indicate that the emission control
system is not working properly.
An improperly operating or damaged exhaust system may allow exhaust
to enter the vehicle. Have a damaged or improperly operating exhaust
system inspected and repaired immediately.
Do not make any unauthorized changes to your vehicle or engine. By
law, vehicle owners and anyone who manufactures, repairs, services,
sells, leases, trades vehicles, or supervises a fleet of vehicles are not
permitted to intentionally remove an emission control device or prevent
it from working. Information about your vehicle’s emission system is on
the Vehicle Emission Control Information Decal located on or near the
engine. This decal also lists engine displacement.
Please consult your warranty information for complete emission warranty
information.
Fuel and Refueling 173
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
On-board Diagnostics (OBD-II)
Your vehicle is equipped with a computer that monitors the engine’s
emission control system. This system is commonly known as the
on-board diagnostics system (OBD-II). The OBD-II system protects
the environment by ensuring that your vehicle continues to meet
government emission standards. The OBD-II system also assists your
authorized dealer in properly servicing your vehicle.
When the service engine soon indicator illuminates, the OBD-II
system has detected a malfunction. Temporary malfunctions
may cause the service engine soon indicator to illuminate.
Examples are:
1. The vehicle has run out of fuel—the engine may misfire or run poorly.
2. Poor fuel quality or water in the fuel—the engine may misfire or run
poorly.
3. The fuel fill inlet may not have been properly closed. See Easy Fuel®
No Cap Fuel System in this chapter.
4. Driving through deep water—the electrical system may be wet.
These temporary malfunctions can be corrected by filling the fuel tank
with good quality fuel, properly closing the fuel fill inlet or letting the
electrical system dry out. After three driving cycles without these or any
other temporary malfunctions present, the service engine soon indicator
should stay off the next time the engine is started. A driving cycle
consists of a cold engine start-up followed by mixed city or highway
driving. No additional vehicle service is required.
If the service engine soon indicator remains on, have your vehicle
serviced at the first available opportunity. Although some malfunctions
detected by the OBD-II may not have symptoms that are apparent,
continued driving with the service engine soon indicator on can result
in increased emissions, lower fuel economy, reduced engine and
transmission smoothness, and can lead to more costly repairs.
174 Fuel and Refueling
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) Testing
Some state, provincial and local governments may have
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) programs to inspect the emission control
equipment on your vehicle. Failure to pass this inspection could prevent
you from getting a vehicle registration.
If the service engine soon indicator is on or the bulb does not
work, the vehicle may need to be serviced. See On-board
Diagnostics (OBD-II) in this chapter.
Your vehicle may not pass the I/M test if the service engine soon
indicator is on or not working properly (bulb is burned out), or if the
OBD-II system has determined that some of the emission control systems
have not been properly checked. In this case, the vehicle is considered
not ready for I/M testing.
If the vehicle’s engine or transmission has just been serviced, or the
battery has recently run down or been replaced, the OBD-II system may
indicate that the vehicle is not ready for I/M testing. To determine if the
vehicle is ready for I/M testing, turn the ignition key to the on position
for 15 seconds without cranking the engine. If the service engine soon
indicator blinks eight times, it means that the vehicle is not ready for I/M
testing; if the service engine soon indicator stays on solid, it means that
the vehicle is ready for I/M testing.
The OBD-II system is designed to check the emission control system
during normal driving. A complete check may take several days. If the
vehicle is not ready for I/M testing, the following driving cycle consisting
of mixed city and highway driving may be performed:
15 minutes of steady driving on an expressway or highway followed
by 20 minutes of stop-and-go driving with at least four 30-second idle
periods.
Allow the vehicle to sit for at least eight hours without starting the
engine. Then, start the engine and complete the above driving cycle.
The engine must warm up to its normal operating temperature. Once the
engine is started, do not turn off the engine until the above driving cycle
is complete. If the vehicle is still not ready for I/M testing, the above
driving cycle will have to be repeated.
Fuel and Refueling 175
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the
LOCK position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.
WARNING: Do not use the Tow/Haul feature when driving in icy
or slippery conditions as the increased engine braking can cause
the rear wheels to slide and the vehicle to swing around with the
possible loss of vehicle control.
Your vehicle has been designed to improve fuel economy by reducing
fuel usage while coasting or decelerating. When you take your foot off
the accelerator pedal and the vehicle begins to slow down, the torque
converter clutch locks up and aggressively shuts off fuel flow to the
engine while decelerating. This fuel economy benefit may be perceived
as a light to medium braking sensation when removing your foot from
the accelerator pedal.
This vehicle is equipped with an Adaptive Transmission Shift Strategy.
The Adaptive Transmission Shift Strategy offers the optimal transmission
operation and shift quality. When the engine is turned off, the shift data
which includes the adaptive information will be stored automatically in
the Powertrain Control Module. If the battery is disconnected for any
reason, the stored information from the last time the key was turned to
off will be read. This way, no information will be lost with any battery
removal or battery disconnect.
176 Transmission
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
P (Park)
This position locks the transmission
and prevents the rear wheels from
turning.
To put your vehicle in gear:
Press the brake pedal
Start the engine
Move the gearshift lever into the desired gear. If your vehicle is
equipped with a floor-shift transmission, press the gearshift lever
release button (on the front of the lever) while shifting into the
desired gear.
To put your vehicle in P (Park):
Come to a complete stop
Move the gearshift lever and securely latch it in P (Park)
R (Reverse)
With the gearshift lever in R (Reverse), the vehicle will move backward.
Always come to a complete stop before shifting into and out of R
(Reverse).
N (Neutral)
With the gearshift lever in N (Neutral), the vehicle can be started and is
free to roll. Hold the brake pedal down while in this position.
D (Drive with Overdrive) with Tow/Haul Off
D (Drive with Overdrive) with Tow/Haul OFF is the normal driving
position for the best fuel economy. Transmission operates in gears one
through six.
T
/
H
P
R
N
D
3
2
1
Transmission 177
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
D (Drive with Overdrive) with Tow/Haul On
The Tow/Haul feature improves
transmission operation when towing
a trailer or a heavy load. All
transmission gear ranges are
available when using Tow/Haul.
To activate Tow/Haul, press the
button on the side of the gearshift
lever.
The TOW HAUL indicator light will
illuminate in the instrument cluster.
Tow/Haul delays upshifts to reduce frequency of transmission shifting.
Tow/Haul also provides engine braking in all forward gears when the
transmission is in the D (Drive with Overdrive) position; this engine
braking will slow the vehicle and assist the driver in controlling the
vehicle when descending a grade. Depending on driving conditions and
load conditions, the transmission may downshift, slow the vehicle and
control the vehicle speed when descending a hill, without the accelerator
pedal being pressed. The amount of downshift braking provided will vary
based upon the amount the brake pedal is depressed.
To deactivate the Tow/Haul feature and return to normal driving mode,
press the button on the end of the gearshift lever. The TOW HAUL light
will no longer be illuminated.
When you shut-off and restart the engine, the transmission will
automatically return to normal D (Drive with Overdrive) mode (Tow/Haul
OFF).
3 (Third) (column-shift only)
Transmission operates in third gear only.
Used for improved traction on slippery roads.
2 (Second)
Transmission operates in 2nd gear only.
Use 2 (Second) to start-up on slippery roads.
T
/
H
T
/
H
P
R
N
D
3
2
1
178 Transmission
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
1 (First)
Transmission operates in 1st gear only.
Provides maximum engine braking.
Allows upshifts by moving gearshift lever.
Will not downshift into 1 (First) at high speeds; allows for 1 (First)
when vehicle reaches slower speeds.
Forced downshifts
Allowed in D (Drive) only.
Press the accelerator to the floor.
Allows transmission to select an appropriate gear.
Automatic Transmission Adaptive Learning
This feature is designed to increase durability and provide consistent
shift feel over the life of the vehicle. A new vehicle or transmission may
have firm shifts, soft shifts or both. This operation is considered normal
and will not affect function or durability of the transmission. Over time,
the adaptive learning process will fully update transmission operation.
Additionally, whenever the battery is disconnected or a new battery
installed, the strategy must be relearned.
Brake-Shift Interlock Floor-Shift Transmission
WARNING: Do not drive your vehicle until you verify that the
brake lamps are working.
WARNING: When doing this procedure, you will be taking
the vehicle out of park which means the vehicle can roll freely.
To avoid unwanted vehicle movement, always fully set the parking
brake prior to doing this procedure. Use wheel chocks if appropriate.
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be
working properly. See your authorized dealer.
This vehicle is equipped with a brake-shift interlock feature that prevents
the gearshift lever from being moved from P (Park) when the ignition is
in the on position unless the brake pedal is pressed.
Transmission 179
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If you cannot move the gearshift lever out of P (Park) with ignition in
the on position and the brake pedal pressed, it is possible that a fuse has
blown or the vehicle’s brake lamps are not operating properly. Refer to
Fuses chapter for more information.
If the fuse is not blown and the brake lamps are working properly, the
following procedure will allow you to move the gearshift lever from P
(Park):
1. Apply the parking brake, turn the
ignition key to the off position, and
remove the key.
2. Using a screwdriver (or similar
tool), carefully pry off and remove
the chrome trim ring (1) from the
shifter bezel base.
3.
Using a screwdriver (or similar tool), carefully pry the trim panel (2) up
and disconnect it from the console to expose the inside of the gearshift.
4. Locate the brake shift interlock
lever on the passenger side of the
shifter assembly.
5. Apply the brake pedal and turn the
ignition key to the on position. Using
a screwdriver (or similar tool), press
and hold the brake shift interlock
lever while pulling the gearshift lever
out of the P (Park) position and into
the N (Neutral) position.
6. Install the trim panel (2) and chrome ring (1) in reverse order.
7. Apply brake pedal, start the vehicle, and release the parking brake.
Note: See your authorized dealer as soon as possible if this procedure is
used.
1
2
180 Transmission
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck in Mud or Snow
Note: Do not rock the vehicle if the engine is not at normal operating
temperature or damage to the transmission may occur.
Note: Do not rock the vehicle for more than a minute or damage to the
transmission and tires may occur, or the engine may overheat.
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow, it may be rocked out by
shifting between forward and reverse gears, stopping between shifts in a
steady pattern. Press lightly on the accelerator in each gear.
Transmission 181
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
USING FOUR-WHEEL DRIVE (4WD) (if equipped)
WARNING: For important information regarding safe operation
of this type of vehicle, see General Information in the Wheels
and Tires chapter.
Note: Do not use 4X4 mode on dry, hard surfaced roads. Doing so will
produce excessive noise, increase tire wear and may damage drive
components. 4X4 mode is only intended for consistently slippery or loose
surfaces.
Your 4x4 features the heavy-duty Control Trac® 4WD system which
includes a computer-operated transfer case. This unique system is
interactive with the road, continually monitoring and adjusting torque
delivery to the front and rear wheels to optimize vehicle control.
4WD Indicator Lights
The indicator lights illuminate in the message center in the
reconfigurable telltale (RTT) location under the following conditions.
Refer to Warning Lamps and Indicators in the Instrument Cluster
chapter.
Note: When a 4X4 system fault is present, the system will typically
remain in whichever 4X4 mode was selected prior to the fault condition
occurring. It will not default to 4X2 in all circumstances. When this
warning is displayed, have your vehicle serviced by an authorized dealer.
4X2 - Momentarily illuminates when 2H is selected.
4X4 AUTO - Continuously illuminates when 4A is selected.
4X4 - Continuously illuminates when 4H is selected.
CHECK 4X4 - Displays when a 4X4 fault is present.
182 Four-Wheel Drive (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
4WD switch positions
WARNING: Utility and four-wheel drive vehicles are not
designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger cars any
more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform satisfactorily
under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns or abrupt maneuvers in
these vehicles.
Note: The AdvanceTrac® with RSC® stability enhancement system can
be turned off manually by pressing the AdvanceTrac button, see the
Traction Control chapter for more information. This will disable the
engine management feature, allowing the vehicle to maintain full power
and enhanced momentum through the obstacle.
Note: The Control Trac selector switch should not be changed while the
rear wheels are slipping.
The Control Trac system functions in
three modes:
4X2 (2WD) delivers power to the rear wheels only. The information
display will momentarily display 4X2 when this mode is selected. This
mode is appropriate for normal on-road driving on dry pavement and
provides best fuel economy.
4X4 AUTO provides electronic control four-wheel drive with power
delivered to all four wheels, as required, for increased traction. The
information display will display 4X4 AUTO when this mode is selected.
This mode is appropriate for all on-road driving conditions, such as
dry road surfaces, wet pavement, snow, or gravel.
4X4 provides electronically locked four-wheel drive power to front and
rear wheels. The information display will display 4X4 when this mode
is selected. This mode is not recommended for use on dry pavement.
This position is only intended for severe winter or off-road conditions,
such as deep snow, ice or shallow sand.
Shifting between system modes
Note: Do not perform these operations if the rear wheels are slipping.
Note: Some noise may be heard as the system shifts or engages.
Press any button (4X2, 4X4 AUTO or 4X4) at a stop or while driving.
The message center may display a message indicating a 4X4 shift is in
progress. Once the shift is complete the message center will then display
the system mode selected.
4X2
4X4
AUTO
4X4
Four-Wheel Drive (If Equipped) 183
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
How Your Vehicle Differs From Other Vehicles
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as
utility and four-wheel drive vehicles handle differently than
vehicles with a lower center of gravity. Utility and four-wheel drive
vehicles are not designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger
cars any more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive
speed and abrupt maneuvers in these vehicles. Failure to drive
cautiously could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control,
vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.
Truck and utility vehicles can differ from some other vehicles. Your
vehicle may be higher to allow it to travel over rough terrain without
getting hung up or damaging underbody components.
The differences that make your vehicle so versatile also make it handle
differently than an ordinary passenger car.
Maintain steering wheel control at all times, especially in rough terrain.
Since sudden changes in terrain can result in abrupt steering wheel
motion, make sure you grip the steering wheel from the outside. Do not
grip the spokes.
Drive cautiously to avoid vehicle damage from concealed objects such as
rocks and stumps.
You should either know the terrain or examine maps of the area before
driving. Map out your route before driving in the area. To maintain
steering and braking control of your vehicle, you must have all four
wheels on the ground and they must be rolling, not sliding or spinning.
Driving Off-Road With Truck and Utility Vehicles
Note: On some 4WD models, the initial shift from two-wheel drive to
four-wheel drive while the vehicle is moving can cause some momentary
clunk and ratcheting sounds. This is the front drivetrain coming up to
speed and the automatic locking hubs engaging and is not cause for
concern.
Note: Your vehicle may be equipped with a front air dam that can
become damaged (due to reduced ground clearance) when taking your
vehicle off-road. This air dam can be taken off by removing two bolts.
4WD vehicles are specially equipped for driving on sand, snow, mud and
rough terrain and have operating characteristics that are somewhat
different from conventional vehicles, both on and off the road.
184 Four-Wheel Drive (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Power is supplied to all four wheels through a transfer case. On 4WD
vehicles, the transfer case allows you to select 4WD when necessary.
Information on transfer case operation and shifting procedures can be
found in this chapter. Information on transfer case maintenance can be
found in the Maintenance chapter. You should become thoroughly
familiar with this information before you operate your vehicle.
4WD (when you select a 4WD mode) uses all four wheels to power the
vehicle. This increases traction, enabling you to drive over terrain and
road conditions that a conventional two-wheel drive vehicle cannot.
Basic Operating Principles In Special Conditions
Do not use 4WD on dry, hard surfaced roads. Doing so will produce
excessive noise, increase tire wear and may damage drive components.
4WD modes are only intended for consistently slippery or loose
surfaces.
Drive slower in strong crosswinds which can affect the normal steering
characteristics of your vehicle.
Be extremely careful when driving on pavement made slippery by
loose sand, water, gravel, snow or ice.
If your vehicle goes off the edge of the pavement
If your vehicle goes off the edge of the pavement, slow down, but
avoid severe brake application, ease the vehicle back onto the
pavement only after reducing your speed. Do not turn the steering
wheel too sharply while returning to the road surface.
It may be safer to stay on the apron or shoulder of the road and slow
down gradually before returning to the pavement. You may lose
control if you do not slow down or if you turn the steering wheel too
sharply or abruptly.
It often may be less risky to strike small objects, such as highway
reflectors, with minor damage to your vehicle rather than attempt a
sudden return to the pavement which could cause the vehicle to slide
sideways out of control or roll over. Remember, your safety and the
safety of others should be your primary concern.
Four-Wheel Drive (If Equipped) 185
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If your vehicle gets stuck
WARNING: Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (56 km/h).
The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.
Note: Do not rock the vehicle if the engine is not at normal operating
temperature or damage to the transmission may occur.
Note: Do not rock the vehicle for more than a few minutes or damage to
the transmission and tires may occur or the engine may overheat.
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow it may be rocked out by
shifting between forward and reverse gears, stopping between shifts, in a
steady pattern. Press lightly on the accelerator in each gear.
Emergency maneuvers
In an unavoidable emergency situation where a sudden sharp turn
must be made, remember to avoid over-driving your vehicle, i.e., turn
the steering wheel only as rapidly and as far as required to avoid the
emergency. Excessive steering will result in less vehicle control, not
more. Additionally, smooth variations of the accelerator and/or brake
pedal pressure should be utilized if changes in vehicle speed are called
for. Avoid abrupt steering, acceleration or braking which could result
in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover and/or
personal injury. Use all available road surface to return the vehicle to a
safe direction of travel.
In the event of an emergency stop, avoid skidding the tires and do not
attempt any sharp steering wheel movements.
If the vehicle goes from one type of surface to another (i.e., from
concrete to gravel) there will be a change in the way the vehicle
responds to a maneuver (steering, acceleration or braking). Again,
avoid these abrupt inputs.
Sand
When driving over sand, try to keep all four wheels on the most solid
area of the trail. Avoid reducing the tire pressures but shift to a lower
gear and drive steadily through the terrain. Apply the accelerator slowly
and avoid spinning the wheels.
Avoid excessive speed because vehicle momentum can work against you
and cause the vehicle to become stuck to the point that assistance may
be required from another vehicle. Remember, you may be able to back
out the way you came if you proceed with caution.
186 Four-Wheel Drive (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Mud and water
Note: Driving through deep water may damage the vehicle.
If you must drive through high water, drive slowly. Traction or brake
capability may be limited.
When driving through water, determine the depth; avoid water higher
than the bottom of the hubs (if possible) and proceed slowly. If the
ignition system gets wet, the vehicle may stall.
Once through water, always try the brakes. Wet brakes do not stop the
vehicle as effectively as dry brakes. Drying can be improved by moving
your vehicle slowly while applying light pressure on the brake pedal.
Be cautious of sudden changes in vehicle speed or direction when you
are driving in mud. Even 4WD vehicles can lose traction in slick mud.
As when you are driving over sand, apply the accelerator slowly and
avoid spinning your wheels. If the vehicle does slide, steer in the
direction of the slide until you regain control of the vehicle.
If the transmission, transfer case or front axle are submerged in water,
their fluids should be checked and changed, if necessary.
If the front or rear axle is submerged in water, the axle lubricant should
be replaced.
After driving through mud, clean off residue stuck to rotating driveshafts
and tires. Excess mud stuck on tires and rotating driveshafts causes an
imbalance that could damage drive components.
“Tread Lightly” is an educational
program designed to increase public
awareness of land-use regulations
and responsibilities in our nations
wilderness areas. Ford Motor
Company joins the U.S. Forest
Service and the Bureau of Land Management in encouraging you to help
preserve our national forest and other public and private lands by “treading
lightly.”
Four-Wheel Drive (If Equipped) 187
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Driving on hilly or sloping terrain
Note: Avoid driving crosswise or turning on steep slopes or hills.
Although natural obstacles may make it necessary to travel diagonally up
or down a hill or steep incline, you should always try to drive straight up
or straight down. . A danger lies in losing traction, slipping sideways and
possibly rolling over. Whenever driving on a hill, determine beforehand
the route you will use. Do not drive over the crest of a hill without
seeing what conditions are on the other side. Do not drive in reverse
over a hill without the aid of an observer.
When climbing a steep slope or hill, start in a lower gear rather than
downshifting to a lower gear from a higher gear once the ascent has
started. This reduces strain on the engine and the possibility of stalling.
If you do stall out, do not try to turn around because you might roll over.
It is better to back down to a safe location.
Apply just enough power to the wheels to climb the hill. Too much
power will cause the tires to slip, spin or lose traction, resulting in loss of
vehicle control.
Descend a hill in the same gear you
would use to climb up the hill to
avoid excessive brake application and
brake overheating. Do not descend in
neutral; instead, disengage overdrive
or manually shift to a lower gear.
When descending a steep hill, avoid
sudden hard braking as you could
lose control. When you brake hard,
the front wheels can’t turn and if
they aren’t turning, you won’t be able
to steer. The front wheels have to be turning in order to steer the vehicle.
If your vehicle has anti-lock brakes, apply the brakes steadily. Do not
pump the brakes.
Driving on snow and ice
WARNING: If you are driving in slippery conditions that require
tire chains or cables, then it is critical that you drive cautiously.
Keep speeds down, allow for longer stopping distances and avoid
aggressive steering to reduce the chances of a loss of vehicle control
which can lead to serious injury or death. If the rear end of the vehicle
slides while cornering, steer in the direction of the slide until you
regain control of the vehicle.
188 Four-Wheel Drive (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
4WD vehicles have advantages over 2WD vehicles in snow and ice but
can skid like any other vehicle.
Should you start to slide while driving on snowy or icy roads, turn the
steering wheel in the direction of the slide until you regain control.
Avoid sudden applications of power and quick changes of direction on
snow and ice. Apply the accelerator slowly and steadily when starting
from a full stop.
Avoid sudden braking as well. Although a 4WD vehicle may accelerate
better than a two-wheel drive vehicle in snow and ice, it won’t stop any
faster, because as in other vehicles, braking occurs at all four wheels.
Do not become overconfident as to road conditions.
Make sure you allow sufficient distance between you and other vehicles
for stopping. Drive slower than usual and consider using one of the lower
gears. In emergency stopping situations, apply the brake steadily. Do not
pump the brakes. Refer to the Brakes section of this chapter for
additional information on the operation of the Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS).
Maintenance and modifications
The suspension and steering systems on your vehicle have been designed
and tested to provide predictable performance whether loaded or empty
and durable load carrying capability. For this reason, Ford Motor
Company strongly recommends that you do not make modifications such
as adding or removing parts (such as lift kits or stabilizer bars) or by
using replacement parts not equivalent to the original factory equipment.
Any modifications to a vehicle that raise the center of gravity can make
it more likely the vehicle will roll over as a result of a loss of control.
Ford Motor Company recommends that caution be used with any vehicle
equipped with a high load or device (such as ladder racks or pickup box
cover).
Failure to maintain your vehicle properly may void the warranty, increase
your repair cost, reduce vehicle performance and operational capabilities
and adversely affect driver and passenger safety. Frequent inspection of
vehicle chassis components is recommended if the vehicle is subjected to
heavy off-road usage.
Four-Wheel Drive (If Equipped) 189
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL INFORMATION
Note: Occasional brake noise is normal. If a metal-to-metal, continuous
grinding or continuous squeal sound is present, the brake linings may be
worn out. Have them inspected by an authorized dealer. If your vehicle
has continuous vibration or shudder in the steering wheel while braking,
have your vehicle inspected by an authorized dealer.
Note: Brake dust may accumulate on the wheels, even under normal
driving conditions. Some dust is inevitable as the brakes wear and does
not contribute to brake noise. See the Vehicle Care chapter for wheel
cleaning instructions.
See the Instrument Cluster chapter for information on the
brake system warning light.
Wet brakes result in reduced braking efficiency. Gently press the brake
pedal a few times when driving from a car wash or standing water to dry
the brakes.
Brake Over Accelerator
In the event the accelerator pedal becomes stuck or entrapped, apply
steady and firm pressure to the brake pedal to slow your vehicle and
reduce engine power. If you experience this condition, apply the brakes
and bring your vehicle to a safe stop. Turn the engine off, shift to
position P and apply the parking brake, then inspect the accelerator
pedal for any interferences. If none are found and the condition persists,
have your vehicle towed to the nearest authorized dealer.
Anti-Lock Brake System
This system helps you maintain steering control during emergency stops
by keeping the brakes from locking.
This lamp momentarily illuminates when you turn the ignition
on. If the light does not illuminate during start-up, remains on
or flashes, the anti-lock brake system may be disabled and may
need to be serviced.
If the anti-lock brake system is disabled, normal braking is still
effective. If the brake warning lamp illuminates with the parking
brake released, have your brake system serviced immediately.
190 Brakes
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
HINTS ON DRIVING WITH ANTI-LOCK BRAKES
When the system is operating, the brake pedal will pulse and may travel
further. Maintain pressure on the brake pedal. You may also hear a noise
from the system. This is normal.
The anti-lock braking system will not eliminate the dangers inherent
when:
you drive too closely to the vehicle in front of you.
your vehicle is hydroplaning.
you take corners too fast.
the road surface is poor.
PARKING BRAKE
WARNING:
Always set the parking brake fully and make sure that
the transmission selector lever is securely latched in position P.
To set the parking brake, press the parking brake pedal down until the
pedal stops.
The brake warning lamp will illuminate and will remain illuminated until
the parking brake is released.
To release, pull the brake release lever located at the lower left side of
the instrument panel.
Brakes 191
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
The traction control system helps avoid drive wheel spin and loss of
traction.
If your vehicle begins to slide, the system applies the brakes to individual
wheels and, when needed, reduces engine power at the same time. If the
wheels spin when accelerating on slippery or loose surfaces, the system
reduces engine power in order to increase traction.
USING TRACTION CONTROL
In certain situations (for example, stuck in snow or mud), turning the
traction control off may be beneficial as this allows the wheels to spin
with full engine power. Turn the traction control system off using the
TCS OFF button located on the center of the instrument panel.
System indicator lights and messages
WARNING: If a failure has been detected within the Traction
Control System, the stability control light will illuminate steadily.
Verify that the Traction Control System was not manually disabled.
If the stability control light still illuminates steadily, have the system
serviced by an authorized dealer immediately. Operating your vehicle
with Traction Control disabled could lead to an increased risk of loss of
vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.
The stability control light temporarily illuminates on engine
start-up and flashes when a driving condition activates the
stability system.
The stability control off light temporarily illuminates on engine
start-up and stays on when the traction control system is
turned off or if a problem occurs in the stability system.
When the traction control system is turned off or on, a message appears
in the information display showing system status.
192 Traction Control
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
WARNING: Vehicle modifications involving braking system,
aftermarket roof racks, suspension, steering system, tire
construction or wheel and tire size may change the handling
characteristics of the vehicle and may adversely affect the performance
of the AdvanceTrac® system. In addition, installing any stereo
loudspeakers may interfere with and adversely affect the AdvanceTrac®
system. Install any aftermarket stereo loudspeaker as far as possible
from the front center console, the tunnel, and the front seats in order
to minimize the risk of interfering with the AdvanceTrac® sensors.
Reducing the effectiveness of the AdvanceTrac® system could lead to
an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal
injury and death.
WARNING: Remember that even advanced technology cannot
defy the laws of physics. It’s always possible to lose control of a
vehicle due to inappropriate driver input for the conditions. Aggressive
driving on any road condition can cause you to lose control of your
vehicle increasing the risk of personal injury or property damage.
Activation of the AdvanceTrac® system is an indication that at least
some of the tires have exceeded their ability to grip the road; this could
reduce the operator’s ability to control the vehicle potentially resulting
in a loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.
If your AdvanceTrac® system activates, SLOW DOWN.
The AdvanceTrac® with Roll Stability Control™ system helps you keep
control of your vehicle when on a slippery surface. The electronic stability
control portion of the system helps avoid skids and lateral slides and roll
stability control helps avoid a vehicle rollover. The traction control system
helps avoid drive wheel spin and loss of traction. See the Traction Control
chapter for details on traction control system operation.
Stability Control 193
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
A Vehicle without AdvanceTrac®
with RSC® skidding off its intended
route.
B Vehicle with AdvanceTrac® with
RSC® maintaining control on a
slippery surface.
USING ADVANCETRAC® WITH RSC®
The system automatically activates when you start your engine. The
AdvanceTrac® with RSC® system cannot be completely turned off, but
the electronic stability control and roll stability control portions of the
system are disabled when the transmission is in position R. You can turn
off the traction control portion of the system independently. See the
Traction Control chapter.
194 Stability Control
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SENSING SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING: To help avoid personal injury, please read and
understand the limitations of the system as contained in this
section. Sensing is only an aid for some (generally large and fixed)
objects when moving in reverse on a flat surface at parking speeds.
Traffic control systems, inclement weather, air brakes, and external
motors and fans may also affect the function of the sensing system;
this may include reduced performance or a false activation.
WARNING: To help avoid personal injury, always use caution
when in R (Reverse) and when using the sensing system.
WARNING: This system is not designed to prevent contact with
small or moving objects. The system is designed to provide a
warning to assist the driver in detecting large stationary objects to
avoid damaging the vehicle. The system may not detect smaller objects,
particularly those close to the ground.
WARNING: Certain add-on devices such as large trailer hitches,
bike or surfboard racks and any device that may block the normal
detection zone of the system, may create false beeps.
Note: Keep the sensors (located on the bumper/fascia) free from snow,
ice and large accumulations of dirt. If the sensors are covered, the
system’s accuracy can be affected. Do not clean the sensors with sharp
objects.
Note: If your vehicle sustains damage to the bumper/fascia, leaving it
misaligned or bent, the sensing zone may be altered causing inaccurate
measurement of obstacles or false alarms.
Note: If your vehicle is equipped with MyKey®, it is possible to prevent
turning the sensing system off. Refer to the MyKey® chapter.
The sensing system warns the driver of obstacles within a certain range
of the bumper area. The system turns on automatically whenever the
ignition is switched on.
When receiving a detection warning, the radio volume is reduced to a
predetermined level. After the warning goes away, the radio volume
returns to the previous level.
Parking Aids 195
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Using the Front and Rear Sensing System
Rear Sensing System
The rear sensors are only active when the transmission is in R (Reverse).
As the vehicle moves closer to the obstacle, the rate of the audible
warning increases. When the obstacle is fewer than 10 inches
(25 centimeters) away, the warning sounds continuously. If a stationary
or receding object is detected farther than 10 inches (25 centimeters)
from the side of the vehicle, the tone sounds for only three seconds.
Once the system detects an object approaching, the warning sounds
again.
A. Coverage area of up to 6 feet
(2 meters) from the rear bumper
(with a decreased coverage area at
the outer corners of the bumper).
The system detects certain objects while the transmission is in R
(Reverse):
and moving toward a stationary object at a speed of 3 mph (5 km/h)
or less.
but not moving, and a moving object is approaching the rear of the
vehicle at a speed of 3 mph (5 km/h) or less.
and moving at a speed of less than 3 mph (5 km/h) and a moving
object is approaching the rear of the vehicle at a speed of less than
3 mph (5 km/h).
A
196 Parking Aids
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Front Sensing System
The front sensors are active when the gearshift is in any position other
than P (Park) or N (Neutral) and the vehicle speed is below 8 mph
(13 km/h).
A. Coverage area of up to 27 inches
(70 centimeters) from the front of
the vehicle and about 6–9 inches
(15–23 centimeters) to the side of
the front end of the vehicle. Refer
to the reverse sensing section for
details on coverage area.
The system sounds an audible warning when obstacles are near either
bumper in the following manner:
Objects detected by the front sensors are indicated by a high-pitched
tone from the front of the vehicle.
Objects detected by the rear sensors are indicated by a lower pitched
tone from the rear of the vehicle.
The sensing system reports the obstacle which is closest to the front
or rear of the vehicle. For example, if an obstacle is 12 inches
(30 centimeters) from the front of the vehicle and, at the same time,
an obstacle is only 6 inches (15 centimeters) from the rear of the
vehicle, the lower pitched tone sounds.
An alternating warning sounds from the front and rear if there
are objects at both bumpers that are closer than 10 inches
(25 centimeters).
For specific information on the reverse sensing portion of the system,
refer to that section.
A
Parking Aids 197
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
REAR VIEW CAMERA SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING: The rear view camera system is a reverse aid
supplement device that still requires the driver to use it in
conjunction with the interior and exterior mirrors for maximum
coverage.
WARNING: Objects that are close to either corner of the
bumper or under the bumper, might not be seen on the screen
due to the limited coverage of the camera system.
WARNING: Back up as slow as possible since higher speeds
might limit your reaction time to stop the vehicle.
WARNING:
Use caution when using the rear video camera and
the liftgate is ajar. If the liftgate is ajar, the camera will be out of
position and the video image may be incorrect. All guidelines (if enabled)
have been removed when the liftgate is ajar.
WARNING: Use caution when turning camera features on or off
while in R (Reverse). Make sure the vehicle is not moving.
The rear view camera system provides a video image of the area behind
the vehicle.
During operation, lines appear in the display which represent your
vehicle’s path and proximity to objects behind the vehicle.
The camera is located on the
liftgate.
198 Parking Aids
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Using the Rear View Camera System
The rear view camera system displays what is behind your vehicle when
you place the transmission in R (Reverse). The system uses two types of
guides to help you see what is behind your vehicle:
1. Fixed guidelines: Show the actual path the vehicle is moving in while
reversing in a straight line, which can be helpful when backing into a
parking space or aligning the vehicle with another object behind the
vehicle.
2. Centerline: Helps align the center of the vehicle with an object (i.e. a
trailer).
Note: If the image comes on while the transmission is not in R
(Reverse), have the system inspected by your authorized dealer.
Note: When towing, the camera only sees what is being towed behind
the vehicle. This might not provide adequate coverage as it usually
provides in normal operation and some objects might not be seen.
In some vehicles, the guidelines may disappear once the trailer tow
connector is engaged.
Note: The default setting for the camera delay is off. Press the Settings
button found on the navigation screen (if equipped) to set the camera
delay feature to on or off.
Note: The camera may not operate correctly under the following
conditions:
Nighttime or dark areas if one or both reverse lamps are not
operating.
The camera’s view is obstructed by mud, water or debris. Clean the
lens with a soft, lint-free cloth and non-abrasive cleaner.
The rear of the vehicle is hit or damaged, causing the camera to
become misaligned.
Parking Aids 199
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Guidelines and the Centerline
Note: Fixed guidelines are only available when the transmission is in R
(Reverse).
Note: The centerline is only available if fixed guidelines are on.
A. Rear bumper
B. Fixed guideline: Red zone
C. Fixed guideline: Yellow zone
D. Fixed guideline: Green zone
E. Centerline
The fixed guidelines fade in and out depending on the steering wheel
position.
Always use caution while reversing. Objects in the red zone are closest
to your vehicle and objects in the green zone are further away. Objects
are getting closer to your vehicle as they move from the green zone to
the yellow or red zones. Use the side view mirrors and rear view mirror
to get better coverage on both sides and rear of the vehicle.
Selectable settings for this feature are FIXED and OFF.
Rear Camera Delay
Navigation display
When shifting the transmission out of R (Reverse) and into any gear
other than P (Park), the camera image remains in the display until the
vehicle speed reaches 5 mph (8 km/h). This occurs when the rear
camera delay feature is on, or until a radio button is selected.
Selectable settings for this feature are ON and OFF. The default setting
for the rear camera delay is OFF.
Rearview mirror display
When shifting out of R (Reverse) and into any other gear, the image in
the rearview mirror will remain on for a few seconds before it shuts off
to assist in parking or trailer hookup.
A
E
D
C
B
200 Parking Aids
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
Cruise control lets you maintain a set speed without keeping your foot
on the accelerator pedal.
USING CRUISE CONTROL
WARNING: Do not use cruise control in heavy traffic, on
winding roads or when the road surface is slippery. This could
result in loss of vehicle control, serious injury or death.
WARNING: When you are going downhill, your vehicle speed
may increase above the set speed. The system will not apply the
brakes. Change down a gear to assist the system in maintaining the set
speed. Failure to do so could result in loss of vehicle control, serious
injury or death.
Note: Cruise control will disengage if your vehicle speed decreases more
than 10 mph (16 km/h) below your set speed while driving uphill.
The cruise controls are located on
the steering wheel.
Switching On Cruise Control
Press and release ON.
RESUME
S
E
T
+
OFF ON
S
E
T
-
Cruise Control 201
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Setting a Speed
1. Accelerate to the desired speed.
2. Press and release SET+.
3. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.
The indicator will turn on in the instrument cluster.
Changing the Set Speed
Press and hold SET+ or SET–. Release the button when you reach
the desired speed.
Press and release SET+ or SET–. The set speed will change in
approximately 1 mph (2 km/h) increments.
Press the accelerator pedal or brake pedal until you reach the desired
speed. Press and release SET+.
Canceling a Set Speed
Tap the brake pedal. The set speed will not be erased.
Resuming a Set Speed
Press and release RESUME.
Switching Off Cruise Control
Note: The set speed is erased when you turn off cruise control.
Press OFF or turn off the ignition.
202 Cruise Control
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
STEERING
Your vehicle is equipped with power steering. Power steering uses energy
from the engine to decrease the driver’s effort in steering the vehicle.
To help prevent damage to the power steering pump:
Never hold the steering wheel to the extreme right or the extreme left
for more than a few seconds when the engine is running.
Do not operate the vehicle with the power steering pump fluid level
below the MIN mark on the reservoir.
Some noise is normal during operation. If the noise is excessive, check
for low power steering pump fluid level before seeking service by your
authorized dealer.
Heavy or uneven steering efforts may be caused by low power steering
pump fluid level. Check for low power steering pump fluid level before
seeking service by your authorized dealer.
Do not fill the power steering pump reservoir above the MAX mark on
the reservoir, as this may result in leaks from the reservoir.
If the power steering system breaks down (or if the engine is turned
off), you can steer the vehicle manually, but it takes more effort.
If the steering wanders or pulls, check for:
Underinflated tire(s) on any wheel(s)
Uneven vehicle loading
High crown in center of road
High crosswinds
Wheels out of alignment
Loose or worn suspension components
Driving Aids 203
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
AUTO LEVELING SUSPENSION SYSTEM (if equipped)
The automatic leveling suspension system is designed to improve ride,
handling and general vehicle performance during:
Certain road conditions
Steering maneuvers
Braking
Acceleration
Towing
This system keeps the rear of your vehicle at a constant level through a
hydraulic pump inside each rear shock. Depending on the payload or
road surface conditions it will take approximately 2 miles (3.2 km) for
the leveling to complete.
If the loaded vehicle is not moved for approximately 12 hours, the
leveling system may bleed down to a lower height. This can be especially
apparent if a trailer is left attached to the parked vehicle for long periods
of time. You must drive your vehicle in order to re-level the suspension.
If a self-equalizing hitch is being used, your vehicle should be drive
approximately 2 miles (3.2 km) with the trailer prior to adjusting
(leveling) the hitch.
204 Driving Aids
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ROOF RACKS AND LOAD CARRIERS
WARNING: When loading the roof rail crossbars, it is
recommended to evenly distribute the load, as well as maintain a
low center of gravity. Loaded vehicles, with higher centers of gravity,
may handle differently than unloaded vehicles. Extra precautions, such
as slower speeds and increased stopping distance, should be taken
when driving a heavily loaded vehicle.
Note: The maximum recommended load is 200 pounds (90 kilograms),
evenly distributed on the crossbars.
Note: Loads should never be placed directly on the roof panel. The roof
panel is not designed to directly carry a load.
For proper function of the roof rack system, loads must be placed
directly on crossbars affixed to the roof rack side rails. Your vehicle may
be equipped with factory-installed crossbars. Ford Genuine Accessory
crossbars, designed specifically for your vehicle, are also recommended
for use with your roof rack system.
Make sure that the load is securely fastened. Check the tightness of the
load before driving and at each fuel stop.
Adjusting the Crossbars (If Equipped)
1. Loosen the thumbwheels at both ends of the
crossbar by turning them counterclockwise (both
crossbars are adjustable).
2. Slide the crossbar to the desired location.
3. Tighten the thumbwheels at both ends of the
crossbar by turning them clockwise.
Make sure to check that the thumbwheels are tight each time a load is
added or removed from the roof rack, and periodically while traveling.
Make sure that the load is secure before traveling.
Load Carrying 205
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
LOAD LIMIT
Vehicle Loading With and Without a Trailer
This section will guide you in the proper loading of your vehicle and/or
trailer, to keep your loaded vehicle weight within its design rating
capability, with or without a trailer. Properly loading your vehicle will
provide maximum return of vehicle design performance. Before loading
your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms for determining
your vehicle’s weight ratings, with or without a trailer, from the vehicle’s
Tire Label or Safety Compliance Certification Label:
Base Curb Weight is the weight of the vehicle including a full tank of
fuel and all standard equipment. It does not include passengers, cargo, or
optional equipment.
Vehicle Curb Weight is the weight of your new vehicle when you
picked it up from your authorized dealer plus any aftermarket
equipment.
Payload
is the combined weight of cargo and passengers that the
vehicle is carrying. The maximum payload for your vehicle can be found
on the Tire Label on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door (vehicles
exported outside the US and Canada may not have a Tire Label). Look for
“THE COMBINED WEIGHT OF OCCUPANTS AND CARGO SHOULD
NEVER EXCEED XXX kg OR XXX lb.” for maximum payload. The
payload listed on the Tire Label is the maximum payload for the vehicle
as built by the assembly plant. If any aftermarket or authorized-dealer
installed equipment has been installed on the vehicle, the weight of the
equipment must be subtracted from the payload listed on the Tire Label in
order to determine the new payload.
206 Load Carrying
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WARNING: The appropriate loading capacity of your vehicle can
be limited either by volume capacity (how much space is
available) or by payload capacity (how much weight the vehicle should
carry). Once you have reached the maximum payload of your vehicle,
do not add more cargo, even if there is space available. Overloading or
improperly loading your vehicle can contribute to loss of vehicle control
and vehicle rollover.
Example only:
Load Carrying 207
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Cargo Weight includes all weight added to the Base Curb Weight,
including cargo and optional equipment. When towing, trailer tongue load
or king pin weight is also part of cargo weight.
GAW (Gross Axle Weight) is the total weight placed on each axle
(front and rear) including vehicle curb weight and all payload.
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable
weight that can be carried by a single axle (front or rear). These
numbers are shown on the Safety Compliance Certification
Label. The label shall be affixed to either the door hinge pillar,
door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post,
next to the driver’s seating position. The total load on each axle
must never exceed its GAWR.
Note: For trailer towing information refer to the RV and Trailer Towing
Guide provided by your authorized dealer.
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) is the Vehicle Curb Weight + cargo +
passengers.
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable
weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all options, equipment,
passengers and cargo). The GVWR is shown on the Safety
Compliance Certification Label. The label shall be affixed to
either the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that
meets the door-latch post, next to the driver’s seating position.
The GVW must never exceed the GVWR.
208 Load Carrying
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Example only:
WARNING: Exceeding the Safety Compliance Certification Label
vehicle weight rating limits could result in substandard vehicle
handling or performance, engine, transmission and/or structural
damage, serious damage to the vehicle, loss of control and personal
injury.
Load Carrying 209
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GCW (Gross Combined Weight) is the weight of the loaded vehicle
(GVW) plus the weight of the fully loaded trailer.
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable
weight of the vehicle and the loaded trailer including all cargo and
passengers that the vehicle can handle without risking damage.
(Important: The towing vehicle’s braking system is rated for operation at
GVWR, not at GCWR.) Separate functional brakes should be used for
safe control of towed vehicles and for trailers where the GCW of the
towing vehicle plus the trailer exceed the GVWR of the towing vehicle.
The GCW must never exceed the GCWR.
Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight is the highest possible weight of a
fully loaded trailer the vehicle can tow. It assumes a vehicle with only
mandatory options, no cargo (internal or external), a tongue load of
10–15% (conventional trailer) or king pin weight of 15–25% (fifth wheel
trailer), and driver only (150 lb. [68 kg]). Consult your authorized
dealer (or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide provided by your
authorized dealer) for more detailed information.
Tongue Load or Fifth Wheel King Pin Weight refers to the amount
of the weight that a trailer pushes down on a trailer hitch.
Examples: For a 5,000 lb. (2,268 kg) conventional trailer, multiply 5,000
by 0.10 and 0.15 to obtain a proper tongue load range of 500 to 750 lb.
(227 to 340 kg). For an 11,500 lb. (5,216 kg) fifth wheel trailer, multiply
by 0.15 and 0.25 to obtain a proper king pin load range of 1,725 to
2,875 lb. (782 to 1,304 kg)
WARNING: Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on
the Safety Compliance Certification Label.
WARNING: Do not use replacement tires with lower load
carrying capacities than the original tires because they may lower
the vehicle’s GVWR and GAWR limitations. Replacement tires with a
higher limit than the original tires do not increase the GVWR and
GAWR limitations.
210 Load Carrying
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WARNING: Exceeding any vehicle weight rating limitation could
result in serious damage to the vehicle and/or personal injury.
Steps for determining the correct load limit:
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and cargo
should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lb.” on your vehicle’s placard.
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will
be riding in your vehicle.
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from
XXX kg or XXX lb.
4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage
load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount equals 1,400 lb. and
there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of
available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lb. (1400-750 (5 x 150)
= 650 lb.).
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on
the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and
luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be
transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this
reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
The following gives you a few examples on how to calculate the available
amount of cargo and luggage load capacity:
Suppose your vehicle has a 1400 lb. (635 kg) cargo and luggage
capacity. You decide to go golfing. Is there enough load capacity to
carry you, 4 of your friends and all the golf bags? You and four friends
average 220 lb. (99 kg) each and the golf bags weigh approximately
30 lb. (13.5 kg) each. The calculation would be: 1400 - (5 x 220) -
(5 x 30) = 1400 - 1100 - 150 = 150 lb. Yes, you have enough load
capacity in your vehicle to transport four friends and your golf bags.
In metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (5 x 99 kg) - (5 x
13.5 kg) = 635 - 495 - 67.5 = 72.5 kg.
Load Carrying 211
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Suppose your vehicle has a 1400 lb. (635 kg) cargo and luggage
capacity. You and one of your friends decide to pick up cement from
the local home improvement store to finish that patio you have been
planning for the past 2 years. Measuring the inside of the vehicle with
the rear seat folded down, you have room for 12-100 lb. (45 kg) bags
of cement. Do you have enough load capacity to transport the cement
to your home? If you and your friend each weigh 220 lb. (99 kg), the
calculation would be: 1400 - (2 x 220) - (12 x 100) = 1400 - 440 -
1200 = - 240 lb. No, you do not have enough cargo capacity to carry
that much weight. In metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg -
(2 x 99 kg) - (12 x 45 kg) = 635 - 198 - 540 = -103 kg. You will need
to reduce the load weight by at least 240 lb. (104 kg). If you remove
3-100 lb. (45 kg) cement bags, then the load calculation would be:
1400 - (2 x 220) - (9 x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 900 = 60 lb. Now you
have the load capacity to transport the cement and your friend home.
In metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (2 x 99 kg) - (9 x
45 kg) = 635 - 198 - 405 = 32 kg.
The above calculations also assume that the loads are positioned in your
vehicle in a manner that does not overload the Front or the Rear Gross
Axle Weight Rating specified for your vehicle on the Safety Compliance
Certification Label. The label shall be affixed to either the door hinge
pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post,
next to the driver’s seating position.
Special Loading Instructions for Owners of Pick-up Trucks and
Utility-type Vehicles
WARNING: Loaded vehicles may handle differently than
unloaded vehicles. Extra precautions, such as slower speeds and
increased stopping distance, should be taken when driving a heavily
loaded vehicle.
Your vehicle can haul more cargo and people than most passenger cars.
Depending upon the type and placement of the load, hauling cargo and
people may raise the center of gravity of the vehicle.
212 Load Carrying
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CARGO MANAGEMENT SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
A storage compartment is located in
the floor of the rear cargo area.
Lift up on the handle to open the
cover.
To close, lower the cover and press
down on the handle until the latch
clicks.
Cargo Shelf and Divider (If Equipped)
WARNING: Do not load any objects on the shelf that may
obstruct your vision or strike occupants of the vehicle in the case
of a sudden stop or collision.
WARNING: Do not place people or pets on or under the parcel
shelf.
Note: Do not put more than 30 pounds (14 kilograms) on the shelf.
The cargo shelf and divider is located behind the rear seat of your
vehicle and has two positions:
A flat shelf which pivots up and snaps into place.
A divider which pivots up and snaps vertically into place.
To move the shelf to the shelf
position: Pull up and pivot the
shelf over the channels on the side
trim panels and snap the shelf ends
in the channels.
Load Carrying 213
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
To move the shelf to the divider
position: Pull up and pivot the
shelf over the channels on the side
trim panels and snap vertically in
place.
POWER DEPLOYABLE RUNNING BOARDS (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING: In extreme climates, excessive ice buildup may
occur, causing the running boards not to deploy. Be sure that the
running boards have deployed, and have finished moving before
attempting to step on them. The running boards will resume normal
function once the blockage is cleared.
WARNING: Turn off the running boards before jacking or placing
any object under the vehicle. Never place your hand between the
extended running board and the vehicle. A moving running board may
cause injury.
Note: Do not use the running boards, front and rear hinge assemblies,
running board motors, or the running board under body mounts to lift
the vehicle when jacking. Always use proper jacking points.
Note: The running boards may operate slower in cooler temperatures.
Debris such as mud, dirt and salt may become trapped in the running
board mechanism, possibly leading to unwanted noise. If this occurs,
manually set the running boards to the deployed position and flush the
system (in particular the front and rear hinge arms) with a high-pressure
car wash wand.
214 Load Carrying
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
The running boards automatically
move when the doors are opened
to assist entering and exiting the
vehicle.
Automatic Power Deploy
The running boards will extend down and out when the doors are
opened.
Automatic Power Stow
The running boards will return to the stowed position after a two second
delay when the doors are closed.
Manual Power Deploy
To manually operate the running boards, refer to the Information
Displays chapter.
This feature can manually set the running boards in the deployed
(OUT) position for access to the roof.
When running boards are manually set in the deployed position, they
will return to the stowed position and enter automatic mode when the
vehicle speed exceeds 5 mph (8 km/h).
Enable and Disable
To enable and disable the power running board feature, refer to the
Information Displays chapter.
When this feature is disabled (OFF), the running boards will move to
the stowed position regardless of the position of the doors.
When this feature is enabled (AUTO), the running boards will move
back to the correct positions based off of the door positions.
Bounce-Back
If an object is in the way of the moving running board, it will reverse
direction and move to the end of travel.
Load Carrying 215
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
TOWING A TRAILER
WARNING: Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on
the certification label.
WARNING: Towing trailers beyond the maximum recommended
gross trailer weight exceeds the limit of your vehicle and could
result in engine damage, transmission damage, structural damage, loss
of vehicle control, vehicle rollover and personal injury.
Note: For information on electrical items such as fuses or relays, see the
Fuses chapter.
Your vehicle’s load capacity designation is by weight, not by volume, so
you cannot necessarily use all available space when loading a vehicle.
Towing a trailer places an extra load on your vehicle’s engine,
transmission, axle, brakes, tires and suspension. Inspect these
components periodically during, and after, any towing operation.
Load Placement
To help minimize how trailer movement affects your vehicle when
driving:
Load the heaviest items closest to the trailer floor.
Load the heaviest items centered between the left and right side
trailer tires.
Load the heaviest items above the trailer axles or just slightly forward
toward the trailer tongue. Do not allow the final trailer tongue weight
to go above or below 10–15% of the loaded trailer weight.
Select a tow bar with the correct rise or drop. When both the loaded
vehicle and trailer are connected, the trailer frame should be level, or
slightly angled down toward your vehicle, when viewed from the side.
When driving with a trailer or payload, a slight takeoff vibration or
shudder may be present due to the increased payload weight. You can
find more information about proper trailer loading and setting your
vehicle up for towing under Load limit in the Load Carrying chapter
and in the RV & Trailer Towing Guide, available at an authorized
dealer.
216 Towing
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
TRAILER SWAY CONTROL
WARNING: Turning off trailer sway control increases the risk of
loss of vehicle control, serious injury or death. Ford does not
recommend disabling this feature except in situations where speed
reduction may be detrimental (such as hill climbing), the driver has
significant trailer towing experience, and can control trailer sway and
maintain safe operation.
Note: This feature does not prevent trailer sway, but reduces it once it
begins.
Note: This feature cannot stop all trailers from swaying.
Note: In some cases, if vehicle speed is too high, the system may turn
on multiple times, gradually reducing vehicle speed.
This feature applies your vehicle brakes at individual wheels and, if
necessary, reduces engine power. If the trailer begins to sway, the
stability control light flashes and the message TRAILER SWAY
REDUCE SPEED appears in the information display. The first thing to
do is slow your vehicle down, then pull safely to the side of the road and
check for proper tongue load and trailer load distribution. See the Load
Carrying chapter for specific loading information.
RECOMMENDED TOWING WEIGHTS
Note: Do not exceed the trailer weight for your vehicle configuration
listed in the chart below.
Note: Make sure to take into consideration trailer frontal area. Do not
exceed:
36.5 feet
2
(3.39 meters
2
) trailer frontal area for vehicles equipped
with the standard towing package.
60.0 feet
2
(5.57 meters
2
) trailer frontal area for vehicles equipped
with the optional towing package.
Note: Exceeding this limitation may significantly reduce the
performance of your towing vehicle. Selecting a trailer with a low
aerodynamic drag and rounded front design helps optimize performance
and fuel economy.
Note: For high altitude operation, reduce the gross combined weight by
2% per 1000 feet (300 meters) starting at the 1000 foot (300 meter)
elevation point.
Towing 217
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: Certain states require electric trailer brakes for trailers over a
specified weight. Be sure to check state regulations for this specified
weight. The maximum trailer weights listed may be limited to this
specified weight, as your vehicle’s electrical system may not include the
wiring connector needed to use electric trailer brakes.
Your vehicle may tow a Class I, II, III or IV trailer provided the maximum
trailer weight is less than or equal to the maximum trailer weight listed
for your vehicle configuration on the following chart.
To calculate the maximum loaded trailer weight for your vehicle:
1. Start with the gross combined weight rating for your vehicle model
and axle ratio. See the following chart.
2. Subtract all of the following that apply to your vehicle:
Vehicle curb weight
Hitch hardware weight, such as a draw bar, ball, locks or weight
distributing
Driver weight
Passenger(s) weight
Payload, cargo and luggage weight
Aftermarket equipment weight.
3. This equals the maximum loaded trailer weight for this combination.
Note: The trailer tongue load figures into the payload for your vehicle.
Reduce the total payload by the final trailer tongue weight.
Consult an authorized dealer to determine the maximum trailer weight
allowed for your vehicle if you are not sure.
Vehicle type Towing package Maximum GCWR
Two–wheel drive
(except L)
Standard
12000 lb (5443 kg)
Two–wheel drive L
Four–wheel drive
(except L)
12300 lb (5579 kg)
Four–wheel drive L 12500 lb (5670 kg)
Two–wheel drive
Four–wheel drive
Optional 15000 lb (6804 kg)
218 Towing
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ESSENTIAL TOWING CHECKS
Follow these guidelines for safe towing:
Do not tow a trailer until you drive your vehicle at least 1000 miles
(1600 kilometers).
Consult your local motor vehicle laws for towing a trailer.
See the instructions included with towing accessories for the proper
installation and adjustment specifications.
Service your vehicle more frequently if you tow a trailer. See your
scheduled maintenance information.
If you use a rental trailer, follow the instructions the rental agency
gives you.
For load specification terms found on the tire label and Safety
Compliance label and for instructions on calculating your vehicle’s load,
refer to Load limit in the Load Carrying chapter.
Remember to account for the trailer tongue weight as part of your
vehicle load when calculating the total vehicle weight.
Trailer Towing Connector (Vehicles with a Trailer Towing Package
and 7–Pin Connector)
When attaching the trailer wiring
connector to your vehicle, only use a
proper fitting connector that works
with the vehicle and trailer functions.
If your vehicle has a trailer towing
package, it may have a 7–pin
connector. Some connectors may
have the SAE J2863 logo, which
confirms that it is the proper wiring
connector and works correctly with your vehicle.
Color Function
1. Yellow Left turn signal and stop lamp
2. White Ground (-)
3. Blue Electric brakes
4. Green Right turn signal and stop lamp
5. Orange Battery (+)
6. Brown Running lights
7. Grey Reverse lights
Towing 219
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Trailer Hitch Cover
Your vehicle is equipped with a removable trailer hitch trim cover.
To remove the trim cover:
1. Loosen the two quarter-turn
fasteners in the bottom of the cover
by turning them counterclockwise.
Pull the cover downward to remove
it. The fasteners remain attached to
the cover.
2. To reinstall the cover, insert the
four plastic tabs on top of the cover
into the corresponding slots, as
shown in the illustration and push
the cover up into the bumper trim.
3. Hold the cover against the bumper trim and reinstall the two
quarter-turn fasteners by turning them clockwise.
Hitches
WARNING: The trailer hitch on this vehicle is part of the vehicle
rear crash safety structure. Do not remove the trailer hitch.
Failure to follow this warning could compromise vehicle crash structure
and increase the risk of injury in a rear end crash.
Do not use a hitch that clamps onto your vehicle’s bumper. Use a
load-carrying hitch. You must distribute the load in your trailer so that
10–15% of the total weight of the trailer is on the tongue.
220 Towing
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Integrated Hitch Rating
WARNING: Towing trailers beyond the maximum tongue weight
exceeds the limit of the towing system and could result in vehicle
structural damage, loss of vehicle control and personal injury.
The standard integrated hitch has two ratings depending on mode of
operation:
Weight-carrying mode requires a draw bar and hitch ball. The draw
bar supports all the vertical tongue load of the trailer.
Weight-distributing mode requires an aftermarket weight-distributing
system, which includes draw bar, hitch ball, spring bars and snap-up
brackets. This system distributes the vertical tongue load of the trailer
between the truck and the trailer.
Mode Maximum trailer
weight - lb. (kg)
Maximum tongue
weight - lb. (kg)
Weight-carrying 6000 (2721) 600 (272)
Weight-distributing 9000 (4082) 900 (408)
Note: These are hitch ratings only. Actual vehicle ratings are dependent
on engine, transmission and axle combinations.
Weight-distributing Hitch Vehicles without Automatic Leveling
Suspension
WARNING: Do not adjust a weight-distributing hitch to any
position where the rear bumper of the vehicle is higher than it
was before attaching the trailer. Doing so will defeat the function of the
weight-distributing hitch, which may cause unpredictable handling, and
could result in serious personal injury.
When hooking-up a trailer using a weight-distributing hitch, always use
the following procedure:
1. Park your vehicle, without the trailer, on a level surface.
2. Measure the height of the top of your vehicle’s front wheel opening
on the fender. This is H1.
3. Attach the trailer to your vehicle without the weight-distributing bars
connected.
4. Measure the height of the top of your vehicle’s front wheel opening
on the fender a second time. This is H2.
Towing 221
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
5. Install and adjust the tension in the weight distributing bars so that
the height of the front fender is approximately halfway between H1
and H2.
6. Check that the trailer is level or slightly nose down toward your
vehicle. If not, adjust the ball height accordingly and repeat
Steps 2–6.
Once the trailer is level or slightly nose down toward the vehicle:
Lock the bar tension adjuster in place.
Check that the trailer tongue securely attaches and locks onto the
hitch.
Install safety chains, lighting, and trailer brake controls as required by
law or the trailer manufacturer.
Weight-distributing Hitch Vehicles with Automatic Leveling
Suspension
WARNING: Do not adjust a weight-distributing hitch to any
position where the rear bumper of the vehicle is higher than it
was before attaching the trailer. Doing so will defeat the function of the
weight-distributing hitch, which may cause unpredictable handling, and
could result in serious personal injury.
Note: If you do not move the loaded vehicle for approximately 12 hours,
the leveling system may bleed down to a lower height. This can be
especially apparent if you leave a trailer attached to the parked vehicle
for long periods. You must drive your vehicle in order to re-level the
suspension.
When connecting a trailer to a vehicle with automatic leveling suspension
using a weight-distributing hitch, always use the following procedure:
1. Load the interior of the vehicle to a weight similar to that which you
intend to carry when towing. This includes things such as passenger
weight and cargo.
2. Drive the vehicle for approximately 2 miles (3 kilometers) to re-level
the suspension.
3. Park your vehicle, without the trailer, on a level surface.
4. Measure the height to the top of your vehicle’s front wheel opening
on the fender. This is H1.
5. Attach the trailer to your vehicle without the weight-distributing bars
connected.
6. Make sure you securely attach and lock the trailer tongue to the
hitch.
222 Towing
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
7. Install safety chains, lighting, and trailer brake controls as required
by law or the trailer manufacturer.
8. Drive the vehicle and trailer at 20–25 mph (32–40 km/h) for
approximately 2 miles (3 kilometers) to re-level the suspension.
9. Park your vehicle and trailer on a level surface.
10. Measure the height to the top of your vehicles front wheel opening
on the fender a second time. This is H2.
11. Install and adjust the tension in the weight distributing bars so that
the height of the front fender is approximately halfway between H1
and H2.
12. Check that the trailer is level or slightly nose down toward the
vehicle. If it is not, remove the trailer, adjust the ball height
accordingly, and repeat Steps 5 -11.
Once the trailer is level or slightly nose down toward the vehicle:
Lock the bar tension adjuster in place.
Check that the trailer tongue securely attaches and locks onto the
hitch.
Install safety chains, lighting, and trailer brake controls as required by
law or the trailer manufacturer.
Safety Chains
Note: Do not attach safety chains to the bumper.
Always connect the trailer’s safety chains to the frame or hook retainers
of your vehicle hitch.
To connect the trailer’s safety chains, cross the chains under the trailer
tongue and allow enough slack for turning tight corners. Do not allow the
chains to drag on the ground.
Trailer Brakes
WARNING: Do not connect a trailer’s hydraulic brake system
directly to your vehicle’s brake system. Your vehicle may not have
enough braking power and your chances of having a collision greatly
increase.
Electric brakes and manual, automatic or surge-type trailer brakes are
safe if you install them properly and adjust them to the manufacturer’s
specifications. The trailer brakes must meet local and federal regulations.
Towing 223
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
The rating for the tow vehicle’s braking system operation is at
the gross vehicle weight rating, not the gross combined weight
rating.
Separate functioning brake systems are required for safe control
of towed vehicles and trailers weighing more than 1500 pounds
(680 kilograms) when loaded.
Trailer Lamps
WARNING: Never connect any trailer lamp wiring to the
vehicle’s tail lamp wiring; this may damage the electrical system
resulting in a fire. Contact an authorized dealer as soon as possible for
assistance in proper trailer tow wiring installation. Additional electrical
equipment may be required.
Trailer lamps are required on most towed vehicles. Make sure all running
lights, brake lights, turn signals and hazard lights are working.
Before Towing a Trailer
Practice turning, stopping and backing up to get the feel of your
vehicle-trailer combination before starting on a trip. When turning, make
wider turns so the trailer wheels clear curbs and other obstacles.
When Towing a Trailer
Do not drive faster than 70 mph (113 km/h) during the first 500 miles
(800 kilometers).
Do not make full-throttle starts.
Check your hitch, electrical connections and trailer wheel lug nuts
thoroughly after you have traveled 50 miles (80 kilometers).
When stopped in congested or heavy traffic during hot weather, place
the gearshift in position P to aid engine and transmission cooling and
to help A/C performance.
Turn off the speed control with heavy loads or in hilly terrain. The
speed control may turn off automatically when you are towing on
long, steep grades.
Shift to a lower gear when driving down a long or steep hill. Do not
apply the brakes continuously, as they may overheat and become less
effective.
If your transmission is equipped with a Grade Assist or Tow/Haul
feature, use this feature when towing. This provides engine braking
and helps eliminate excessive transmission shifting for optimum fuel
economy and transmission cooling.
224 Towing
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If your vehicle is equipped with AdvanceTrac™ with RSC, this system
may turn on during typical cornering maneuvers with a heavily loaded
trailer. This is normal. Turning the corner at a slower speed while
towing may reduce this tendency.
If you are towing a trailer frequently in hot weather, hilly conditions,
at the gross combined weight rating (or any combination of these
factors), consider refilling your rear axle with synthetic gear lubricant
(if the axle is not already filled with it). See the Capacities and
Specifications chapter for the lubricant specification.
Allow more distance for stopping with a trailer attached. Anticipate
stops and brake gradually.
Avoid parking on a grade. However, if you must park on a grade:
1. Turn the steering wheel to point your vehicle tires away from
traffic flow.
2. Set your vehicle parking brake.
3. Place the automatic transmission in position P.
4. Place wheel chocks in front and back of the trailer wheels.
(Chocks not included with vehicle.)
Your vehicle may be equipped with a temporary or conventional spare
tire. A “temporary” spare tire is different in size (diameter or width),
tread-type (All-Season or All-Terrain) or is from a different manufacturer
than the road tires on your vehicle. Consult information on the tire label
or Safety Compliance label for limitations when using.
Launching or Retrieving a Boat or Personal Watercraft (PWC)
Note: Disconnect the wiring to the trailer before backing the trailer into
the water.
Note: Reconnect the wiring to the trailer after removing the trailer from
the water.
When backing down a ramp during boat launching or retrieval:
Do not allow the static water level to rise above the bottom edge of
the rear bumper.
Do not allow waves to break higher than 6 inches (15 centimeters)
above the bottom edge of the rear bumper.
Exceeding these limits may allow water to enter vehicle components:
Causing internal damage to the components.
Affecting driveability, emissions, and reliability.
Replace the rear axle lubricant anytime the rear axle submerges in
water. Water may have contaminated the rear axle lubricant, which does
not normally require checking or changing unless it is leaking or other
axle repair is required.
Towing 225
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
TRANSPORTING THE VEHICLE
If you need to have your vehicle towed, contact a professional towing
service or, if you are a member of a roadside assistance program, your
roadside assistance service provider.
We recommend the use of a wheel lift and dollies or flatbed equipment
to tow your vehicle. Do not tow with a slingbelt. Ford Motor Company
has not approved a slingbelt towing procedure. Vehicle damage may
occur if towed incorrectly, or by any other means.
Ford Motor Company produces a towing manual for all authorized tow
truck operators. Have your tow truck operator refer to this manual for
proper hook-up and towing procedures for your vehicle.
It is acceptable to have your two-wheel drive vehicle towed with the
front wheels on the ground (without dollies) and the rear wheels off the
ground.
We recommend towing a four-wheel drive vehicle with all wheels off the
ground, such as using a wheel lift and dollies or flatbed equipment.
226 Towing
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
TOWING THE VEHICLE ON FOUR WHEELS
Emergency Towing
If your vehicle becomes inoperable (without access to wheel dollies,
car-hauling trailer, or flatbed transport vehicle), it can be flat-towed (all
wheels on the ground, regardless of the powertrain and transmission
configuration) under the following conditions:
Your vehicle is facing forward for towing in a forward direction.
Place the transmission in position N. See Automatic transmission
in the Transmission chapter if you cannot move the transmission
into N.
Maximum speed is 35 mph (56 km/h).
Maximum distance is 50 miles (80 kilometers).
Recreational Towing
Note: Put your climate control system in recirculated air mode to
prevent exhaust fumes from entering your vehicle. See the Climate
Control chapter.
Follow these guidelines if you have a need for recreational towing,
such as towing your vehicle behind a motorhome. We designed these
guidelines to prevent damage to your transmission.
Do not tow your vehicle with any wheels on the ground as transmission
or vehicle damage may occur. It is recommended to tow your vehicle
with all four (4) wheels off the ground, such as when using a car-hauling
trailer. Otherwise, you cannot tow your vehicle. See an authorized dealer
if you must flat-tow a vehicle equipped with the Control Trac®
four–wheel drive system.
Towing 227
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
BREAKING-IN
You need to break in new tires for approximately 300 miles
(480 kilometers). During this time, your vehicle may exhibit some unique
driving characteristics. Avoid driving too fast during the first 1000 miles
(1600 kilometers). Vary your speed frequently and change up through
the gears early. Do not labor the engine. Do not tow during the first
1000 miles (1600 kilometers).
ECONOMICAL DRIVING
Fuel economy is affected by several things, such as how you drive, the
conditions you drive under and how you maintain your vehicle.
There are some things to keep in mind that may improve your fuel
economy:
Accelerate and slow down in a smooth, moderate fashion.
Drive at steady speeds without stopping.
Anticipate stops; slowing down may eliminate the need to stop.
Combine errands and minimize stop-and-go driving.
Close the windows for high-speed driving.
Drive at reasonable speeds (traveling at 55 mph [88 km/h] uses 15%
less fuel than traveling at 65 mph [105 km/h]).
Keep the tires properly inflated and use only the recommended size.
Use the recommended engine oil.
Perform all regularly scheduled maintenance.
There are also some things you may not want to do because they may
reduce your fuel economy:
Sudden or hard accelerations.
Rev the engine before turning it off.
Idle for periods longer than one minute.
Warm up your vehicle on cold mornings.
Use the air conditioner or front defroster.
Use the speed control in hilly terrain.
228 Driving Hints
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Rest your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
Drive a heavily loaded vehicle or tow a trailer.
Carry unnecessary weight (approximately 1 mpg [0.4 km/L] is lost for
every 400 pounds [180 kilograms] of weight carried).
Add particular accessories to your vehicle (e.g.; bug deflectors,
rollbars or light bars, running boards, ski racks).
Drive with the wheels out of alignment.
DRIVING THROUGH WATER
Note:Driving through deep water may allow water into the transmission
and engine causing internal damage. If you drove through deep water,
check the transmission and engine fluid. If water is found, see your
authorized dealer immediately for fluid replacement.
Do not drive quickly through standing water, especially if the depth is
unknown. Traction or brake capability may be limited and if the ignition
system gets wet, your engine may stall. Water may also enter your
engine’s air intake and severely damage your engine.
If driving through deep or standing
water is unavoidable, proceed very
slowly. Never drive through water
that is higher than the bottom of
the hubs (for trucks) or the bottom
of the wheel rims (for cars).
Once through the water, always try the brakes. Wet brakes do not stop
the vehicle as effectively as dry brakes. Drying can be improved by
moving your vehicle slowly while applying light pressure on the brake
pedal.
Driving Hints 229
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
FLOOR MATS
WARNING: Always use floor mats that are designed to fit the
footwell of your vehicle. Only use floor mats that leave the pedal
area unobstructed. Only use floor mats that are firmly secured to
retention posts so that they cannot slip out of position and interfere
with the pedals or impair safe operation of your vehicle in other ways.
Pedals that cannot move freely can cause loss of vehicle control and
increase the risk of serious personal injury.
Always make sure that the floor mats are properly attached to the
retention posts in the carpet that are supplied with your vehicle.
Floor mats must be properly secured to both retention posts to
ensure mats do not shift out of position.
Never place floor mats or any other covering in the vehicle footwell
that cannot be properly secured to prevent them from moving and
interfering with the pedals or the ability to control the vehicle.
Never place floor mats or any other covering on top of already
installed floor mats. Floor mats should always rest on top of the
vehicle carpeting surface and not another floor mat or other
covering. Additional floor mats or any other covering will reduce
the pedal clearance and potentially interfere with pedal operation.
Check attachment of floor mats on a regular basis. Always properly
reinstall and secure floor mats that have been removed for cleaning
or replacement.
Always make sure that objects cannot fall into the driver footwell
while the vehicle is moving. Objects that are loose can become
trapped under the pedals causing a loss of vehicle control.
230 Driving Hints
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WARNING (Continued)
Failure to properly follow floor mat installation or attachment
instructions can potentially cause interference with pedal operation
causing loss of control of vehicle.
To install floor mats, position the floor mat so that the eyelet is over
the retention post and press down to lock in.
To remove the floor mat, reverse the installation procedure.
Driving Hints 231
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE
Vehicles Sold in the U.S.: Getting Roadside Assistance
To fully assist you should you have a vehicle concern, Ford Motor
Company offers a complimentary roadside assistance program. This
program is separate from the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. The service
is available:
24 hours a day, seven days a week
for the coverage period listed on the Roadside Assistance Card
included in your owner’s manual portfolio.
Roadside assistance will cover:
a flat tire change with a good spare (except vehicles that have been
supplied with a tire inflation kit).
battery jump start.
lock-out assistance (key replacement cost is the customer’s
responsibility).
fuel delivery Independent Service Contractors, if not prohibited by
state, local or municipal law, shall deliver up to 2.0 gallons (7.5 liters)
of gasoline or 5.0 gallons (18.9 liters) of diesel fuel to a disabled
vehicle. Fuel delivery service is limited to two no-charge occurrences
within a 12-month period.
winch out available within 100 feet (30.5 meters) of a paved or
county maintained road, no recoveries.
towing Ford and Lincoln eligible vehicles towed to an authorized
dealer within 35 miles (56 kilometers) of the disablement location or
to the nearest authorized dealer. If a member requests to be towed to
an authorized dealer more than 35 miles (56 kilometers) from the
disablement location, the member shall be responsible for any mileage
costs in excess of 35 miles (56 kilometers).
Trailers shall be covered up to $200 if the disabled eligible vehicle
requires service at the nearest authorized dealer. If the trailer is disabled,
but the towing vehicle is operational, the trailer does not qualify for any
roadside services.
232 Roadside Emergencies
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Vehicles sold in the U.S. : Using roadside assistance
Complete the roadside assistance identification card and place it in your
wallet for quick reference. This card is found in the owner’s manual
portfolio in the glove compartment.
U.S. Lincoln vehicle customers who require Roadside Assistance, call
1-800-521-4140.
If you need to arrange roadside assistance for yourself, Ford Motor
Company will reimburse a reasonable amount for towing to the nearest
dealership within 35 miles (56 km). To obtain reimbursement
information, U.S. Lincoln vehicle customers call 1-800-521-4140.
Customers will be asked to submit their original receipts.
Vehicles Sold in Canada: Getting Roadside Assistance
Canadian customers who require roadside assistance, call
1–800–665–2006.
Vehicles Sold in Canada: Using Roadside Assistance
For your convenience, you may complete the roadside assistance
identification card found in the centerfold of this warranty guide and
retain for future reference.
Canadian roadside coverage and benefits may differ from the U.S.
coverage. If you require more information, please refer to the coverage
section of your warranty guide, call us in Canada at 1-800-665-2006, or
visit our website at www.ford.ca.
HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS
The hazard flasher control is located on the instrument panel
by the radio. Use it when your vehicle is disabled and is
creating a safety hazard for other motorists.
Press the flasher control and all front and rear direction signals will
flash.
Press the flasher control again to turn them off.
Note: With extended use, the flashers may run down your 12–volt
battery.
Roadside Emergencies 233
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
FUEL PUMP SHUT-OFF SWITCH
The fuel pump shut-off switch is a device intended to stop the electric
fuel pump when your vehicle has been involved in a substantial jolt.
After a collision, if the engine cranks but does not start, the fuel pump
shut-off switch may have been activated.
The fuel pump shut-off switch is
located behind an access panel in the
left rear quarter trim panel, near the
liftgate.
The fuel pump shut-off switch has a
red reset button on top of it.
If your vehicle is equipped with a
power liftgate, the fuel pump shut-off
switch is left of the power liftgate
motor.
Use the following procedure to reset the fuel pump shut-off switch.
1. Turn the ignition to the off position.
2. Check the fuel system for leaks.
3. If you cannot see a fuel leak, reset the fuel pump shut-off switch by
pushing the red reset button in.
4. Turn the ignition to the on position. Pause for a few seconds and
return the key to the off position.
5. Check again for fuel system leaks.
234 Roadside Emergencies
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
JUMP-STARTING THE VEHICLE
WARNING: The gases around the battery can explode if exposed
to flames, sparks, or lit cigarettes. An explosion could result in
injury or vehicle damage.
WARNING: Batteries contain sulfuric acid which can burn skin,
eyes and clothing, if contacted.
Do not attempt to push-start your automatic transmission vehicle.
Automatic transmissions do not have push-start capability. Attempting
to push-start a vehicle with an automatic transmission may cause
transmission damage.
When the battery is disconnected or a new battery is installed, the
automatic transmission must relearn its shift strategy. As a result, the
transmission may exhibit a combination of firm and soft shifts. This
operation is considered normal and will not affect function or durability
of the transmission. Over time, the adaptive learning process will fully
update transmission operation.
Preparing Your Vehicle
Note: Use only a 12–volt supply to start your vehicle.
Note: Do not disconnect the battery of the disabled vehicle as this could
damage the vehicle’s electrical system.
1. Park the booster vehicle close to the hood of the disabled vehicle
making sure the two vehicles do not touch. Set the parking brake on
both vehicles and stay clear of the engine cooling fan and other moving
parts.
2. Check all battery terminals. Remove the positive terminal cover
(if equipped) and any excessive corrosion before you attach the battery
cables. Ensure that vent caps are tight and level.
3. Turn the heater fan on in both vehicles to protect from any electrical
surges. Turn all other accessories off.
Roadside Emergencies 235
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Connecting the Jumper Cables
WARNING: Do not connect the end of the second cable to the
negative (-) terminal of the battery to be jumped. A spark may
cause an explosion of the gases that surround the battery.
Note: Do not attach the negative (-) cable to fuel lines, engine rocker
covers, the intake manifold or electrical components as grounding points.
Note: In the illustration, the vehicle on the bottom is used to designate
the assisting (boosting) battery.
1. Connect the positive (+) jumper
cable to the positive (+) terminal of
the discharged battery.
2. Connect the other end of the
positive (+) cable to the positive
(+) terminal of the assisting battery.
3. Connect the negative (-) cable to
the negative (-) terminal of the
assisting battery.
4. Make the final connection of the
negative (-) cable to an exposed
metal part of the stalled vehicle’s
engine, away from the battery and
the carburetor or fuel injection
system.
Ensure that the cables are clear of fan blades, belts, moving parts of both
engines, or any fuel delivery system parts.
Jump Starting
1. Start the engine of the booster vehicle and run the engine at a
moderately increased speed.
2. Start the engine of the disabled vehicle.
3. Once the disabled vehicle has been started, run both engines for an
additional three minutes before disconnecting the jumper cables.
4
2
1
3
236 Roadside Emergencies
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Removing the Jumper Cables
Note: In the illustration, the vehicle on the bottom is used to designate
the assisting (boosting) battery.
Remove the jumper cables in the reverse order that they were
connected.
1. Remove the jumper cable from
the ground metal surface.
2. Remove the jumper cable on the
negative (-) terminal of the booster
vehicle’s battery.
3. Remove the jumper cable from
the positive (+) terminal of the
booster vehicle’s battery.
4. Remove the jumper cable from
the positive (+) terminal of the
disabled vehicle’s battery.
After the disabled vehicle has been started and the jumper cables
removed, allow it to idle for several minutes so the engine computer can
relearn its idle conditions.
4
1
3
2
Roadside Emergencies 237
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GETTING THE SERVICES YOU NEED
Warranty repairs to your vehicle must be performed by an authorized
dealer. While any authorized dealer handling your vehicle line will
provide warranty service, we recommend you return to your selling
authorized dealer who wants to ensure your continued satisfaction.
Please note that certain warranty repairs require special training,
equipment or both, so not all authorized dealers are authorized to
perform all warranty repairs. This means that, depending on the
warranty repair needed, you may have to take your vehicle to another
authorized dealer.
A reasonable time must be allowed to perform a repair after taking your
vehicle to the authorized dealer. Repairs will be made using Ford or Motorcraft
parts, or remanufactured or other parts that are authorized by Ford.
Away from home
If you are away from home when your vehicle needs service, contact the
Ford Customer Relationship Center or use the online resources listed
below to find the nearest authorized dealer.
In the United States:
Mailing address
Ford Motor Company
Customer Relationship Center
P.O. Box 6248
Dearborn, MI 48121
Telephone
1-800-521-4140
(TDD for the hearing impaired: 1-800-232-5952)
Online
Additional information and resources are available online at
www.lincolnowner.com
U.S. dealer locator by Dealer Name, City/State, or Zip Code
Owner Guides
Maintenance Schedules
Recalls
Ford Extended Service Plans
Ford Genuine Accessories
Service specials and promotions.
238 Customer Assistance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
In Canada:
Mailing address
Lincoln Customer Relationship Centre
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited
P.O. Box 2000
Oakville, Ontario L6K 1C8
Telephone
1-800-387-9333
Online
www.lincolncanada.com
Additional assistance
If you have questions or concerns, or are unsatisfied with the service you
are receiving, follow these steps:
1. Contact your Sales Representative or Service Advisor at your
selling/servicing authorized dealer.
2. If your inquiry or concern remains unresolved, contact the Sales
Manager, Service Manager or Customer Relations Manager.
3. If you require assistance or clarification on Ford Motor Company
policies, please contact the Ford Customer Relationship Center
In order to help you serve you better, please have the following
information available when contacting a Customer Relationship Center:
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
Your telephone number (home and business)
The name of the authorized dealer and city where located
The vehicle’s current odometer reading
In some states, you must directly notify Ford in writing before pursuing
remedies under your state’s warranty laws. Ford is also allowed a final
repair attempt in some states.
In the United States, a warranty dispute must be submitted to the BBB
AUTO LINE before taking action under the Magnuson-Moss Warranty
Act, or to the extent allowed by state law, before pursuing replacement
or repurchase remedies provided by certain state laws. This dispute
handling procedure is not required prior to enforcing state created rights
or other rights which are independent of the Magnuson-Moss Warranty
Act or state replacement or repurchase laws.
Customer Assistance 239
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
IN CALIFORNIA (U.S. ONLY)
California Civil Code Section 1793.2(d) requires that, if a manufacturer or
its representative is unable to repair a motor vehicle to conform to the
vehicle’s applicable express warranty after a reasonable number of
attempts, the manufacturer shall be required to either replace the vehicle
with one substantially identical or repurchase the vehicle and reimburse
the buyer in an amount equal to the actual price paid or payable by the
consumer (less a reasonable allowance for consumer use). The consumer
has the right to choose whether to receive a refund or replacement vehicle.
California Civil Code Section 1793.22(b) presumes that the manufacturer
has had a reasonable number of attempts to conform the vehicle to its
applicable express warranties if, within the first 18 months of ownership
of a new vehicle or the first 18000 mi (29 000 km), whichever occurs
first:
1. Two or more repair attempts are made on the same nonconformity
likely to cause death or serious bodily injury OR
2. Four or more repair attempts are made on the same nonconformity (a
defect or condition that substantially impairs the use, value or safety of
the vehicle) OR
3. The vehicle is out of service for repair of nonconformities for a total of
more than 30 calendar days (not necessarily all at one time).
In the case of 1 or 2 above, the consumer must also notify the
manufacturer of the need for the repair of the nonconformity at the
following address:
Ford Motor Company
16800 Executive Plaza Drive
Mail Drop 3NE-B
Dearborn, MI 48126
You are required to submit your warranty dispute to BBB AUTO LINE
before asserting in court any rights or remedies conferred by California
Civil Code Section 1793.22(b). You are also required to use BBB AUTO
LINE before exercising rights or seeking remedies created by the Federal
Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act, 15 U.S.C. sec. 2301 et seq. If you choose
to seek redress by pursuing rights and remedies not created by California
Civil Code Section 1793.22(b) or the Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act,
resorting to BBB AUTO LINE is not required by those statutes.
240 Customer Assistance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
THE BETTER BUSINESS BUREAU (BBB) AUTO LINE PROGRAM
(U.S. ONLY)
Your satisfaction is important to Ford Motor Company and to your
dealer. If a warranty concern has not been resolved using the three-step
procedure outlined earlier in this chapter in the Getting the Services
You Need section, you may be eligible to participate in the BBB AUTO
LINE program.
The BBB AUTO LINE program consists of two parts mediation and
arbitration. During mediation, a representative of the BBB will contact
both you and Ford Motor Company to explore options for settlement of
the claim. If an agreement is not reached during mediation or you do not
want to participate in mediation, and if your claim is eligible, you may
participate in the arbitration process. An arbitration hearing will be
scheduled so that you can present your case in an informal setting
before an impartial person. The arbitrator will consider the testimony
provided and make a decision after the hearing.
Disputes submitted to the BBB AUTO LINE program are usually decided
within 40 days after you file your claim with the BBB. You are not bound
by the decision, and may reject the decision and proceed to court where
all findings of the BBB Auto Line dispute, and decision, are admissible
in the court action. Should you choose to accept the BBB AUTO LINE
decision, Ford is then bound by the decision, and must comply with the
decision within 30 days of receipt of your acceptance letter.
BBB AUTO LINE Application: Using the information provided below,
please call or write to request a program application. You will be asked
for your name and address, general information about your new vehicle,
information about your warranty concerns, and any steps you have
already taken to try to resolve them. A Customer Claim Form will be
mailed that will need to be completed, signed and returned to the BBB
along with proof of ownership. Upon receipt, the BBB will review the
claim for eligibility under the Program Summary Guidelines.
You can get more information by calling BBB AUTO LINE at
1-800-955-5100, or writing to:
BBB AUTO LINE
3033 Wilson Boulevard, Suite 600
Arlington, Virginia 22201
BBB AUTO LINE applications can also be requested by calling the Ford
Motor Company Customer Relationship Center at 1-800-392-3673.
Note: Ford Motor Company reserves the right to change eligibility
limitations, modify procedures, or to discontinue this process at any time
without notice and without obligation.
Customer Assistance 241
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
UTILIZING THE MEDIATION or ARBITRATION PROGRAM
(CANADA ONLY)
This pertains to vehicles delivered to authorized Canadian dealers.
In those cases, where you continue to feel that the efforts by Ford of
Canada and the authorized dealer to resolve a factory-related vehicle
service concern have been unsatisfactory, Ford of Canada participates in
an impartial third party mediation or arbitration program administered by
the Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP).
The CAMVAP program is a straightforward and relatively speedy
alternative to resolve a disagreement when all other efforts to produce
a settlement have failed. This procedure is without cost to you and is
designed to eliminate the need for lengthy and expensive legal
proceedings.
In the CAMVAP program, impartial third-party arbitrators conduct
hearings at mutually convenient times and places in an informal
environment. These impartial arbitrators review the positions of the
parties, make decisions and, when appropriate, render awards to resolve
disputes. CAMVAP decisions are fast, fair, and final as the arbitrator’s
award is binding on both you and Ford of Canada.
CAMVAP services are available in all Canadian territories and provinces.
For more information, without charge or obligation, call your CAMVAP
Provincial Administrator directly at 1-800-207-0685 or visit
www.camvap.ca.
GETTING ASSISTANCE OUTSIDE THE U.S. AND CANADA
Before exporting your vehicle to a foreign country, contact the
appropriate foreign embassy or consulate. These officials can inform you
of local vehicle registration regulations and where to find unleaded fuel.
If you cannot find unleaded fuel or can only get fuel with an anti-knock
index lower than is recommended for your vehicle, contact our Customer
Relationship Center.
The use of leaded fuel in your vehicle without proper conversion may
damage the effectiveness of your emission control system and may cause
engine knocking or serious engine damage. Ford Motor Company or Ford
of Canada is not responsible for any damage caused by use of improper
fuel. Using leaded fuel may also result in difficulty importing your vehicle
back into the United States.
242 Customer Assistance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living
in Asia-Pacific Region, Sub-Saharan Africa, U.S. Virgin Islands,
Central America, the Caribbean, and Israel, contact the nearest
authorized dealer. If the authorized dealer cannot help you,
contact:
FORD MOTOR COMPANY
FORD EXPORT OPERATIONS & GLOBAL INITIATIVES
Customer Relationship Center
1555 Fairlane Drive Fairlane Business Park #3
Allen Park, Michigan 48101
U.S.A.
Telephone: (313) 594-4857
FAX: (313) 390-0804 Email: [email protected]
For customers in Guam, the Commonwealth of the Northern
Mariana Islands (CNMI), America Samoa, and the U.S. Virgin
Islands, please feel free to call our Toll-Free Number: (800)
841-FORD (3673)
If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living
in Puerto Rico, contact the nearest authorized dealer. If the
authorized dealer cannot help you, contact:
FORD MOTOR COMPANY
FORD EXPORT OPERATIONS & GLOBAL INITIATIVES
Customer Relationship Center
1555 Fairlane Drive Fairlane Business Park #3
Allen Park, Michigan 48101
U.S.A.
Telephone: (313) 594-4857
FAX: (313) 390-0804 Email: www.ford.com.pr
If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living
in the Middle East, contact the nearest authorized dealer. If the
authorized dealer cannot help you, contact:
Ford Middle East
Customer Relationship Center
P.O. Box 21470 Dubai, United Arab Emirates
Telephone: +971 4 3326084
Toll-Free Number of the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia: 800 8971409
Local Telephone Number of Kuwait: 24810575
FAX: +971 4 3327299
www.me.ford.com
Customer Assistance 243
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If you buy your vehicle in North America and then relocate to any of the
above locations, register your vehicle identification number (VIN) and
new address with Ford Motor Company Export Operations & Global
Growth Initiatives by emailing [email protected].
If you are in another foreign country, contact the nearest
authorized dealer. In the event your inquiry is unresolved,
communicate your concern with the dealership’s Sales Manager,
Service Manager or Customer Relations Manager. If you require
additional assistance or clarification, please contact the
respective Customer Relationship Center as previously listed.
Customers in the U.S. should call 1-800-392-3673.
ORDERING ADDITIONAL OWNER’S LITERATURE
To order the publications in this portfolio, contact Helm, Incorporated at:
HELM, INCORPORATED
47911 Halyard Drive
Plymouth, Michigan 48170
Attention: Customer Service
Or to order a free publication catalog, call toll free: 1-800-782-4356
Monday-Friday 8:00 a.m. - 6:00 p.m. EST
Helm, Incorporated can also be reached by their website:
www.helminc.com.
(Items in this catalog may be purchased by credit card, check or
money order.)
Obtaining a French Owners Manual
A French owner’s manual can be obtained from your authorized dealer or
by contacting Helm, Incorporated using the contact information listed
previously in this section.
244 Customer Assistance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (U.S. ONLY)
If you believe that your vehicle has
a defect which could cause a crash
or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform the
National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Ford Motor Company.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and
if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a
recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved
in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Ford Motor
Company.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at
1–888–327–4236 (TTY: 1–800–424–9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov;
or write to:
Administrator
1200 New Jersey Avenue, Southeast
Washington, D.C. 20590
You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from
http://www.safercar.gov.
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (CANADA ONLY)
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or
could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform Transport
Canada, using their toll-free number: 1–800–333–0510, or online at:
http://www.tc.gc.ca/eng/roadsafety/menu.htm
Customer Assistance 245
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CHANGING A FUSE
Fuses
WARNING: Always replace a fuse with one that has the
specified amperage rating. Using a fuse with a higher amperage
rating can cause severe wire damage and could start a fire.
If electrical components in your
vehicle are not working, a fuse may
have blown. Blown fuses are identified
by a broken wire within the fuse.
Check the appropriate fuses before
replacing any electrical components.
Standard Fuse Amperage Rating and Color
COLOR
Fuse
rating
Mini
fuses
Standard
fuses
Maxi
fuses
Cartridge
maxi
fuses
Fuse link
cartridge
2A Grey Grey
3A Violet Violet
4A Pink Pink
5A Tan Tan
7.5A Brown Brown
10A Red Red
15A Blue Blue
20A Yellow Yellow Yellow Blue Blue
25A Natural Natural Natural Natural
30A Green Green Green Pink Pink
40A Orange Green Green
50A Red Red Red
60A Blue Yellow Yellow
70A Tan Brown
80A Natural Black Black
15
246 Fuses
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
FUSE SPECIFICATION CHART
Power Distribution Box
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery before servicing high
current fuses.
WARNING: To reduce risk of electrical shock, always replace the
cover to the power distribution box before reconnecting the
battery or refilling fluid reservoirs.
The power distribution box is located in the engine compartment. It has
high-current fuses that protect your vehicle’s main electrical systems
from overloads.
If the battery has been disconnected and reconnected, see Changing the
Vehicle Battery in the Maintenance chapter.
The high-current fuses are coded as follows:
Fuse or
relay
location
Fuse amp
rating
Protected circuits
1 Powertrain control module relay
2 Starter relay
Fuses 247
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Fuse or
relay
location
Fuse amp
rating
Protected circuits
3 Blower motor relay
4 Trailer tow battery charge relay
5 Fuel pump relay
6 Electronic fan 1 relay
7 Rear window defroster/heated mirror
relay
8 Electronic fan 3 relay
9 Run/start relay
10 Not used
11 40A** Power running board
12 40A** Run/start relay
13 30A ** Starter relay
14 40A** Electronic fan
15 20A** Right hand high intensity discharge
headlamp relay
16 40A** Electronic fan
17 20A** Left hand high intensity discharge
headlamp relay
18 30A** Trailer brake
19 Not used
20 Not used
21 30A** Trailer tow battery charge relay
22 30A** Passenger power seat
23 Air conditioner clutch relay
24 Trailer tow park lamp relay
25 Right hand high intensity discharge
headlamp relay
26 Not used
27 20A* 4x4
28 25A* Trailer tow park lamp relay
248 Fuses
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Fuse or
relay
location
Fuse amp
rating
Protected circuits
29 20A* Backup lamps, Integrated wheel end
solenoid
30 10A* Air conditioner clutch relay
31 Not used
32 40A** Blower motor relay
33 40A** 110–volt AC power point
34 30A** Auxiliary blower motor
35 30A** Powertrain control module relay
36 30A** Power liftgate
37 Trailer tow left hand stop/turn relay
38 Trailer tow right hand stop/turn relay
39 Backup lamps relay
40 Electronic fan 2 relay
41 10A* Powertrain control module keep-alive
power
42 Not used
43 5A* Brake on/off switch
44 20A* Fuel pump relay
45 25A* Trailer tow stop/turn lamps relay
46 Not used
47 Not used
48 Not used
49 Not used
50 30A** Front wiper motor relay
51 40A** Rear window defroster and heated
mirror relay
52 10A* Anti-lock brake system run/start feed
53 Not used
54 Not used
55 5A* Fuel pump relay coil run/start feed
Fuses 249
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Fuse or
relay
location
Fuse amp
rating
Protected circuits
56 30A* Passenger compartment fuse panel
run/start feed
57 10A* Blower motor relay coil
58 15A* Trailer tow backup lamps
59 15A* Heated mirrors
60 Not used
61 Fuel pump diode
62 Left high intensity discharge headlamp
relay
63 25A** Electronic fan
64 30A** Moonroof
65 20A** Auxiliary power point (instrument
panel)
66 20A** Auxiliary power point (rear of center
console)
67 40A** Front row climate controlled seats
68 60A** Anti-lock brake system valves
69 60A** Anti-lock brake system pump
70 30A** Third row power fold seat
71 20A** Auxiliary power point/cigar lighter
72 20A** Auxiliary power point (right rear
quarter panel)
73 Not used
74 30A** Driver power seat
75 20A* Vehicle power 1 powertrain control
module
76 20A* Vehicle power 2 powertrain control
module
77 15A* Vehicle power4–ignition coils
78 Not used
250 Fuses
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Fuse or
relay
location
Fuse amp
rating
Protected circuits
79 20A* Vehicle power 3 powertrain control
module
80 Not used
81 Not used
82 Not used
83 Not used
84 Not used
85 Wiper motor relay
* Mini Fuses ** Cartridge Fuses
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
The fuse panel is located under the right-hand side of the instrument
panel.
To remove the trim panel for access
to the fuse box, pull the panel
toward you and swing it out away
from the side and remove it.
To reinstall it, line up the tabs with
the grooves on the panel, then push
it shut.
To remove the fuse box cover, press in the tabs on both sides of the
cover, then pull the cover off.
To reinstall the fuse box cover, place the top part of the cover on the
fuse panel, then push the bottom part of the cover until you hear it click
shut. Gently pull on the cover to make sure it is seated properly.
Fuses 251
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
The fuses are coded as follows:
Fuse or relay
location
Fuse amp
rating
Protective circuits
1 30A Driver window
2 15A Driver side memory module
3 15A Audio rear seat controls, Satellite
radio, SYNC
4 30A Passenger window
5 10A Keypad illumination, 3rd row seat
enable, Brake-shift interlock,
Smart fuse panel logic power
6 20A Turn signals
7 10A Low beam headlamps (left)
8 10A Low beam headlamps (right)
9 15A Interior lights
10 15A Switch backlighting, Puddle lamps
252 Fuses
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Fuse or relay
location
Fuse amp
rating
Protective circuits
11 10A Not used (spare)
12 7.5A Power mirrors, Driver seat
memory switch
13 5A Not used (spare)
14 10A Power liftgate module keep-alive
power, Clock
15 10A Climate control, Global positioning
satellite module
16 15A Not used (spare)
17 20A Door locks, Liftgate release,
Liftglass release
18 20A Second row heated seats
19 25A Rear wiper
20 15A Adjustable pedals, Datalink
21 15A Fog lamps
22 15A Park lamps
23 15A High beam headlamps
24 20A Horn
25 10A Demand lamps, Glove box, Visor
26 10A Instrument panel cluster
27 20A Ignition switch
28 5A Radio
29 5A Instrument panel cluster
30 5A Not used (spare)
31 10A Not used (spare)
32 10A Airbag module
33 10A Not used (spare)
34 5A Not used (spare)
35 10A Rear park assist, 4x4, Rear video
camera, 2nd row heated seats
36 5A Passive anti-theft system
37 10A Climate control
Fuses 253
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Fuse or relay
location
Fuse amp
rating
Protective circuits
38 20A Subwoofer, THX amplifier
39 20A Radio
40 20A THX amplifier
41 15A Power windows, Power vents,
Power moonroof, Auto dimming
rear view mirror, 110–volt AC
power point
42 10A Not used (spare)
43 10A Rear wiper logic, Rain sensor
44 10A Trailer tow battery charge relay
coil
45 5A Front wiper logic
46 7.5A Climate control, Auxiliary relay
control
47 30A Circuit
Breaker
Power windows, Moonroof
48 Delayed accessory relay
254 Fuses
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL INFORMATION
WARNING: Turn off the power running boards, if equipped,
before working under the vehicle, jacking or placing any object
under the vehicle. Never place your hand between the extended
running board and the vehicle. A moving running board may cause
injury.
Have your vehicle serviced regularly to help maintain its roadworthiness
and resale value. There is a large network of Ford authorized dealers
that are there to help you with their professional servicing expertise.
We believe that their specially trained technicians are best qualified to
service your vehicle properly and expertly. They are supported by a wide
range of highly specialized tools developed specifically for servicing your
vehicle.
To help you service your vehicle, we provide scheduled maintenance
information which makes tracking routine service easy.
If your vehicle requires professional service, your authorized dealer
can provide the necessary parts and service. Check your warranty
information to find out which parts and services are covered.
Use only recommended fuels, lubricants, fluids and service parts
conforming to specifications. Motorcraft® parts are designed and built to
provide the best performance in your vehicle.
Precautions
Do not work on a hot engine.
Make sure that nothing gets caught in moving parts.
Do not work on a vehicle with the engine running in an enclosed
space, unless you are sure you have enough ventilation.
Keep all open flames and other burning material (such as cigarettes)
away from the battery and all fuel related parts.
Maintenance 255
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Working with the Engine Off
1. Set the parking brake and shift to P (Park).
2. Turn off the engine and remove the key (if equipped).
3. Block the wheels.
Working with the Engine On
WARNING: To reduce the risk of vehicle damage or personal
burn injuries, do not start your engine with the air cleaner
removed and do not remove it while the engine is running.
1. Set the parking brake and shift to positionP.
2. Block the wheels.
OPENING AND CLOSING THE HOOD
1. Inside the vehicle, pull the hood
release handle located under the
bottom of the instrument panel.
2. Go to the front of the vehicle and
release the auxiliary latch that is
located under the front center of
the hood.
3. Lift the hood until the lift
cylinders hold it open.
B
R
A
K
E
256 Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
UNDER HOOD OVERVIEW
5.4L V8
A. Windshield washer fluid reservoir
B. Engine oil dipstick
C. Brake fluid reservoir
D. Engine coolant reservoir
E. Air filter assembly
F. Power steering fluid reservoir
G. Power distribution box
H. Engine oil filler cap
I. Battery
W
A
S
H
E
R
F
L
U
I
D
O
N
LY
A B C D
EFGHI
Maintenance 257
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK
A. MIN
B. MAX
ENGINE OIL CHECK
Refer to the scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate
intervals for checking the engine oil.
1. Make sure the vehicle is on level ground.
2. Turn the engine off and wait 15 minutes for the oil to drain into the
oil pan.
3. Set the parking brake and ensure the gearshift is securely latched in P
(Park).
4. Open the hood. Protect yourself from engine heat.
5. Locate and carefully remove the engine oil level dipstick. See the
Under Hood Overview in this chapter for location of dipstick.
6. Wipe the dipstick clean. Insert the dipstick fully, then remove it again.
If the oil level is between the lower and upper holes or between the MIN
and MAX marks (depending on application), the oil level is acceptable.
DO NOT ADD OIL.
If the oil level is below the lower hole or the MIN mark, add enough
oil to raise the level within the lower and upper holes or within the
MIN-MAX range.
Oil levels above the upper hole or the MAX mark may cause engine
damage. Some oil must be removed from the engine by an authorized
dealer.
7. Put the dipstick back in and ensure it is fully seated.
A B
258 Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Adding Engine Oil
Note: Do not remove the engine oil level dipstick or the filler cap when
the engine is running.
Note: Do not add engine oil further than the MAX mark. Oil levels above
the MAX mark may cause engine damage.
Only use oils certified for gasoline engines by the
American Petroleum Institute (API). An oil with this
trademark symbol conforms to the current engine
and emission system protection standards and fuel
economy requirements of the International Lubricants
Specification Advisory Council (ILSAC), comprised of
U.S. and Japanese automobile manufacturers.
1. Check the engine oil level.
2. If the engine oil level is not within the normal range, add engine oil
that meets Ford specifications. See Capacities and Specifications for
more information. Remove the engine oil filler cap and use a funnel to
pour the engine oil into the opening.
3. Recheck the engine oil level. Make sure the oil level is not above the
normal operating range on the engine oil level dipstick.
4. Install the dipstick and ensure it is fully seated.
5. Fully install the engine oil filler cap by turning the filler cap clockwise
until three clicks are heard or until the cap is fully seated.
ENGINE COOLANT CHECK
Checking the Engine Coolant
When the engine is cold, check the concentration and level of the engine
coolant at the intervals listed in the Scheduled Maintenance Information.
Note: Make sure that the level is between the MIN and MAX marks on
the coolant reservoir.
Note: Coolant expands when it is hot. The level may extend beyond the
MAX mark.
Note: If the level is at the MIN mark, below the MIN mark, or empty,
add coolant immediately. See Adding Engine Coolant in this chapter.
The coolant concentration should be maintained within 48% to 50%, which
equates to a freeze point between -30°F (-34°C) and -34°F (-37°C).
Maintenance 259
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: For best results, coolant concentration should be tested with a
refractometer such as Rotunda tool 300-ROB75240 available from your
dealer. Ford does not recommend the use of hydrometers or coolant test
strips for measuring coolant concentrations.
Note: Automotive fluids are not interchangeable; do not use engine
coolant/antifreeze or windshield washer fluid outside of its specified
function and vehicle location.
Adding Engine Coolant
WARNING: Do not add engine coolant when the engine is hot.
Steam and scalding liquids released from a hot cooling system
can burn you badly. Also, you can be burned if you spill coolant on hot
engine parts.
WARNING: Do not put engine coolant in the windshield washer
fluid container. If sprayed on the windshield, engine coolant
could make it difficult to see through the windshield.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of personal injury, make sure the
engine is cool before unscrewing the coolant pressure relief cap.
The cooling system is under pressure; steam and hot liquid can come
out forcefully when the cap is loosened slightly.
WARNING: Do not add coolant further than the MAX mark.
Note: Do not use stop leak pellets, cooling system sealants or additives
as they can cause damage to the engine cooling and/or heating systems.
This damage would not be covered under your vehicle’s warranty.
Note: During normal vehicle operation, the engine coolant may change
color from orange to pink or light red. As long as the engine coolant is
clear and uncontaminated, this color change does not indicate the engine
coolant has degraded nor does it require the engine coolant to be
drained, the system to be flushed, or the engine coolant to be replaced.
DO NOT MIX different colors or types of coolant in your vehicle. Make
sure the correct coolant is used. Mixing of engine coolants may harm
your engine’s cooling system. The use of an improper coolant may harm
engine and cooling system components and may void the warranty.
260 Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
In case of emergency, a large amount of water without engine coolant
may be added in order to reach a vehicle service location. In this
instance, the cooling system must be drained, chemically cleaned with
Motorcraft Premium Cooling System Flush, and refilled with engine
coolant as soon as possible. Water alone (without engine coolant) can
cause engine damage from corrosion, overheating or freezing.
Do not use alcohol, methanol, brine or any engine coolants mixed with
alcohol or methanol antifreeze (coolant). Alcohol and other liquids can
cause engine damage from overheating or freezing.
Do not add extra inhibitors or additives to the coolant. These can be
harmful and compromise the corrosion protection of the engine
coolant.
Unscrew the cap slowly. Any pressure will escape as you unscrew the
cap.
Add prediluted engine coolant meeting the Ford specification.
See Capacities and Specifications for more information.
Whenever coolant has been added, the coolant level in the coolant
reservoir should be checked the next few times you drive the vehicle.
If necessary, add enough prediluted engine coolant to bring the coolant
level to the proper level.
Recycled Engine Coolant
Ford Motor Company does not recommend the use of recycled engine
coolant since a Ford-approved recycling process is not yet available.
Used engine coolant should be disposed of in an appropriate
manner. Follow your community’s regulations and standards for recycling
and disposing of automotive fluids.
Severe Climates
If you drive in extremely cold climates:
It may be necessary to have a Ford authorized dealer increase the
coolant concentration above 50%.
A coolant concentration of 60% will provide improved freeze point
protection. Engine coolant concentrations above 60% will decrease the
overheat protection characteristics of the engine coolant and may
cause engine damage.
Maintenance 261
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If you drive in extremely hot climates:
It may be necessary to have a Ford authorized dealer decrease the
coolant concentration to 40%.
A coolant concentration of 40% will provide improved overheat
protection. Engine coolant concentrations below 40% will decrease the
corrosion/freeze protection characteristics of the engine coolant and
may cause engine damage.
Vehicles driven year-round in non-extreme climates should use
prediluted engine coolant for optimum cooling system and engine
protection.
What You Should Know About Fail-Safe Cooling
If the engine coolant supply is depleted, this feature allows the vehicle to
be driven temporarily before incremental component damage is incurred.
The fail-safe distance depends on ambient temperatures, vehicle load and
terrain.
How Fail-Safe Cooling Works
If the engine begins to overheat, the engine coolant temperature gauge
will move to the red (hot) area and:
The coolant temperature warning light will illuminate.
The service engine soon indicator will illuminate.
If the engine reaches a preset over-temperature condition, the engine
will automatically switch to alternating cylinder operation. Each disabled
cylinder acts as an air pump and cools the engine.
When this occurs the vehicle will still operate. However:
The engine power will be limited.
The air conditioning system will be disabled.
Continued operation will increase the engine temperature and the engine
will completely shut down, causing steering and braking effort to increase.
Once the engine temperature cools, the engine can be restarted. Take
your vehicle to an authorized dealer as soon as possible to minimize
engine damage.
262 Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When Fail-Safe Mode is Activated
WARNING: Fail-safe mode is for use during emergencies only.
Operate the vehicle in fail-safe mode only as long as necessary to
bring the vehicle to rest in a safe location and seek immediate repairs.
When in fail-safe mode, the vehicle will have limited power, will not be
able to maintain high-speed operation, and may completely shut down
without warning, potentially losing engine power, power steering assist,
and power brake assist, which may increase the possibility of a crash
resulting in serious injury.
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the
engine is running or hot.
You have limited engine power when in the fail-safe mode, so drive the
vehicle with caution. The vehicle will not be able to maintain high-speed
operation and the engine will run rough. Remember that the engine is
capable of completely shutting down automatically to prevent engine
damage, therefore:
1. Pull off the road as soon as safely possible and turn off the engine.
2. Arrange for the vehicle to be taken to an authorized dealer.
3. If this is not possible, wait a short period for the engine to cool.
4. Check the coolant level and replenish if low.
5. Restart the engine and take your vehicle to an authorized dealer.
Note: Driving the vehicle without repairing the engine problem increases
the chance of engine damage. Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer
as soon as possible.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID CHECK
Note: Transmission fluid should be checked by an authorized dealer.
If required, fluid should be added by an authorized dealer.
The automatic transmission does not have a transmission fluid dipstick.
Refer to your scheduled maintenance information for scheduled
intervals for fluid checks and changes. Your transmission does not
consume fluid. However, the fluid level should be checked if the
transmission is not working properly, (i.e., if the transmission slips
or shifts slowly) or if you notice some sign of fluid leakage.
Maintenance 263
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Do not use supplemental transmission fluid additives, treatments or
cleaning agents. The use of these materials may affect transmission
operation and result in damage to internal transmission components.
BRAKE FLUID CHECK
Fluid levels between the MIN and MAX lines are within the normal
operating range; there is no need to add fluid. If the fluid levels are
outside of the normal operating range, the performance of the system
could be compromised; seek service from your authorized dealer
immediately.
POWER STEERING FLUID CHECK
Check the power steering fluid. Refer to scheduled maintenance
information.
1. Start the engine and let it run until it reaches normal operating
temperature (the engine coolant temperature gauge indicator will be
near the center of the normal area between H and C).
2. While the engine idles, turn the steering wheel left and right several
times.
3. Turn the engine off.
4. Check the fluid level in the reservoir. It should be between the MIN
and MAX lines. Do not add fluid if the level is in this range.
5. If the fluid is low, add fluid in small amounts, continuously checking
the level until it reaches the range between the MIN and MAX lines. Be
sure to put the cap back on the reservoir. Refer to the Capacities and
Specifications chapter for the proper fluid type.
FUEL FILTER
Your vehicle is equipped with a lifetime fuel filter that is integrated with
the fuel tank. Regular maintenance or replacement is not needed.
WASHER FLUID CHECK
WARNING: If you operate your vehicle in temperatures below
40°F (5°C), use washer fluid with antifreeze protection. Failure
to use washer fluid with antifreeze protection in cold weather could
result in impaired windshield vision and increase the risk of injury or
accident.
Add fluid to fill the reservoir if the level is low. Only use a washer fluid
that meets Ford specifications. See the technical specifications chart in
the Capacities and Specifications chapter.
264 Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: The front and rear washer systems are supplied from the same
reservoir.
State or local regulations on volatile organic compounds may restrict
the use of methanol, a common windshield washer antifreeze additive.
Washer fluids containing non-methanol antifreeze agents should be used
only if they provide cold weather protection without damaging the
vehicle’s paint finish, wiper blades or washer system.
CHANGING THE VEHICLE BATTERY
WARNING: Batteries normally produce explosive gases which
can cause personal injury. Therefore, do not allow flames, sparks
or lighted substances to come near the battery. When working near the
battery, always shield your face and protect your eyes. Always provide
proper ventilation.
WARNING: When lifting a plastic-cased battery, excessive
pressure on the end walls could cause acid to flow through the
vent caps, resulting in personal injury and/or damage to the vehicle or
battery. Lift the battery with a battery carrier or with your hands on
opposite corners.
WARNING: Keep batteries out of reach of children. Batteries
contain sulfuric acid. Avoid contact with skin, eyes or clothing.
Shield your eyes when working near the battery to protect against
possible splashing of acid solution. In case of acid contact with skin or
eyes, flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and
get prompt medical attention. If acid is swallowed, call a physician
immediately.
WARNING: Battery posts, terminals and related accessories
contain lead and lead compounds. Note: Wash hands after
handling.
Note: If your battery has a cover/shield, make sure it is reinstalled after
the battery has been cleaned or replaced.
For longer, trouble-free operation, keep the top of the battery clean and
dry. Also, make certain the battery cables are always tightly fastened to
the battery terminals.
Maintenance 265
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: Electrical or electronic accessories or components added to the
vehicle by the dealer or the owner may adversely affect battery
performance and durability.
Your vehicle is equipped with a Motorcraft® maintenance-free battery
which normally does not require additional water during its life of
service.
If you see any corrosion on the battery or terminals, remove the cables
from the terminals and clean with a wire brush. You can neutralize the
acid with a solution of baking soda and water.
It is recommended that the negative battery cable terminal be
disconnected from the battery if you plan to store your vehicle for an
extended period of time. This will minimize the discharge of your battery
during storage.
Because your vehicle’s engine is electronically controlled by a computer,
some control conditions are maintained by power from the battery. When
the battery is disconnected or a new battery is installed, the engine must
relearn its idle and fuel trim strategy for optimum driveability and
performance. To begin this process:
1. With the vehicle at a complete stop, set the parking brake.
2. Put the gearshift in P (Park), turn off all accessories and start the
engine.
3. Run the engine until it reaches normal operating temperature.
4. Allow the engine to idle for at least one minute.
5. Turn the A/C on and allow the engine to idle for at least one minute.
6. Drive the vehicle to complete the relearning process.
The vehicle may need to be driven 10 miles (16 km) or more to
relearn the idle and fuel trim strategy.
Note: If you do not allow the engine to relearn its idle trim, the idle
quality of your vehicle may be adversely affected until the idle trim is
eventually relearned.
If the battery has been disconnected or a new battery has been installed,
the clock and radio settings must be reset once the battery is reconnected.
266 Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CHECKING THE WIPER BLADES
Run the tip of your fingers over the edge of the blade
to check for roughness.
Clean the wiper blades with washer fluid or water
applied with a soft sponge or cloth.
CHANGING THE WIPER BLADES
Replace wiper blades at least once per year for optimum performance.
To replace the wiper blades:
1. Fold back the wiper arm and
position the wiper blade at a right
angle to the wiper arm.
2. To remove the wiper blade, press
the retaining clip (A) to disengage
the wiper blade, then pull the blade
down toward the windshield to
remove it from the arm.
3. Install the new wiper blade on the arm and press it into place until a
click is heard.
Poor wiper quality can be improved by cleaning the wiper blades and
windshield. Refer to Windows and wiper blades in the Cleaning
chapter.
To prolong the life of the wiper blades, it is highly recommended to
scrape off the ice on the windshield before turning on the wipers.
The layer of ice has many sharp edges and can damage the micro edge
of the wiper rubber element.
A
Maintenance 267
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Changing the Rear Window Wiper Blade
To replace the rear wiper blade:
1. Pull the wiper arm as far away from the glass as possible. Do not use
excessive force because it can break the wiper arm. Hold it there until
the next step.
2. Grasp the wiper blade and rotate
it away from the wiper arm using
moderate force until it disengages
from the wiper arm.
3. Once the wiper blade is loose,
slide it away from the wiper arm.
4. To attach the new wiper to the
wiper arm, align the cross pin and
keyway (denoted with the arrows)
and firmly press the wiper blade
into the wiper arm until an audible
snap is heard.
If you find this procedure too difficult, please see your dealer.
AIR FILTER CHECK
WARNING: To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and or
personal burn injuries, do not start your engine with the air
cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running.
Note: Failure to use the correct air filter element may result in severe
engine damage. The customer warranty may be void for any damage to
the engine if the correct air filter element is not used.
When changing the air filter element, use only the air filter element
listed. See Motorcraft® Part Numbers in the Capacities and
Specifications chapter.
268 Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
See Scheduled Maintenance Information for the appropriate intervals
for changing the air filter element.
Note: Failure to use the correct air filter element may result in severe
engine damage. The customer warranty may be void for any damage to
the engine if the correct air filter element is not used.
Changing the Air Filter Element
1. Locate the mass air flow sensor
electrical connector on the air
outlet tube. This connector will
need to be unplugged.
2. Unlock the locking clip on the
connector (connector shown from
below for clarity), then squeeze and
pull the connector off of the air
outlet tube.
3. Clean the area around the air
tube to air cover connection to
prevent debris from entering the
system and then loosen the bolt on
the air tube clamp so the clamp is
no longer snug to the air tube. It is
not necessary to completely remove
the clamp.
4. Pull the air tube off from the air
cleaner housing.
Maintenance 269
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
5. Release the three clamps that secure
the cover to the air filter housing. Push
the air filter cover toward the center of
the vehicle and up slightly to release it.
6. Remove the air filter element
from the air filter housing.
7. Install a new air filter element.
8. Replace the air filter housing
cover and secure the clamps.
Be careful not to crimp the filter
element edges between the air filter
housing and cover and ensure that
the tabs on the edge are properly
aligned into the slots.
9. Slip the air tube onto the air
filter housing and tighten the
air-tube clamp bolt snugly, but do
not overtighten it.
10. Reconnect the mass air flow
sensor electrical connector to the
outlet tube. Make sure the locking
tab on the connector is in the
“locked” position (connector shown
from below for clarity).
270 Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ADJUSTING THE HEADLAMPS
The headlamps on your vehicle are properly aimed at the assembly plant.
If your vehicle has been in an accident, an authorized dealer should
check the alignment of your headlamps.
Vertical Aim Adjustment
Before aim adjustment, disable the air suspension system. Refer to
Message center in the Driver Controls chapter.
1. Park the vehicle directly in front of a wall or screen on a level surface,
approximately 25 feet (7.6 meters) away.
(A) 8 feet (2.4 meters)
(B) Center height of lamp to
ground
(C) 25 feet (7.6 meters)
(D) Horizontal reference line
2. Measure the height from the center of your headlamp (indicated by
a 3.0 millimeter circle on the lens) to the ground and mark an 8 foot
(2.4 meter) horizontal reference line on the vertical wall or screen at this
height (a piece of masking tape works well).
3. Turn on the low beam headlamps to illuminate the wall or screen and
open the hood. Cover one of the headlamps so no light from that lamp
hits the wall.
4.
On the wall or screen you will
observe a light pattern with a distinct
horizontal edge towards the right.
If this edge is not at the horizontal
reference line, the beam will need to
be adjusted so the edge is at the
same height as the horizontal
reference line.
C
A
B
D
Maintenance 271
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
5. Locate the vertical adjuster on
each headlamp, then use a Phillips
#2 screwdriver to turn the adjuster
either counterclockwise or
clockwise in order to adjust the
vertical aim of the headlamp. The
upper edge of the light pattern
should touch the horizontal
reference line.
6. HORIZONTAL AIM IS NOT REQUIRED FOR THIS VEHICLE AND IS
NOT ADJUSTABLE.
7. Repeat Steps 3–5 for the other headlamp.
8. Close the hood and turn off the lamps.
CHANGING A BULB
Lamp Assembly Condensation
Exterior lamps are vented to accommodate normal changes in pressure.
Condensation can be a natural by-product of this design. When moist air
enters the lamp assembly through the vents, there is a possibility that
condensation can occur when the temperature is cold. When normal
condensation occurs, a thin film of mist can form on the interior of the
lens. The thin mist eventually clears and exits through the vents during
normal operation. Clearing time may take as long as 48 hours under dry
weather conditions.
These are examples of acceptable condensation:
Presence of thin mist (no streaks, drip marks or droplets).
Fine mist covers less than 50% of the lens.
These are examples of unacceptable moisture (usually caused by a lamp
water leak):
Water puddle inside the lamp.
Large water droplets, drip marks or streaks present on the interior of
the lens.
Take your vehicle to a dealer for service if any of the above conditions of
unacceptable moisture are present.
272 Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Replacing HID Headlamp Bulbs
The low/high beam headlamps on your vehicle use a “high intensity
discharge” source. These lamps operate at a high voltage. For bulb
replacement, see your authorized dealer.
Replacing Front Parking Lamp, Turn Signal, and Side Marker Bulbs
The front parking lamp, turn signal, and side marker bulbs are located in
the headlamp assembly. Follow the same steps to replace any of these
bulbs.
1. Make sure the headlamp control is in the off position.
2. Open the hood.
3. At the back of the headlamp lens,
remove the two headlamp assembly
bolts.
4. Pull the headlamp assembly
forward slightly to expose the
electrical connectors.
5. Rotate the bulb socket
counterclockwise and remove it.
6. Pull the bulb straight out of the
socket and push in the new bulb.
7. To complete installation of the
parking lamp/turn signal assembly,
follow the removal procedures in
reverse order.
Maintenance 273
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Replacing Fog Lamp Bulbs
1. From underneath the vehicle,
rotate the harness/bulb assembly
counterclockwise to remove it from
the fog lamp assembly.
2. Carefully disconnect the bulb
from the harness assembly via the
two snap clips.
Install the new bulb in reverse
order.
Replacing Tail, Stop, Turn Signal, and Backup Lamp Bulbs
The tail, stop, turn signal, and backup lamp bulbs are located in the
same portion of the tail lamp assembly, one just below the other. Follow
the same steps to replace any of these bulbs.
1. Make sure the headlamp switch is
in the off position.
2. Open the liftgate to expose the
lamp assembly screws.
3. Remove the two screws from the
lamp assembly.
4. Carefully pry the lamp assembly away from the vehicle by pulling the
assembly directly straight out to expose the bulb socket. DO NOT TIP
THE LAMP ASSEMBLY SIDEWAYS.
5. Rotate the bulb socket counterclockwise and remove from lamp
assembly.
6. Pull bulb straight out of the socket and push in the new bulb.
7. Install the bulb socket into the lamp assembly and rotate clockwise.
8. Install the lamp assembly on the vehicle and secure with two screws.
274 Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Replacing Supplemental Tail Lamp Bulbs
1. Make sure the headlamp switch is in the off position.
2. Open the liftgate and remove interior trim panel.
3. Remove four nuts from the lamp
assembly.
4. Carefully pry the lamp assembly
away from the vehicle by pulling the
assembly directly straight out to
expose the bulb socket. DO NOT
TIP THE LAMP ASSEMBLY
SIDEWAYS.
5. Rotate the bulb socket counterclockwise and remove from lamp
assembly.
6. Pull bulb straight out of socket and push in the new bulb.
7. Install the bulb socket into the lamp assembly and rotate clockwise.
8. Install the lamp assembly on the vehicle and secure with four nuts.
9. Install the interior trim panel.
Replacing License Plate Lamp Bulbs
The license plate bulbs are located in the license plate housing assembly
on the liftgate. To change the license plate bulbs:
1. Make sure the headlamp switch is
in the off position.
2. Remove the license lamp screw
from the assembly.
3. Pull the lamp down and twist
the bulb socket counterclockwise.
Remove the bulb socket from the
lamp.
4. Pull out the old bulb and push in
the new bulb.
5. Install the bulb socket in the lamp assembly by turning it clockwise.
6. Install the lamp assembly and secure it with the retaining screw.
Maintenance 275
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Replacing the High-Mount Brake Lamp Bulbs
To change the high-mount brake
lamp bulbs:
1. Remove the two screws holding
the lamp assembly in place.
2. Pull the lamp assembly straight
out.
3. Disconnect the wire harness.
4. Press the four tabs that hold the
light assembly on, one at a time,
and pull the black bulb carrier away
from the lamp.
5. Pull the old bulb out and replace
with the new bulb.
6. Snap the black bulb carrier into
the lamp assembly.
7. Connect the wire harness.
8. Install the lamp assembly with
two screws.
Replacing Approach Lamp/Mirror Turn Signal Bulbs
For bulb replacement, see your authorized dealer.
BULB SPECIFICATION CHART
Replacement bulbs are specified in the chart below. Headlamp bulbs
must be marked with an authorized “D.O.T.” for North America to ensure
lamp performance, light brightness and pattern and safe visibility.
The correct bulbs will not damage the lamp assembly or void the lamp
assembly warranty and will provide quality bulb burn time.
276 Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Function Number of bulbs Trade number
Headlamps (low and
high-beam)
2 *See your dealer
Front park lamps 2 3157K
Front turn lamps 2 3157A (amber)
Front side marker 2 168A (amber)
Fog lamps 2 H11
Front row map lamps 2 1600XB
2nd row reading lamp 1 1600XB
Rear cargo lamp 1 211–2XB
Rear turn/tail/brake
lamps
4 3057K
Backup lamps 2 921
Supplemental tail
lamps
4 906
Approach lamps 2 906
Mirror turn signal
lamps
2 906 (amber)
License lamp 2 168
High-mount brake
lamp
5 W5W
Visor vanity lamp -
Slide on rail system
(SOR)
2 A6224PF
All replacement bulbs are clear in color except where noted.
To replace all instrument panel lights - see your authorized dealer
* For vehicles with HID (high intensity discharge) lamps, see your
authorized dealer for service.
Maintenance 277
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL INFORMATION
Your Ford or Lincoln authorized dealer has many quality products
available to clean your vehicle and protect its finishes.
CLEANING PRODUCTS
For best results, use the following products or products of equivalent
quality:
Motorcraft Bug and Tar Remover (ZC-42)
Motorcraft Custom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15)
Motorcraft Detail Wash (ZC-3-A)
Motorcraft Dusting Cloth (ZC-24)
Motorcraft Engine Shampoo and Degreaser (United States only) (ZC-20)
Motorcraft Engine Shampoo (Canada only) (CXC-66-A)
Motorcraft Multi-Purpose Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-101)
Motorcraft Premium Glass Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-100)
Motorcraft Premium Quality Windshield Washer Fluid (Canada only)
[CXC-37-(A, B, D or F)]
Motorcraft Premium Windshield Wash Concentrate with Bitterant
(United States only) ZC-32-B1)
Motorcraft Professional Strength Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54)
Motorcraft Spot and Stain Remover (United States only) (ZC-14)
Motorcraft Ultra-Clear Spray Glass Cleaner (ZC-23)
Motorcraft Wheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37-A)
CLEANING THE EXTERIOR
Wash your vehicle regularly with cool or lukewarm water and a neutral
pH shampoo, such as Motorcraft® Detail Wash.
Do not use a commercial or high-pressure wand on the surface or
edge of stripes and graphics. This can cause damage to the film and
cause the edge of the film to peel away from the vehicle surface.
Never use strong household detergents or soap, such as dish washing
or laundry liquid. These products can discolor and spot painted
surfaces.
Never wash a vehicle that is hot to the touch or during exposure to
strong, direct sunlight.
278 Vehicle Care
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Dry the vehicle with a chamois or soft terry cloth towel in order to
eliminate water spotting.
Immediately remove items such as gasoline, diesel fuel, bird droppings
and insect deposits because they can cause damage to the vehicle’s
paintwork and trim over time. Use Motorcraft Bug and Tar Remover.
Note: Suntan lotions and insect repellents can damage any painted
surface; if these substances come in contact with your vehicle, wash it
off as soon as possible.
Remove any exterior accessories before entering a car wash.
Stripes or Graphics (if equipped)
Do not use a commercial or high-pressure wand on the surface or edge
of stripes and graphics. This can cause damage to the film and cause the
edge of the film to peel away from the vehicle surface.
Exterior Chrome
Note: Never use abrasive materials such as steel wool or plastic pads as
they can scratch the chrome surface.
Note: Do not use chrome cleaner, metal cleaner or polish on wheels and
wheel covers.
Wash the vehicle first, using cool or lukewarm water and a neutral pH
shampoo, such as Motorcraft Detail Wash.
Use Motorcraft Custom Bright Metal Cleaner. Apply the product as
you would a wax to clean bumpers and other chrome parts; allow the
cleaner to dry for a few minutes, then wipe off the haze with a clean,
dry rag.
Do not apply cleaning product to hot surfaces and do not leave
cleaning product on chrome surfaces for a period of time exceeding
that which is recommended.
Note: Using other non-recommended cleaners can result in severe
and permanent cosmetic damage.
Underbody
Flush the complete underside of your vehicle frequently. Keep body and
door drain holes free from packed dirt.
Vehicle Care 279
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Cleaning Plastic Exterior Parts
Use only approved products to clean plastic parts.
For routine cleaning, use Motorcraft Detail Wash.
If tar or grease spots are present, use Motorcraft Bug and Tar
Remover.
WAXING
Regular waxing is necessary to protect the paint on your car from the
elements. We recommend that you wash and wax the painted surface
once or twice a year.
When washing and waxing, park your vehicle in a shaded area out of
direct sunlight. Always wash your vehicle before applying wax.
Use a quality wax that does not contain abrasives.
Follow the manufacturer’s instructions to apply and remove the wax.
Apply a small amount of wax in a back-and-forth motion, not in
circles.
Do not allow wax to come in contact with any non-body (low-gloss
black) colored trim. The wax discolors or stains the parts over time,
such as:
Bumpers
Grained door handles
Side mouldings
Mirror housings
Windshield cowl area.
Do not apply wax to glass areas.
After waxing, your car’s paint should feel smooth, and be free of
streaks and smudges.
REPAIRING MINOR PAINT DAMAGE
Your authorized dealer has touch-up paint to match your vehicle’s color.
Take your color code (printed on a sticker in the driver’s door jamb) to
an authorized dealer to make sure you get the correct color.
Remove particles, such as bird droppings, tree sap, insect deposits, tar
spots, road salt and industrial fallout, before repairing paint chips.
Always read the instructions before using the products.
280 Vehicle Care
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CLEANING THE ENGINE
Engines are more efficient when they are clean because grease and dirt
buildup keep the engine warmer than normal.
When washing:
Take care when using a power washer to clean the engine.
The high-pressure fluid could penetrate the sealed parts and cause
damage.
Do not spray a hot engine with cold water to avoid cracking the
engine block or other engine components.
Spray Motorcraft® Engine Shampoo and Degreaser on all parts that
require cleaning and pressure rinse clean. In Canada, use Motorcraft®
Engine Shampoo.
Never wash or rinse the engine while it is hot or running; water in the
running engine may cause internal damage.
Never wash or rinse any ignition coil, spark plug wire or spark plug
well, or the area in and around these locations.
Cover the battery, power distribution box, and air filter assembly to
prevent water damage when cleaning the engine.
CLEANING THE WINDOWS AND WIPER BLADES
The windows and wiper blades should be cleaned regularly. If the wipers
do not wipe properly, substances on the vehicle’s glass or the wiper
blades may cause squeaking or chatter noise from the blades, and
streaking and smearing of the windshield. To clean these items, follow
these tips:
The windows may be cleaned with a non-abrasive cleaner such as
Motorcraft® Ultra-Clear Spray Glass Cleaner.
The wiper blades can be cleaned with isopropyl (rubbing) alcohol or
Motorcraft Premium Windshield Washer Concentrates in the U.S., or
Motorcraft Premium Quality Windshield Washer Fluid in Canada.
Replace your wiper blades when they appear worn or do not function
properly.
Do not use abrasive materials, as they may cause scratches.
Do not use fuel, kerosene, or paint thinner to clean any parts.
Vehicle Care 281
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If you cannot remove those streaks after cleaning with the glass cleaner
or if the wipers chatter and move in a jerky motion, clean the outer
surface of the windshield and the wiper blades using a sponge or soft
cloth with a neutral detergent or mild-abrasive cleaning solution. After
cleaning, rinse the windshield and wiper blades with clean water. The
windshield is clean if beads do not form when you rinse the windshield
with water.
Note: Do not use sharp objects, such as a razor blade, to clean the
inside of the rear window or to remove decals, as it may cause damage
to the rear window defroster’s heated grid lines.
CLEANING THE INTERIOR
WARNING: Do not use cleaning solvents, bleach or dye on the
vehicle’s safety belts, as these actions may weaken the belt
webbing.
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with seat-mounted airbags, do
not use chemical solvents or strong detergents. Such products
could contaminate the side airbag system and affect performance of the
side airbag in a collision.
For fabric, carpets, cloth seats, safety belts and seats equipped with side
airbags:
Remove dust and loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.
Apply a layer of high quality foam cleaner, designed for automotive
interiors, to the dry stained area (s) of the item you are cleaning and
allow soaking for one minute.
If grease or tar is present on the material, spot-clean the area first
with Motorcraft Spot and Stain Remover. In Canada, use Motorcraft
Multi-Purpose Cleaner.
If a ring forms on the fabric after spot cleaning, clean the entire area
immediately (but do not oversaturate) or the ring can set.
Do not use household cleaning products or glass cleaners, which can
stain and discolor the fabric and affect the flame retardant abilities of
the seat materials.
CLEANING THE CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEATS (IF EQUIPPED)
Remove dust and loose dirt with a whisk broom or a vacuum cleaner.
Remove fresh spots immediately. Clean the seat with a damp cloth, using
a mild soap and water solution, if necessary.
282 Vehicle Care
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CLEANING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL AND INSTRUMENT
CLUSTER LENS
WARNING: Do not use chemical solvents or strong detergents
when cleaning the steering wheel or instrument panel to avoid
contamination of the airbag system.
Clean the instrument panel and cluster lens with a clean, damp, white,
cotton cloth, then use a clean and dry, white, cotton cloth to dry these
areas.
Avoid cleaners or polishes that increase the gloss of the upper portion
of the instrument panel. The dull finish in this area helps protect the
driver from undesirable windshield reflection.
Be certain to wash or wipe your hands clean if you have been in
contact with certain products, such as insect repellent and suntan
lotion, in order to avoid possible damage to the interior painted
surfaces.
Do not use household or glass cleaners as these may damage the
finish of the instrument panel, interior trim and cluster lens.
Do not allow air fresheners and hand sanitizers to spill on interior
surfaces. If a spill occurs, wipe off immediately. Damage may not be
covered by your warranty.
If a staining liquid like coffee or juice has been spilled on the instrument
panel or on interior trim surfaces, clean as follows:
1. Wipe up spilled liquid using a clean, white, cotton cloth.
2. Wipe the surface with a damp, clean, white, cotton cloth. For more
thorough cleaning, use a mild soap and water solution. If the spot cannot
be completely cleaned by this method, the area may be cleaned using a
commercially available cleaning product designed for automotive
interiors.
3. If necessary, apply more soap and water solution or cleaning product
to a clean, white, cotton cloth and press the cloth onto the soiled area;
allow this to set at room temperature for 30 minutes.
4. Remove the soaked cloth, and if it is not soiled badly, use this cloth to
clean the area by using a rubbing motion for 60 seconds.
5. Following this, wipe area dry with a clean, white, cotton cloth.
Vehicle Care 283
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CLEANING LEATHER SEATS (IF EQUIPPED)
Remove dust and loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.
Clean spills and stains as quickly as possible.
For routine cleaning, wipe the surface with a soft, damp cloth. For
more thorough cleaning, wipe the surface with a mild soap and water
solution. Dry the area with a soft cloth.
If the leather cannot be completely cleaned using a mild soap and
water solution, the leather may be cleaned using a commercially
available leather cleaning product designed for automotive interiors.
To check for compatibility, first test any cleaner or stain remover on
an inconspicuous part of the leather.
Do not use household cleaning products, alcohol solutions,
oil/petroleum-based leather conditioners, or solvents or cleaners
intended specifically for rubber, vinyl and plastics. These products
may cause premature wearing or damage to the leather.
CLEANING THE ALLOY WHEELS
Note: Do not use chrome cleaner, metal cleaner or polish on wheels and
wheel covers.
A clearcoat paint finish coats aluminum wheels and wheel covers.
In order to maintain their condition:
Clean weekly with Motorcraft Wheel and Tire Cleaner. Use a sponge
to remove heavy deposits of dirt and brake dust accumulation. Rinse
thoroughly with a strong stream of water when you have completed
the cleaning process.
To remove tar and grease, use Motorcraft Bug and Tar Remover.
Never apply any cleaning chemical to hot or warm wheel rims or
covers.
Some automatic car washes may cause damage to the finish on your
wheel rims or covers.
Industrial-strength (heavy-duty) cleaners, or cleaning chemicals, in
combination with brush agitation to remove brake dust and dirt, could
wear away the clearcoat finish over time.
Do not use hydrofluoric acid-based or high caustic-based wheel
cleaners, steel wool, fuels or strong household detergent.
If you intend on parking your vehicle for an extended period after
cleaning the wheels with a wheel cleaner, drive your vehicle for a few
minutes before doing so. This reduces the risk of increased corrosion
of the brake discs.
284 Vehicle Care
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
VEHICLE STORAGE
If you plan on storing your vehicle for an extended period of time
(30 days or more), read the following maintenance recommendations to
make sure your vehicle stays in good operating condition.
All motor vehicles and their components were engineered and tested for
reliable, regular driving. Long-term storage under various conditions may
lead to component degradation or failure unless specific precautions are
taken to preserve the components.
General
Store all vehicles in a dry, ventilated place.
Protect from sunlight, if possible.
If vehicles are stored outside, they require regular maintenance to
protect against rust and damage.
Body
Wash vehicle thoroughly to remove dirt, grease, oil, tar or mud from
exterior surfaces, rear-wheel housing and underside of front fenders.
Periodically wash vehicles stored in exposed locations.
Touch up raw or primed metal to prevent rust.
Cover chrome and stainless steel parts with a thick coat of auto wax
to prevent discoloration. Re-wax as necessary when the vehicle is
washed.
Lubricate hood latch, all door latches and trunk lid hinges with a light
grade oil.
Cover interior trim to prevent fading.
Keep all rubber parts free from oil and solvents.
Engine
The engine oil and filter should be changed prior to storage, as used
engine oil contains contaminates that may cause engine damage.
Start the engine every 15 days. Run at fast idle until it reaches normal
operating temperature.
With your foot on the brake, shift through all the gears while the
engine is running.
Fuel system
Fill the fuel tank with high-quality fuel until the first automatic shutoff
of the fuel pump nozzle.
Vehicle Care 285
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Cooling system
Protect against freezing temperatures.
When removing vehicle from storage, check coolant fluid level.
Confirm there are no cooling system leaks, and fluid is at the
recommended level.
Battery
Check and recharge as necessary. Keep connections clean.
If storing your vehicle for more than 30 days without recharging the
battery, it may be advisable to disconnect the battery cables to ensure
battery charge is maintained for quick starting.
Note: If battery cables are disconnected, it will be necessary to reset
memory features.
Brakes
Make sure brakes and parking brake are fully released.
Tires
Maintain recommended air pressure.
Miscellaneous
Make sure all linkages, cables, levers and pins under vehicle are
covered with grease to prevent rust.
Move vehicles at least 25 feet (8 meters) every 15 days to lubricate
working parts and prevent corrosion.
Removing Vehicle from Storage
When your vehicle is ready to come out of storage, do the following:
Wash your vehicle to remove any dirt or grease film build-up on
window surfaces.
Check windshield wipers for any deterioration.
Check under the hood for any foreign material that may have collected
during storage (mice/squirrel nests).
Check the exhaust for any foreign material that may have collected
during storage.
Check tire pressures and set tire inflation per the Tire Label.
Check brake pedal operation. Drive the vehicle 15 feet (4.5 meters)
back and forth to remove rust build-up.
Check fluid levels (including coolant, oil and gas) to make sure there
are no leaks and fluids are at recommended levels.
If the battery was removed, clean the battery cable ends and inspect.
Contact your authorized dealer if you have any concerns or issues.
286 Vehicle Care
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL INFORMATION
Notice to Utility Vehicle, Van and Truck Owners
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover
rate than other types of vehicles. To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death from a rollover or other crash you must:
Avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers;
Drive at safe speeds for the conditions;
Keep tires properly inflated;
Never overload or improperly load your vehicle; and
Make sure every passenger is properly restrained.
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.
All occupants must wear seat belts. Children and infants must use
appropriate restraints to minimize the risk of injury or ejection.
Utility vehicles, vans and trucks handle
differently than passenger cars in the
various driving conditions that are
encountered on streets, highways and
off-road. Utility vehicles, vans and
trucks are not designed for cornering
at speeds as high as passenger cars
any more than low-slung sports cars
are designed to perform satisfactorily
under off-road conditions.
Four-Wheel Drive System (If Equipped)
WARNING: Do not become overconfident in the ability of
four-wheel drive vehicles. Although a four-wheel drive vehicle
may accelerate better than a two-wheel drive vehicle in low-traction
situations, it will not stop any faster than two-wheel drive vehicles.
Always drive at a safe speed.
A vehicle equipped with four-wheel drive (when selected) has the ability
to use all four wheels to power itself. This increases traction which may
enable you to safely drive over terrain and road conditions that a
conventional two-wheel drive vehicle cannot.
Wheels and Tires 287
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Power is supplied to all four wheels through a transfer case or power
transfer unit. Four-wheel drive vehicles allow you to select different drive
modes as necessary. You can find information on transfer case operation
and shifting procedures in the Transmission chapter. You can find
information on transfer case maintenance in the Maintenance chapter.
You should become thoroughly familiar with this information before you
operate your vehicle.
On some four-wheel drive models, the initial shift from two-wheel drive
to four-wheel drive while the vehicle is moving can cause a momentary
clunk and ratcheting sound. These sounds are normal as the front
drivetrain comes up to speed and are not cause for concern.
How Your Vehicle Differs from Other Vehicles
Sport-utility vehicles, vans and
trucks can differ from some other
vehicles in a few noticeable ways.
Your vehicle may be:
Higher to allow higher load
carrying capacity and to allow
it to travel over rough terrain
without getting hung up or
damaging underbody
components.
Shorter to give it the capability
to approach inclines and drive
over the crest of a hill without
getting hung up or damaging
underbody components. All other
things held equal, a shorter
wheelbase may make your vehicle quicker to respond to steering
inputs than a vehicle with a longer wheelbase.
288 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Narrower to provide greater
maneuverability in tight spaces,
particularly in off-road use.
As a result of the above dimensional
differences, sport-utility vehicles,
vans and trucks often will have a
higher center of gravity and a
greater difference in center of
gravity between the loaded and
unloaded condition.
These differences that make your
vehicle so versatile also make it
handle differently than an ordinary
passenger car.
TIRE CARE
Information About Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Tire Quality Grades apply to new
pneumatic passenger car tires. The Tire
Quality Grades can be found where
applicable on the tire sidewall between
tread shoulder and maximum section
width. For example:
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A
These Tire Quality Grades are determined by standards that the
United States Department of Transportation has set.
Tire Quality Grades apply to new pneumatic passenger car tires.
They do not apply to deep tread, winter-type snow tires, space-saver or
temporary use spare tires, light truck or LT type tires, tires with nominal
rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches or limited production tires as defined in
Title 49 Code of Federal Regulations Part 575.104(c)(2).
U.S. Department of Transportation-Tire quality grades: The U.S.
Department of Transportation requires Ford Motor Company to give you
the following information about tire grades exactly as the government
has written it.
Wheels and Tires 289
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the
tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government
test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear 1
1
2
times as well
on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance
of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may
depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits,
service practices, and differences in road characteristics and climate.
Traction AA A B C
WARNING: The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning or peak traction characteristics.
The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. The
grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured
under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction
performance.
Temperature A B C
WARNING: The temperature grade for this tire is established for
a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive
speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in
combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the
tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire
to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to
sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance
which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard No. 139. Grades B and A represent higher levels of
performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by
law.
290 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Glossary of Tire Terminology
Tire label: A label showing the OE (Original Equipment) tire sizes,
recommended inflation pressure and the maximum weight the vehicle
can carry.
Tire Identification Number (TIN): A number on the sidewall of each
tire providing information about the tire brand and manufacturing plant,
tire size and date of manufacture. Also referred to as DOT code.
Inflation pressure: A measure of the amount of air in a tire.
Standard load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a
maximum load at 35 psi [37 psi (2.5 bar) for Metric tires]. Increasing
the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase the tire’s
load-carrying capability.
Extra load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a
heavier maximum load at 41 psi [43 psi (2.9 bar) for Metric tires].
Increasing the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase
the tire’s load-carrying capability.
kPa: Kilopascal, a metric unit of air pressure.
PSI: Pounds per square inch, a standard unit of air pressure.
Cold tire pressure: The tire pressure when the vehicle has been
stationary and out of direct sunlight for an hour or more and prior to
the vehicle being driven for 1 mile (1.6 kilometers).
Recommended inflation pressure: The cold inflation pressure found
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either the
door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the
door-latch post, next to the driver’s seating position) or Tire Label
located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door.
B-pillar: The structural member at the side of the vehicle behind the
front door.
Bead area of the tire: Area of the tire next to the rim.
Sidewall of the tire: Area between the bead area and the tread.
Tread area of the tire: Area of the perimeter of the tire that
contacts the road when mounted on the vehicle.
Rim: The metal support (wheel) for a tire or a tire and tube assembly
upon which the tire beads are seated.
Wheels and Tires 291
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
INFORMATION CONTAINED ON THE TIRE SIDEWALL
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This information
identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire and also
provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for safety standard
certification and in case of a recall.
Information on P Type Tires
P215/65R15 95H is an example of
a tire size, load index and speed
rating. The definitions of these
items are listed below. (Note that
the tire size, load index and speed
rating for your vehicle may be
different from this example.)
A. P: Indicates a tire, designated by the Tire and Rim Association, that
may be used for service on cars, sport utility vehicles, minivans and light
trucks.
Note: If your tire size does not begin with a letter, this may mean it is
designated by either the European Tire and Rim Technical Organization
or the Japan Tire Manufacturing Association.
B. 215: Indicates the nominal width of the tire in millimeters from
sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger the number, the
wider the tire.
C. 65: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire’s ratio of height to
width.
D. R: Indicates a radial type tire.
E. 15: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel
diameter.
H
I
J
K
L
M
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
292 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
F. 95: Indicates the tire’s load index. It is an index that relates to how
much weight a tire can carry. You may find this information in your
owner’s manual. If not, contact a local tire dealer.
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not
required by federal law.
G. H: Indicates the tire’s speed rating. The speed rating denotes the
speed at which a tire is designed to be driven for extended periods of
time under a standard condition of load and inflation pressure. The tires
on your vehicle may operate at different conditions for load and inflation
pressure. These speed ratings may need to be adjusted for the difference
in conditions. The ratings range from 81 mph (130 km/h) to 186 mph
(299 km/h). These ratings are listed in the following chart.
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not
required by federal law.
Letter rating Speed rating - mph (km/h)
M 81 (130)
N 87 (140)
Q 99 (159)
R 106 (171)
S 112 (180)
T 118 (190)
U 124 (200)
H 130 (210)
V 149 (240)
W 168 (270)
Y 186 (299 )
Note: For tires with a maximum speed capability over 149 mph
(240 km/h), tire manufacturers sometimes use the letters ZR. For
those with a maximum speed capability over 186 mph (299 km/h), tire
manufacturers always use the letters ZR.
Wheels and Tires 293
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
H. U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN): This begins with
the letters DOT and indicates that the tire meets all federal standards.
The next two numbers or letters are the plant code designating where it
was manufactured, the next two are the tire size code and the last four
numbers represent the week and year the tire was built. For example,
the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After 2000 the numbers
go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th week of 2001. The
numbers in between are identification codes used for traceability. This
information is used to contact customers if a tire defect requires a recall.
I. M+S or M/S: Mud and Snow, or
AT: All Terrain, or
AS: All Season.
J. Tire Ply Composition and Material Used: Indicates the number of
plies or the number of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire tread and
sidewall. Tire manufacturers also must indicate the ply materials in the
tire and the sidewall, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others.
K. Maximum Load: Indicates the maximum load in kilograms and
pounds that can be carried by the tire. See the Safety Compliance
Certification Label (affixed to either the door hinge pillar, door-latch
post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post, next to the
driver’s seating position), for the correct tire pressure for your vehicle.
L. Treadwear, Traction and Temperature Grades
Treadwear: The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the
wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150
would wear one and one-half (1
1
2
) times as well on the government
course as a tire graded 100.
Traction: The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B,
and C. The grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement
as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test
surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor
traction performance.
Temperature: The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a
specified indoor laboratory test wheel.
294 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
M. Maximum Inflation Pressure: Indicates the tire manufacturer’s
maximum permissible pressure or the pressure at which the maximum
load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is normally higher than the
vehicle manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation pressure, which can
be found on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either
the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the
door-latch post, next to the driver’s seating position), or Tire Label which
is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. The cold
inflation pressure should never be set lower than the recommended
pressure on the vehicle label.
The tire suppliers may have additional markings, notes or warnings, such
as standard load or radial tubeless.
Additional Information Contained on the Tire Sidewall for LT Type
Tires
LT type tires have some additional
information beyond those of P type
tires. These differences are described
below.
Note: Tire Quality Grades do not
apply to this type of tire.
A. LT: Indicates a tire, designated
by the Tire and Rim Association,
that is intended for service on light
trucks.
B. Load Range/Load Inflation
Limits: Indicates the tire’s
load-carrying capabilities and its
inflation limits.
C. Maximum Load Dual lb (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a dual, defined
as four tires on the rear axle (a total of six or more tires on the vehicle).
D. Maximum Load Single lb (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a single,
defined as two tires (total) on the rear axle.
A
B
C
B
D
Wheels and Tires 295
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Information on T Type Tires
T type tires have some additional
information beyond those of P type
tires. These differences are
described below.
T145/80D16 is an example of a tire
size.
Note: The temporary tire size for
your vehicle may be different from
this example. Tire Quality Grades
do not apply to this type of tire.
A. T: Indicates a type of tire, designated by the Tire and Rim
Association, that is intended for temporary service on cars, sport-utility
vehicles, minivans and light trucks.
B. 145: Indicates the nominal width of the tire in millimeters from
sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger the number, the
wider the tire.
C. 80: Indicates the aspect ratio, which gives the tire’s ratio of height to
width. Numbers of 70 or lower indicate a short sidewall.
D. D: Indicates a diagonal type tire. R: Indicates a radial type tire.
E. 16: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel
diameter.
Location of the Tire Label
You will find a Tire Label containing tire inflation pressure by tire size
and other important information located on the B-Pillar or the edge of
the driver’s door. See the payload description and graphic in the Load
Carrying chapter.
A
B
C
D
E
296 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
INFLATING YOUR TIRES
Safe operation of your vehicle requires that your tires are properly
inflated. Remember that a tire can lose up to half of its air pressure
without appearing flat.
Every day before you drive, check your tires. If one looks lower than
the others, use a tire gauge to check pressure of all tires and adjust if
required.
At least once a month and before long trips, inspect each tire and check
the tire pressure with a tire gauge (including spare, if equipped). Inflate
all tires to the inflation pressure recommended by Ford Motor Company.
WARNING: Under-inflation is the most common cause of tire
failures and may result in severe tire cracking, tread separation
or blowout, with unexpected loss of vehicle control and increased risk
of injury. Under-inflation increases sidewall flexing and rolling
resistance, resulting in heat build-up and internal damage to the tire.
It also may result in unnecessary tire stress, irregular wear, loss of
vehicle control and accidents. A tire can lose up to half of its air
pressure and not appear to be flat!
You are strongly urged to buy a reliable tire pressure gauge, as automatic
service station gauges may be inaccurate. Ford recommends the use of
a digital or dial-type tire pressure gauge rather than a stick-type tire
pressure gauge.
Use the recommended cold inflation pressure for optimum tire
performance and wear. Under-inflation or over-inflation may cause
uneven treadwear patterns.
Always inflate your tires to the Ford recommended inflation pressure
even if it is less than the maximum inflation pressure information found
on the tire. The Ford recommended tire inflation pressure is found on
the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either the door
hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch
post, next to the driver’s seating position), or Tire Label which is located
on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. Failure to follow the tire
pressure recommendations can cause uneven treadwear patterns and
adversely affect the way your vehicle handles.
Wheels and Tires 297
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Maximum Inflation Pressure is the tire manufacturer’s maximum
permissible pressure or the pressure at which the maximum load
can be carried by the tire. This pressure is normally higher than the
manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation pressure, which can be found
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either the door
hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch
post, next to the driver’s seating position), or Tire Label which is located
on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. The cold inflation
pressure should never be set lower than the recommended pressure
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label.
When weather temperature changes occur, tire inflation pressures also
change. A 10°F (6°C) temperature drop can cause a corresponding
drop of 1 psi (7 kPa) in inflation pressure. Check your tire pressures
frequently and adjust them to the proper pressure which can be found
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label.
To check the pressure in your tire(s):
1. Make sure the tires are cool, meaning they are not hot from driving
even a mile.
Note: If you are checking tire pressure when the tire is hot (for
example, driven more than 1 mile [1.6 kilometers]), never bleed or
reduce air pressure. The tires are hot from driving and it is normal for
pressures to increase above recommended cold pressures. A hot tire at
or below recommended cold inflation pressure could be significantly
under-inflated.
Note: If you have to drive a distance to get air for your tire(s), check
and record the tire pressure first and add the appropriate air pressure
when you get to the pump. It is normal for tires to heat up and the air
pressure inside to go up as you drive.
2. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire, then firmly press the tire
gauge onto the valve and measure the pressure.
3. Add enough air to reach the recommended air pressure.
Note: If you overfill the tire, release air by pressing on the metal stem in
the center of the valve. Then recheck the pressure with your tire gauge.
4. Replace the valve cap.
5. Repeat this procedure for each tire, including the spare.
298 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: Some spare tires operate at a higher inflation pressure than the
other tires. For T-type mini-spare tires, see the Dissimilar Spare Tire
and Wheel Assembly Information section. Store and maintain at 60 psi
(4.15 bar). For full-size and dissimilar spare tires, see Dissimilar Spare
Tire and Wheel Assembly Information under Changing a Road Wheel
in this chapter. Store and maintain at the higher of the front and rear
inflation pressure as shown on the Tire Label.
6. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there are no nails or other
objects embedded that could poke a hole in the tire and cause an air
leak.
7. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are no gouges, cuts or bulges.
Inspecting Your Tires and Wheel Valve Stems
Periodically inspect the tire treads for uneven or excessive wear and
remove objects such as stones, nails or glass that may be wedged in the
tread grooves. Check the tire and valve stems for holes, cracks, or cuts
that may permit air leakage and repair or replace the tire and replace
the valve stem. Inspect the tire sidewalls for cracking, cuts, bruises and
other signs of damage or excessive wear. If internal damage to the tire is
suspected, have the tire demounted and inspected in case it needs to be
repaired or replaced. For your safety, tires that are damaged or show
signs of excessive wear should not be used because they are more likely
to blow out or fail.
Improper or inadequate vehicle maintenance can cause tires to wear
abnormally. Inspect all your tires, including the spare, frequently, and
replace them if one or more of the following conditions exist:
Tire Wear
When the tread is worn down to
1/16th of an inch (2 millimeters),
tires must be replaced to help
prevent your vehicle from skidding
and hydroplaning. Built-in treadwear
indicators, or wear bars, which look
like narrow strips of smooth rubber
across the tread will appear on the
tire when the tread is worn down to
1/16th of an inch (2 millimeters).
When the tire tread wears down to the same height as these wear bars,
the tire is worn out and must be replaced.
Wheels and Tires 299
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Damage
Periodically inspect the tire treads and sidewalls for damage (such as
bulges in the tread or sidewalls, cracks in the tread groove and separation
in the tread or sidewall). If damage is observed or suspected, have the tire
inspected by a tire professional. Tires can be damaged during off-road use,
so inspection after off-road use is also recommended.
WARNING: Age
Tires degrade over time depending on many factors such as
weather, storage conditions, and conditions of use (such as load, speed,
inflation pressure) the tires experience throughout their lives.
In general, tires should be replaced after six years regardless of tread
wear. However, heat caused by hot climates or frequent high loading
conditions can accelerate the aging process and may require tires to be
replaced more frequently.
You should replace your spare tire when you replace the road tires or
after six years due to aging even if it has not been used.
U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This information
identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire and also
provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for safety standard
certification and in case of a recall.
This begins with the letters DOT and indicates that the tire meets all
federal standards. The next two numbers or letters are the plant code
designating where it was manufactured, the next two are the tire size
code and the last four numbers represent the week and year the tire was
built. For example, the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After
2000 the numbers go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th
week of 2001. The numbers in between are identification codes used for
traceability. This information is used to contact customers if a tire defect
requires a recall.
300 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Tire Replacement Requirements
WARNING:
Only use replacement tires and wheels that are the
same size, load index, speed rating and type (such as P-metric
versus LT-metric or all-season versus all-terrain) as those originally
provided by Ford. The recommended tire and wheel size may be found on
either the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either the door
hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch
post, next to the driver’s seating position), or the Tire Label which is
located on the B-Pillar or edge of the driver’s door. If this information is not
found on these labels, then you should contact your authorized dealer as
soon as possible. Use of any tire or wheel not recommended by Ford can
affect the safety and performance of your vehicle, which could result in an
increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and
death. Additionally the use of non-recommended tires and wheels could
cause steering, suspension, axle, transfer case or power transfer unit
failure. If you have questions regarding tire replacement, contact your
authorized dealer as soon as possible.
WARNING:
To reduce the risk of serious injury, when mounting
replacement tires and wheels, you should not exceed the maximum
pressure indicated on the sidewall of the tire to set the beads without
additional precautions listed below. If the beads do not seat at the
maximum pressure indicated, re-lubricate and try again.
When inflating the tire for mounting pressures up to 20 psi (1.38 bar)
greater than the maximum pressure on the tire sidewall, the following
precautions must be taken to protect the person mounting the tire:
1. Make sure that you have the correct tire and wheel size.
2. Lubricate the tire bead and wheel bead seat area again.
3. Stand at a minimum of 12 feet (3.66 meters) away from the tire
wheel assembly.
4. Use both eye and ear protection.
For a mounting pressure more than 20 psi (1.38 bar) greater than the
maximum pressure, a Ford dealer or other tire service professional
should do the mounting.
Always inflate steel carcass tires with a remote air fill with the person
inflating standing at a minimum of 12 feet (3.66 meters) away from the
tire wheel assembly.
Wheels and Tires 301
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Your vehicle is equipped with tires designed to provide a safe ride and
handling capability.
Important: Remember to replace the wheel valve stems when the road
tires are replaced on your vehicle.
The two front tires or two rear tires should generally be replaced as a
pair.
The tire pressure sensors mounted in the wheels (originally installed on
your vehicle) are not designed to be used in aftermarket wheels.
The use of wheels or tires not recommended by Ford Motor Company
may affect the operation of your tire pressure monitoring system.
If the tire pressure monitoring system indicator is flashing, the system is
malfunctioning. Your replacement tire might be incompatible with your
tire pressure monitoring system, or some component of the system may
be damaged.
Safety Practices
WARNING: If your vehicle is stuck in snow, mud, or sand, do
not rapidly spin the tires. Spinning the tires can tear the tire
and cause an explosion. A tire can explode in as little as three to five
seconds.
WARNING: Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (56 km/h).
The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.
Driving habits have a great deal to do with your tire mileage and safety.
Observe posted speed limits.
Avoid fast starts, stops and turns.
Avoid potholes and objects on the road.
Do not run over curbs or hit the tire against a curb when parking.
302 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Highway Hazards
No matter how carefully you drive, there is always the possibility that
you may eventually have a flat tire on the highway. Drive slowly to the
closest safe area out of traffic. This may further damage the flat tire, but
your safety is more important.
If you feel a sudden vibration or ride disturbance while driving, or you
suspect your tire or vehicle has been damaged, immediately reduce your
speed. Drive with caution until you can safely pull off the road. Stop and
inspect the tires for damage. If a tire is under-inflated or damaged,
deflate it, remove the wheel and replace it with your spare tire and
wheel. If you cannot detect a cause, have the vehicle towed to the
nearest repair facility or tire dealer to have the vehicle inspected.
Tire and Wheel Alignment
A bad jolt from hitting a curb or pothole can cause the front end of your
vehicle to become misaligned or cause damage to your tires. If your
vehicle seems to pull to one side when you are driving, the wheels
may be out of alignment. Have an authorized dealer check the wheel
alignment periodically.
Wheel misalignment in the front or the rear can cause uneven and
rapid treadwear of your tires and should be corrected by an authorized
dealer. Front-wheel drive vehicles and those with an independent rear
suspension may require alignment of all four wheels.
The tires should also be balanced periodically. An unbalanced tire and
wheel assembly may result in irregular tire wear.
Tire Rotation
Note: If your tires show uneven wear ask an authorized dealer to check
for and correct any wheel misalignment, tire imbalance or mechanical
problem involved before tire rotation.
Note: Your vehicle may be equipped with a dissimilar spare tire and
wheel assembly. A dissimilar spare tire and wheel assembly is defined as
a spare tire or wheel that is different in brand, size or appearance from
the road tires and wheels. If you have a dissimilar spare tire and wheel
assembly, it is intended for temporary use only and should not be used
in a tire rotation.
Note: After having your tires rotated, inflation pressure must be checked
and adjusted to the vehicle requirements.
Wheels and Tires 303
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Rotating your tires at the recommended interval (as indicated in your
scheduled maintenance information) will help your tires wear more
evenly, providing better tire performance and longer tire life.
Rear-wheel drive
vehicles/Four-wheel drive vehicles
(front tires at left of diagram)
Sometimes irregular tire wear can be corrected by rotating the tires.
USING SNOW CHAINS
WARNING: Snow tires must be the same size, load index, speed
rating as those originally provided by Ford. Use of any tire or
wheel not recommended by Ford can affect the safety and performance
of your vehicle, which could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle
control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death. Additionally, the use
of non-recommended tires and wheels could cause steering, suspension,
axle, transfer case or power transfer unit failure.
Note: The suspension insulation and bumpers will help prevent vehicle
damage. Do not remove these components from your vehicle when using
snow tires and chains.
The tires on your vehicle have all-weather treads to provide traction in
rain and snow. However, in some climates, you may need to use snow
tires and chains. If you need to use chains, it is recommended that steel
wheels (of the same size and specifications) be used, as chains may chip
aluminum wheels.
Follow these guidelines when using snow tires and chains:
If possible, avoid fully loading your vehicle.
Use only cable type chains or chains offered by Ford as an accessory
or equivalent. Other conventional link type chains may contact and
cause damage to the vehicle’s wheel house and/or body.
Do not install chains on the front wheels as this may interfere with
suspension components.
304 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Chains are not recommended for use on the P275/55R20 tire.
Install chains securely, verifying that the chains do not touch any
wiring, brake lines or fuel lines.
Do not exceed 30 mph (48 km/h) with tire chains on your vehicle.
Drive cautiously. If you hear the chains rub or bang against your
vehicle, stop and retighten the chains. If this does not work, remove
the chains to prevent damage to your vehicle.
Remove the tire chains when they are no longer needed. Do not use
tire chains on dry roads.
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system is NOT a
substitute for manually checking tire pressure. The tire pressure
should be checked periodically (at least monthly) using a tire gauge.
See Inflating Your Tires in this chapter. Failure to properly maintain
your tire pressure could increase the risk of tire failure, loss of control,
vehicle rollover and personal injury.
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked
monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure
recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle
placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a
different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire
inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation
pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire
pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure
telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should
stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the
proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the
tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling
and stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire
maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire
pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger
illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.
Wheels and Tires 305
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator
to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS
malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale.
When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for
approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated.
This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as
the malfunction exists.
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be
able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions
may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of
replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the
TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction
telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the
TPMS to continue to function properly.
The tire pressure monitoring system complies with part 15 of the FCC
rules and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Changing Tires with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System
Note: Each road tire is equipped
with a tire pressure sensor located
inside the tire and wheel assembly
cavity. The pressure sensor is
attached to the valve stem.
The pressure sensor is covered by
the tire and is not visible unless the
tire is removed. Take care when
changing the tire to avoid damaging
the sensor.
You should always have your tires serviced by an authorized dealer.
Check the tire pressure periodically (at least monthly) using an accurate
tire gauge. See Inflating Your Tires in this chapter.
306 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Understanding Your Tire Pressure Monitoring System
The tire pressure monitoring system measures pressure in your four road
tires and sends the tire pressure readings to your vehicle. The low tire
pressure warning light will turn on if the tire pressure is significantly low.
Once the light is illuminated, your tires are under-inflated and need to be
inflated to the manufacturer’s recommended tire pressure. Even if the
light turns on and a short time later turns off, your tire pressure still
needs to be checked.
When your temporary spare tire is installed
When one of your road tires needs to be replaced with the temporary
spare, the tire pressure monitoring system will continue to identify an
issue to remind you that the damaged road wheel or tire needs to be
repaired and put back on your vehicle.
To restore the full function of the tire pressure monitoring system, have
the damaged road wheel or tire repaired and remounted on your vehicle.
For additional information, see Changing Tires with a Tire Pressure
Monitoring System in this section.
When you believe your system is not operating properly
The main function of the tire pressure monitoring system is to warn you
when your tires need air. It can also warn you in the event the system is
no longer capable of functioning as intended. See the following chart for
information concerning your tire pressure monitoring system:
Wheels and Tires 307
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Low tire
pressure
warning light
Possible cause Customer action required
Solid warning
light
Tire(s)
under-inflated
1. Make sure tires are at the proper
pressure. See Inflating your tires
in this chapter.
2.
After inflating your tires to the
manufacturer’s recommended
pressure as shown on the Tire Label
(located on the edge of driver’s door
or the B-Pillar), the vehicle must be
driven for at least two minutes over
20 mph (32 km/h) before the light
turns off.
Spare tire in use Repair the damaged road wheel
and tire and reinstall it on the
vehicle to restore system function.
For a description on how the
system functions, see When your
temporary spare tire is installed
in this section.
Tire pressure
monitoring
system
malfunction
If the tires are properly inflated
and the spare tire is not in use but
the light remains on, contact your
authorized dealer as soon as
possible.
Tire rotation
without sensor
training
On vehicles with different front and
rear tire pressures, the system
must be retrained following every
tire rotation. See Tire rotation in
this chapter.
308 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Low tire
pressure
warning light
Possible cause Customer action required
Flashing
warning light
Spare tire in use Repair the damaged road wheel
and tire and reinstall it on the
vehicle to restore system function.
For a description on how the
system functions, see When your
temporary spare tire is installed
in this section.
Tire pressure
monitoring
system
malfunction
If the tires are properly inflated
and the spare tire is not in use but
the light remains on, contact your
authorized dealer as soon as
possible.
When inflating your tires
When putting air into your tires (such as at a gas station or in your
garage), the tire pressure monitoring system may not respond
immediately to the air added to your tires.
It may take up to two minutes of driving over 20 mph (32 km/h) for the
light to turn off after you have filled your tires to the recommended
inflation pressure.
How temperature affects your tire pressure
The tire pressure monitoring system monitors tire pressure in each
pneumatic tire. While driving in a normal manner, a typical passenger
tire inflation pressure may increase approximately 2 to 4 psi (14 to
28 kPa) from a cold start situation. If the vehicle is stationary overnight
with the outside temperature significantly lower than the daytime
temperature, the tire pressure may decrease approximately 3 psi
(21 kPa) for a drop of 30°F (17°C) in ambient temperature. This lower
pressure value may be detected by the system as being significantly
lower than the recommended inflation pressure and activate the system
warning light for low tire pressure. If the low tire pressure warning light
is on, visually check each tire to verify that no tire is flat. If one or more
tires are flat, repair as necessary. Check air pressure in the road tires.
If any tire is under-inflated, carefully drive the vehicle to the nearest
location where air can be added to the tires. Inflate all the tires to the
recommended inflation pressure.
Wheels and Tires 309
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CHANGING A ROAD WHEEL
WARNING: The use of tire sealants may damage your tire
pressure monitoring system and should not be used. However, if
you must use a sealant, have an authorized dealer install a new tire
pressure monitoring system sensor and valve stem.
WARNING: See Tire Pressure Monitoring System in this
chapter for important information. If the tire pressure monitoring
sensor becomes damaged, it will no longer function.
Note: The tire pressure monitoring system indicator light will illuminate
when the spare tire is in use. To restore the full function of the
monitoring system, all road wheels equipped with tire pressure
monitoring sensors must be mounted on this vehicle.
If you get a flat tire while driving, do not apply the brake heavily.
Instead, gradually decrease your speed. Hold the steering wheel firmly
and slowly move to a safe place on the side of the road.
Have a flat serviced by an authorized dealer in order to prevent damage
to the system sensors. See Tire Pressure Monitoring System earlier in
this chapter. Replace the spare tire with a road tire as soon as possible.
During repairing or replacing of the flat tire, have the authorized dealer
inspect the tire pressure monitoring system sensor for damage.
Dissimilar Spare Tire and Wheel Assembly Information
WARNING: Failure to follow these guidelines could result in an
increased risk of loss of vehicle control, injury or death.
If you have a dissimilar spare tire and wheel assembly, then it is intended
for temporary use only. This means that if you need to use it, you should
replace it as soon as possible with a road tire and wheel assembly that is
the same size and type as the road tires and wheels that were originally
provided by Ford. If the dissimilar spare tire or wheel is damaged, it
should be replaced rather than repaired.
A dissimilar spare tire and wheel assembly is defined as a spare tire or
wheel that is different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires
and wheels and can be one of three types:
1. T-type mini-spare: This spare tire begins with the letter T for tire
size and may have Temporary Use Only molded in the sidewall.
310 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
2. Full-size dissimilar spare with label on wheel: This spare tire
has a label on the wheel that states: THIS TIRE AND WHEEL FOR
TEMPORARY USE ONLY
When driving with one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above, do not:
exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
load the vehicle beyond maximum vehicle load rating listed on the
Safety Compliance Label.
tow a trailer.
use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare
tire.
use more than one dissimilar spare tire at a time.
use commercial car washing equipment.
try to repair the dissimilar spare tire.
Use of one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above at any one wheel
location can lead to impairment of the following:
Handling, stability and braking performance
Comfort and noise
Ground clearance and parking at curbs
Winter weather driving capability
Wet weather driving capability
All-wheel driving capability
3. Full-size dissimilar spare without label on wheel
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire and wheel assembly,
do not:
exceed 70 mph (113 km/h).
use more than one dissimilar spare tire and wheel at a time.
use commercial car washing equipment.
use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare
tire and wheel.
The usage of a full-size dissimilar spare tire and wheel assembly can lead
to impairment of the following:
Handling, stability and braking performance
Comfort and noise
Wheels and Tires 311
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Ground clearance and parking at curbs
Winter weather driving capability
Wet weather driving capability
All-wheel driving capability (if applicable)
Load leveling adjustment (if applicable)
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire and wheel assembly,
additional caution should be given to:
towing a trailer.
driving vehicles equipped with a camper body.
driving vehicles with a load on the cargo rack.
Drive cautiously when using a full-size dissimilar spare tire and wheel,
and seek service as soon as possible.
Tire Change Procedure
WARNING: When one of the front wheels is off the ground, the
transmission alone will not prevent the vehicle from moving or
slipping off the jack, even if the transmission selector lever is in
position P.
WARNING: To help prevent the vehicle from moving when you
change a tire, be sure to place the transmission selector lever in
position P, set the parking brake and block (in both directions) the
wheel that is diagonally opposite (other side and end of the vehicle) to
the tire being changed.
WARNING: Never get underneath a vehicle that is supported
only by a jack. If the vehicle slips off the jack, you or someone
else could be seriously injured.
WARNING: Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the
vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off the road to
avoid the danger of being hit when operating the jack or changing the
wheel.
312 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WARNING: Always use the jack provided as original equipment
with your vehicle. If using a jack other than the one provided as
original equipment with your vehicle, make sure the jack capacity is
adequate for the vehicle weight, including any vehicle cargo or
modifications.
WARNING: Disable the power running boards before jacking,
lifting, or placing any object under the vehicle. Never place your
hand between the power running board and vehicle as extended power
running boards will retract when the doors are closed. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in personal injury.
Note: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle when the vehicle is
being jacked.
Park on a level surface, activate the hazard flashers and set the parking
brake. Then, place the transmission selector lever in position P and turn
the engine off.
Location of the spare tire and tools
The spare tire and tools for your vehicle are stowed in the following
locations:
Item Location
Spare tire Under the vehicle, just forward of
the rear bumper
Jack tools Under the access panel located in
the floor compartment behind the
rear seat
Wheels and Tires 313
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Removing the jack and tools
1. Open the liftgate, then locate the
access panel on the floor behind the
third row seat. Unlatch and remove
the panel.
2.
Remove the jack and tools
assembly tray from the compartment
by turning the wing-nut
counterclockwise to relieve tension
against the jack assembly tray.
Remove the bag from the jack and
tool assembly tray by loosening the
strap.
Note: Pay close attention to the orientation of the bag, because it will
have to be reinstalled after changing the tire.
3. Unsnap the wheel lug nut wrench, jack extension and handle from the
plastic tray.
4. Remove the jack from the tray assembly.
Removing the spare tire
1. Remove the jack handle and
winch extension from the tray and
assemble them.
2.
Open the spare tire winch
access plug in the bottom of the
compartment for the jack and tools
tray.
3. Insert the winch extension tool
assembly through the access hole in
the floor and engage the winch.
4. To remove the spare tire, turn the handle counterclockwise until the
tire is lowered to the ground and the cable is slightly slack.
5. Slide the retainer through the center of the spare tire wheel.
314 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
6. Block the wheels (both front or
both rear) on the opposite end of
the vehicle from the wheel being
changed. If on a grade, block both
wheels on the downward side of the
hill.
7. Turn off the deployable running boards. See the Driving Aids
chapter.
8. Obtain the spare tire and jack tools from their storage locations.
9. Use the tip of the jack handle to remove any wheel trim.
10. Loosen each wheel lug nut one-half turn counterclockwise but do not
remove them until the wheel is raised off the ground.
11. Position the jack according to
the jack locator arrows found on the
frame and turn the jack handle and
extension tool assembly clockwise.
Note: Use the frame rail as the
jacking location point, not the
control arm.
12. Raise the vehicle to provide sufficient ground clearance when
installing the spare tire; about 1/4 inch (6 millimeters).
Wheels and Tires 315
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Front
Rear
Note: Jack at the specified locations to avoid damage to the vehicle.
13. Remove the lug nuts with the lug wrench.
14. Replace the flat tire with the spare tire, making sure the valve stem
is facing outward.
15. Reinstall the lug nuts until the wheel is snug against the hub. Do not
fully tighten the lug nuts until the wheel has been lowered.
16. Lower the wheel by turning the jack handle counterclockwise.
17. Remove the jack and fully
tighten the lug nuts in the order
shown and reinstall the wheel cover.
See Wheel Lug Nut Torque
Specifications later in this chapter
for the proper lug nut torque
specification.
18. Unblock the wheels.
1
3
5
4
6
2
316 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
19. Put flat tire, jack, lug wrench and tools away. Make sure the jack bag
is properly reinstalled around the jack and tools assembly tray with the
strap securely fastened. Be sure to tighten the wing nut sufficiently so it
does not rattle when you drive.
Stowing the Spare Tire
1. Lay the tire on the ground, near the rear of the vehicle, with the valve
stem side facing up.
2.
Slide the wheel partially under
the vehicle and install the retainer
through the wheel center. If equipped,
you may have to remove the wheel
center cap prior to pushing the
retainer through the center of the
wheel. To remove the center cap,
press it off with the jack tool from the
inner side of the wheel. Pull on the
cable to align the components at the
end of the cable.
3. Assemble the jack handle and winch extension (as shown in
illustration), then insert the winch extension through the access hole
behind the third row seat and engage the winch.
4. Turn the jack handle clockwise until the tire is raised to its stowed
position underneath the vehicle. The wrench will become harder to turn
and the spare tire winch will ratchet or slip when the tire is raised to
maximum tightness. A clicking sound will be heard from the winch
indicating that the tire is properly stowed.
5. Disassemble the jack tool and winch extension and snap them back
into the tool tray.
6. Reinstall the jack bag properly around the jack and tool assembly tray,
making sure the strap is securely fastened.
7. Close the access hole with the rubber plug.
8. Reinstall the tray into the vehicle and secure it with the wing nut
(turn clockwise until tight).
Wheels and Tires 317
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Wheel Lug Nut Torque Specifications
WARNING: When a wheel is installed, always remove any
corrosion, dirt or foreign materials present on the mounting
surfaces of the wheel or the surface of the wheel hub, brake drum or
brake disc that contacts the wheel. Make sure that any fasteners that
attach the rotor to the hub are secured so they do not interfere with
the mounting surfaces of the wheel. Installing wheels without correct
metal-to-metal contact at the wheel mounting surfaces can cause the
wheel nuts to loosen and the wheel to come off while the vehicle is in
motion, resulting in loss of control.
Retighten the lug nuts to the specified torque within 100 miles
(160 kilometers) after any wheel disturbance (such as rotation, flat tire,
wheel removal).
Bolt size Wheel lug nut torque*
ft-lb Nm
M14 x 2.0 150 200
* Torque specifications are for nut and bolt threads free of dirt and
rust. Use only Ford recommended replacement fasteners.
Note: Inspect the wheel pilot hole
and mounting surface prior to
installation. Remove any visible
corrosion or loose particles.
318 Wheels and Tires
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
Engine 5.4L V8 Engine
Cubic inches 330
Fuel Minimum 87 octane or (E-85)
Firing order 1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ignition system Coil on plug
Spark plug gap 0.039–0.043 inch
(1.05 +/– 0.05 mm)
Compression ratio 9.8:1
Engine Drivebelt Routing
Capacities and Specifications 319
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Item Capacity Ford part name
Ford part number / Ford
specification
Brake fluid
1
Between MIN and
MAX on reservoir
Motorcraft™ High
Performance DOT 4 LV
Motor Vehicle Brake
Fluid
PM-20 / WSS-M6C65-A2 and
ISO4925 Class 6
Hinges, latches, striker
plates and rotors, seat
tracks, fuel filler door
hinge and spring
Multi-Purpose Grease
(Lithium grease)
Motorcraft XL-5 (aerosol) /
CRCSL3151ESB /
ESB-M1C93-B
Lock cylinders
Motorcraft Penetrating
and Lock Lubricant
XL-1 /
None
Engine coolant
2
Base radiator
without auxiliary
rear heat
16.4 qt (15.5L)
Motorcraft Orange
Antifreeze/Coolant
Prediluted
VC-3DIL-B (US)
CVC-3DIL-B (Canada) /
WSS-M97B44-D2
Heavy duty trailer
tow radiator
without auxiliary
rear heat
16.9 qt (16.0L)
Base radiator with
auxiliary rear heat
19.0 quarts
(18.0L)
Heavy duty trailer
tow radiator with
auxiliary rear heat
19.5 qt (18.5L)
Engine oil
3,4,5
7.0 qt (6.6L)
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20
Motor Oil
XO-5W20-QSP
WSS-M2C945-A
320 Capacities and Specifications
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Item Capacity Ford part name
Ford part number / Ford
specification
Automatic transmission
fluid
(6R80)
6,7
13.1 qt (12.4L)
Motorcraft
MERCON™ LV ATF
XT-10-QLV /
MERCON LV
Power steering fluid
Fill between MIN
and MAX lines on
reservoir
Motorcraft
MERCON LV ATF
XT-10-QLV /
MERCON LV
Front axle fluid (Four
Wheel Drive)
3.5 pt (1.7L)
Motorcraft SAE 80W-90
Premium Rear Axle
Lube
XY-80W90-QL /
WSP-M2C197-A
Rear axle fluid
(9.75 inch axle)
8
4.5 pt(2.1L)
Motorcraft SAE 75W-140
Synthetic Rear Axle
Lube
XY-75W140-QL /
WSL-M2C192-A
Transfer case fluid
Four Wheel Drive
Electronic Shift
On Fly
1.6 - 1.8 qt (1.5 -
1.7L)
Motorcraft Transfer Case
Fluid
XL–12 /
ESP-M2C166-H
Four Wheel Drive
Torque On
Demand
1.5 qt (1.4L)
Motorcraft
MERCON LV ATF
XT-10-QLV /
MERCON LV
Capacities and Specifications 321
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Item Capacity Ford part name
Ford part number / Ford
specification
Windshield washer fluid Fill as required
Motorcraft Premium
Windshield Washer
Concentrate (US)
Premium Quality
Windshield Washer Fluid
(Canada)
ZC-32-A (US)
CXC-37-(A, B, D, and F)
(Canada) /
WSB-M8B16-A2/- -
Fuel tank
Standard
28.0 gal (106.0L)
——
Navigator L
33.5 gal (126.8L)
——
A/C Refrigerant
9
2.25 lb (1.02 kg)
Motorcraft R134a
Refrigerant
YN-19 (US)
CYN-16–R (Canada) /
WSH-M17B19–A
A/C Refrigerant
Compressor Oil
9
8 fl oz (236 ml)
Motorcraft PAG
Refrigerant Compressor
Oil
YN-12–D /
WSH-M1C231–B
1
Ford recommends using Motorcraft™ (Ford) DOT 4 LV High Performance Brake Fluid or
equivalent meeting WSS-M6C65-A2 and ISO 4925 Class 6. Use of any fluid other than the
recommended fluid may cause degraded brake performance and not meet the Ford performance
standards. Keep brake fluid clean and dry. Contamination with dirt, water, petroleum products or
other materials may result in brake system damage and possible failure.
2
Add the coolant type originally equipped in your vehicle.
3
We have designed your engine to use Motorcraft motor oils or equivalent oil brands that meet
our specifications. Motor oils of the recommended viscosity grade that meet API SN requirements
and display the API Certification Mark for gasoline engines are also acceptable.
322 Capacities and Specifications
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
4
Do not use API S category oils labeled as SN, SM,SL or lower category unless the label also
displays the API certification mark. These oils do not meet all of the requirements of your
vehicles engine and emission system.
5
Do not use supplemental engine oil additives in your engine. They are unnecessary and could
lead to engine damage that is not covered by your Ford warranty.
6
Automatic transmissions that require MERCON™ LV should only use MERCON LV fluid. Refer
to scheduled maintenance information to determine the correct service interval. Use of any
fluid other than the recommended fluid may cause transmission damage.
7
Indicates only approximate dry-fill capacity. Some applications may vary based on cooler size
and if equipped with an in-tank cooler.
8
Your vehicle’s rear axle is filled with a synthetic rear axle lubricant and is considered lubricated
for life. These lubricants are not to be checked or changed unless a leak is suspected, service is
required or the axle has been submerged in water. The axle lubricant should be changed any
time the axle has been submerged in water.
9
Warning: The air conditioning refrigerant system contains refrigerant R–134a under high
pressure. Opening and air conditioning refrigerant system can cause personal injury. Only
qualified personnel should service the air conditioning refrigerant system.
Capacities and Specifications 323
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
MOTORCRAFT® PART NUMBERS
Component 5.4L V8 engine
Air filter element FA-1883
Battery
BXT-65-650 or BXT-65-750
(if equipped)
Oil filter FL-820-S
Spark plugs
1
HJFS24FP/SP-509
Seat filter (if equipped) FS-104
Windshield wiper blade
WW-2201-PF
WW-1601-PF (rear)
1
Refer to scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate
intervals for changing the spark plugs.
Note: Replace the spark plugs with ones that meet Ford material and
design specifications for your vehicle, such as Motorcraft® or equivalent
replacement parts. The customer warranty may be void for any damage
to the engine if such spark plugs are not used.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The vehicle identification number
is located on the driver’s side
instrument panel.
Please note that in the graphic,
XXXX is representative of your
vehicle identification number.
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
324 Capacities and Specifications
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) contains the following
information:
A. World manufacturer identifier
B. Brake system / Gross Vehicle
Weight Rating (GVWR) / Restraint
Devices and their location
C. Make, vehicle line, series, body
type
D. Engine type
E. Check digit
F. Model year
G. Assembly plant
H. Production sequence number.
VEHICLE CERTIFICATION LABEL
The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration Regulations require
that a Safety Compliance Certification
Label be affixed to a vehicle and
prescribe where the Safety Compliance
Certification Label may be located.
The Safety Compliance Certification
Label shall be affixed to either the
door hinge pillar, the door latch post,
or the edge of the door near the door
latch, next to the driver’s seating
position.
Capacities and Specifications 325
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
TRANSMISSION CODE DESIGNATION
You can find a transmission code on
the Safety Compliance Certification
Label. The following table tells you
which transmission each code
represents.
Description Code
Six-speed automatic (6R80) 6
326 Capacities and Specifications
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ACCESSORIES
For a complete listing of the accessories that are available for your
vehicle, please contact an authorized dealer or visit our online store at:
www.Accessories.Lincoln.com (United States only).
Lincoln Motor Company will repair or replace any properly authorized
dealer-installed Lincoln Genuine Accessories found to be defective in
factory-supplied materials or workmanship during the warranty period,
as well as any component damaged by the defective accessories.
Lincoln Motor Company will warrant your vehicle through the warranty
that provides the greatest benefit:
12 months or 12000 miles (20000 kilometers) (whichever occurs first).
The remainder of your new vehicle limited warranty.
Contact an authorized dealer for details and a copy of the warranty.
Exterior style
Chrome hood accent Deflectors
Splash guards
Interior style
Ambient lighting Floor mats
Illuminated door sill plates
Lifestyle
SUV camping tent* Rear seat entertainment*
Racks and carriers* Towing accessories
Cargo organization and management
Peace of mind
Remote start Vehicle security systems
Forward bumper mounted
warning sensors*
Wheel locks
Locking gas plug for capless fuel system
Accessories 327
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
*The accessory manufacturer designs, develops and therefore warrants
Lincoln Licensed Accessories, and does not design or test these
accessories to Lincoln Motor Company engineering requirements.
Contact an authorized Lincoln dealer for the manufacturer’s limited
warranty details, and request a copy of the Lincoln Licensed Accessories
product limited warranty from the accessory manufacturer.
For maximum vehicle performance, keep the following information in
mind when adding accessories or equipment to your vehicle:
When adding accessories, equipment, passengers and luggage to your
vehicle, do not exceed the total weight capacity of the vehicle or of
the front or rear axle (GVWR or GAWR as indicated on the Safety
Compliance Certification label). Ask an authorized dealer for specific
weight information.
The Federal Communications Commission (FCC) and Canadian Radio
Telecommunications Commission (CRTC) regulate the use of mobile
communications systems that are equipped with radio transmitters,
for example, two-way radios, telephones and theft alarms. Any such
equipment installed in your vehicle should comply with Federal
Communications Commission (FCC) and Canadian Radio
Telecommunications Commission (CRTC) regulations and should
be installed only by an authorized dealer.
An authorized dealer needs to install mobile communications systems.
Improper installation may harm the operation of your vehicle,
particularly if their manufacturer did not design the mobile
communication device specifically for automotive use.
If you or an authorized Lincoln dealer add any non-Lincoln custom
electrical or electronic accessories or components to the vehicle, you
may adversely affect battery performance and durability. In addition,
you may adversely affect the performance of other electrical systems
in the vehicle.
328 Accessories
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
FORD ESP EXTENDED SERVICE PLANS
PROTECT YOURSELF FROM THE RISING COST OF VEHICLE REPAIRS
WITH A FORD EXTENDED SERVICE PLAN.
SERVICE PLANS (U.S. only)
More than 32 Million Ford and Lincoln owners have discovered the
powerful protection Ford ESP. It is the only extended service plan
backed by Ford Motor Company, and provides peace of mind protection
beyond the expiration of the New Vehicle Warranty coverage.
Ford ESP can quickly pay for itself
One service bill the cost of parts and labor can easily exceed the
price of your Ford Extended Service Plan. With Ford ESP, you minimize
your risk for unexpected repair bills and rising repair costs.
Coverage for up to 500+ covered components
There are four, Extended Service Plans with different levels of coverage.
Ask your dealer for details.
1. PremiumCARE Our most comprehensive coverage. With over 500
covered components, this plan is so complete that we generally only
discuss what’s not covered.
2. ExtraCARE Covers 113 components, and includes many high tech
items
3. BaseCARE Covers 84 components
4. PowertrainCARE Covers 29 critical components
Ford ESP is honored by all Ford and Lincoln Dealers in the United
States and Canada. It is the only Extended Service Plan authorized and
backed by Ford Motor Company. That means you get:
Reliable, quality service anywhere you go
Repairs performed by factory trained technicians, using Genuine Ford
and Lincoln parts
Rental Car Reimbursement
1st day Rental Benefit You take advantage of replacement
transportation if your vehicle is at the dealership for same day covered
repairs.
Extended Rental Benefits If your vehicle is kept overnight for
covered repairs, you are eligible for rental car coverage, including
Bumper to Bumper warranty repairs, or Field Service Actions.
Ford Extended Service Plan 329
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Roadside Assistance
Exclusive 24/7 roadside assistance, including:
Towing, flat-tire change and battery jump starts
Out of fuel and lock-out assistance
Travel Expense reimbursement for lodging, meals and rental car
Destination assistance for taxi, shuttle, rental car coverage and
emergency transportation
Transferable Coverage
If you sell your vehicle before your Ford Extended Service Plan coverage
expires, you can transfer any remaining coverage to the new owner.
Whenever you sell your vehicle, prospective buyers may have a higher
degree of confidence that vehicle was properly maintained with Ford
ESP, thereby improving resale value!
Avoid the Rising cost of vehicle maintenance
Ford ESP also offers a Premium Maintenance Plan that covers all
scheduled maintenance, and select items that routinely wear out.
The coverage is prepaid, so you never have to worry about affording
vehicle maintenance. It covers regular checkups, routine inspections,
preventative care and replacement items that require periodic attention
for normal wear:
Windshield Wiper Blades
Spark Plugs (except in California)
The clutch Disc
Brake pads and linings
Shock Absorbers
Belts and Hoses
Diesel Exhaust Fluid Replenishment
Contact your selling dealership today so they can customize a Genuine
Ford Extended Service Plan that fits your driving lifestyle and budget.
Interest Free Financing Options Available
Take advantage of our interest free installment payment plan. Just a 10%
down payment will provide you with an affordable, no interest, no fee
payment program.
330 Ford Extended Service Plan
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Complete the information below and mail to:
Ford ESP
PO Box 8072
Royal Oak Michigan 48068-0039
To learn more, call our Ford ESP specialists at 800-367-3377. Don’t
forget to ask about our interest free payment program, allowing you all
the security and benefits Ford ESP has to offer while paying over time.
You are pre-approved with no credit checks, no hassles!
SERVICE PLANS (CANADA ONLY)
You can get more protection for your vehicle by purchasing a Ford
Extended Service Plan. Ford Extended Service Plan is the only service
contract backed by Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited. Depending
on the plan you purchase, Ford Extended Service Plan provides benefits
such as:
Rental reimbursement
Coverage for certain maintenance and wear items
Protection against repair costs after your New Vehicle Limited
Warranty Coverage expires
Roadside Assistance benefits
There are several Ford Extended Service Plans available in various time,
distance and deductible combinations. Each plan is tailored to fit your
own driving needs, including reimbursement for towing and rental.
When you purchase Ford Extended Service Plan, you receive added
peace-of-mind protection throughout Canada and the United States,
provided by a network of participating Ford Motor Company dealers.
The Lincoln Maintenance Protection Plan is honored at authorized
Lincoln dealers.
Note: Repairs performed outside of Canada and the United States are
not eligible for Ford Extended Service Plan coverage.
This information is subject to change.
For more information, visit your local Ford of Canada dealer or
www.ford.ca to find the Ford Extended Service Plan that is right for you.
Ford Extended Service Plan 331
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL INFORMATION
Radio Frequencies and Reception Factors
AM and FM frequencies are established by the Federal Communications
Commission (FCC) and the Canadian Radio and Telecommunications
Commission (CRTC). Those frequencies are:
AM: 530, 540–1700, 1710 kHz
FM: 87.9–107.7, 107.9 MHz
Radio reception factors
Distance and
strength
The further you travel from an FM station,
the weaker the signal and the weaker the
reception.
Terrain Hills, mountains, tall buildings, bridges,
tunnels, freeway overpasses, parking garages,
dense tree foliage and thunderstorms can
interfere with the reception.
Station overload When you pass a ground-based broadcast
repeating tower, a stronger signal may
overtake a weaker one and result in the audio
system muting.
CD and CD Player Information
Note: CD units play commercially pressed 4.75-inch (12 centimeter)
audio compact discs only. Due to technical incompatibility, certain
recordable and re-recordable compact discs may not function correctly
when used in Ford CD players.
Note: Do not insert CDs with homemade paper (adhesive) labels into
the CD player as the label may peel and cause the CD to become
jammed. You should use a permanent felt tip marker rather than
adhesive labels on your homemade CDs. Ballpoint pens may damage
CDs. Please contact your authorized dealer for further information.
Note: Do not use any irregularly shaped discs or discs with a scratch
protection film attached.
Always handle discs by their edges only. Clean the disc with an approved
CD cleaner only. Wipe it from the center of the disc toward the edge.
Do not clean in a circular motion.
332 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Do not expose discs to direct sunlight or heat sources for extended
periods.
MP3 Track and Folder Structure
Audio systems capable of recognizing and playing MP3 individual tracks
and folder structures work as follows:
There are two different modes for MP3 disc playback: MP3 track
mode (system default) and MP3 folder mode.
MP3 track mode ignores any folder structure on the MP3 disc. The
player numbers each MP3 track on the disc (noted by the .mp3 file
extension) from T001 to a maximum of T255. Note: The maximum
number of playable MP3 files may be less depending on the structure
of the CD and exact model of radio present.
MP3 folder mode represents a folder structure consisting of one level
of folders. The CD player numbers all MP3 tracks on the disc (noted
by the .mp3 file extension) and all folders containing MP3 files, from
F001 (folder) T001 (track) to F253 T255.
Creating discs with only one level of folders helps with navigation
through the disc files.
If you are burning your own MP3 discs, it is important to understand
how the system reads the structures you create. While various files
may be present, (files with extensions other than mp3), only files with
the .mp3 extension are played; other files are ignored by the system.
This enables you to use the same MP3 disc for a variety of tasks on your
work computer, home computer and your in-vehicle system.
In track mode, the system displays and plays the structure as if it were
only one level deep (all .mp3 files play, regardless of being in a specific
folder). In folder mode, the system only plays the .mp3 files in the
current folder.
Audio System 333
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
AM/FM/CD WITH SYNC®
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle
control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use
extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off
the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your
vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while
driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible.
Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the
use of electronic devices while driving.
A. Memory presets:
In radio mode, store your favorite radio stations. To store a radio
station, tune to the station, then press and hold a preset button until
sound returns.
In satellite radio mode, store up to six stations on each satellite band.
B. Eject:
Press this button to eject the current CD.
To eject a specific CD, press this button, then the corresponding
memory preset button.
Press and hold this button to eject all CDs.
M L
R
P
O
N
Q
K J
I
H G F
B
A
C
D
E
1
LOAD
VOL
PUSH
AUX
CD
AM/FM
SHUFFLE
REV
FWD
OK
SEEK
MENU
TUNE
SEEK
TEXT
SCAN
23456
334 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
C. TUNE and Phone:
In radio mode, turn the control to manually search the frequency
band.
In MP3 mode, turn the control to go to the next or previous folder
(when folder mode is active).
In satellite radio mode, press the SEEK buttons to tune to the next
or previous channel.
In category mode, turn the control to scroll through the list of
available satellite radio categories.
In phone mode, press this button to access the phone features of the
SYNC system. See the SYNC® chapter for more information.
D. MENU: Press this button to access different audio system features.
You can also adjust settings for the family entertainment system if your
vehicle is equipped with this feature.
If your vehicle is equipped with satellite radio, you can access
different menus by pressing OK.
Set the time by pressing MENU until SET HOURS or SET
MINUTES appears and using the arrow buttons to adjust the time.
Set the strongest stations on the radio frequency by pressing MENU
until AUTOSET appears. AUTOSET does not override your original
presets.
RBDS displays text transmitted by certain radio stations and
searches for music categories. To search for music categories, turn on
RBDS (by using the SEEK buttons when RBDS ON/OFF appears).
Press the up and down arrow buttons to scroll through categories,
then use the SEEK buttons to begin the search.
SPEEDVOL (speed compensated volume) allows you to adjust radio
volume to compensate for noise levels when vehicle speed increases.
Track/Folder is only available on MP3 files when in CD mode. In
track mode, pressing the SEEK arrows allows you to scroll through
all the tracks on the disc. In folder mode, pressing the SEEK arrows
allows you to scroll through all the tracks within the selected folder.
Press the FOLDER buttons to access other folders.
COMPRESS (Compression) is only available in CD and MP3 modes.
Switching compression on brings the soft and loud passages together
for a more consistent listening level. Use the SEEK buttons and up
and down arrow buttons to switch it on and off.
Family entertainment options are also available, if your vehicle is
equipped with this feature.
E. Up and down arrow buttons: Press these buttons to make
selections in MENU mode.
Audio System 335
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
F. Play, Pause and OK:
Play and Pause allow you to play or pause a track when listening to a
CD.
OK allows you to confirm commands with phone and media features
of the SYNC system. See the SYNC® chapter for more information.
G. SEEK:
In radio mode, press and release this button to go to the next preset
radio station or disc track.
In CD and MP3 modes, press this button to select the next track, or
press and hold to advance within the same track.
H. FWD: Press this button to manually fast forward in a CD track or
MP3 file.
I. TEXT/SCAN:
In radio and CD/MP3 mode, press and hold to hear a brief sampling
of radio stations, CD tracks or MP3 files.
In CD/MP3 mode, press and release to display track title, artist name
and disc title.
Note: In text mode, sometimes the display requires additional text to be
displayed. When the > or < indicator is present, press the SEEK arrows
to view the additional text.
J. REV: Press this button to manually rewind in a CD track or MP3 file.
K. SEEK:
In radio mode, press and release this button to go to the previous
preset radio station or disc track.
In CD and MP3 modes, press this button to select the previous track,
or press and hold to reverse within the same track.
L. SHUFFLE: Play music on the selected CD or MP3 folder in random
order.
M. AM/FM: Press this button to select a frequency band.
N. CD: Press this button to enter CD or MP3 mode.
O. AUX: Press this button to access the media features of the SYNC®
system. See the SYNC® chapter for more information.
P. VOL-PUSH:
Press this button to switch the system off and on.
Turn it to adjust the volume.
Q. CD slot: Insert a CD.
336 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
R. LOAD: Load a CD.
Press LOAD and a memory preset button to load a CD to a specific
slot.
Press and hold to autoload up to six CDs. The last disc inserted
automatically plays.
REAR AUDIO CONTROLS
Your vehicle is equipped with rear seat audio controls. This allows front
and middle seat passengers to listen to different media sources (radio,
CD or SYNC) simultaneously.
Note: The front and middle seat passengers cannot listen to two
different radio stations at the same time.
A. Headphone/Speaker Press this button to turn the rear speakers on
(Single Play mode) or off (Dual Play mode).
B. MEDIA Press this button to scroll through available playing media,
such as AM, FM1, FM2, CD, SAT1, SAT2, SAT3, and SYNC.
If in Dual Play mode, SHARED illuminates in the audio display when
the front and rear modes are set to the same media.
If you select SYNC, press + or to scroll through the different
options: SYNC USB, SYNC BTST and SYNC LINE. See the SYNC
chapter for more information.
C. Right arrow button
In radio mode, press and release this button to scroll through
memory presets. Press and hold to go to the next station.
In CD and SYNC modes, press and release this button to go to the
next track. Press and hold to fast forward within that track.
MEDIA
VOLUME
B
H FG E D CI
A
J
Audio System 337
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
D. Wired headphone jack
E. Left arrow button
In radio mode, press and release this button to scroll through
memory presets. Press and hold to go to the previous station
In CD and SYNC modes, press and release this button to advance to
the previous track. Press and hold to rewind within that track.
F. Auxiliary audio input jacks: Plug in and play auxiliary audio
sources.
G. VOLUME Press the up and down arrow buttons to increase or
decrease the headphone volume level. From the rear seat controls, the
volume cannot be higher than the current audio setting unless the
speakers are off.
H. Wired headphone jack
I. - Press the button to access the previous CD.
J. + Press to access the next CD.
Switching the Rear Audio Controls On
After you switch the ignition on, FULL rear controls are on and the
system is in Single Play mode.
Parental Control
The multimedia system allows for three varying levels of parental control.
By simultaneously pressing the 3 and 5 memory preset buttons, the rear
passengers may be allowed to access FULL or LOCAL control or be
LOCKED out of rear seat controls altogether.
1. Press the 3 and 5 memory preset buttons at the same time. LOCAL
illuminates in both front and rear audio displays, indicating that only
LOCAL rear control is available. Note: While in Single Play mode,
LOCAL is the same as LOCKED. In Dual Play mode, LOCAL allows
the driver to control the media selected at the radio, or over media
played through the rear auxiliary input jacks.
2. Pressing the 3 and 5 buttons a second time locks the rear control.
The rear passengers are restricted from control over media of any
kind (the rear controls are disabled). Note: If in Dual Play mode, the
headphone icon normally illuminated in the audio display when in
Dual Play turns off in the audio display.
3. Pressing the 3 and 5 buttons a third time restores full control to the
rear seat controls. Switching the ignition off and then on again has
the same effect.
338 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Switching Dual Play Mode On
You can switch Dual Play mode on by simultaneously pressing the 2 and
4 memory preset buttons on the audio or by doing the following:
1. Press the headphone/speaker control. The headphone icon
illuminates in both front and rear audio displays indicating the rear
seat speakers are off and the headphones are on.
2. Press MEDIA to change audio sources (as heard in the headphones
only).
3. Use the other controls to adjust the playing media.
Switching Off Dual Play Mode
Use any one of the following to switch off Dual Play mode:
Press the 2 and 4 memory preset buttons simultaneously again.
Press the 3 and 5 memory preset buttons simultaneously to LOCK
the rear seat controls.
Press the headphone/speaker button again.
Using Dual Play Mode with Headphones
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in your vehicle
and do not let children operate the system while unsupervised.
If wired headphones or auxiliary systems are used, children may
become entangled in the cords and seriously injure themselves.
Plug a 1/8–inch (3.5 millimeter) headphone (not included) into the
headphone jack. Press the speaker button, or the 2 and 4 memory preset
buttons simultaneously on the radio to switch on the headphones. DUAL
PLAY illuminates in the audio display, there is no sound from the rear
speakers and the fade control is inactive, signaling that Dual Play is on.
The front speakers remain on for the front passengers. Press the speaker
button, or the 2 and 4 memory preset buttons simultaneously on the
radio again to switch off the headphones and Dual Play mode. SINGLE
PLAY illuminates in the audio display; fade control is active and there is
sound from rear speakers, signaling that Single Play is on.
You need to switch the rear seat controls on to use any rear controls
(whether in Single Play or Dual Play mode). To use Dual Play, switch
on the rear seat controls; the headphone icon illuminates in the audio
display. See Switching the rear audio controls on previously.
Audio System 339
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SATELLITE RADIO INFORMATION (IF EQUIPPED)
Satellite Radio Channels
Sirius broadcasts a variety of music, news, sports, weather, traffic and
entertainment satellite radio channels. For more information and a
complete list of Sirius satellite radio channels, visit www.siriusxm.com in
the United States, www.sirius.ca in Canada, or call Sirius at
1–888–539–7474.
Note: This receiver includes the eCos real-time operating system. eCos
is published under the eCos License.
Satellite Radio Reception Factors
Potential satellite radio reception issues
Antenna
obstructions
For optimal reception performance, keep the
antenna clear of snow and ice build-up and
keep luggage and other material as far away
from the antenna as possible.
Terrain Hills, mountains, tall buildings, bridges,
tunnels, freeway overpasses, parking garages,
dense tree foliage and thunderstorms can
interfere with your reception.
Station overload When you pass a ground-based
broadcast-repeating tower, a stronger signal
may overtake a weaker one and the audio
system may mute.
Satellite radio signal
interference
Your display may show ACQUIRING...to
indicate the interference and the audio
system may mute.
Sirius Satellite Radio Service
Note:
Sirius reserves the unrestricted right to change, rearrange, add or
delete programming including canceling, moving or adding particular
channels, and its prices, at any time, with or without notice to you. Ford
Motor Company shall not be responsible for any such programming changes.
340 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Sirius satellite radio is a
subscription-based satellite radio
service that broadcasts a variety of
music, sports, news, weather, traffic
and entertainment programming.
Your factory-installed Sirius satellite
radio system includes hardware and
a limited subscription term which begins on the date of sale or lease of
your vehicle. See an authorized dealer for availability.
For more information on extended subscription terms (a service fee is
required), the online media player and a complete list of Sirius satellite
radio channels, and other features, please visit www.siriusxm.com in the
United States, www.sirius.ca in Canada, or call Sirius at 1–888–539–7474.
Satellite Radio Electronic Serial Number (ESN)
You need your ESN to activate, modify or track your satellite radio
account. When in satellite radio mode, you can view this number by
pressing SIRIUS and memory preset 1 at the same time. To access your
ESN, press the bottom left corner of the touchscreen, then SIRIUS >
Options.
Troubleshooting
Radio display Condition Possible action
Acquiring Radio requires more
than two seconds to
produce audio for the
selected channel.
No action required.
This message should
disappear shortly.
Sat Fault/SIRIUS
system failure
There is an internal
module or system
failure present.
If this message does
not clear shortly, or
with an ignition key
cycle, your receiver
may have a fault.
See an authorized
dealer for service.
Invalid Channel The channel is no
longer available.
Tune to another
channel or choose
another preset.
Audio System 341
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Radio display Condition Possible action
Unsubscribed Channel Your subscription does
not include this
channel.
Contact Sirius at
1–888–539–7474 to
subscribe to the
channel, or tune to
another channel.
No Signal The signal is lost from
the Sirius satellite or
Sirius tower to your
vehicle antenna.
The signal is blocked.
When you move into
an open area, the
signal should return.
Updating Update of channel
programming in
progress.
No action required.
The process may take
up to three minutes.
Call SIRIUS
1–888–539–7474
Your satellite service is
no longer available.
Call Sirius at
1–888–539–7474 to
resolve subscription
issues.
None Found. Check
Channel Guide.
All the channels in the
selected category are
either skipped or
locked.
Use the channel guide
to turn off the Lock or
Skip function on that
station.
Subscription Updated Sirius has updated the
channels available for
your vehicle.
No action required.
AUXILIARY INPUT JACK
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle
control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use
extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off
the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your
vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while
driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible.
Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the
use of electronic devices while driving.
342 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
WARNING: For safety reasons, do not connect or adjust the
settings on your portable music player while your vehicle is
moving.
WARNING: Store the portable music player in a secure location,
such as the center console or the glove box, when your vehicle is
moving. Hard objects may become projectiles in a crash or sudden stop,
which may increase the risk of serious injury. The audio extension cable
must be long enough to allow the portable music player to be safely
stored while your vehicle is moving.
The auxiliary input jack allows you
to connect and play music from
your portable music player through
your vehicle speakers. You can use
any portable music player designed
for use with headphones. Your audio
extension cable must have male
1
8
-inch (3.5 millimeter) connectors
at each end.
1. Switch off the engine, radio and portable music player. Set the
parking brake and put the transmission in position P.
2. Plug the extension cable from the portable music player into the
auxiliary input jack.
3. Switch the radio on. Select either a tuned FM station or a CD.
4. Adjust the volume as desired.
5. Switch your portable music player on and adjust its volume to half its
maximum level.
6. Press AUX until LINE or LINE IN appears in the display. You
should hear music from your device even if it is low.
7. Adjust the volume on your portable music player until it reaches the
volume level of the FM station or CD. Do this by switching back and
forth between the AUX and FM or CD controls.
LINE IN
Audio System 343
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
USB PORT (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle
control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use
extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off
the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your
vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while
driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible.
Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the
use of electronic devices while driving.
The USB port allows you to plug in
media playing devices, memory sticks
and charge devices (if supported).
See the SYNC chapter for more
information.
REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle
control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use
extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off
the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your
vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while
driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible.
Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the
use of electronic devices while driving.
Note: Make sure you run the engine while using the device. To avoid
discharging your vehicle battery:
Do not use this device without the engine running.
Turn off the device when your vehicle is not in use for long periods.
LINE IN
344 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
The system consists of the following features:
Seven-inch color TFT-LCD panel (480x234) with 16:9 aspect
Built-in, top-loading slot load DVD player
Infrared transmitters for infrared wireless headphones
Audio/Video source input (three RCA jacks)
USB 2.0 (optional)
One-eighth inch stereo headphone jack
Forward remote sensor on the front panel
Full-function remote control
Five control buttons on the front panel: POWER, SOURCE, STOP,
PLAY and EJECT
On-screen display control
12V DC power input
FM transmitter (may be optional)
Note: Do not touch the inner pins of the jacks on the front panel.
Electrostatic discharge may cause permanent damage to the device.
Your system plays the following types of discs:
DVD-Video: DVD contains video.
DVD +/- R: DVD contains video.
CD-DA: CD contains musical or sound content only.
CD-Video: CD contains movie only.
CD-R/RW: CD contains audio files (such as a CD-R with MP3 files),
MPEG or JPEG files.
Your system does not play the following types of discs:
Optical disc CD-1
CD-ROM
DVD-ROM mini disc-CDG (audio only, not graphics)
Important Notice
It is unlawful in most jurisdictions for a person to drive a motor vehicle
which is equipped with a television viewer or screen that is located in
the motor vehicle at any point forward of the back of the driver’s seat, or
that is visible, directly or indirectly, to the driver while operating your
vehicle. In the interest of safety, do not install the unit where it is visible,
directly or indirectly, by the operator of the motor vehicle. If your vehicle
is equipped with a wireless rear seat audio system or any other wireless
infrared device, power the system off in order to operate the DVD
headrest system. If the system is on, the two systems may interfere with
each other canceling out or creating undesirable audio through the
wireless headphones.
Audio System 345
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Safety Precaution
For safety reasons:
Do not change discs while your vehicle is moving.
Do not allow children to unfasten their safety belts to change discs or
make changes to the system.
Make changes with the remote control, while safety belts remain
fastened.
Enjoy your entertainment system, but remember that safety of your
passengers is the highest priority.
Wireless Headphones
This unit includes a built-in dual channel infrared transmitter for use with
your wireless headphones. You can change headphone volume using the
individual controls on each headset. To use wireless headphones effectively,
you must maintain line-of-sight between headphones and transmitter.
Allowing obstructions to come between headphone and transmitter, or body
motions that allow the user to conceal the headphone from the transmitter
(like reaching or bending), adversely affect audio performance. Infrared
transmission, like visible light, travels only in a straight line.
Wired Headphones
You can use any standard stereo headphones by plugging them into the
1/8–inch (3.5 millimeter) headphone jack on each of the headrest DVD
systems. Remove and save the protective plastic cover to access the
jacks. Remember to replace the cover when the jacks are not in use.
A/V Input
You can connect an external audio/video device that uses common RCA
interface cables to the Ford DVD system, such as a video game device or
VCR. Connect the device RCA cables to the AV RCA INPUT jacks according
to color: yellow for video, red for right audio and white for left audio.
The signal from the external audio/video source overrides other video
sources for that monitor.
346 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Wireless FM Transmitter
Your device has an internal FM transmitter. This allows you to listen to
the DVD player audio signal by tuning your vehicle FM radio to a radio
frequency that you select, then accessing the SOUND-AROUND feature
by using the remote control. SOUND-AROUND allows the user to choose
from a number of pre-programmed frequencies to play back the rear-seat
entertainment system audio over the radio. When you engage
SOUND-AROUND, as long as the DVD player is active, it adversely
affects the FM radio reception of other stations, especially neighboring
stations nearest to whichever station is in use for the DVD player.
Performance of SOUND-AROUND varies based on geographic location.
You may need to change the SOUND-AROUND frequency periodically
when travelling long distances. This helps maintain the best performance
when listening to DVD system content over the radio. Audio heard
through wireless headphones remains unaffected by SOUND-AROUND.
There may also be a reduction in AM radio performance as well. AM and
FM radio performance can be expected to return to normal when the
DVD system is turned off.
How to use the FM Transmitter
1. Switch on the system and place a disc in Monitor A.
2. Point the remote control at the monitor, and then press DVD A.
3.
Press SOUND AROUND ON/OFF to turn FM transmission off and on.
4. Select a radio frequency (88.3, 88.7, 89.1, 89.5, 89.9, and 90.3MHz) by
pressing SOUND AROUND SELECT.
5. Select a frequency, and then tune your radio to the corresponding
frequency. Try each station frequency until you achieve a clear audio
signal.
Console Controls
Note: Do not use any solvents or cleaning materials when cleaning the
video device.
Note: Do not use any abrasive cleaners, which may scratch the screen.
Use only a lightly dampened lint free cloth to wipe the screen if it is
dirty.
Note: Lock the LCD screen in the fully closed position when not in use.
Note: Do not put pressure on the screen.
Note: Caution children against touching or scratching the screen, as it
may become dirty or damaged.
Audio System 347
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: Items marked with an
*
are only available on systems with a DVD
player.
A. DVD compartment slot
*
: Insert a disc with the label side facing the
rear passengers.
B. Infrared transmitters: These transmit audio to the wireless
headphones.
C. EJECT
*
: Press this button to eject the disc from the DVD
compartment.
D. STOP
*
: Press this button to stop playing the disc.
E. PLAY
*
: Press this button to play the disc.
F. Headphone jack: Plug in your wired headphones with a 1/8-inch
(3.5 millimeter) stereo connector plug to listen to audio from the
program.
G. Video input jack (red): Connect an RCA cable to this port.
H. Video input jack (white): Connect an RCA cable to this port.
I. Video input jack (yellow): Connect an RCA cable to this port.
VIDEO
disc
POWER SOURCE VDEO L RAUDIO PLAY STOP ELECT
AV INPUT
H FJ
I G
C
B
A
E
D
L
N
M
O
K
348 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
J. USB port (optional): Listen to music or view images you stored on a
USB device such as a USB memory stick or a memory card reader.
K. SOURCE: Press this button to select Monitor A, Monitor B, AUX/TV
(if available), and AUX 2 (if available).
L. POWER: Press this button to turn the system off and on.
M. TFT LCD panel: Seven-inch TFT LCD panel.
N. Level lock and release latch: Use this latch to change the viewing
angle of the LCD panel or lock the panel into the secured position.
O. Infrared sensor - forward sensor eye: This allows the remote
control to navigate the on-screen display.
Remote Control
Note: The remote control uses infrared light to send commands to the
DVD player, just as many home video systems do. Just point the remote
control at the DVD player infrared window located above each screen in
order to control that DVD player. While you can connect a second device
such as a VCR through the auxiliary inputs, and view the playback on
the screen, you cannot control that device by aiming its remote control
at the Ford DVD player. The Ford DVD system remote control is the
only remote control you can use with the system. For example, if you
connect a VCR to the DVD system, you must point the VCR remote
control at the VCR to control it.
Installing the Battery
Before using your remote control, install the batteries as follows:
1. Turn the remote control face down. Press down on the ridged area of
the battery cover and slide it off.
2. Install two AAA batteries. Make sure you install the batteries
properly, with the + and facing the correct way, as shown in the
battery compartment.
3. Slide the cover back until it clicks.
Note: Different types of batteries have different characteristics. Do not
mix different types.
Note: Do not mix old and new batteries. Mixing old and new batteries
can shorten battery life and cause chemical leaks from the old batteries.
Note: Keep the batteries out of the reach of children. If someone
swallows a battery, immediately consult a doctor. When you dispose of
used batteries, keep to governmental regulations or environmental public
institution rules that apply in your area.
Audio System 349
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: Remove the batteries if the remote control is not used for a month
or longer.
Button Function Descriptions
Note: The remote control only operates this device. It is not a universal
remote control and does not control other equipment.
1. SOURCE: Press this button to use any equipment connected to
the audio/video inputs. Each time you press the button, the source
changes in the following sequence: Monitor A, Monitor B, AUX/TV
and AUX 2.
2. POWER: Press this button to turn the device off and on.
3. DVD-Monitor A:
Press this button to control DVD mode of Monitor A.
4. TV-Monitor A
*
: Press this button to control TV mode of Monitor A.
5. SOUND AROUND ON/OFF
*
: Press this button to turn the FM
transmitter off and on.
6. MUTE: Press this button to turn off the sound sent to the headphones.
The screen displays that the sound is muted. Pressing the button again
restores sound to the previously set level. This feature is only functional
in DVD mode.
7. MENU: Press this button to go to the disc’s root menu.
POWER
SOURCE
A
SOUND
AROUND
SOUND
AROUNDMUTE
MENU REPEAT
CH+
CH-
TITLE SUBTITLE ANGLE AUDIO
DISPLAY
RANDOM
PLAY
123
654
7 8 9
0
CLR INT
FR FF PREV NEXT
STOP PAUSE
VOL- VOL+
PIX
A
D
VD
ON/OFF
SELECT
TV DVD TV
SETUP EJECT
B
5
9
29
27
30
17
33
28
32
31
201
2
7
8
12
4
3
15
21
22
24
26
25
8
23
6
9
10
16
13
18
11
14
19
350 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
8. CH + and CH -:
In DVD mode, press these buttons to move the select bar to items
among the menu or file list.
In TV mode, press these buttons to go to the next channel or
previous channel.
In on-screen display mode, press these buttons to change the setting
of a selected item.
9. VOL + and VOL -:
In DVD mode, press these buttons to move the select bar to items to
one of the items in the menu or file list.
When not in on-screen display mode, press these buttons to change
the volume of the playing media.
10. ENTER: Press this button to select from the on-screen display, or begin
disc playback.
11. TITLE: Press this button to go to a disc’s title menu.
12. SUBTITLE: If a disc has subtitle options, press this button to display
the subtitle menu. Keep pressing the button until you reach your
desired option.
13. Numbers: Decimal numbers: 0 to 9.
14. CLR: Press this button to clear any numeric input from the number
keypad.
15. PLAY: Press this button to play a disc in the DVD player.
16. STOP: Press this button to stop the playing media.
Pressing STOP once, then PLAY, resumes disc playback from where
it left off.
Pressing STOP twice, then PLAY, resumes disc playback from the
beginning.
17. PAUSE: Press this button to pause the disc.
18. FR (Fast Rewind): Press this button to search the disc backward
continuously. There are five speed options to choose: 2X, 4X, 8X, 16X,
and 32X.
19. FF (Fast Forward): Press this button to search the disc forward
continuously. There are five speed options to choose: 2X, 4X, 8X, 16X,
and 32X.
20. SETUP: Press this button to navigate the Setup Menu. See How to use
the DVD on-screen display (OSD) menu for more information.
21. EJECT: Press this button to eject or load a disc.
22. TV-Monitor B
*
: Press this button to control TV mode of Monitor B.
23. DVD-Monitor B: Press this button to control DVD mode of Monitor B.
24. SOUND AROUND SELECT
*
: Press this button to select an FM
transmitter channel.
Audio System 351
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
25. PIX: Press this button to access settings for BRIGHTNESS, CONTRAST,
SATURATION, HUE, SHARPNESS, IR HEADPHONE, and RESET. When
you find the desired setting, use CH + and CH - to change the setting.
The bar display automatically disappears if no changes are made within
six seconds, or if any button is pressed.
26. REPEAT: Press this button to switch the repeat mode by ALL, TITLE,
CHAPTER and cancel the repeat mode while playing DVD-video. Other
disc types such as VCD, CD, and SVCD only have two repeat modes
that you can select: TRACK and ALL. Note: Both repeat functions of
VCD and SVCD need the PBC status set to ON, when available.
27. AUDIO: Press this button if a disc has different language options. Press
this button repeatedly until you reach your desired option.
28. ANGLE: Press this button to view with a different camera angle. Press
this button repeatedly until you have reached your desired viewing
angle. This feature is only available on DVDs that support frames with
multiple angles.
29. DISPLAY: Press this button display information on the screen including
title, chapter or track, time elapsed and time remaining. You can also
press this button to turn off the display.
30. RANDOM: Press this button to play titles in a random order
31. INT: Press this button to play each audio file for 10 seconds as a review
or scan.
32. NEXT: When a disc has more than one chapter, track or file, press this
button to move to the next chapter, track or file. Press the button
briefly during play to select the next chapter for DVD-video or track
and file for media such as VCD, SVCD, MP3 and CD.
33. PREV: When a disc has more than one chapter, track or file, press this
button to move to the previous chapter, track or file. Press the button
briefly during play to select the next chapter for DVD-video or track
and file for media such as VCD, SVCD, MP3 and CD.
*
If available
Turning the Device On and Off
1. Pivot the screen downward until you reach a comfortable viewing
angle.
2. Press POWER on the lower-left corner of the front panel or on the
remote control. The controls illuminate when the system is in use.
3. When the device is on and is displaying a picture, pivot the screen to
change the viewing angle to optimize the picture quality.
4. Remember to turn the device off and pivot the LCD panel to the
locked position when not in use.
352 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
DVD Basics
To get the most use out of each DVD, make sure you read this section
completely.
Regional Coding
Both the DVD player and disc have specific region codes. These regional
codes must match in order for the disc to play. If the codes do not
match, the disc does not play. The system is set to the region code
designated for your area by the DVD Copy Control Association. Other
regions do not play in this system.
Loading and Playing Discs
When you press POWER, the system turns on in DVD mode. Place the
disc about halfway into the disc compartment slot, with the disc’s label
facing the rear of your vehicle. Insert the disc straight into the player; do
not insert the disc at an angle.
The disc loads automatically and begins to play. Some discs start at the
root menu, where you have to select disc play manually.
Depending on the disc and playback location on the disc, the icon may
display in the upper-left corner of the screen indicating that still
playback is not possible.
Notes
To keep a disc clean, do not touch its surface. Handle the disc by its
edge.
Keep your discs in their cases or disc magazines when not in use.
Also, do not subject a disc to heat or high temperatures. Avoid
leaving them in a parked vehicle, on a dashboard or on a rear tray.
Do not attach labels, or use discs with sticky ink or residue. Such
discs may stop spinning, causing a system malfunction, or ruining the
disc.
Do not use any discs with labels or stickers attached. The following
malfunctions may result from using such discs:
The system cannot eject a disc due to a label or sticker peeling off
and jamming the eject mechanism.
The system cannot read audio data correctly, such as playback
skipping or no playback at all, due to heat shrinking of a sticker or
label causing the disc to warp.
Audio System 353
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Before playing a disc, clean it with a commercially available cleaning
cloth. Wipe each disc from the center out. Do not use solvents such
as benzene, thinner, commercially available cleaners, or antistatic
spray intended for analog discs.
Do not use any irregularly shaped discs. If you insert an irregular,
non-round, shaped disc, it may jam in the DVD player or not play
properly.
How to Use the DVD On-screen Display Menus
You can use the on-screen display menu screen to adjust all the settings
on your screen.
General Setup
Press SETUP on the remote control, and then use CH +, CH -, VOL +
and VOL - to navigate the Setup Page. Press ENTER to make a
selection, and then VOL - to return to the submenu.
To exit the Setup Display, press SETUP again.
OSD Language
The OSD Lang submenu allows the user to select the language for the
on-screen display. Press VOL +, and then use CH + and CH - on the
remote control to select the desired language. The user can select
English, Simple/Traditional Chinese, French, German, Italian, Spanish,
Portuguese or Korean. Press ENTER to make a selection, and then VOL
- to return to the submenu.
Angle Mark
The angle mark is an option for different viewing angles on the DVD.
Press VOL + and VOL - to turn the angle mark setting off and on. Press
ENTER to make a selection, and then VOL - to return to the submenu.
Audio Setup
Press SETUP on the remote control, and then use CH +, CH -, VOL +
and VOL - to navigate the Setup Page. Press ENTER to make a
selection, and then VOL - to return to the submenu.
Speaker Setup
Press SETUP on the remote control and then use VOL + to navigate to
the Audio Setup Page. Press ENTER to navigate to the submenu. Use
CH +, CH -, VOL + and VOL - to navigate the submenus. Press ENTER
or VOL + to make a selection, and then VOL + and VOL - to see the
selection items. Press ENTER to make a selection, and then VOL - to
return to the submenu.
354 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
The Speaker Setup menu has the following options:
LT/RT
Stereo
V SURR
OFF
The Dolby Digital Setup menu has the following options:
Stereo
L-Mono
R-Mono
Mix-Mono
Quality Setup
Press SETUP on the remote control, and then use CH +, CH -, VOL +
and VOL - to navigate the Setup Page. Press ENTER to make a
selection, and then VOL - to return to the submenu.
Video Quality Setup
Press SETUP on the remote control and then press VOL + to navigate
to the Video Setup Page. Press ENTER twice to enter the submenu. Use
CH +, CH -, VOL + and VOL - to navigate the submenus. Press ENTER
or VOL + to select an item, and then VOL + and VOL - to see the
selection items. Press ENTER to make a selection, and then VOL - to
return to the submenu.
Video Quality
You can adjust the following features:
SHARPNESS softens or sharpens the picture. You can select Low,
Med. or High.
BRIGHTNESS brightens or darkens the picture. The setting ranges
from -20 to +20.
CONTRAST allows you to increase or decrease the picture contrast.
The setting ranges from -16 to +16.
HUE allows you to increase or decrease the color hue. The setting
ranges from -9 to +9.
SATURATION allows you to increase or decrease the color intensity.
The setting ranges from -9 to +9.
How to Use the Device On-screen Display Menus
Press SETUP on the remote control, and then use CH +, CH -, VOL +
and VOL - to navigate the Setup Page. Press ENTER to make a
selection, and then VOL - to return to the submenu.
Audio
This allows the user to control the audio stream in the selected language
for playback automatically.
Audio System 355
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Subtitle
This allows the user to turn the subtitles on and off in the selected
language for playback automatically.
Disc Menu
This allows the user to control the DVD disc menu in the selected
language.
Parental
This section of the Setup Menu allows user to control the content of
movie playback from G to ADULT. The parental control function allows
you to limit viewing to your preference. The rating levels are 1 through 8
and are country-dependent.
After navigating to the Parental submenu, use VOL + and the CH + and
CH - buttons to select:
KID SAFE (Children)
G
PG
PG 13
PGR
R
NC 17
ADULT
Note: The lower you make the value, the stricter the limitation is.
Password
Press SETUP and navigate to the Password submenu under the
Password Setup Page.
1. Press VOL +, and then press ENTER on the remote control to enter
the submenu.
2. Input the old six-digit password or the default password. The default
password is 136900.
3. Input a new six-digit password using the numeric buttons.
4. Confirm the new password by entering the same new password again.
5. Scroll to OK, and then press ENTER to finish.
Default
Press SETUP on the remote control, and then navigate to the Default
submenu under the Preference page using CH +, CH - and VOL +.
Press VOL +, and then press ENTER to carry out the reset. This
function does not affect the parental settings.
356 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Playing an Audio CD
When playing an audio CD, the DISPLAY banner appears automatically.
It displays the current track and the amount of time the track has been
playing, the total amount of time on the disc and the current time
running on the disc.
Press DISPLAY on the remote control to see the DISPLAY banner.
Press DISPLAY once: Single Elapsed appears along with the current
track playing and the time of that track.
Press DISPLAY twice: Single Remain appears along with the current
track playing and the amount of time left.
Press DISPLAY three times: Total Elapsed appears along with the
current track playing and the total time playing on CD.
Press DISPLAY four times: Total Remain appears along with the
current track playing and the amount of time left on CD.
Press the REPEAT on the remote control to repeat either the currently
playing track or the entire CD.
Playing an MP3 Disc
MP3 is a format for storing digital audio. An audio CD-quality song
compressed into the MP3 format has very little loss of quality, while
taking up much less space. You can play CD-R discs encoded in MP3
format in your DVD player.
Selecting Folders and Songs
When you insert an MP3 disc in the player, an MP3 audio-navigation
screen appears automatically. You can change folders and songs by
navigating the file system. The DVD player plays the songs in the order
you burned them to the disc.
1. If a disc is playing, press DISPLAY on the remote control, and then
press CH + and CH - to go through the folder list on the left side of
the navigation screen.
2. Highlight the folder you want, and then press ENTER.
3. Press CH + and CH - to go through the song list and highlight the
song you want. Press ENTER to begin playing the highlighted song.
Skipping Songs
Press NEXT on the remote control to move to the next song. Press
PREV to move to the beginning of the currently playing song. Press
PREV twice to move to the previous song.
Audio System 357
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Selecting a Play Mode
You can choose what order the songs play on a disc temporarily. The
FOLDER play mode is the default. To access the play mode operations,
press REPEAT on the remote control. The play mode options are:
Single: Play a selected song.
Repeat One: Repeat the song that is playing.
Folder: Play the folder in the order you recorded the songs.
Folder Repeat: Repeat the folder that is playing.
Random: Play the songs in the random order.
Shuffle: Play the songs within the selected folder in random order.
Order of Tracks
The DVD-headrest module plays the files in the order that you added
them to the USB drive. Therefore, the playback order may not be the
same as what appears on the screen. To access the file structure and
menus, for the USB device, you need the remote control set to the
appropriate systems (A or B).
When you insert the USB device, the system may begin playing files
automatically, returning to the previous position, if it was unplugged
during a previous playback. To return to the menus, press MENU or
VOL -, depending on the type of file you are playing. The current
directory appears, listing all file types.
Controls
MENU: Press this button to return to the menu structure.
CH + and CH -: Press these buttons to move the select bar up and
down within the selected menu or file list.
VOL -: Press this button to move the menu up one level. Pressing
this button in some menu functions returns you to the menu
structure.
VOL +: Press this button to select a menu item.
ENTER: Press this button to make a selection or begin file playback.
PLAY: Press this button to play a file.
STOP: Press this button to stop the playing media.
PAUSE: Press this button to stop the media playback temporarily.
FR (Fast Rewind): Press this button to reverse through the file
continuously. There are five speed options to choose: 2X, 4X, 8X,
16X, and 32X.
FF (Fast Forward): Press this button to fast forward through the
file continuously. There are five speed options to choose: 2X, 4X, 8X,
16X, and 32X.
PREV: Press this button to go to the previous file.
NEXT: Press this button to go to the next file.
358 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Connecting an MP3 Device
Using a USB Cable
Plug the MP3 Dock Connector to USB cable into a high-power USB port
on your DVD-headrest module, and then connect the other end to the
player.
See the documentation that came with your device for more information.
Charging the MP3 Player Battery
After you turn the DVD-headrest module on, connect the device to the
USB port on your DVD-headrest module
Note: Not all devices are able to charge when connected to the USB
port.
Using an A/V Cable
1. Connect the device to the headphone port using an A/V cable. Note:
Use the A/V cable made specifically for the device. Other similar
RCA-type cables might not work.
2. Connect the video and audio connectors to the AV-IN ports on
your DVD-headrest module, matching the yellow, red and white
connectors to the appropriate jacks.
Troubleshooting
Symptom Possible cause
The device does not
power on.
Your vehicle ignition is not on.
The remote control does not have batteries
installed.
The infrared sensor is
inoperative.
The batteries in the remote control are not
working.
The remote sensor eye is blocked.
The infrared transmitter is blocking the sensor
eye of the component to be controlled
The disc does not play. You inserted the disc backward.
The disc is defective. Try another disc.
The disc is not compatible with the
entertainment system.
The device code and disc region code do not
match. This device is set to Region 1.
Audio System 359
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Symptom Possible cause
The disc plays, but
then immediately
stops.
The disc is dirty and needs cleaning.
Condensation has formed inside the device.
Allow the player to dry out.
There is no picture. The signal source is not connected.
The setting may be in the wrong status. Match
the monitor mode with the source correctly.
There is a distorted
picture.
The disc may be dirty. Check the disc for
fingerprints and clean with a soft cloth, wiping
from center to edge.
Sometimes a small amount of picture
distortion may appear. This is not a
malfunction.
I cannot advance
through a movie.
You cannot advance through the opening
credits and warning information that appears
at the beginning of movies because the disc
prohibits that action.
There is no sound, or
there is distorted
sound.
You did not connect the DVD player properly.
You did not attach the cables securely into the
appropriate jacks.
If you are using the wireless headphones,
make sure you turn them on.
The headphone volume is too low.
Something may be blocking the signal between
the monitor and the headphones.
The device feels warm. If the device is in use for a long time, it does
become warm. This is normal.
The player does not
respond to all
commands during
playback.
The disc prohibits some operations.
Refer to the instructions in the disc inlay.
360 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Compliance Information
FCC Notice
This device has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class
B digital device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are
designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a
residential installation. This device generates, uses, and can radiate radio
frequency energy, and if not installed and used in accordance with the
instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications.
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a
particular installation. If this device does cause unacceptable interference to
radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the device
off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one
or more of the following measures:
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
Increase the separation between the device and receiver.
Connect the device into an outlet on a circuit different from that to
which the receiver is connected.
Consult your dealer or an experienced radio or TV technician for help.
FCC Warning:
To assure continued FCC compliance, the user must use the provided
grounded power supply cord and the shielded video interface cable with
bonded ferrite cores. Also, any unauthorized change or modifications to
this device would void the user’s authority to operate this device.
Macrovision Notice
This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is
protected by U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights. Use of
this copyright protection technology must be authorized by Macrovision,
and is intended for home and other limited viewing uses only unless
otherwise authorized by Macrovision. Reverse engineering or disassembly
is prohibited.
Audio System 361
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Warranty
INVISION Automotive Systems Inc., (the “Company”) warrants to the
original retail purchaser of this product, when purchased from a
participating new car dealership, that should this product under normal
use and conditions, be proven defective in material or workmanship,
such defect(s) will be repaired or replaced with reconditioned product
(at the Company’s option) without charge for parts and repair labor
when the work is performed by the original dealership of purchase,
or an authorized representative of that dealership.
This Warranty will match the warranty of the Original Equipment
Manufacturer (“OEM”) when installed on a new vehicle with a minimum
of 36 months or 36,000 miles. If the product is installed on a used
vehicle, then only a 12 month or 12,000 mile Warranty from the date of
installation will apply. This Warranty is not applicable to any extended
warranty purchased.
To obtain repair or replacement within the terms of this Warranty, the
product must be returned to a participating new car dealership for
warranty service or replacement. The dealership will perform
troubleshooting to determine if repair or replacement is warranted. If a
participating dealership cannot be contacted, then the Purchaser should
contact the Company to obtain the name and location of a dealership
where service under this Warranty can be obtained.
This Warranty does not extend to the elimination of externally generated
static or noise, correction of antenna problems, costs incurred for
installation, removal or reinstallation of the product, or to damage to
digital memory devices, media devices, gaming devices, discs, speakers,
accessories, or vehicle electrical systems.
362 Audio System
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
This Warranty does not apply to any product or part thereof which, in
the opinion of the Company, has suffered or been damaged through
alteration, improper installation, mishandling, misuse, neglect, accident,
or by removal or defacement of the factory serial number/bar code
label(s). THE EXTENT OF THE COMPANY’S LIABILITY UNDER THIS
WARRANTY IS LIMITED TO THE REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT
PROVIDED ABOVE AND, IN NO EVENT, SHALL THE COMPANY’S
LIABILITY EXCEED THE PURCHASE PRICE PAID BY PURCHASER
FOR THE PRODUCT.
This Warranty is in lieu of all other express warranties or liabilities. ANY
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING ANY IMPLIED WARRANTY OF
MERCHANTABILITY, SHALL BE LIMITED TO THE DURATION OF
THIS WRITTEN WARRANTY. ANY ACTION FOR BREACH OF ANY
WARRANTY HEREUNDER, INCLUDING ANY IMPLIED WARRANTY OF
MERCHANTABILITY, MUST BE BROUGHT WITHIN A PERIOD OF 48
MONTHS FROM THE DATE OF ORIGINAL PURCHASE. IN NO CASE
SHALL THE COMPANY BE LIABLE FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL OR
INCIDENTAL DAMAGES FOR BREACH OF THIS OR ANY OTHER
WARRANTY, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WHATSOEVER. No person or
representative is authorized to assume for the Company any liability
other than expressed herein in connection with the sale of this product.
Some states do not allow limitations on how long an implied warranty
lasts or the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential damage
so the above limitations or exclusions may not apply to you. This
Warranty gives you specific legal rights and you may also have other
rights which vary from state to state.
Audio System 363
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SYNC is an in-vehicle communications system that works with your
Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone and portable media player. This allows
you to:
Make and receive calls.
Access and play music from your portable music player.
Use 911 Assist, Vehicle Health Report and SYNC Services (Traffic,
Directions & Information) (if equipped).
Use applications, such as Pandora and Stitcher, via SYNC AppLink™
(if applicable).
Access phonebook contacts and music via voice commands.
Stream music from your connected phone.
Text message.
Use the advanced voice recognition system.
USB device charging (if your device supports this).
364 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL INFORMATION
Make sure you review your device’s manual before using it with SYNC.
Support
The SYNC support team is available to help you with any questions you
cannot answer on your own.
Monday-Saturday, 8:30am-9:00pm EST.
Sunday, 10:30am-7:30pm EST.
In the United States, call: 1–800–392–3673.
In Canada, call: 1–800–565–3673.
Times are subject to change due to holidays.
SYNC Owner Account
Why do I need a SYNC owner account?
Required to activate Vehicle Health Report and to view the reports
online.
Required to activate the subscription-based SYNC Services and to
personalize your Saved Points and Favorites.
Essential for keeping up with the latest software downloads available
for SYNC.
Access to customer support for any questions you may have.
Driving Restrictions
For your safety, certain features are speed-dependent and restricted
when your vehicle is traveling over 3 mph (5 km/h).
Safety Information
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle
control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use
extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off
the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your
vehicle. We recommend against the use of any handheld device while
driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible.
Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the
use of electronic devices while driving.
SYNC® 365
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When using SYNC:
Do not operate playing devices if the power cords or cables are
broken, split or damaged. Place cords and cables out of the way,
so they do not interfere with the operation of pedals, seats,
compartments or safe driving abilities.
Do not leave playing devices in your vehicle during extreme conditions
as it could cause them damage. See your device’s manual for further
information.
Do not attempt to service or repair the system. See your authorized
dealer.
For your safety, some SYNC functions are speed-dependent. Their use is
limited to when your vehicle is traveling at speeds under 3 mph (5 km/h).
Make sure that you review your device’s manual before using it with
SYNC.
Privacy Information
When a cellular phone is connected to SYNC, the system creates a
profile within your vehicle that is linked to that cellular phone. This
profile is created in order to offer you more cellular features and to
operate more efficiently. Among other things, this profile may contain
data about your cellular phone book, text messages (read and unread),
and call history, including history of calls when your cell phone was not
connected to the system. In addition, if you connect a media device,
the system creates and retains an index of supported media content.
The system also records a short development log of approximately
10 minutes of all recent system activity. The log profile and other system
data may be used to improve the system and help diagnose any problems
that may occur.
The cellular profile, media device index, and development log remain in
the vehicle unless you delete them and are generally accessible only in
the vehicle when the cellular phone or media player is connected. If you
no longer plan to use the system or the vehicle, we recommend you
perform a Master Reset to erase all stored information.
366 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
System data cannot be accessed without special equipment and access
to the vehicle’s SYNC module. Ford Motor Company and Ford of Canada
do not access the system data for any purpose other than as described
absent consent, a court order, or where required by law enforcement,
other government authorities, or other third parties acting with lawful
authority. Other parties may seek to access the information
independently of Ford Motor Company and Ford of Canada. For further
privacy information, see the sections on 911 Assist, Vehicle Health
Report, and Traffic, Directions and Information.
USING VOICE RECOGNITION
This system helps you control many features using voice commands.
This allows you to keep your hands on the wheel and focus on what is in
front of you.
Initiating a Voice Session
Push the voice icon; a tone sounds and Listening appears in the
display. Say any of the following:
Say: If you want to:
“Phone” Make calls.
“USB” Access the device connected to your USB
port.
“Bluetooth Audio” Stream audio from your phone.
“Line in” Access the device connected to the auxiliary
input jack.
“Cancel” Cancel the requested action.
“SYNC” Return to the main menu.
“Voice settings” Adjust the level of voice interaction and
feedback.
“Vehicle Health Report” Run a vehicle health report.
*
“Services” Access the SYNC Services portal.
*
“Mobile apps” Access mobile applications.
*
“Help” Hear a list of voice commands available in the
current mode.
*
If equipped, U.S. only.
SYNC® 367
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
System Interaction and Feedback
The system provides feedback through audible tones, prompts, questions
and spoken confirmations depending on the situation and the chosen
level of interaction (voice settings). You can customize the voice
recognition system to provide more or less instruction and feedback.
The default setting is to a higher level of interaction in order to help you
learn to use the system. You can change these settings at any time.
Adjusting the Interaction Level
Push the voice icon; when prompted, say “Voice settings”, then
any of the following:
When you say: The system:
“Interaction mode standard” Provides more detailed interaction and
guidance.
“Interaction mode advanced” Provides less audible interaction and
more tone prompts.
The system defaults to the standard interaction mode.
Confirmation prompts are short questions the system asks when it is not
sure of your request or when there are multiple possible responses to your
request. (For example, the system may ask “Phone, is that correct?”) If
turned off, the system simply makes a best guess as to what you requested
and you may still occasionally be asked to confirm settings.
“Confirmation prompts on”
“Confirmation prompts off”
The system creates candidate lists when it has the same confidence level
of several options based on your voice command. When turned on, you
may be prompted with as many as four possibilities for clarification.
For example, “Say 1 after the tone to call John Doe at home. Say 2 after
the tone to call Johnny Doe on mobile. Say 3 after the tone to call Jane
Doe at home.” Or, “Say 1 after the tone to play John Doe, Say 2 after the
tone to play Johnny Doe.”
“Phone candidate lists on”
“Phone candidate lists off”
“Media candidate lists on”
“Media candidate lists off”
368 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Helpful Hints
Make sure the interior of the vehicle is as quiet as possible. Wind
noise from open windows and road vibrations may prevent the system
from correctly recognizing spoken commands.
After pressing the voice icon, wait until after the tone sounds and
Listening appears before saying a command. Any command spoken
prior to this does not register with the system.
Speak naturally, without long pauses between words.
At any time you can interrupt the system while it is speaking by
pressing the voice icon.
USING SYNC WITH YOUR PHONE
Hands-free calling is one of the main features of SYNC. While the system
supports a variety of features, many are dependent on your cellular
phone’s functionality. At a minimum, most cellular phones with Bluetooth
wireless technology support the following functions:
Answering an incoming call
Ending a call
Using privacy mode
Dialing a number
Redialing
Call waiting notification
Caller ID.
Other features, such as text messaging using Bluetooth and automatic
phonebook download, are phone-dependent features. To check your
phone’s compatibility, see your phone’s user manual and visit
www.SYNCMyRide.com, www.SYNCMyRide.ca or www.syncmaroute.ca.
SYNC® 369
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Pairing a Phone for the First Time
Note: SYNC can support downloading up to approximately 1000 entries
per Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone.
Note: Make sure the vehicle ignition and radio are turned on and the
transmission is in position P.
Note: To scroll through the menus, press the up and down arrows on
your audio system.
Wirelessly pairing your phone with SYNC allows you to make and receive
hands-free calls.
1. Press the phone button; when the display indicates no phone is
paired, press OK.
2. When Find SYNC appears in the display, press OK.
3. Put your phone into Bluetooth discovery mode. See your phone’s
user guide if necessary.
4. When prompted on your phone’s display, enter the six-digit PIN
provided by SYNC in the radio display.
5. The display indicates when the pairing is successful.
Depending on your phone’s capability and your market, the system may
prompt you with questions such as setting the current phone as the
primary phone (the phone SYNC automatically tries to connect with
first upon vehicle start-up), downloading your phone book, etc.
Pairing Subsequent Phones
Note: To scroll through the menus, press the up and down arrows on
your audio system.
Note: Make sure the vehicle ignition and radio are turned on and that
the transmission is in position P.
1. Press the phone button and scroll until System Settings is selected.
2. Press OK and scroll until Bluetooth Devices is selected and press OK.
3. Scroll until Add Bluetooth Device is selected and press OK.
4. When Find SYNC appears in the display, press OK.
5. Put your phone into Bluetooth discovery mode. See your phone’s
user guide if necessary.
6. When prompted on your phone’s display, enter the six-digit PIN
provided by SYNC in the radio display. The display indicates when
the pairing is successful.
7. The system then prompts with questions such as if you would like
to set the current phone as the primary phone (the phone SYNC
automatically tries to connect with first upon vehicle start-up),
download your phone book, etc.
370 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Phone Voice Commands
Press the voice icon and say “Phone”. Say any of the following:
“PHONE”
“Call <name>”
1,2
“Call <name> on mobile OR cell”
1,2
“Call <name> on other”
1,2
“Phone book <name> at home”
2
“Phone book <name> on mobile OR cell”
2
“Call history outgoing”
2
“Phone book <name> on Other”
2
“Call history missed”
2
“Menu”
2,3
“Join”
“Call <name> at home”
1,2
“Call <name> at work” OR “Call <name> in office”
1,2
“Dial”
1,4
“Phone book <name>”
2
“Phone book <name> at work” OR “Phone book <name> at office”
2
“Call history incoming”
2
“Connections”
2
“Go to privacy”
“Hold”
1
These commands do not require you to say “Phone” first.
2
These commands are not available until phone information is completely
downloaded using Bluetooth.
3
See “MENU” table below.
4
See “DIAL” table below.
SYNC® 371
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
“MENU”
“(Phone) connections”
*
“(Phone) settings (message) notification off”
*
“(Phone) settings (message) notification on”
*
“(Phone) settings (set) phone ringer”
*
“(Phone) settings (set) ringer 1”
*
“(Phone) settings (set) ringer 2”
*
“(Phone) settings (set) ringer 3”
*
“(Phone) settings (set) ringer off”
*
“Battery”
“Phone name”
“Signal”
“Text message inbox”
*
Words in ( ) are optional and do not have to be spoken for the system
to understand the command.
Phone book commands: When you ask SYNC® to access a phone book
name, number, etc., the requested information appears in the display to
view. Press the phone button and say “Call” to call the contact.
“DIAL”
“411” (four-one-one), “911” (nine-one-one)
“700 (seven hundred)” (seven hundred)
“800 (eight hundred)” (eight hundred)
“900 (nine hundred)” (nine hundred)
“#” (pound)
“<number> 0–9”
“Asterisk” (*)
“Clear” (deletes all entered digits)
“Delete” (deletes one digit)
“Plus”
“Star”
Note: To exit dial mode, press and hold the phone button or press
MENU to go to the PHONE menu.
372 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Making Calls
Press the voice icon and when prompted say:
1. Say “Call <name>” or “Dial”, then the desired number.
2. When the system confirms the number, say “Dial” again to initiate the
call.
To erase the last spoken digit, say “Delete” or press the left arrow
button. To erase all spoken digits, say “Clear” or press and hold the left
arrow button.
To end the call, press and hold the phone button.
Receiving Calls
When receiving a call, you can:
Answer the call by pressing the phone button.
Reject the call by pressing and holding the phone button.
Ignore the call by doing nothing.
Phone Options during an Active Call
During an active call, you have additional menu features which become
available such as putting a call on hold, joining calls, etc. Use the arrow
buttons to scroll through the menu options.
To access:
1. Press MENU during an active call.
2. When Active Call Menu is selected, press OK.
3. Scroll to cycle through the following options:
When you select: You can:
Mute Call?
Mute the call.
Privacy
Switch a call from an active hands-free
environment to your cellular phone for a more
private conversation.
Press OK when Privacy on/off appears. (The
display indicates In Privacy and the system
transfers your call.)
Call Hold
Put an active call on hold.
Press OK when Place Call on Hold? appears.
To answer another call at this time, press the
phone button.
SYNC® 373
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
Join Calls
Join two separate calls.
1. Press the phone button.
2. Access the desired contact through SYNC
or use voice commands to place the second
call. Once actively in the second call, press
MENU.
3. Scroll until Join Calls appears and press
OK. Press OK again when Join Calls? appears.
Note: SYNC supports a maximum of three
callers on a multiparty/conference call.
Enter Tones
Enter “tones” such as numbers for passwords.
Scroll until the desired number appears in the
display, then press OK; a tone sounds as
confirmation. Repeat as necessary.
Phonebook
Access your phonebook contacts.
1. Press OK to select, then scroll through
your phonebook contacts.
2. Press OK again when the desired selection
appears in the display.
3. Press the phone button.
Call History
Access your call history log.
1. Press OK to select, then scroll through
your call history options (incoming, outgoing
or missed).
2. Press OK when the desired selection
appears in the display.
3. Press the phone button to call the
selection.
Return
Exit the current menu.
374 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Accessing Features through the Phone Menu
SYNC’s phone menu allows you to redial a number, access your call
history and phone book and send text messages as well as access phone
and system settings. You can also access advanced features, such as 911
Assist, Vehicle Health Report and SYNC Services.
1. Press the phone button to enter the Phone Menu.
2. Scroll to cycle through:
When you select: You can:
Phone Redial
Redial the last number called (if available).
Press OK to select, then press OK again to
confirm.
Call History
1
Allows you to access any previously dialed,
received or missed calls while your phone has
been connected to the system.
1. Press OK to select.
2. Scroll to select from Call History Incoming,
Call History Outgoing or Call History Missed.
Press OK make your selection.
3. Press OK or the phone button to call the
desired selection.
Note: The system attempts to automatically
re-download your phone book and call history
each time your phone connects to SYNC
(if the auto download feature is on and your
Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone supports
this feature).
Phonebook
1,2
Allows you to access your downloaded
phonebook.
1. Press OK to confirm and enter. If your
phonebook has fewer than 255 listings, they
appear alphabetically in flat file mode. If there
are more, they are organized into alphabetical
categories.
2. Scroll until the desired contact appears,
then press OK.
3. Press OK or the phone button.
SYNC® 375
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
Text Message
1
Enables you to send, download and delete
text messages.
Phone Settings
1
Allows you to view your phone’s status, set
ring tones, select your message notification,
change phone book entries and automatically
download your cellular phone among other
features.
SYNC Services
3
Access the SYNC services portal where you
can request various types of information,
traffic reports and directions.
911 Assist
4
Place an emergency call to a 911 operator for
you after an accident (if the feature is used
properly).
Vehicle Health
Report
3
Create and receive a diagnostic report card on
your vehicle.
Mobile Apps
3
Interact with SYNC-capable mobile
applications on your smartphone.
System Settings
Access Bluetooth Devices menu listings (add,
connect, set as primary, on/off, delete) as well
as Advanced menu listings (prompts,
languages, defaults, master reset, install
application and system information).
Exit Phone Menu
Exit the phone menu by pressing OK.
1
This is a phone-dependent feature.
2
This is a phone-dependent and speed-dependent feature.
3
If equipped, United States only.
4
If equipped, United States and Canada only.
Text Messaging
Note: This is a phone-dependent feature.
SYNC allows you to receive, send, download and delete text messages.
The system can also read incoming text messages to you so that you do
not have to take your eyes off the road.
376 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Receiving a Text Message
Note: This is a phone-dependent feature. Your phone must support
downloading text messages using Bluetooth to receive incoming text
messages.
Note: Forwarding a text message is a speed-dependent feature and can
only be done when the vehicle is traveling at 3 mph (5 km/h) or less.
Note: Only one recipient is allowed per text message.
When a new message arrives, an audible tone sounds and the display
indicates you have a new message. You have these options:
1. Press the voice button, wait for the prompt and say “Read Message”
to have SYNC read the message to you.
2. Press OK to receive and open the text message or do nothing and
the message goes into your text message inbox. Press OK again and
SYNC reads your message aloud as you are not able to view the
message. You can then also choose whether you’d like to reply or
forward the message.
3. Press OK and scroll to choose between:
Reply to Text Message: Press OK to access and then scroll
through the list of pre-defined messages to send.
Forward Text Message: Press OK to forward the message to
anyone in your Phonebook or Call History. You can also choose
Enter Number.
Sending, Downloading and Deleting Your Text Messages
Text messaging is a phone-dependent feature. If your phone is
compatible, SYNC allows you to receive, send, download and delete text
messages.
1. Press the phone button.
2. Scroll until Text Message appears and press OK.
3. Scroll to select from the following options:
Send Text Message? enables you to send a new text message based on
a pre-defined set of 15 messages.
Download Unread Msgs allows you to download your unread messages
(only) to SYNC. To download the messages, press OK to select. The
display indicates your messages are being downloaded. When complete,
SYNC takes you to your inbox.
Delete All Messages? allows you to delete current text messages from
SYNC (not your phone). To delete the messages, press OK to select.
The display indicates when all your text messages have been deleted
and SYNC returns you to the text message menu.
SYNC® 377
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: SYNC does not automatically download all of your unread text
messages at every ignition cycle (as it does with call history and
phonebook if automatic download is set to on).
Return exits the current menu when you press OK.
If you select Send Text Message?:
1. Press OK to select. If the system detects your phone does not
support this feature, Unsupported appears in the display and SYNC
returns to the main menu.
2. Scroll to cycle through the message options in the following chart.
3. Press OK when the desired selection is in the display. The system
now needs to know who to send the message to.
4. Scroll to cycle through Phonebook or Call History entries. You can
also select Enter Number to audibly enter a desired number.
5. Press OK to enter the desired menu and scroll to select the specific
contact.
6. Press OK when the contact appears and press OK again to confirm
when the system asks if you would like to send the message. Each
text message is sent with the following signature: “This message was
sent from my <Ford or Lincoln>”.
Pre-defined text message options
Can’t talk right now
Call me
Call you later
Be there in 10 minutes
Be there in 20 minutes
Yes
No
Why?
Thanks
Where R you?
I need more directions
I love you
Too funny
Can’t wait to see you
I’m stuck in traffic
378 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Accessing Your Phone Settings
These are phone-dependent features. Your phone settings allow you to
access and adjust features such as your ring tone, text message
notification, modify your phone book and also set up automatic
download.
1. Press the phone button.
2. Scroll until Phone Settings appears, then press OK.
3. Scroll to select from the following options:
When you select: You can:
Phone Status
See the provider, name, signal power, battery
power and roaming status of your connected
phone.
Press OK to select and scroll to view the
information. When done, press OK again to
return to the phone status menu.
Set Ringer
Select which ring tone sounds during an
incoming call (one of the system’s or your
phone’s).
1. Press OK to select and scroll to hear
Ringer 1, Ringer 2, Ringer 3 and Phone
Ringer.
2. Press OK to select.
Note: If your phone supports in-band ringing,
your phone’s ringer sounds when Phone
Ringer is chosen.
Message Notification
Have the option of hearing an audible tone to
notify you when a text message arrives.
1. Press OK to select and scroll between
Message Notification On or Message
Notification Off.
2. Press OK to select.
SYNC® 379
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
Modify Phonebook
Modify the contents of your phone book (i.e.,
add, delete, download). Press OK to select
and scroll between:
Add Contacts: Press OK to add more contacts
from your phone book. Push the desired
contact(s) on your phone. See your phone’s
user guide on how to push contacts.
Delete Phonebook: Press OK to delete the
current phone book and call history. When
Delete Phonebook appears, press OK to
confirm. SYNC takes you back to the Phone
Settings menu.
Download Phonebook: Press OK to select and
press OK again when Confirm
Download? appears.
Auto Download
Automatically download your phone book
each time your phone connects to SYNC.
Press OK to select. When Auto Download
On? appears, press OK to have your
phonebook automatically downloaded each
time.
Select Off to NOT download your phonebook
every time your phone connects to SYNC.
Your phonebook, call history and text
messages can only be accessed when your
specific phone is connected to SYNC.
Note: Downloading times are phone- and
quantity-dependent.
Note: When auto download is on, any
changes, additions or deletions saved since
your last download are deleted.
Return
Exit the current menu.
380 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
System Settings
System Settings provide access to your Bluetooth Devices and
Advanced menu features. Use the arrow buttons to scroll through the
menu options.
The Bluetooth Devices menu allows you to add, connect, delete and set a
phone as primary as well as turn your Bluetooth feature on and off.
The Advanced menu allows you to access and set prompts, languages,
defaults, perform a master reset, install an application and view system
information.
Bluetooth Devices Menu Options
This menu allows you to add, connect, delete, set a phone as primary,
and turn Bluetooth on or off.
1. Press the phone button to enter the Phone Menu.
2. Scroll until System Settings appears and press OK.
3. Scroll until Bluetooth Devices appears and select OK.
4. Scroll to select from the following options:
If you select: You can:
Add Bluetooth Device
*
See Using SYNC with your phone earlier in this
chapter for pairing instructions.
Connect Bluetooth
Device
Connect a previously paired Bluetooth-enabled
phone.
1. Press OK to select and view a list of previously
paired phones.
2. Scroll until the desired device is chosen, then
press OK to connect the phone.
Note: Only one device can be connected at a time.
When another phone is connected, the previous
one is disconnected.
Set Primary Phone Set a previously paired phone as your primary
phone.
Press OK to select and scroll to select the desired
phone. Press OK to confirm.
Note: SYNC attempts to connect with the primary
phone at every ignition cycle. When a phone is
selected as primary, it appears first in the list and
is marked with an asterisk (*).
Set Bluetooth On/Off
Turn the Bluetooth feature on and off.
Press OK and scroll to toggle between On and Off.
When the desired selection is chosen, press OK.
Note: Turning Bluetooth off disconnects all
Bluetooth devices and deactivates all Bluetooth
features.
SYNC® 381
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If you select: You can:
Delete Device
Delete a paired phone.
Press OK and scroll to select the device. Press OK
to confirm.
Delete All Devices
Delete all previously paired phones (and all
information originally saved with those phones).
Press OK to select.
Return
Exit the current menu.
*
This is a speed-dependent feature.
Advanced Menu Options
This menu allows you to access settings such as prompts, languages,
defaults, perform a master reset, install an application and view system
information.
1. Press the phone button to enter the Phone Menu.
2. Scroll until System Settings appears and press OK.
3. Scroll until Advanced appears and select OK.
4. Scroll to select from the following options:
If you select: You can:
Prompts
Get help from SYNC by using questions, helpful
hints or asking you for a specific action. To turn
these prompts on or off:
1. Press OK to select and scroll to select between
on or off.
2. Press OK when the desired selection appears in
the display. SYNC takes you back to the
Advanced menu.
Languages
Choose between English, Espanol and Francais.
Once selected, all of SYNC’s radio displays and
prompts are in the selected language.
1. Press OK to select and then scroll through the
languages.
2. Press OK when the desired selection appears in
the display. If you change the language setting, the
display indicates that the system is updating. When
complete, SYNC takes you back to the
Advanced menu.
382 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If you select: You can:
Factory Defaults
Return to the factory default settings. This
selection does not erase your indexed information
(phonebook, call history, text messages and paired
devices).
1. Press OK to select and then press OK again
when Restore Defaults? appears in the display.
2. Press OK to confirm.
Master Reset
Completely erase all information stored on SYNC
(phonebook, call history, text messages and paired
devices) and return to the factory default settings.
Press OK to select. The display indicates when
complete and SYNC takes you back to the
Advanced menu.
Install Application Install applications you have downloaded.
Press OK and scroll to select. Press OK to confirm.
System Info
Access the Auto Version number as well as the
FPN number.
Press OK to select.
MAP Profile
This is a Bluetooth component which can further
help your phone with the exchange of text
messages.
Return
Exit the current menu.
SYNC APPLICATIONS AND SERVICES (IF EQUIPPED)
Note: In order for the following features to work, your cellular phone
must be compatible with SYNC. To check your phone’s compatibility, visit
www.SYNCMyRide.com, www.SYNCMyRide.ca or www.syncmaroute.ca.
SYNC Services (if equipped, United States only): Provides access to
traffic, directions and information such as travel, horoscopes, stock
prices and more.
911 Assist: Can alert 911 in the event of an emergency.
Vehicle Health Report (if equipped, United States only): Provides a
diagnostic and maintenance report card of your vehicle.
SYNC AppLink: Allows you to connect to and use certain applications
such as Pandora and Stitcher (if your phone is compatible).
SYNC® 383
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
911 Assist®
WARNING: Unless the 911 Assist setting is set on prior to a
crash, the system will not dial for help which could delay
response time, potentially increasing the risk of serious injury or death
after a crash.
WARNING: Do not wait for 911 Assist to make an emergency
call if you can do it yourself. Dial emergency services
immediately to avoid delayed response time which could increase the
risk of serious injury or death after a crash. If you do not hear 911
Assist within five seconds of the crash, the system or phone may be
damaged or non-functional.
WARNING: Always place your phone in a secure location in the
vehicle so it does not become a projectile or get damaged in a
crash. Failure to do so may cause serious injury to someone or damage
the phone which could prevent 911 Assist from working properly.
Note: SYNC 911 Assist feature must be set on prior to the incident.
Note: Before setting this feature on, ensure that you read the 911 Assist
privacy notice later in this section for important information.
Note: If 911 Assist is turned on or off by any user, that setting applies
for all paired phones. If 911 Assist is turned off, a voice message plays
and/or a display message/icon comes on when the vehicle is started after
a previously paired phone connects.
Note: Every phone operates differently. While SYNC 911 Assist works
with most cellular phones, some may have trouble using this feature.
If a crash deploys an airbag (excludes knee airbags and rear inflatable
safety belts [if equipped]) or activates the fuel pump shut-off, your SYNC
equipped vehicle may be able to contact emergency services by dialing
911 through a paired and connected Bluetooth-enabled phone. For more
information about 911 Assist, visit www.SYNCMyRide.com,
www.SYNCMyRide.ca or www.syncmaroute.ca.
For information on airbag deployment, see the Supplementary
Restraints System chapter.
For information on the fuel pump shut-off, see the Roadside
Emergencies chapter.
384 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Setting 911 Assist On
Perform the following:
1. Press the phone button to enter the Phone Menu.
2. Scroll until 911 Assist is selected.
3. Press OK to confirm and enter the 911 Assist menu.
4. Scroll to select between On and Off selections.
5. Press OK when the desired option appears in the radio display.
Set On or Set Off appears in the display as confirmation.
Off selections include: Off with reminder and Off without reminder.
Off with reminder provides a display and voice reminder at phone
connection at vehicle start. Off without reminder provides a display
reminder only without a voice reminder at phone connection.
To make sure that 911 Assist works properly:
SYNC must be powered and working properly at the time of the
incident and throughout feature activation and use.
SYNC 911 Assist feature must be set on prior to the incident.
A Bluetooth-enabled and compatible phone has to be paired and
connected to SYNC.
A connected Bluetooth-enabled phone must have the ability to make
and maintain an outgoing call at the time of the incident.
A connected Bluetooth-enabled phone must have adequate network
coverage, battery power and signal strength.
The vehicle must have battery power and be located in the United
States, Canada or in a territory in which 911 is the emergency
number.
In the Event of a Crash
Not all crashes deploy an airbag or activate the fuel pump shut-off
(which would activate 911 Assist); however, if 911 Assist is triggered,
SYNC tries to contact emergency services. If a connected phone is
damaged or loses connection to SYNC, SYNC searches for, and tries to
connect to, any available previously paired phone and tries to make the
call to 911.
Before making the call:
SYNC provides a short window of time (about 10 seconds) to cancel the
call. Failure to cancel the call results in SYNC attempting to dial 911.
SYNC says the following, or a similar message: “SYNC will attempt to call
911, to cancel the call, press Cancel on your screen or press and hold the
phone button on your steering wheel.”
SYNC® 385
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If the call is not cancelled and a successful call is made, a pre-recorded
message is played for the 911 operator, then the occupant(s) in the
vehicle is able to talk with the operator. Be prepared to provide your
name, phone number and location immediately, because not all 911
systems are capable of receiving this information electronically.
911 Assist May Not Work If
Your cellular phone or 911 Assist hardware was damaged in a crash.
The vehicle’s battery or SYNC system has no power.
The phone(s) paired and connected to the system was thrown from
the vehicle.
911 Assist Privacy Notice
Once 911 Assist is set on, it may disclose to emergency services that the
vehicle has been in a crash involving the deployment of an airbag or
activation of the fuel pump shut-off. Certain versions or updates to 911
Assist may also be capable of electronically or verbally disclosing to 911
operators the vehicle location, and/or other details about the vehicle or
crash to assist 911 operators to provide the most appropriate emergency
services. If you do not want to disclose this information, do not turn the
feature on.
Vehicle Health Report
WARNING: Always follow scheduled maintenance instructions,
regularly inspect your vehicle, and seek repair for any damage or
problem you suspect. Vehicle Health Report supplements, but cannot
replace normal maintenance and vehicle inspection. Vehicle Health
Report only monitors certain systems that are electronically monitored
by the vehicle and will not monitor or report the status of any other
system, (i.e., brake lining wear). Failure to perform scheduled
maintenance and regularly inspect your vehicle may result in vehicle
damage and serious injury.
Note: Your Vehicle Health Report feature requires activation prior to
use. Visit www.SYNCMyRide.com to register. There is no fee or
subscription associated with Vehicle Health Report, but you must register
to use this feature.
Note: This feature may not function properly if you have enabled caller
ID blocking on your mobile phone. Before running a report, review the
Vehicle Health Report privacy notice.
386 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note: In order to allow a break-in period for your vehicle, you may not
be able to create a Vehicle Health Report until your vehicle odometer has
reached 200 miles.
Register for Vehicle Health Report and set your report preferences at
www.SYNCMyRide.com. After registering, you can request a Vehicle
Health Report (inside your vehicle). Return to your account at
www.SYNCMyRide.com to view your report. You can also choose for
SYNC to automatically remind you to run reports at specific mileage
intervals. Cellular phone airtime usage may apply when reporting.
The system allows you to check your vehicle’s overall health in the form
of a diagnostic report card. The vehicle health report contains valuable
information such as:
Vehicle Diagnostic Information
Scheduled maintenance
Open Recalls and Field Service Actions
Unserviced items from vehicle inspections by your authorized dealer.
You can run a report (after the vehicle has been running a minimum of
60 seconds) by pressing the voice button and saying “Vehicle health
report”, or pressing the phone button.
To run a report using the phone button:
1. Press the phone button to enter Phone Menu.
2. Scroll until Vehicle Health is selected and press OK.
3. Scroll to select from the following options:
Vehicle Health Report options
User Preferences:
Press OK to select
and enter the menu.
Scroll to select from:
Automatic Reports: Press OK and select on
or off. Select On to have SYNC automatically
prompt you to run a health report at certain
mileage intervals. Note: You must first turn
this feature on before you can select the
mileage intervals at which you would like to
be prompted.
Mileage Intervals: Press OK. Scroll to select
between 5000, 7500 or 10000 mile intervals
and press OK to make your selection.
Return: Press OK to exit the menu.
SYNC® 387
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Vehicle Health Report options
Run Report? Press OK for SYNC to run a health report of
your vehicle’s diagnostic systems and send the
results to Ford where it is combined with
scheduled maintenance information, open
recalls and other field service actions and
unserviced vehicle inspection items from your
authorized dealer.
Vehicle Health Report Privacy Notice
When you run a Vehicle Health Report, Ford Motor Company may collect
your cellular phone number (to process your report request) and
diagnostic information about your vehicle. Certain versions or updates to
Vehicle Health Report may also collect additional vehicle information.
Ford may use the vehicle information it collects for any purpose.
If you do not want to disclose your cellular phone number or vehicle
information, do not run the feature or set up your Vehicle Health Report
profile at www.SYNCMyRide.com. See www.SYNCMyRide.com - Vehicle
Health Report Terms and Conditions, and Privacy Statement - for more
information.
SYNC Services: Traffic, Directions & Information (TDI)
Note: SYNC Services requires activation prior to use. Visit
www.SYNCMyRide.com to register and check your eligibility for
complimentary services. Standard phone and message rates may apply.
Subscription may be required. You must also have the active SYNC
Services Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone paired and connected to the
system in order to connect to, and use, SYNC Services. See the Using
SYNC with your phone for pairing instructions.
Note: This feature does not function properly if you have enabled caller
ID blocking on your mobile phone. Make sure your mobile phone is not
blocking caller ID before using SYNC Services.
388 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Note:
The driver is ultimately responsible for the safe operation of the
vehicle, and therefore, must evaluate whether it is safe to follow the
suggested directions. Any navigation features are provided only as an aid.
Make your driving decisions based on your observations of local conditions
and existing traffic regulations. Do not follow the route suggestions if doing
so would result in an unsafe or illegal maneuver, if you would be placed in an
unsafe situation, or if you would be directed into an area that you consider
unsafe. Maps used by this system may be inaccurate because of errors,
changes in roads, traffic conditions or driving conditions.
Note: When you connect, the service uses GPS technology and advanced
vehicle sensors to collect the vehicle’s current location, travel direction
and speed to help provide you with the directions, traffic reports, or
business searches you request. Further, to provide the services you
request and for continuous improvement, the service may collect and
record call details and voice communications. For more information, see
SYNC Services Terms and Conditions at www.SYNCMyRide.com. If you
do not want Ford or its service providers to collect the vehicle travel
information or other information identified in the Terms and Conditions,
do not activate or use the service.
SYNC Services uses advanced vehicle sensors, integrated GPS technology
and comprehensive map and traffic data, to give you personalized traffic
reports, precise turn-by-turn directions, business search, news, sports,
weather and more. For a complete list of services, or to learn more,
please visit www.SYNCMyRide.com.
Connecting to SYNC Services Using Voice Commands
1. Press the voice button.
2. When prompted, say “Services”. This initiates an outgoing call to
SYNC Services using your paired and connected Bluetooth-enabled
cellular phone.
3. Once you are connected to the service, follow the voice prompts to
request the desired service, such as “Traffic” or “Directions”. You can
also say “What are my choices?” to receive a complete list of available
services from which to choose.
4. Say “Services” to return to the services main menu or for help, say
“Help”.
SYNC® 389
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Connecting to SYNC Services Using the Navigation Screen
1. Select the Phone hard button.
2. Select the SYNC Apps soft button tab.
3. Select the SYNC Services soft button to connect to SYNC Services.
Receiving Turn-by-Turn Directions
1. When connected to SYNC Services, say “Directions” or “Business
search”. To find the closest business or type of business to your
current location, just say “Business search” and then “Search near
me”. If you need further assistance in finding a location you can say
“Operator” at any time within a Directions or Business search to
speak with a live operator. You may also be prompted to speak with
an operator when the automatic system has difficulty matching your
voice request. The live operator can assist you by searching for
businesses by name or by category, residential addresses by street
address or by name or specific street intersections. Operator Assist is
a feature of your SYNC Services subscription. For more information
on Operator Assist visit www.SYNCMyRide.com/support.
2. Follow the voice prompts to select your destination. Once your
destination is selected, your current vehicle location is uploaded and
a route based on current traffic conditions is calculated and sent
back to your vehicle. After the route download is complete, the
phone call is automatically ended. You then receive audible and
visual driving instructions as you travel toward your destination.
3. While on an active route, you can select or say “Route summary” or
“Route status” to view the Route Summary turn list or the Route
Status ETA. You can also turn voice guidance on or off, cancel the
route or update the route.
If you miss a turn, SYNC automatically asks if you want the route
updated. Just say, “Yes” when prompted and a new route will be
delivered to your vehicle.
390 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Disconnecting from SYNC Services
1. Press and hold the phone button on the steering wheel.
2. Say “Good-bye” from the SYNC Services main menu.
SYNC Services quick tips
Personalizing You can personalize your Services feature to
provide quicker access to your most used or
favorite information. You can save address
points such as work or home. You can also
save favorite information like sports teams or
a news category. To learn more, log onto
www.SYNCMyRide.com.
Push to interrupt Press the voice button at any time (while you
are connected to SYNC Services) to interrupt
a voice prompt or an audio clip (such as a
sports report), wait for the listening tone, and
say your voice command.
Portable Your subscription is associated with your
Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone number,
not your VIN (Vehicle Identification Number).
You can pair and connect your phone to any
vehicle equipped with SYNC Services and
continue enjoying your personalized services.
You can even access your account outside the
vehicle. Just use the number on your phone’s
call history. Traffic and Directions features do
not function properly but information services
and the 411 connect and text message
features are available.
SYNC® 391
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SYNC AppLink™
Note: This feature is only available in the United States.
Note: Your smartphone must be paired and connected to SYNC to access
AppLink.
Note: iPhone users need to connect the phone to the USB port in order
to start the application. It is recommended to lock your iPhone after
starting an application.
Note: The AppLink feature is not available if your vehicle is equipped
with the MyFord Touch or MyLincoln Touch system.
Depending on your display type, you can access AppLink from the media
menu, the phone menu, or by using voice commands. Once an app is
running through AppLink, you can control main features of the app
through voice commands and steering wheel controls.
To Access Using the Phone Menu
1. Press the Phone button.
2. Browse to Mobile Applications and press OK.
3. Browse to your desired app and press OK.
4. Once an app is running through SYNC, you can access an app’s menu
by pressing the MENU button to first access the SYNC menu.
5. Scroll until “<App name> Menu” is displayed (such as Pandora
Menu), then press OK. From here, you can access an application’s
features, such as Thumbs up, Thumbs down, etc. For more
information, please visit www.SYNCMyRide.com.
To Access Using the Media Menu
1. Press the AUX button to access the SYNC menu.
2. Press the Menu button to access the SYNC Media menu.
3. Browse to Mobile Applications and press OK.
4. Browse to your desired app and press OK.
5. Once an app is running through SYNC, you can access an app’s menu
by pressing the MENU button to first access the SYNC menu.
6. Scroll until “<App name> Menu” is displayed (such as Pandora
Menu), then press OK. From here, you can access an application’s
features, such as Thumbs up, Thumbs down, etc. For more
information, please visit www.SYNCMyRide.com.
To Access Using the Navigation Screen (If Equipped)
1. Press the Phone button.
2. Press the SYNC Apps tab.
3. Press Mobile Apps.
4. Select the app to start it.
392 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
To Access Using Voice Commands
1. Press the voice icon.
2. When prompted, say “Mobile Apps”.
3. Say the name of the application after the tone.
4. The app should start. While an app is running through SYNC, you can
press the voice button and speak commands specific to the app, such
as “Play Station Quickmix”. Say “Help” to discover available voice
commands.
USING SYNC WITH YOUR MEDIA PLAYER
You can access and play music from your digital music player over the
vehicle’s speaker system using the system’s media menu or voice
commands. You can also sort and play your music by specific categories,
such as artists, albums, etc.
SYNC is capable of hosting nearly any digital media player including:
iPod, Zune™, Plays from device players, and most USB drives. SYNC also
supports audio formats such as MP3, WMA, WAV and ACC.
Connecting Your Digital Media Player via the USB Port
Note: If your digital media player has a power switch, ensure that the
device is turned on.
To connect using voice commands:
1. Plug the device into the vehicle’s USB port.
2. Press the voice icon and when prompted, say “USB”.
3. You can now play music by saying any of the appropriate voice
commands. See the media voice commands.
To connect using the system menu:
1. Plug the device into the vehicle’s USB port.
2. Press AUX and then MENU to enter the Media Menu.
3. Scroll until Select Source appears and press OK.
4. Scroll to select USB and press OK.
5. Depending on how many digital media files are on your connected
device, Indexing may appear in the radio display. When indexing is
complete, the screen returns to the Play Menu.
6. Press OK and scroll through selections of:
Play All
Artists
Albums
Genres
Playlists
Tracks
SYNC® 393
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Explore USB
Similar Music
Return
When the desired selection appears in the display, press OK to build
your desired music selection.
What’s Playing?
At any time when a track is playing, you can press the voice
icon and ask the system, “What’s playing?”. The system reads
the metadata tags (if populated) of the playing track to you.
Media Voice Commands
Press the voice icon and, when prompted, say “USB” then any
of the following:
“USB”
“Autoplay off”
“Autoplay on”
“(Phone) (Media) (Bluetooth) Connections”
“Pause”
“Play”
“Play album <name>”
1,3
“Play all”
“Play artist <name>”
1,3
“Play genre <name>”
1,3
“Play next folder”
2
“Play next track”
“Play playlist <name>”
1,3
“Play previous folder”
2
“Play previous track”
“Play song <name>”
1,3
“Play track <name>”
1,3
“Refine album <name>”
1,3
“Refine artist <name>”
1,3
“Refine song <name>”
1,3
“Refine track <name>”
1,3
394 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
“USB”
“Repeat off”
“Repeat on”
“Search album <name>”
1,3
“Search artist <name>”
1,3
“Search genre <name>”
1,3
“Search song <name>”
1,3
“Search track <name>”
1,3
“Shuffle off”
“Shuffle on”
“Similar music”
“What’s playing?”
1
“<name>” is a dynamic listing, meaning that it could be the name of any
desired group, artist, etc.
2
Voice commands which are only available in folder mode.
3
Voice commands which are not available until indexing is complete.
Voice command guide
“Autoplay” Turn on to listen to music which has already
been randomly indexed during the indexing
process.
Turn off and the system does not begin to play
any of your music until all media has all been
indexed. Indexing times can vary from device to
device and also with regard to the number of
songs being indexed.
“Search/Play Genre” The system searches all the data from your
indexed music and, if available, begins to play
the chosen type of music. You can only play
genres of music which are present in the
GENRE metadata tags that you have on your
digital media player.
“Similar Music” The system compiles a playlist and then plays
similar music to what is currently playing from
the USB port using indexed metadata
information.
“Search/Play
Artist/Track/Album”
The system searches for a specific
artist/track/album from the music indexed
through the USB port.
SYNC® 395
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Voice command guide
“Refine” This allows you to make your previous command
more specific. For example, if you asked to
search and play all music by a certain artist, you
could then say “refine album” and choose a
specific album from the list to view. If you then
select Play, the system only plays music from
that specific album.
Press the voice icon and when prompted say “Bluetooth Audio” and then
any of the following:
“BLUETOOTH AUDIO”
“(Phone) (Media) (Bluetooth) Connections”
“Pause”
“Play”
“Play next track
“Play previous track
Media Menu Features
The media menu allows you to select your media source, how to play
your music (by artist, genre, shuffle, repeat, etc.), and also to add,
connect or delete devices.
1. Press AUX and then MENU to enter the Media Menu.
2. Scroll to cycle through:
When you select: You can:
Play Menu
Play your music by artist, album, genre,
playlists, tracks, similar music or to simply, play
all. You can also choose to Explore USB to view
the supported digital music files on your playing
device.
See Play Menu later in this section for more
information.
396 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
Select Source
SYNC USB: Press OK to access music plugged
into your USB port. You can also plug in devices
to charge them (if supported by your device).
Once connected, the system indexes any
readable media files. (The time required to
complete this depends on the size of the media
content being indexed.) If Autoplay is on, you
can access media files randomly as they are
indexed. If turned off, indexed media is not
available until the indexing process is complete.
SYNC is capable of indexing thousands of
average size media and notifies you if the
maximum indexing file size is reached.
Bluetooth Audio
: This is a phone-dependent
feature which allows you to stream music
playing on your Bluetooth-enabled phone.
If supported by your device, you can press
SEEK to play the previous or next track.
SYNC Line In: Press OK to select and play
music from your portable music player over the
vehicle’s speakers.
Note: If you have already connected a device to
the USB port, you cannot access the line in
feature. Some digital media players require both
USB and line in ports to stream data and music
separately.
SYNC® 397
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
Media Settings
Choose to shuffle or repeat your music and
select your Autoplay settings. Once these
selections are turned on, they remain on until
turned off. Press SEEK to play the previous or
next track.
Note: Some digital media players require both
USB and line in ports to stream data and music
separately. Press OK to select and then scroll to
choose from:
Shuffle
: Press OK to shuffle available media
files in the current playlist. Note: To shuffle
all media tracks, you must select Play All in
the Play Menu and then select Shuffle.
Repeat: Press OK to repeat any song.
Autoplay: Press OK to listen to music which
has already been randomly indexed during
the indexing process.
Mobile Apps Interact with SYNC-capable mobile applications
on your smart phone. See SYNC AppLink
earlier in this chapter for more information.
System Settings
Access Bluetooth Device menu listings (add,
connect, set as primary, on/off, delete) as well
as Advanced menu listings (prompts, languages,
defaults, master reset, install application and
system information).
Note: See System Settings for more information.
Exit Media Menu
Press OK to exit the media menu.
Accessing Your Play Menu
This menu allows you to select and play your media by artist, album,
genre, playlist, track, similar music or even to explore what is on your
USB device.
1. Make sure that your device is plugged into the USB port and is
turned on.
2. Press AUX and then MENU to enter the Media Menu.
3. Scroll to select the Play Menu and press OK.
398 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If there are no media files to access, the display indicates there is no
media. If there are media files, you have the following options to scroll
through and select from:
When you select: You can:
Play All Play all indexed media (tracks) from your
playing device in flat file mode, one at a time in
numerical order.
Press OK to select. The first track title appears
in the display.
Artists
Sort all indexed media by artist. Once selected,
the system lists and then play all artists and
tracks alphabetically. If there are less than
255 indexed artist, they are listed alphabetically
in flat file mode. If there are more, they are
categorized in alphabetical categories.
1. Press OK to select. You can select to play All
Artists or any indexed artist.
2. Scroll until the desired artist is chosen and
press OK.
Albums
Sort all indexed media by albums. If there are
less than 255 indexed albums, they are listed
alphabetically in flat file mode. If there are
more, they are organized into alphabetical
categories.
1. Press OK to enter the album menu and select
from playing all albums or from any individual
indexed album.
2. Scroll until the desired album is chosen and
press OK.
Genres
Sort indexed music by genre (category) type.
SYNC lists the genres alphabetically in flat file
mode. If there are more than 255, SYNC
automatically organizes them into alphabetical
categories.
Press OK to select and then scroll to select the
desired genre and press OK.
Playlists
Access your playlists (from formats such as
ASX, .M3U, .WPL, .MTP.). The system lists your
playlists alphabetically in flat file mode. If there
are more than 255, they are organized into
alphabetical categories.
Press OK to select. Then scroll to select the
desired playlist and press OK.
SYNC® 399
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
Tracks
Search for and play a specific track which has
been indexed. SYNC lists your tracks
alphabetically in flat file mode. If there are more
than 255, SYNC automatically organizes them
into alphabetical categories.
Press OK to select. Then scroll to select the
desired track and press OK.
Explore USB Explore all supported digital media on your
media device connected to the USB port.
You can only view media content which is
compatible with SYNC; other files saved are not
visible.
Press OK to select. Then scroll to explore
indexed media on your flash drive.
Similar Music Play music similar to what is currently playing
from the USB port. The system uses the
metadata information of each song to compile a
playlist for you.
Press OK to select. The system creates a new
list of similar songs and begins playing. The
metadata tags must be populated for this feature
to include each track.
Note: With certain playing devices, if your
metadata tags are not populated, the tracks
won’t be available in voice recognition, play
menu or similar music. However, if you place
these tracks onto your playing device in “Mass
Storage Device Mode”, they are available in
voice recognition, play menu browsing and
similar music. Unknowns are placed into any
unpopulated metadata tag.
Return
Exit the current menu.
System Settings
System settings provide access to your Bluetooth Devices and
Advanced menu features.
The Bluetooth Devices menu allows you to add, connect and delete a
device as turn the Bluetooth feature on and off.
Your Advanced menu allows you to access and set prompts, languages,
defaults and perform a master reset.
400 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Bluetooth Devices Menu Options
This menu allows you to add, connect and delete devices as well as turn
Bluetooth on and off.
1. Press AUX and then MENU to enter the Media Menu.
2. Scroll until System Settings appears and select OK.
3. Scroll until Bluetooth Devices appears.
4. Press OK and then scroll to select from:
When you select: You can:
Add Bluetooth
Device
*
Allows you to pair additional devices to the
system.
1. Press OK to select and press OK again
when Find SYNC appears in the display.
2. Follow the directions in your phone’s user
guide to put your phone into discovery mode.
A six-digit PIN appears in the display.
3. When prompted on your phone’s six-digit
display, enter the PIN.
Connect Bluetooth
Device
Connect a previously paired
Bluetooth-enabled phone.
1. Press OK to select and view a list of
devices.
2. Scroll until the desired device is chosen
and press OK to connect the device.
Set Bluetooth On/Off
Turn the Bluetooth feature on and off.
Press OK and scroll to toggle between On and
Off. When the desired selection is chosen,
press OK. Turning Bluetooth off disconnects
all Bluetooth devices and deactivates
Bluetooth features.
Delete Device
Delete a paired media device.
Press OK and scroll to select the device.
Press OK to confirm.
Delete All Devices
Delete all previously paired devices.
Press OK to select.
Return
Exit the current menu.
*
This is a speed-dependent feature
SYNC® 401
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Advanced Menu Options
This menu allows you to access settings such as prompts, language,
performing a master reset as well as returning to factory defaults.
1. Press AUX and then MENU to access the Media Menu.
2. Scroll until System Settings appears and select OK.
3. Scroll until Advanced appears.
4. Press OK and then scroll to select from the following:
When you select: You can:
Prompts
Have SYNC guide you via questions, helpful
hints or ask you for a specific action.
1. Press OK to select and scroll to select
between on or off.
2. Press OK when the desired selection
appears in the display. SYNC takes you back
to the Advanced menu.
Languages
Choose from English, Francais and Espanol.
The displays and prompts are in the selected
language.
1. Press OK to select and then scroll through
the languages.
2. Press OK when the desired selection
appears in the display.
3. If you change the language setting, the
display indicates that the system is updating.
When complete, SYNC takes you back to the
Advanced menu.
Factory Defaults
Return to the factory default settings.
This selection does not erase your indexed
information (phonebook, call history, text
messages and paired devices).
1. Press OK to select and then press OK again
when Restore Defaults? appears in the display.
2. Press OK to confirm.
402 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
Master Reset
Completely erase all information stored on
SYNC (all phonebook, call history, text
messages and all paired devices) and return
to the factory default settings.
Application Download new software applications
(if available) and then load the desired
applications through your USB port. See the
web site for more information.
Return
Exit the current menu.
TROUBLESHOOTING
Your SYNC system is easy to use. However, should questions arise, see
the tables below.
Use the website at any time to check your phone’s compatibility,
register your account and set preferences as well as access a
customer representative via an online chat (during certain hours). Visit
www.SYNCMyRide.com, www.SYNCMyRide.ca or www.syncmaroute.ca for
more information.
Phone issues
Issue Possible
cause(s)
Possible solution(s)
Excessive
background noise
during a phone
call.
The audio control
settings on your
phone may be
affecting SYNC
performance.
Review your phone’s user guide
regarding audio adjustments.
During a call, I
can hear the
other person but
they cannot hear
me.
Possible phone
malfunction.
Try turning off the device,
resetting the device, removing
the device’s battery, then trying
again.
SYNC® 403
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Phone issues
Issue Possible
cause(s)
Possible solution(s)
SYNC is not able
to download my
phonebook.
Thisisa
phone-dependent
feature, OR
Possible phone
malfunction.
Go to the website to review
your phone’s compatibility.
Try turning off the device,
resetting the device or removing
the device’s battery, then trying
again.
Try pushing your phonebook
contacts to SYNC by using the
Add Contacts feature.
Use the SYNCmyphone
feature available on the website.
The system says
Phonebook
Downloaded but
my phonebook in
SYNC is empty or
is missing
contacts.
Limitations on
your phone’s
capability.
Try pushing your phonebook
contacts to SYNC by using the
Add Contacts feature.
If the missing contacts are
stored on your SIM card, try
moving them to the device
memory.
Remove any pictures or
special ring tones associated
with the missing contact.
404 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Phone issues
Issue Possible
cause(s)
Possible solution(s)
I am having
trouble
connecting my
phone to SYNC.
Thisisa
phone-dependent
feature, OR
Possible phone
malfunction.
Go to the website to review
your phone’s compatibility.
Try turning off the device,
resetting the device or removing
the device’s battery, then trying
again.
Try deleting your device from
SYNC, deleting SYNC from your
device and trying again.
Check the security and auto
accept/prompt always settings
relative to the SYNC Bluetooth
connection on your phone.
Update your device’s software
firmware.
Turn off the Auto phonebook
download setting.
Text messaging is
not working on
SYNC.
Thisisa
phone-dependent
feature, OR
Possible phone
malfunction.
Go to the website to review
your phone’s compatibility.
Try turning off the device,
resetting the device or removing
the device’s battery, then trying
again.
SYNC® 405
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
USB and media issues
Issue Possible
cause(s)
Possible solution(s)
I am having
trouble
connecting my
device.
Possible device
malfunction.
Try turning off the device,
resetting the device or removing
the device’s battery, then trying
again.
Make sure you are using the
manufacturer’s cable.
Make sure the USB cable is
properly inserted into the device
and the vehicle’s USB port.
Make sure that the device
does not have an auto-install
program or active security
settings.
SYNC does not
recognize my
device when I
turn on the car.
This is a device
limitation.
Make sure you are not leaving
the device in your vehicle
during very hot or cold
temperatures.
Bluetooth audio
does not stream.
Thisisa
phone-dependent
feature, OR
The device is
not connected.
Make sure the device is
connected to SYNC and that you
have pressed play on your
device.
406 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
USB and media issues
Issue Possible
cause(s)
Possible solution(s)
SYNC does not
recognize music
that is on my
device.
Your music files
may not contain
the proper artist,
song title, album
or genre
information, OR
The file may be
corrupted, OR
The song may
have copyright
protection which
does not allow it
to play.
Make sure that all song details
are populated.
Some devices require you to
change the USB settings from
mass storage to MTP class.
Vehicle Health Report and SYNC Services (Traffic, Directions
and Information) issues
Issue Possible
cause(s)
Possible solution(s)
I received a text
that the Vehicle
Health Report is
not activated.
Your account
may not be
activated on the
website, OR
You may have
the wrong VIN
(vehicle
identification
number) listed.
This is a free feature, but you
must first register online to use
it.
Make sure that your VIN is
correctly listed in your account.
SYNC® 407
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Vehicle Health Report and SYNC Services (Traffic, Directions
and Information) issues
Issue Possible
cause(s)
Possible solution(s)
I am unable to
retrieve the
report on the
website, or I
receive a system
error.
The preferred
dealer
information did
not load correctly.
When you register your account,
you must list a preferred dealer.
If one is already listed, try
selecting another dealer and
logging out. Log back in and
change it back to your preferred
dealer and retrieve the report.
I am unable to
submit a report.
This could be
due to your
phone’s
compatibility, OR
Bad signal
strength, OR
Your phone
may not be
activated on the
website.
Update your mobile number
in your account on the website.
Make sure you have full signal
strength and that your
Bluetooth volume level has been
turned up.
Try deleting your phone and
performing a clean pairing.
I heard a
commercial when
I tried to use
Traffic, Directions
and Information.
The phone in
use is not
activated, OR
Your phone has
ID blocker active.
This is a free feature, but you
must first register online to use
it.
Turn off ID blocker on your
phone as the system recognizes
you by your phone number.
Make sure the currently
connected phone is the same
one that is registered on your
SyncMyRide account.
408 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Voice command issues
Issue Possible
cause(s)
Possible solution(s)
SYNC does not
understand what
I am saying.
You may be
using the wrong
voice commands,
OR
You may be
speaking too soon
or at the wrong
time.
Review the Phone voice
commands and the Media voice
commands at the beginning of
their respective sections.
Be aware that SYNC’s
microphone is either in your
rear view mirror or in the
headliner just above the
windshield.
SYNC does not
understand the
name of a song or
artist.
You may be
using the wrong
voice commands,
OR
You may not be
saying the name
exactly as it is
saved, OR
The system
may not be
reading the name
the same way you
are saying it.
Review the media voice
commands at the beginning of
the media section.
Say the song or artist exactly
as listed. If you say, “Play Artist
Prince”, the system does not
play music by Prince and the
Revolution or Prince and the
New Power Generation.
Make sure you are saying the
complete title, such as
“California remix featuring
Jennifer Nettles”.
If the songs are saved in all
CAPS, you have to spell them.
LOLA requires you to say, “Play
L-O-L-A”.
Do not use special characters
in the title as the system does
not recognize them.
SYNC® 409
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Voice command issues
Issue Possible
cause(s)
Possible solution(s)
SYNC does not
understand or is
calling the wrong
contact when I
want to make a
call.
You may be
using the wrong
voice commands,
OR
You may not be
saying the name
exactly as it is
saved, OR
Contacts in
your phonebook
may be very short
and similar, or
they may contain
special
characters, OR
Your
phonebook
contacts may be
saved in CAPS.
Review the phone voice
commands at the beginning of
the phone section.
Make sure you are saying the
contacts exactly as listed. For
example, if a contact is saved as
Joe Wilson, say “Call Joe
Wilson”.
The system works better if
you list full names, such as “Joe
Wilson” rather than “Joe”.
Do not use special characters
such as 123 or ICE, as the
system does not recognize them.
If contacts are saved in CAPS,
you have to spell them. JAKE
requires you to say, “Call
J-A-K-E”.
410 SYNC®
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
AppLink issues
Issue Possible
cause(s)
Possible solution(s)
SYNC does not
find any mobile
apps that are on
my phone.
Your device
may not support
the AppLink
feature, OR
The application
does not support
AppLink., OR
If you have an
iPhone, it may
not be plugged in,
OR
Your phone
may not be
paired or
connected.
Check the website for
compatible devices and
applications.
Make sure your device is
paired and connected. If you
have an iPhone, make sure it is
plugged in using the USB and
that the application is running
in the foreground.
SYNC® 411
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
NAVIGATION CONTROLS
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle
control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use
extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off
the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your
vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while
driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible.
Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the
use of electronic devices while driving.
The system divides the screen in two sections after it initializes:
Status bars: This is the top and bottom portion of the screen.
It displays the clock or date and other useful information, depending
on which mode you are in.
Display area: The touchscreen changes depending on current
system operation. Different buttons display in this area, depending on
which mode you are in.
Note: Some features, such as Sirius satellite radio, may not be available
in your location. Check with an authorized dealer.
412 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
A. Memory presets:
Store your favorite radio stations. To store a radio station, tune to the
station, then press and hold a preset button until sound returns.
In radio and satellite radio mode, press a button to access your saved
presets or channels.
B. CD and DVD slot: Insert a CD or DVD, label side up.
C. Eject: Press this button to eject a CD or DVD from the system.
D. TUNE RPT:
In radio or satellite radio mode, turn the control to advance in
individual increments up or down the frequency band to the desired
station.
In MP3 mode, turn the control to advance to the next or previous
folder.
In navigation mode, press this button to hear the last spoken
navigation guidance prompt.
E. MAP:
Press this button to access the navigation map.
Press while the map display is active to center the map on the
current vehicle position. Press while the map display and route are
active to see the different map guidance views.
F. DEST:
Press this button to access the destination entry menu.
Press while the destination entry menu is active to show additional
destination entry techniques.
G. NAV:
Press this button to access the navigation menu.
Press while the navigation menu is active to access the navigation
menu tabs.
H. I (Information): Press this button to access features such as Where
am I?, Sirius Travel Link, Calendar, System Info and Help.
I. PHONE: Press this button to access the SYNC phone menu.
J. DISP: Press this button to select a display mode: On, Status Bar Only,
and Off.
K. SEEK:
In radio and satellite radio mode, press the arrow buttons to find
previous or next available stations or channels within the currently
selected Category or Genre.
In CD and DVD modes, press the arrow buttons to select the previous
or next track or chapter.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 413
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
L. MENU:
Press this button to access the system menu.
Press while the system menu is active to access the menu tabs of
Display, Clock, Feedback Settings, System Settings and Valet Mode.
M. SOUND:
Press this button to access the sound menu.
Press while the sound menu is active to access the menu tabs of
Bass/Treble, Balance/Fade, SCV (Speed Compensated Volume), DSP
(Digital Signal Processing) and Visualizer.
N. MEDIA:
Press this button to access the media menu.
Press while the media menu is active to access the available sources
of CD/DVD, Jukebox and User Device.
O. RADIO:
Press this button to access the radio menu.
Press while the radio menu is active to access the available sources of
AM, FM1, FM2, SAT1, SAT2, and SAT3.
P. VOL: Press and hold this button to turn the system off and on. Turn
the control to adjust the volume.
Note: If a navigation route is active when the navigation system is off,
the system resumes the route when you turn the system on.
DISPLAY MODE
You can choose to turn your screen on or off and if you would like to
view the status bars on the top and bottom of the screen. Press DISP to
see the options.
Display Mode Voice Commands
The following voice commands are available in display mode.
If you are not in display mode, press the voice button on the
steering wheel. When prompted, say “Display mode” and then
any of the following commands.
Display mode voice commands
“Display on”
“Display off”
“Status bar”
“Brighter”
“Dimmer”
“Day”
414 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Display mode voice commands
“Night”
“Auto”
“Help”
STATUS BARS
The top status bar shows the
current mode, exterior temperature,
time and display icons if you have
enabled Bluetooth or other options.
The bottom status bar shows the
Home icon and may show the Artist
and Title of the currently playing
CD, Artist and Title for Jukebox and
radio.
Customizing Your Home Screen
Depending on your vehicle’s option package and software, your screens
may vary in appearance from the screens shown in this section. Your
features may also be limited depending on your market. Check with an
authorized dealer for availability.
Press the house icon to access the home screen. Here you can:
Save or view pictures.
View your current audio settings.
Display the audio visualizer.
You can split the screen in to two different sections, or you can choose
to have one main view.
The left side displays an uploaded photo or the map screen.
The right side displays an uploaded photo or the radio and visualizer.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 415
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Loading Photos
Note: The system is not compatible with discs written in Packet Write
mode.
Your system allows you to upload and view up to 32 photos.
Only the photograph(s), which meets the following conditions, display:
The file must be 1.5MB or smaller.
The file extension must be .jpe, .jpg or .jpeg.
The file path must be 255 characters or fewer.
Up to 256 files or folders can display in one folder.
The CD or DVD must be ISO 9660 format; the system does not
support UDF format.
To load photos:
1. Touch the left side of the home screen.
2. Touch the Add button. When the disclaimer appears asking to
confirm the supported photo formats, press OK.
3. Insert a CD-ROM that contains your photos.
4. Touch OK. The right side of the screen displays a list of the photos.
5. Select either Add or Add All to save photos to the hard drive.
Editing and Deleting Photos
To edit photos, go to the home screen, then:
1. Touch the current photo on the home screen.
2. Select the Edit button.
3. Adjust the photo by zooming in or out, moving right, left, up or down
and rotating left or right.
Note: Press the Reset button to return to the original image.
To delete a photo, select the Delete button.
To delete all photos:
1. Press the Menu hard button.
2. Select the System Settings tab on the touchscreen.
3. Press the View button for Delete Stored Items.
4. Select Saved photos.
416 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Using the Touch-sensitive Controls on Your System
To turn a feature on and off, just touch the graphic with your finger.
To get the best performance from the touch-sensitive controls:
Make sure your hands are clean and dry.
Since the touchscreen operates based on the touch of a finger, you
may have trouble using it if you are wearing gloves.
Use your bare finger to touch the center of a touch-control graphic.
Touching off-center of the graphic may affect operation of a nearby
control.
Do not press hard on the controls. They are sensitive to light touch.
Keep metal and other conductive material away from the surface of the
touchscreen as this may cause electronic interference (for example,
inadvertently turning on a feature other than the one you meant to turn
on).
Cleaning the Touchscreen Display
Use a clean, soft cloth such as one used for cleaning glasses. If dirt or
fingerprints are still visible, apply a small amount of alcohol to the cloth.
Do not pour or spray alcohol onto the display. Do not use detergent or
any type of solvent to clean the display.
USING VOICE RECOGNITION
This system helps you control many features using voice commands.
This allows you to keep your hands on the wheel and focus on what
is in front of you. The system provides feedback through audible tones,
prompts, questions and spoken confirmations depending on the situation
and the chosen level of interaction (voice settings).
The system also asks short questions (confirmation prompts) when it is
not sure of your request or when there are multiple possible responses
to your request.
When using voice commands, words and icons may appear in the lower
left status bar indicating the status of the voice session (such as
Listening, Success, Failed, Paused or Try Again).
Navigation System (If Equipped) 417
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
How To Use Voice Commands with Your System
Press the voice icon; after the tone, speak your command
clearly.
You can say these commands at any time.
“Audio” “Navigation”
“CD” “Radio”
“Disc” “SYNC”
*
“Display mode” “Tutorial”
“DVD” “User profile”
“Jukebox” “Video CD”
“Line in” “Voice settings”
“Mobile apps” “Help”
*
See the SYNC chapter for more information on these features.
To access a list of all available voice commands, press the I hard button.
Select the Help tab on the touchscreen, then the Voice Commands tab
and choose the desired category.
Helpful Hints
Make sure the interior of your vehicle is as quiet as possible. Wind
noise from open windows and road vibrations may prevent the system
from correctly recognizing spoken commands.
After pressing the voice icon, wait until after the tone sounds and
Listening appears before saying a command. Any command spoken
prior to this does not register with the system.
Speak naturally, without long pauses between words.
At any time, you can interrupt the system while it is speaking by
pressing the voice icon.
418 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Voice Settings
Voice settings allow you to customize the level of system interaction,
help and feedback. The system defaults to standard interaction, which
uses candidate lists, and confirmation prompts as these provide the
highest level of guidance and feedback.
Interaction Mode: Novice mode provides detailed interaction and
guidance while the advanced mode has less audible interaction and more
tone prompts.
Confirmation Prompts: The system uses these short questions to
confirm your voice request. If turned off, the system simply makes a best
guess as to what you requested. The system may still occasionally ask
you to confirm settings.
SYSTEM MENU FEATURES
Your system offers many menu features, such as allowing you to adjust
the touchscreen brightness, time and language, feedback and system
settings. You can access these options by pressing the MENU hard
button.
If you select: You can:
Display Brightness allows you to adjust screen
brightness by touching + or -.
Contrast allows you to adjust screen contrast
by touching + or -.
Day/Night Mode allows you to select Day
mode, Night mode or have the system
automatically switch for you by selecting Auto
mode.
Daytime Color allows you to select a light or
dark color for daytime screen lighting.
Note: When the headlamps are on under very
bright outdoor light conditions, the system
remains in day mode, even if you select night.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 419
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If you select: You can:
Clock Display Clock allows you to turn the clock
off and on.
Note: If your vehicle is equipped with an
in-dash analog clock, you can set the time on
this screen, but it may not appear in the
status bar for viewing purposes.
Format allows you to switch between
12– and 24–hour clock displays.
Auto Time Zone allows you to have the
system automatically switch the time
whenever you enter a new time zone.
Note: The system does not implement
daylight savings time.
Restore Defaults allows you to restore
system defaults.
420 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If you select: You can:
Feedback Settings Touch Screen Button Beep allows you to
select when the system sounds an audible
tone: All Buttons (whenever any system
button is touched), Touch Screen (only when
touchscreen selections are made) or Off
(no audible tones at all).
Voice Volume allows you to change
navigation voice and audible tone volume by
touching + or -.
Satellite Radio Channel Name allows you
to choose to display the satellite radio
channel name.
Voice Recognition Interaction Mode
allows you to choose the level of system
interaction and feedback. Standard is the
default and provides the most interaction and
feedback using prompts. Advanced uses less
feedback and prompts.
Voice Recognition Confirmation allows
you to choose level of voice command
confirmation. Selecting On causes the system
to ask you to confirm a command. Selecting
Off causes the system to ask for confirmation
less frequently.
Voice Recognition User Profile allows you
to switch between user profiles.
Train the system to recognize your voice
better. You can create two profiles. See Using
voice recognition earlier in this section.
Manage Voice Rec. User profiles allows
you to edit Profile 1 or 2 by creating a new
profile or deleting a previously created profile.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 421
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If you select: You can:
System Settings Language allows you to choose between
English, Spanish and French.
Units allows you to choose between English
and Metric measurements.
Keyboard Layout allows you to choose
between an ABC and QWERTY keyboard.
Delete Stored Items allows you to choose
to delete all of the entries from Address Book,
Previous Destinations, Avoid Areas, Saved
Photos and Voice Recognition Profiles. Touch
View to see what entries have been stored.
Restore Factory Default Settings allows
you to restore factory default settings.
Valet Mode Lock and unlock the system using a four-digit
PIN.
Note: You can reset the PIN by
simultaneously pressing and holding presets 1
and 5 while on the PIN entry screen. After
approximately five seconds, the system
transitions to the valet mode screen indicating
that you reset the PIN. Once you have reset
the PIN, the system then allows you to set a
new PIN.
Voice Control Set the system to listen automatically for USB
or SYNC voice commands first. This
eliminates the need to say “USB” or “User
Device” before any SYNC media commands.
422 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ENTERTAINMENT
Your system offers many media options. You can access these options
using the touchscreen or voice commands.
AM/FM Radio
Press the RADIO hard button.
To change between AM, FM1 and FM2, touch the AM or FM
tab. You can also access satellite radio by pressing this button.
See Sirius satellite radio later in this section for more information.
When you select: You can:
Show Options Scan allows you to hear a brief sampling of
all radio stations.
Scan Presets allows you to hear a brief
sampling of all stations stored in the memory
presets.
Autoset Presets allows you to store the
strongest local stations available in the AM
and FM frequency bands.
HD Radio turns HD radio on. This allows you
to receive radio broadcasts digitally (where
available), providing free, crystal-clear sound.
See the HD Radio™ information in the
following section.
*
Multicast allows you to choose which HD
radio broadcast you would like to receive.
When HD Radio broadcasts are available, this
button appears if the selected station has
more than one digital broadcast. HD1 signifies
the main programming status and is available
in analog and digital broadcasts. Any
additional multicast stations (HD2 through
HD8) broadcast digitally. You can access these
by pressing Multicast. See the HD Radio™
information in the following section.
**
Navigation System (If Equipped) 423
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
Show Presets View the preset stations. Save a station by
pressing and holding one of the memory
preset areas. There is a brief mute while the
radio saves the station. Sound returns when
finished.
Set PTY/All Select a category of music you would like to
search for and then choose to either seek or
scan for the stations.
**
Note: The system scans the frequency band
three times for the chosen program type.
If the program type is unavailable in your
reception range, the system returns to the
previous station.
*
This feature is only available in the United States.
**
This feature is only available on the FM1 and FM2 radio tabs in the
United States.
Audio and Radio Voice Commands
If you are listening to the audio system, press the voice button
on the steering wheel control. When prompted, say any of the
commands in the following chart.
If you are not listening to the audio system, press the voice button and,
after the tone, say “Audio”, then any of the commands in the following
chart.
“AUDIO”
“CD” “Line in” “Sirius”
“Disc” “Off “SYNC”
“DVD” “On” “USB”
“Headphones” “Phone” “User Device”
“Headphones off” “Radio” “Video CD”
“Jukebox” “Read Message” “Help”
424 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If you are listening to the radio, press the voice button on the
steering wheel control. When prompted, say any of the
commands in the following chart.
If you are not listening to the radio, press the voice button and, after the
tone, say “Radio”, then any of the commands in the following chart.
“RADIO”
“<530–1710>” “FM2” “Store preset <1–6>”
“<87.7–107.9>” “FM2 preset <1–6>” “Store AM preset
<1–6>”
“AM” “Off “Store FM 1 preset
<1–6>”
“AM <530–1710>” “On” “Store FM 2 preset
<1–6>”
“AM preset <1–6>” “Preset <1–6>” “Store autoset presets”
“FM <87.7–107.9>” “Seek down” “Tune”
**
“FM1” “Seek up” “Help”
“FM1 preset <1–6>” “Store”
*
*
If you have said, “Store”, see the following “Store” chart.
**
If you have said, “Tune”, see the following “Tune” chart.
“TUNE”
“<530–1710>” “AM preset <1–6>” “FM2”
“<87.7–107.9>” “FM <87.7–107.9>” “FM2 preset <1–6>”
“AM” “FM1” “Preset <1–6>”
“AM <530–1710>” “FM1 preset <1–6>” “Help”
“STORE”
“Preset <1–6>”
“AM preset <1–6>”
“FM 1 preset <#>”
“FM 2 preset <#>”
“Autoset presets”
Navigation System (If Equipped) 425
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
HD Radio™ Information (If Available)
Note: HD Radio broadcasts are not available in all markets.
HD Radio technology is the digital evolution of analog AM/FM radio. Your
system has a special receiver that allows it to receive digital broadcasts
(where available) in addition to the analog broadcasts, it already
receives. Digital broadcasts provide a better sound quality than analog
broadcasts with free, crystal-clear audio and no static or distortion. For
more information, and a guide to available stations and programming,
please visit www.hdradio.com.
When HD Radio is on and you tune to a station broadcasting HD Radio
technology, you may notice the following indicators on your screen:
HD) logo blinks when acquiring a digital station and stays solid
when digital audio is playing. When this logo is available, you
may also see Title and Artist fields on-screen.
Multicast indicator appears in FM mode (only) if the current station is
broadcasting multiple digital broadcasts. The highlighted numbers signify
available digital channels where new or different content is available.
HD1 signifies the main programming status and is available in analog and
digital broadcasts. Other multicast stations (HD2 through HD7) are only
available digitally.
When HD Radio broadcasts are active, you can access the following
functions:
When you select: You can:
Scan Hear a brief sampling of all available stations.
This feature still works when HD Radio
reception is on, although it does not scan for
HD2-HD7 channels. You may see the HD logo
appear if the station has a digital broadcast.
Seek Hear the next strong radio station.
If the current station has multiple digital
broadcasts, the multicast indicator appears.
Press Seek repeatedly to advance through all
available broadcasts. If you are on the last
multicast channel, press Seek to advance to
the next strong station.
426 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
Tune Go up and down the frequency in individual
increments.
If the current station has multiple digital
broadcasts, the multicast indicator appears.
Press Tune repeatedly to advance through all
available broadcasts. If you are on the last
broadcast channel, press to advance to the
next frequency on the band.
Set PTY/All Select a category of music you would like to
search for and then choose to either seek or
scan for the stations.
Note: The system scans the frequency band
three times for the chosen program type.
If the program type is unavailable in your
reception range, the system returns to the
previous station.
Multicast Allows you to choose which HD radio
broadcast you would like to receive. When HD
Radio broadcasts are available, this button
appears if the selected station has more than
one digital broadcast. HD1 signifies the main
programming status and is available in analog
and digital broadcasts. Any additional
multicast stations (HD2 through HD8)
broadcast digitally. You can access these by
pressing Multicast.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 427
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
To save a multicast
station as a preset
When the channel is active on-screen, press
and hold a memory preset slot until the sound
returns. There is a brief mute while the radio
saves the station. Sound returns when
finished. When recalling a HD2 or HD3
memory preset, there is a mute before the
digital audio plays, as the system must once
again acquire the digital signal.
As with any saved radio station, you cannot
access the saved station if your vehicle is
outside the station’s reception area.
HD Radio Reception and Station Troubleshooting
Potential Reception Issues
Reception area If you are listening to a multicast station and
you are on the fringe of the reception area,
the station may mute due to weak signal
strength.
If you are listening to HD1, the system
switches back to the analog broadcast until
the digital broadcast is available again.
However, if you are listening to any of the
possible HD2-HD7 multicast channels, the
station mutes and stay muted unless it is able
to connect to the digital signal again.
Station blending When the system first receives a station
(aside from HD2-HD7 multicast stations), it
first plays the station in the analog version.
Once the receiver verifies the station is an HD
Radio station, it shifts to the digital version.
Depending on the station quality, you may
hear a slight sound change when the station
changes from analog to digital. Blending is the
shift from analog to digital sound or digital
back to analog sound.
428 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
In order to provide the best possible experience, use the contact form to
report any station issues found while listening to a station broadcasting
with HD Radio technology. Independent entities own and operate each
station. These stations are responsible for ensuring all audio streams and
data fields are accurate.
Potential Station Issues
Issue Cause Action
Echo, stutter, skip or
repeat in audio.
Increase or decrease
in audio volume.
This is poor time
alignment by the radio
broadcaster.
No action required.
This is a broadcast
issue.
Sound fading or
blending in and out.
The radio is shifting
between analog and
digital audio.
No action required.
The reception issue
may clear up as you
continue to drive.
There is an audio
mute delay when
selecting HD2 or HD3,
multicast preset or
Direct Tune.
The digital multicast is
not available until the
HD Radio broadcast is
decoded. Once
decoded, the audio is
available.
No action required.
This is normal
behavior. Wait until
the audio is available.
Cannot access HD2 or
HD3 multicast channel
when recalling a
preset or from a direct
tune.
The previously stored
multicast preset or
direct tune is not
available in your
current reception area.
No action required.
The station is not
available in your
current location.
Text information does
not match currently
playing audio.
Data service issue by
the radio broadcaster.
Fill out the station
issue form at website
listed below.
*
There is no text
information shown for
currently selected
frequency.
Data service issue by
the radio broadcaster
Fill out the station
issue form at website
listed below.
*
HD2-HD7 stations not
found when Scan is
pressed.
Pressing Scan disables
HD2-HD7 channel
search.
No action required.
This is normal
behavior.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 429
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
*
http://www.ibiquity.com/automotive/report_radio_station_experiences
HD Radio Technology manufactured under license from iBiquity Digital
Corp. U.S. and foreign patents. HD Radio and the HD and HD Radio
logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp. Ford Motor
Company and iBiquity Digital Corp. are not responsible for the content
sent using HD Radio technology. Content may be changed, added or
deleted at any time at the station owner’s discretion.
HD Radio Voice Commands
If you are listening to the radio, press the voice button on
the steering wheel control. When prompted, say any of the
commands in the following chart.
If you are not listening to the radio, press the voice button and, after the
tone, say “Radio”, then any of the commands in the following chart.
“RADIO”
“<87.7 - 107.9> HD <1–8>”
“FM <87.7-107.9> HD <1-8>”
“Tune”
*
“Help”
*
If you have said, “Tune”, see the following “Tune” chart.
“TUNE”
“<87.7 - 107.9> HD <1–8>”
“FM <87.7-107.9> HD <1-8>”
“Tune HD <1-8>”
“Help”
430 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Sirius® Satellite Radio (If Activated)
Press the RADIO hard button, then select SAT on the
touchscreen.
When you select: You can:
SAT123 Press this button to access three different
satellite radio modes (SAT1, SAT2 or SAT3).
Scan Press this button to hear a brief sampling of
all satellite radio channels within the current
genre.
Scan Presets Press these buttons to hear a brief sampling
of all channels stored in the memory presets.
Channel Guide See a list of channels sorted by genre and
also skip or lock out certain channels. Select
the desired genre and choose a channel by
pressing the channel name button. You can
then choose to Skip or Lock a certain
channel. A skipped channel is not accessible
using the tune knob, scan or seek functions.
(To access the skipped channel, select Direct
Tune and enter the channel number.) You can
only access a locked channel by entering the
Channel Guide and then entering the system’s
PIN.
Direct Tune Enter the desired satellite channel number
using the on-screen keypad.
Set Genre Press this button to choose from a list of
genres. Once you choose a genre, and you
press SEEK, it only looks for channels in that
genre.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 431
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
Memo Press this button to save a song title and
artist to the system. When the saved song is
playing on any satellite radio channel, the
system alerts you with a pop-up in the lower
status bar. You can either tune to the station
or ignore the pop-up. When you are in the
Memo screen, the following options are
available:
Refresh allows you to refresh the current
artist and title information.
Song Alert allows you to store the song
information displayed in the Title Field. The
next time the stored song plays, the system
displays an audio and visual notification.
Artist Alert allows you to store the artist
information currently displayed in the Artist
Field. The next time the artist plays, the
system alerts you with a pop-up.
Alert On/Off allows you to select Artists and
Titles that you would like the system to alert
you to when they are playing on other
channels.
Note: Sirius® does not support the Alert
feature on all channels. Ford Motor Company
shall not be responsible for Alert feature
variation.
Show Presets Display presets at the bottom of the screen.
432 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Sirius® Satellite Radio Voice Commands
If you are listening to Sirius satellite radio, press the voice
button on the steering wheel control. When prompted, say any
of the commands in the following chart.
If you are not listening to Sirius satellite radio, press the voice button
and, after the tone, say “Sirius”, then any of the commands in the
following chart.
“Sirius”
“<0–233>” “Seek up”
“<Channel name>” “Sirius off”
“Preset <#>” “Sirius On”
“SAT 1” “Store”
*
“SAT 1 preset <#>” “Store preset <1–6>”
“SAT 2” “Store SAT1 preset <1–6>”
“SAT 2 preset <#>” “Store SAT2 preset <1–6>”
“SAT 3” “Store SAT3 preset <1–6>”
“SAT 3 preset <#>” “Tune”
**
“Seek down “Help”
*
If you have said, “Store”, see the following “Store” chart.
**
If you have said, “Tune”, see the following “Tune” chart.
“STORE”
“Preset <1–6>”
“SAT1 preset <1–6>”
“SAT2 preset <1–6>”
“SAT3 preset <1–6>”
“TUNE”
“<0–233>” “SAT 2”
“<Channel name>” “SAT 2 preset <#>”
“Preset <#>” “SAT 3”
“SAT 1” “SAT 3 preset <#>”
“SAT 1 preset <#>” “Help”
Navigation System (If Equipped) 433
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Sirius® Information
Note: Sirius reserves the unrestricted right to change, rearrange, add or
delete programming including canceling, moving or adding particular
channels, and its prices, at any time, with or without notice to you. Ford
Motor Company shall not be responsible for any such programming
changes.
Sirius satellite radio is a
subscription-based satellite radio
service that broadcasts a variety of
music, sports, news, weather, traffic
and entertainment programming.
Your factory-installed Sirius satellite
radio system includes hardware and
a limited subscription term that begins on the date of sale or lease of
your vehicle. See an authorized dealer for availability.
For more information on extended subscription terms (a service fee is
required), the online media player and a list of Sirius satellite radio
channels, and other features, please visit www.siriusxm.com in the
United States, www.sirius.ca in Canada, or call Sirius at 1-888-539-7474.
Satellite radio electronic serial number (ESN): You need your ESN
to turn on, modify or track your satellite radio account. The ESN is on
the System Information Screen (SR ESN: XXXXXXXXXXXX). To access
your ESN, touch the I button on the navigation screen, and then select
the System Info tab.
Potential reception issues
Antenna
obstructions
For optimal reception performance, keep the
antenna clear of snow and ice build-up and
keep luggage and other materials as far away
from the antenna as possible.
Terrain Hills, mountains, tall buildings, bridges,
tunnels, freeway overpasses, parking garages,
dense tree foliage and thunderstorms can
interfere with your reception.
Station overload When you pass a ground-based
broadcast-repeating tower, a stronger signal
may overtake a weaker one and the audio
system may mute.
434 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Potential reception issues
Satellite radio signal
interference
Your display may show ACQUIRING... to
indicate the interference and the audio
system may mute.
Troubleshooting tips
Radio Display Condition Possible Action
Acquiring... Radio requires more
than two seconds to
produce audio for the
selected channel.
No action required.
This message should
disappear shortly.
Sat Fault/Sirius
System Failure
There is an internal
module or system
failure present.
If this message does
not clear shortly, or
with an ignition key
cycle, your receiver
may have a fault.
See an authorized
dealer for service.
Invalid Channel. The channel is no
longer available.
Tune to another
channel or choose
another preset.
Unsubscribed Channel. Your subscription does
not include this
channel.
Contact Sirius at
1-888-539-7474 to
subscribe to the
channel, or tune to
another channel.
No Signal. The signal is lost from
the Sirius satellite or
Sirius tower to your
vehicle antenna.
The signal is blocked.
When you move into
an open area, the
signal should return.
Updating. Update of channel
programming in
progress.
No action required.
The process may take
up to three minutes.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 435
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Troubleshooting tips
Radio Display Condition Possible Action
Call Sirius
1–888–539–7474.
Your satellite service is
no longer available.
Contact Sirius at
1-888-539-7474 to
resolve subscription
issues.
No Channels Available. All the channels in the
selected channels are
either skipped or
locked.
Use the channel guide
to turn off the Lock
or Skip function on
that station.
Subscription Updated. Sirius has updated the
channels available for
your vehicle.
No action required.
CD
Press the MEDIA hard button, and then select the CD tab on
the touchscreen. If there is no disc in the system, NO DISC
appears in the status bar and you cannot access the CD screen.
Once a disc is loaded, you can choose from Scan, Compress, Repeat,
Shuffle, Track List and Record.
When you select: You can:
Scan Hear a brief sampling of all listenable tracks.
Compress Turn the compression feature on and off. This
feature boosts more quiet music and lowers
louder music to minimize the need for volume
adjustment.
Repeat Hear the selected track continuously.
Shuffle Play the tracks in a random order.
Track List View a list of the tracks.
Record Save the CD or CD tracks into the Jukebox to
hear them played later.
436 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
CD Voice Commands
If you are listening to a CD, press the voice button on the
steering wheel control. When prompted, say any of the
commands in the following chart.
If you are not listening to a CD, press the voice button and, after the
tone, say “CD”, then any of the commands in the following chart.
“CD”
“Folder mode” “Play next folder” “Repeat folder”
“Folder mode off” “Play next track” “Repeat off”
“Pause” “Play previous folder” “Repeat track”
“Play” “Play previous track” “Shuffle”
“Play folder <1–255>” “Play track <1–512>” “Shuffle off”
“Play folder <1–255>
track <1–512>”
“Repeat” “Help”
MP3
Press the MEDIA hard button, and then select the CD tab on
the touchscreen. If there is no disc in the system, NO DISC
appears in the status bar and you cannot access the CD screen.
Once a disc is loaded, you can choose from Scan, Compress, Repeat,
Shuffle, Folder Mode and Folder List.
When you select: You can:
Scan Hear a brief sampling of all listenable tracks.
Compress Turn the compression feature on and off. This
feature boosts more quiet music and lowers
louder music to minimize the need for volume
adjustment.
Repeat Hear the selected track continuously.
Shuffle Play the tracks in a random order.
Folder Mode Listen to and seek through songs within the
current folder.
Folder List
Press this button to access and view folders on
the disc. Select the root folder (if available),
then any other folder on the disc.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 437
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
DVD
Note: Your system only plays NTSC formatted discs. The system does
not support PAL format.
Your system allows you to play DVD audio and video discs. Make sure
your vehicle is in position P (vehicles equipped with an automatic
transmission) or the parking brake is engaged (vehicles equipped with a
manual transmission). This allows you to be able to view and hear the
DVD. If your vehicle is moving, the video does not play.
When you select: You can:
Title Go to the disc’s main title screen.
Menu Go to the disc’s main menu.
Cursor Controls Navigate to the desired menu selections.
Settings Video Display Settings allows you to adjust
the brightness and contrast. You can also
choose to return to the default settings by
pressing Restore Default.
Audio Language allows you to choose which
language you would like the DVD audio track
to play in.
Subtitle Display allows you to turn subtitles
off and on.
Subtitle Language allows you to choose the
subtitle language.
Aspect Ratio allows you to choose wide, full,
normal or cinema display.
Angle Mark Notification allows you to have
more viewing angles from which to select.
Once you have made your selection, press
ENTER to confirm.
Search Go to a specific title or chapter using the
keypad.
Note: Some of the above settings are disc-dependent and availability and
operation may vary.
438 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
During disc play, you can also touch
the screen to access the virtual
remote, which allows you to Move
Controls on the screen, as well as
use the cursor controls, Enter and
Return to navigate and select within
the menus.
Dolby noise reduction is manufactured under license from Dolby
Laboratories Licensing Corporation. Dolby and the double-D symbol are
registered trademarks of Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation.
Disc Voice Commands
If you are listening to or watching a disc, press the voice button
on the steering wheel control. When prompted, say any of the
commands in the following chart.
If you are not listening to or watching a disc, press the voice button and,
after the tone, say “Disc”, then any of the commands in the following
chart.
“Disc”
“Folder mode” “Play next chapter” “Play previous track”
“Folder mode off” “Play next folder” “Play title <1–99>”
“Menu” “Play next group” “Play track <1–512>”
“Pause” “Play next title” “Repeat”
“Play” “Play next track” “Repeat off”
“Play chapter
<1–999>”
“Play previous
chapter”
“Shuffle”
“Play folder <1–255>” “Play previous folder” “Shuffle off”
“Play folder <1–255>
track <1–512>”
“Play previous group” “Title menu”
“Play group <1–9>” “Play previous title” “Help”
Navigation System (If Equipped) 439
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
DVD Voice Commands
If you are watching a DVD, press the voice button on the
steering wheel control. When prompted, say any of the
commands in the following chart.
If you are not watching a DVD, press the voice button and, after the
tone, say “DVD”, then any of the commands in the following chart.
“DVD”
“Menu” “Play next title”
“Menu title” “Play next track <1–512>”
“Pause” “Play previous chapter”
“Play” “Play previous title”
“Play chapter <1–999>” “Play previous track”
“Play group <1–9>” “Play title <1–99>”
“Play next chapter” “Repeat”
“Play next group” “Repeat off”
Video CD Voice Commands
If you are watching a video CD, press the voice button on the
steering wheel control. When prompted, say any of the
commands in the following chart.
If you are not watching a video CD, press the voice button and, after the
tone, say “Video CD”, then any of the commands in the following chart.
Video CD voice commands
“Play”
“Pause”
“Play next track”
“Play previous track”
“Play track <1–512>”
“Help”
440 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Jukebox
Your system has a Jukebox feature, which allows you to save desired
tracks or CDs to the hard drive for later access. The hard drive can
store up to 10 GB* (164 hours; approximately 2472 tracks) of music.
The system contains a Gracenote media database that allows for display
of song title, album title, and album cover art. After saving music to the
hard drive, you can access and play your music by specific tracks, artists,
albums or genres. You can even choose to create and access your own
playlists.
*Note: 1 GB equals one billion bytes (1000000000B).
Recording Music to Your Jukebox
To record music to your jukebox:
1. Insert a CD, and then select Record on the touchscreen.
2. Select individual tracks or press Select All to record the entire CD.
Note: The system automatically saves all tracks if you do not select
any.
3. Press the Start Recording button.
The progress shows at the bottom of the screen.
Note: If you are not actively listening to the disc during recording, the
record rate is much quicker (as fast as five minutes).
Accessing the Music in Your Jukebox
Once you have saved music to your jukebox, you can then choose
different ways to play the music.
1. Press the MEDIA hard button on the navigation system.
2. Select the Jukebox tab on the touchscreen. You can then select from
the following options:
When you select: You can:
Scan Hear a brief sampling of all listenable tracks.
Repeat Hear the selected track continuously.
Shuffle Play the tracks in a random order.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 441
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
When you select: You can:
Music library Access all of your saved music. You can
choose to view or play the material in the
following ways:
Play All Tracks allows you to play all tracks
saved in the jukebox.
Playlist allows you to play your own playlist.
Play genre allows you to have the system
play only music from a specific genre.
Play artist allows you to have the system
play only music by a specific artist.
Play album allows you to have the system
play only music from a specific album.
Options Edit Playlists allows you to edit your
playlists.
Edit Music Library Contents allows you to
make changes to the content in your music
library.
Update Album Information from CD
Database allows you to update the residing
album information from the Gracenote
database after a recent software update.
Hard Disk Drive Information allows you to
access the system’s hard drive disc
information, such as used space, free space
and total capacity.
CD Database Information allows you to
access the CD database information.
442 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Creating a Playlist
Press the MEDIA hard button, and then select the Jukebox tab on the
touchscreen.
1. Select Options.
2. Select Edit Playlists, then which playlist you would like to create.
3.
Select which category you would like to access from your saved music.
4. Select the desired songs and then press Add. The system shows you the
currently selected songs. You can choose to Edit Name to change the
name of the playlist, Delete Playlist to remove it, Add Tracks to the
playlist or Sort Playlist.
5. After you change the playlist, select Edit Name to rename your playlist.
Jukebox Voice Commands
If you are listening to music stored in the jukebox, press the
voice button on the steering wheel control. When prompted, say
any of the commands in the following chart.
If you are not listening to music stored in the jukebox, press the voice
button and, after the tone, say “Jukebox”, then any of the commands in
the following chart.
“JUKEBOX”
“Pause” “Play playlist <name>” “Search album
<name>”
3
“Play”
1
“Play previous track” “Search artist
<name>”
3
“Play album <name>”
1
“Play track <name>”
1
“Search genre
<name>”
3
“Play artist <name>”
1
“Refine album
<name>”
2
“Search track
<name>”
3
“Play genre <name>” “Refine artist
<name>”
2
“Shuffle”
“Play next track” “Repeat” “Shuffle off”
“Play playlist <1–5>” “Repeat off” “Help”
1
You can say these commands at any time during listening to the jukebox
and after any of the search and refine commands.
2
You can narrow your search beyond the “Search” command by using
these commands.
3
While listening to the jukebox, press the voice button on the steering
wheel control. When prompted, you may say any of these commands.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 443
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
User Device
If your vehicle is equipped with SYNC, there is a User Device tab.
For more information, see the SYNC chapter.
Line In (Auxiliary Input Jack)
Your vehicle is equipped with an audio input jack, which allows you to
plug a portable audio device into your vehicle’s audio system. To turn
this feature on, press the MEDIA hard button on the system.
For more information on the auxiliary input jack, see Auxiliary input
jack in the Audio Systems chapter.
INFORMATION
Under the Information menu, you can access features such as Where Am
I? and Sirius Travel Link, view your calendar, see system information and
get basic system help.
Press the I (Information) hard button to access these features.
Where Am I?
Press the I button and select the Where Am I? tab. The system gives you
your current GPS location (latitude and longitude), the current street
you are on as well as the street in front and behind your vehicle position
along with distance information.
Note: Not all tab selections shown here are available in all markets.
Check with an authorized dealer for availability.
Sirius® Travel Link™
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle
control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use
extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off
the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your
vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while
driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible.
Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the
use of electronic devices while driving.
Note: A paid subscription is required to access and use these features.
Go to www.siriusxm.com/travellink for more information.
Sirius Travel Link can help you locate the best gas prices, find movie
listings, get current traffic alerts, access the current weather map, get
accurate ski conditions and scores to current sports games.
444 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Press the I (information) button, then select Sirius Travel Link.
Choose from any of the following services:
When you select: You can:
Traffic On Route Identify traffic incidents on your route, nearby
your vehicle’s current location or near any of
your favorite places (if programmed).
Traffic Nearby
My Places
Weather View the nearby weather, current weather, or
the 5–day forecast for the chosen area. Select
Weather Map to see storms, radar
information, charts and winds. Select Area
to select from a listing of weather locations.
In addition, you can view ski conditions for a
specific area.
Fuel Prices View fuel prices at stations close to your
vehicle’s location or on an active navigation
route.
Movie Listings View nearby movie theaters and their show
times (if available).
Sports Info. View scores and schedules from a variety of
sports. You can also save up to 10 favorite
teams for easier access. The score
automatically refreshes when a game is in
progress.
Sirius Travel Link Voice Commands
Press the voice button and, after the tone, say “Travel Link”,
then any of the commands in the following chart:
“TRAVEL LINK”
“5–day weather forecast” “NBA schedule”
“Baseball schedule” “NBA scores”
“Baseball scores” “NFL schedule”
“College basketball schedule” “NFL scores”
“College basketball scores” “NHL schedule”
“College football schedule” “NHL scores”
Navigation System (If Equipped) 445
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
“TRAVEL LINK”
“College football scores” “Sports schedule”
*
“Fuel prices” “Sports scores”
**
“Golf leaders” “Traffic”
“Golf schedule” “Travel link help”
“Motor sports order” “Weather”
“Motor sports schedule” “Weather map”
“Movie listings”
*
If you have said, “Sports schedule”, you may say any of the commands
in the “Sports schedule” chart:
**
If you have said, “Sports scores”, you may say any of the commands in
the “Sports scores” chart:
“SPORTS SCHEDULES”
“Baseball schedule” “NBA schedule”
“College basketball schedule” “NFL schedule”
“College football schedule” “NHL schedule”
“Golf schedule” “Travel link help”
“Motor sports schedule”
“SPORTS SCORES”
“Baseball scores” “NBA scores”
“College basketball scores” “NFL scores”
“College football scores” “NHL scores”
“Golf leaderboard” “Travel link help”
“Motor sports results”
Calendar
Press the I (information) button, then select Calendar. You can
then select which month you would like to view by using the
arrow buttons or selecting Go to Today.
You can view calendars from one previous year and the next 10 years.
Note: Not all tab selections may be available in all markets. Check with
an authorized dealer for availability.
446 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
System Information
Press the I (information) button, then select System
Information.
In this screen, you can view the following options:
Phone number for your Customer Service Center
Current system versions installed
Current Sirius Radio ESN
Sirius Travel Link ESN.
Note: Not all tab selections may be available in all markets. Check with
an authorized dealer for availability.
Help
The Help screen allows you to view basic information about controls and
driving restrictions as well as traffic legend information and basic voice
commands available in various modes.
If you select: You can:
Basic Operation View hard buttons on your navigation system.
Press the desired icon to view the button
description.
Driving Restriction View the system’s driving restriction.
Traffic Legend View the color code for the Speed and Flow
of roads on the navigation system. You can
also select Traffic Incidents to help you
differentiate between viewed and unviewed
incidents.
Voice Commands View a brief listing of possible voice
commands in a specific mode.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 447
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SOUND
The sound menu allows you to access and adjust settings, such as Bass,
Treble, Fade, Balance, Speed Compensated Volume (SCV) and the
visualizer. Press the SOUND hard button.
When you select: You can:
Bass/Treble Increase or decrease levels by pressing + or -.
Balance/Fade Adjust the sound between the left and right
speakers and front and rear speakers.
SCV Have the system automatically adjust radio
volume according to vehicle speed to
compensate for road and wind noise. Select a
level of compensation between 1 and 7 by
pressing the corresponding button.
Visualizer Turn the audio visualizer display on or off.
Note: Turning the visualizer setting to off
does not remove the visualizer on the home
screen. You need to select a different view in
order to remove the visualizer.
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Your navigation system allows you to set a destination by using your
touchscreen or voice commands.
The navigation system contains map coverage for the United States,
Puerto Rico and U.S. Virgin Islands, Canada and Mexico.
Disclaimer
A disclaimer appears once per ignition cycle when the DEST button is
pressed. Press Accept to agree to the terms and access navigation
functions. If you do not press Accept, you only have access to
non-navigation functions. The disclaimer has information similar to the
following:
Always obey local traffic regulations.
We recommend you program the system only when your vehicle is at
a stop.
Some functions are unavailable while your vehicle is moving to help
minimize distraction.
Periodic map updates are available at an additional cost.
448 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Route Guidance in Incompletely Mapped Areas
There are some rural areas in the map database without fully verified
roads. When the system is in route guidance mode, and the navigation
system encounters these incompletely mapped areas, the system alerts
you by:
Announcing, “Entering an area with incomplete map data; please
follow with caution”
Saying, “with caution” in the first route guidance instruction before
each turn
Highlighting the route on the map in yellow
Highlighting the incomplete mapped streets in yellow on the turn list
Coloring the guidance arrows yellow.
Please drive using extra caution when driving in these areas as the
mapping information may be somewhat inaccurate.
Programming a Destination Using the Touchscreen
1. Press the DEST hard button.
2. Select from the following:
Quick
Note: Items on this screen are selectable at any speed.
Cancel Route Touch this button to cancel the current route.
Emergency Touch this button to find hospitals and police
stations close to your vehicle’s location. The
system may display up to 25 locations.
Favorite Destinations This feature stores your home location and up to
five address book entries. To set an entry, touch
a preset button, and then follow the screen
prompts. The system displays the icon and name
associated with the location.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 449
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Quick
Note: Items on this screen are selectable at any speed.
Find Nearest POI Select up to five different points of interest
(POI) favorites that you can search for while
your vehicle is moving. You can change these
categories at any time but the default categories
are:
Gas Station
ATM
Restaurant
Accommodations
Parking Garage
When you select a category, the system displays
a list in order of distance from your vehicle’s
location. The Quick POI search range
automatically increases to a 50 mile (80 km)
radius if no point of interest is found within the
default 25 mile (40 km) radius.
You also have the option to select List All
Categories, which displays a list of all categories.
Previous Destination Touch this button to select one of your previous
destinations.
Address Book Touch this button to set an entry in your address
book as your destination.
Standard
Note: Items on this screen are selectable only when your vehicle is
moving at speeds slower than 5 mph (8 km/h).
Address Book You can store up to 25 entries, which you can
use as destinations, waypoints and areas to
avoid. You can sort the entries alphabetically,
by date or icon.
*
Previous
Destination
You can store up to 20 recently used
destinations and waypoints. Duplicate entries
do not appear in the list. Adding a new entry
deletes the oldest one from the list.
*
Phone Number Touch this button to search for a destination
using the phone number of a saved point of
interest or address book entry. Use the keypad
on the screen to enter the phone number.
450 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Standard
Note: Items on this screen are selectable only when your vehicle is
moving at speeds slower than 5 mph (8 km/h).
Map Touch this button to select a point on the map
as a destination or waypoint by using the map
cursor.
Street Address Touch this button to program a street address
as a destination or waypoint.
State/Prov lets you use the keyboard to
type or you can select the area to search from
a list. The system bases the search on your
vehicle’s current position or the previous
selection. You can set the Auto Fill feature on
to have the system fill in some information for
you based on readings from your vehicle’s
GPS. Depending on your settings, the system
may automatically fill in some of the location
information for you.
City is the name of the city of your
destination.
Street is the name of the street where your
destination is located. You can search for
street names, which include numbers, such as
Second Street, if the name is entered using
digits or a spelling of the number. This is valid
for street names containing numbers 1 (One)
through 20 (Twenty) or 1st (First) through
20th (Twentieth) only.
Number is the address number.
List is where you can view and select from
a list of State, Province, Territories, Cities and
Names. The system provides a list based on
the first letter you type into a field.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 451
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Standard
Note: Items on this screen are selectable only when your vehicle is
moving at speeds slower than 5 mph (8 km/h).
Point of Interest
(POI)
Touch this button to select a point of interest
on the map as a destination or waypoint.
There are three ways to search for a point of
interest:
1. Enter a city name in the City field and a
point of interest in the Name field.
2. Enter a city name in the City field, choose a
point of interest category by selecting
Category, and then enter the point of interest
name in the Name field. You can also press
List. However, if there are more than 999
choices, this option is not possible.
3. Choose a category from the point of interest
by selecting Category and enter a point of
interest name in the Name field.
State/Prov lets you use the keyboard to
type or you can select the area to search from
a list. The system bases the search on your
vehicle’s current position or the previous
selection. You can set the Auto Fill feature on
to have the system fill in some information for
you. Depending on your settings, the system
may automatically fill in some of the location
information for you.
City is the name of the city.
Category is where you select the desired
point of interest category or subcategory.
Name is where you select to search for a
point of interest using a full or partial name.
List is where you can view and select from
a list of State, Province, Territories, Cities and
Names. The system provides a list based on
the first letter you type into a field.
452 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Standard
Note: Items on this screen are selectable only when your vehicle is
moving at speeds slower than 5 mph (8 km/h).
Freeway
Entrance/Exit
Touch this button to select an entrance and
exit point to a freeway you select. You can sort
the entrance and exit point alphabetically or in
order of distance from your vehicle’s position.
You can then select the point you choose as a
destination or waypoint.
State/Prov lets you use the keyboard to
type or you can select the area to search from
a list. The system bases the search on your
vehicle’s current position or the previous
selection. You can set the Auto Fill feature on
to have the system fill in some information for
you. Depending on your settings, the system
may automatically fill in some of the location
information for you.
Freeway is the name of the freeway you
can search.
List is where you can view and select from
a list of State, Province, Territories, Cities and
Names. The system provides a list based on
the first letter you type into a field.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 453
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Standard
Note: Items on this screen are selectable only when your vehicle is
moving at speeds slower than 5 mph (8 km/h).
Intersection Touch this button to select an intersection
point. Enter the name of the first street, then
the first letter of the second street. The
system displays possible intersection matches
based on the first letter of the second street.
Once you choose the intersection, you can sort
the list alphabetically or in order of distance
from your vehicle’s position.
State/Prov lets you use the keyboard to
type or you can select the area to search from
a list. The system bases the search on your
vehicle’s current position or the previous
selection. You can set the Auto Fill feature on
to have the system fill in some information for
you. Depending on your settings, the system
may automatically fill in some of the location
information for you.
City is the name of the city you can search.
Street # 1 is the name of the first street
you can search. You can search for street
names, which include numbers, such as
Second Street, if the name is entered using
digits or a spelling of the number. This is valid
for street names containing numbers 1 (One)
through 20 (Twenty) or 1st (First) through
20th (Twentieth) only.
Street # 2 is the field where you enter the
first letter of the second street to search.
List is where you can view and select from
a list of State, Province, Territories, Cities and
Names. The system provides a list based on
the first letter you type into a field.
454 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
*
To delete all stored Address Book and Previous Destination entries at
once:
1. Press the MENU hard button.
2. Select the System Settings tab.
3. Press the View button for Delete Stored Items.
4. Select Address Book or Previous Destinations.
Edit Route
Cancel Route Touch this button to cancel the current route.
Detour Touch this button to avoid an area on the
current route.
View Route Touch this button to view the entire current
route. You can select from the following
options:
View Destination displays a close-up view
of the destination and surrounding area.
View Next Waypoint displays a close-up
view of next waypoint and surrounding area.
View Turn List displays the turn list for the
current destination. You can also select a road
on the turn list to avoid, if you choose.
Edit Route
Preferences
Once you select a route as the fastest or
shortest route, you can also select from to:
Avoid Freeways
Avoid Tollroads
Avoid Ferries
Avoid Time Restrictions
Avoid HOV Lanes
Edit Traffic
Preferences
Touch this button to edit traffic preferences.
*
Edit
Destination/Waypoints
Touch this button to edit the destination or
waypoints of a defined route.
Edit Turn List Touch this button to delete or avoid a road in
the current turn list.
*
This feature requires activation of Sirius Travel Link, which is only
available in the United States.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 455
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Programming a Destination Using Voice Commands
Press the voice button on the steering wheel.
If you want to: Say:
Enter an address. “Destination street address”
Enter an intersection. “Destination intersection”
Find a point of interest
(POI) by its category.
“Destination nearest <POI category>” or
“Destination nearest POI”
Find a point of interest
(POI) by its name.
“Destination POI”
Go to a previous
destination.
“Destination previous destination”
Go to your home
location.
“Destination home”
Use a nametag from
your address book.
“Destination <nametag>”
Get help. “Help”
Note: If you set the system language to French or Spanish, you need to
spell out the city and street names. When in Spelling Mode, you may
speak letters or say, “Line #”. The system works even if you have made a
spelling error.
POI Categories
Your system offers a variety of POI (Point of Interest) categories.
Main Categories
Food/Drink & Dining Automotive
Travel & Transportation Shopping
Financial Entertainment & Arts
Emergency Recreation & Sports
Community Government
Health & Medicine Domestic Services
456 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Within these main categories, there are subcategories, which contain
more listings:
Subcategories
Restaurant
Auto Dealership
Parking
Public Transit
Home & Garden
Education
Personal Care Services
Setting Your Navigation Preferences
Select settings for the system to take into account when planning your
route. Press the NAV hard button.
Map Preferences
Map Content Street Name displays current street name
during route guidance.
Time to Dest displays the distance to your
destination and the estimated time of arrival.
Speed Limit displays the speed limit of
major roads during route guidance.
Breadcrumbs displays your vehicle’s
previously traveled route with white dots.
The dots display for about the last 140 miles
(225 km) driven.
Point of Interest (POI) Icons displays
point of interest icons on the map.
Map View Full Map displays the map in full screen with
turn icons in the upper right corner.
Arrow/Map divides the screen in two.
The map is on the left and upcoming turn
information on the right.
Turn List/Map divides the screen in two. The
map is on the left and turn list on the right.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 457
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Map Preferences
Bird’s Eye View ON provides an elevated map perspective.
OFF turns the feature off.
Adjust Angle offers six different map angles.
Turn List Format Top-to-Bottom starts the turn instructions
from the top.
Bottom-to-Top starts the turn instructions
from the bottom.
Route Preferences
Preferred Route Have the system display the shortest or
fastest route first.
Avoid Freeways Have the system avoid freeways when
calculating a route.
Avoid Tollroads Have the system avoid tollroads when
calculating a route.
Avoid Ferries Have the system avoid ferries when
calculating a route.
Avoid Time
Restricted Roads
Have the system avoid time-restricted roads
when calculating a route. These roads may
have turn, lane or entrance restrictions based
on local traffic conditions or seasonal
restrictions.
458 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Traffic Preferences
*
Traffic Icons to
overlay on Map
Touch this button to display a list of map
icons that you can turn off and on. The list of
icons includes:
Weather related incidents
Road work
Incident
Accident
Closed road
Traffic Flow Overlay Touch this button to have the map show
traffic flow coloring on major roads. Roads
display in green (all clear), yellow (reduced
speed) and red (stopped).
Traffic Alert
Notification
Touch this button to have the system traffic
incidents notifications along your programmed
route.
If you select Yes, a traffic incident pop-up
asks you to consider or ignore the traffic
incident. If you select Ye s again, this makes
the system recalculate a new route for you.
If you select Ignore, this closes the pop-up
window.
*
This feature requires activation of Sirius Travel Link, which is only
available in the United States.
Navigation Preferences
Guidance Prompts Voice guides you with tones and voice
prompts only.
Tone only guides you with tones only.
OFF turns off any voice or tone prompts.
Auto-Fill
State/Province
When this feature is on, the system
automatically fills in the state or province
information based on your vehicle’s GPS
location. If you live in a border area, you may
not want this feature on.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 459
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Navigation Preferences
Avg. Speed:
Residential
When this feature is on, the system displays
the average speed on a residential road,
initially set to 25 mph (40 km/h). You can
change the setting for your driving
preferences. This setting helps estimate your
arrival time at a destination based on your
driving preferences.
Avg. Speed: Main
Roads
When this feature is on, the system displays
the average speed on a main road, initially set
to 45 mph (72 km/h). You can change the
setting for specific roads and for your driving
preferences. This setting helps estimate your
arrival time at a destination based on your
driving preferences.
Avg. Speed: Freeways When this feature is on, the system displays
the average speed on a freeway, initially set to
65 mph (105 km/h). You can change the
setting for specific roads and for your driving
preferences. This setting helps estimate your
arrival time at a destination based on your
driving preferences.
Parking POI
Notification
When this feature is on, the system displays
available parking accommodations around a
destination that is part of your route.
Low Fuel POI
Notification
When this feature is on, the system displays
gas station icons when the fuel level is low.
Fuel Price Display When this feature is on, the system displays
fuel prices at local stations. You can choose to
display prices for Unleaded or Diesel.
*
460 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Navigation Preferences
Calibrate Position allows you to adjust the direction of
your vehicle by pressing the arrow buttons on
the screen.
Distance allows you to recalibrate the
distance to the destination while your vehicle
is moving.
Restore Default
Settings
Touch the Reset button to return the settings
to factory defaults.
*
This feature requires activation of Sirius Travel Link, which is only
available in the United States.
Avoid Areas
Add Add items and areas that you want the
system to avoid when creating a route for
you. The system does its best to avoid these.
*
*
There may be some situations where it is impossible to avoid the
selection(s) completely. For example, if a destination or waypoint is
located in the area that is set to avoid, the system cannot avoid it.
Map Mode
Press the MAP hard button to view map mode. When in map mode, an
icon appears on the upper left side of the screen; this is a toggle button
to change the view of the map display.
Roads on the map display in a variety of colors. Building footprints
display areas of major buildings in the 20 largest cities in the U.S. These
areas may display depending on their size and the map zoom level.
Heading Up always shows the direction of forward travel to be
upward on the screen. This view is available for map scales up to
2.5 miles (4 kilometers). The system remembers this setting for
larger map scales, but shows the map in North Up only. If the scale
returns below this level, the system restores Heading Up.
Heading Up Bird’s Eye View provides an elevated perspective
of the map. You can adjust the viewing angle through the map
preferences.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 461
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
North Up always shows the northern direction to be upward on
the screen.
Map Icons
Vehicle mark shows the current location of your vehicle. It
stays in the center of the map display, except when in scroll
mode.
Scroll cursor allows you to scroll the map; the fixed icon is in
the center of the screen. The map position closest to the cursor
is in a window on the top center part of the screen.
Address book entry default icon(s) indicates the location on
the map of an address book entry. This is the default symbol
shown after the entry has been stored to the Address Book by any
method other than the map. You can select from any of the 22 icons
available. You can use each icon more than once.
Home indicates the location on the map currently stored as the
home position. You can only save one address from the Address
Book as your Home entry. You cannot change this icon.
POI (Point Of Interest) icons display on the map and can be
turned on or turned off. Up to about 56 subcategories can display
on the map one at a time.
Starting point indicates the starting point of a planned route.
Waypoints indicate the location of a waypoint on the map.
The number inside the circle is different for each waypoint and
represents the position of the waypoint in the route list.
Destination symbol indicates the ending point of a planned
route.
Next maneuver point indicates the location of the next turn
on the planned route.
S
2
462 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
No GPS symbol indicates that insufficient GPS satellite signals
are available for accurate map positioning. This icon may display
under normal operation in an area with poor GPS access.
Map Scale
The map display scale has 17 levels, ranging from
0.02 miles (.03 kilometers) to 1000 miles (1600 kilometers).
The system synchronizes the zoom scales for North Up,
Heading Up and 3D Map views.
In Map Mode, you can zoom in or out, changing the display
scale, by touching an arrow button on the left side of the
screen.
In Full Screen Map Mode, touch this button to use the Zoom Direct
buttons. The Zoom Direct buttons represent the most common map
scales. Touch a button to show the map at the desired scale. The scale is
approximate and based on the width of the map scale button. The size of
the scale varies based on the screen size.
Map Scrolling
Single scroll mode allows you to press and release on the map display
to bring the pressed position to the center of the screen. The scroll
mode times out after five minutes of inactivity.
Continuous scroll mode allows you to touch and hold the map to
begin scrolling continuously in one of eight directions closest to the point
that is touched. The scroll continues until you release the map, and
increases in speed after three seconds. This is not possible if your
vehicle is moving. The scroll mode times out after five minutes of
inactivity.
Bird’s eye view scroll mode is available after you touch the map twice,
and then selecting one of the eight buttons that appear on the map, in
an oval pattern, in the center of the screen. The two scroll buttons
located in the farthest east and west points of the oval, scroll in a circle
around your vehicle. The remaining buttons scroll in a straight line in the
arrow direction.
0.1 mi
Navigation System (If Equipped) 463
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Quick-touch Buttons
When in map mode, touch anywhere on the map display to access the
following options:
When you select: You can:
Set as Dest Select a scrolled location on the map as your
destination. You may scroll the map by
pressing your index finger on the map display.
When you reach the desired location, simply
let go and then press Set as Dest.
Set as Waypoint Set the current location as a waypoint.
Save to Address
Book
Save the current location to the address book.
POI Icons On/Off Select point of interest icons to display on the
map. You can select up to three icons to
display on the map at the same time.
View Traffic Adjust the map display to the right scale.
This scale allows the entire route to be visible
in the screen.
View/Edit Route Access these features when a route is active:
Cancel route.
Edit route preferences.
Edit destination/waypoints.
View route.
Edit traffic preferences.
*
Edit turn list.
*
This feature requires activation of Sirius Travel Link, which is only
available in the United States.
Navteq is the digital map provider for the navigation application. If you
find map data errors, you may report them directly to Navteq by going to
http://mapreporter.navteq.com. Navteq evaluates all reported map errors
and responds with the result of their investigation by e-mail.
464 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Navigation Map Updates
Annual navigation map updates are available for purchase through your
dealership, by calling 1-800-NAVMAPS (in Mexico, call 01–800–557–5539) or
going to www.navigation.com/ford. You need to specify the make and model
of your vehicle to determine if there is an update available.
Navigation Voice Commands
When in navigation mode, press the voice button on the
steering wheel control. After the tone, say “Navigation”, then
any of the following commands:
“NAVIGATION”
“Cancel next waypoint” “Show destination”
“Cancel route” “Show heading up”
“Destination”
*
“Show map”
“Destination <nametag>” “Show next waypoint”
“Destination <POI category>” “Show north up”
“Destination home” “Show route”
“Destination intersection” “Show turn list”
“Destination nearest <POI
category>”
“Voice off”
“Destination nearest POI” “Voice on”
“Destination POI” “Voice volume decrease”
“Destination previous
destination”
“Voice volume increase”
“Destination street address” “Zoom in”
“Detour” “Zoom out”
“Play nametags” “Help”
“Repeat instruction”
*
If you have said the command, “Destination”, you may say any of the
above commands or commands in the following Destination chart.
“DESTINATION”
“<nametag>”
“<POI category>”
“Home”
Navigation System (If Equipped) 465
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
“DESTINATION”
“Intersection”
“Nearest <POI category>”
“Nearest POI”
“POI”
“POI category”
“Previous destination”
“Street address”
“Help”
Troubleshooting
Symptoms Possible Cause Action
Focus error. The system is not able
to play a reproduced
disc.
Contact an authorized
dealer.
Bad disc. You inserted the disc
upside down or the
system is unable to
read the information
on the disc.
The system
automatically ejects
the disc.
Track error. The system is unable
to reproduce a corrupt
MP3 file.
The system skips the
corrupted track.
Invalid disc detected. The disc is either dirty
or contains an
unsupported format.
Wipe the disc with a
dry, soft cloth from
the center to the outer
edge of the disc.
A pop-up window
displays “Address not
found” or “Address
range does not exist.
Show the midpoint of
the street?”
The house number
entered does not exist
in the map database.
Press NO and enter a
valid number for the
specified street, or
press YES to view the
middle point of the
street.
466 Navigation System (If Equipped)
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Symptoms Possible Cause Action
A pop-up window
displays “Navigation
fault. A system fault
has been detected that
may cause the
navigation to perform
abnormally. Please
contact your
dealership.”
There is a system
hardware or software
error.
Contact an authorized
dealer.
A pop-up window
displays “Error. PINs
did not match. Please
re-enter.”
You entered the wrong
PIN to unlock the
system for valet mode.
Press OK and try
entering your PIN
again. If it does not
work, contact an
authorized dealer.
A pop-up window
displays “Invalid PIN.
Please Re-enter.”
You entered the wrong
PIN.
Press OK and try
entering your PIN
again to lock the
system.
Navigation System (If Equipped) 467
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL INFORMATION
SYNC® End User License Agreement (EULA)
You have acquired a device (“DEVICE”) that includes software
licensed by Ford Motor Company and its affiliates (“FORD MOTOR
COMPANY”) from an affiliate of Microsoft Corporation (“MS”).
Those installed software products of MS origin, as well as associated
media, printed materials, and “online” or electronic documentation
(“MS SOFTWARE”) are protected by international intellectual property
laws and treaties. The MS SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold. All rights
reserved.
The MS SOFTWARE may interface with and/or communicate with,
or may be later upgraded to interface with and/or communicate with
additional software and/or systems provided by FORD MOTOR
COMPANY. The additional software and systems of FORD MOTOR
COMPANY origin, as well as associated media, printed materials,
and “online” or electronic documentation (“FORD SOFTWARE”)
are protected by international intellectual property laws and treaties.
The FORD SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold. All rights reserved.
The MS SOFTWARE and/or FORD SOFTWARE may interface with
and/or communicate with, or may be later upgraded to interface with
and/or communicate with additional software and/or systems provided by
third party software and service suppliers. The additional software and
services of third party origin, as well as associated media, printed
materials, and “online” or electronic documentation (“THIRD PARTY
SOFTWARE”) are protected by international intellectual property laws
and treaties. The THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold.
All rights reserved.
The MS SOFTWARE, FORD SOFTWARE and THIRD PARTY
SOFTWARE hereinafter collectively and individually will be referred
to as SOFTWARE.
IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO THIS END USER LICENSE
AGREEMENT (“EULA”), DO NOT USE THE DEVICE OR
COPY THE SOFTWARE. ANY USE OF THE SOFTWARE,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO USE ON THE DEVICE,
WILL CONSTITUTE YOUR AGREEMENT TO THIS EULA
(OR RATIFICATION OF ANY PREVIOUS CONSENT).
GRANT OF SOFTWARE LICENSE: This EULA grants you the
following license:
You may use the SOFTWARE as installed on the DEVICE and as
otherwise interfacing with systems and/or services provide by or
through FORD MOTOR COMPANY or its third party software and
service providers.
468 Appendices
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
DESCRIPTION OF OTHER RIGHTS AND LIMITATIONS:
Speech Recognition: If the SOFTWARE includes speech recognition
component(s), you should understand that speech recognition is an
inherently statistical process and that recognition errors are inherent
in the process. Neither FORD MOTOR COMPANY nor its suppliers
shall be liable for any damages arising out of errors in the speech
recognition process.
Limitations on Reverse Engineering, Decompilation and
Disassembly: You may not reverse engineer, decompile, or
disassemble nor permit others to reverse engineer, decompile or
disassemble the SOFTWARE, except and only to the extent that such
activity is expressly permitted by applicable law notwithstanding this
limitation.
Limitations on Distributing, Copying, Modifying and Creating
Derivative Works: You may not distribute, copy, make modifications
to or create derivative works based on the SOFTWARE, except and
only to the extent that such activity is expressly permitted by
applicable law notwithstanding this limitation.
Single EULA: The end user documentation for the DEVICE and
related systems and services may contain multiple EULAs, such as
multiple translations and/or multiple media versions (e.g., in the user
documentation and in the software). Even if you receive multiple
EULAs, you are licensed to use only one (1) copy of the SOFTWARE.
SOFTWARE Transfer: You may permanently transfer your rights
under this EULA only as part of a sale or transfer of the DEVICE,
provided you retain no copies, you transfer all of the SOFTWARE
(including all component parts, the media and printed materials, any
upgrades, and, if applicable, the Certificate(s) of Authenticity), and
the recipient agrees to the terms of this EULA. If the SOFTWARE is
an upgrade, any transfer must include all prior versions of the
SOFTWARE.
Termination: Without prejudice to any other rights, FORD MOTOR
COMPANY or MS may terminate this EULA if you fail to comply with
the terms and conditions of this EULA.
Security Updates/Digital Rights Management: Content owners use
the WMDRM technology included in your DEVICE to protect their
intellectual property, included copyrighted content. Portions of the
SOFTWARE on your DEVICE use WMDRM software to access
WMDRM-protected content. If the WMDRM software fails to protect
the content, content owners may ask Microsoft to revoke the
Appendices 469
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SOFTWARE’s ability to use WMDRM to play or copy protected
content. This action does not affect unprotected content. When your
DEVICE downloads licenses for protected content, you agree that
Microsoft may include a revocation list with the licenses. Content
owners may require you to upgrade the SOFTWARE on your DEVICE
to access their content. If you decline an upgrade, you will not be able
to access content that requires the upgrade.
Consent to Use of Data: You agree that MS, Microsoft Corporation,
FORD MOTOR COMPANY, third party software and systems suppliers,
their affiliates and/or their designated agent may collect and use
technical information gathered in any manner as part of product
support services related to the SOFTWARE or related services. MS,
Microsoft Corporation, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, third party software
and services suppliers, their affiliates and/or their designated agent
may use this information solely to improve their products or to
provide customized services or technologies to you. MS, Microsoft
Corporation, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, third party software and
systems suppliers, their affiliates and/or their designated agent may
disclose this information to others, but not in a form that personally
identifies you.
Internet-Based Services Components: The SOFTWARE may
contain components that enable and facilitate the use of certain
Internet-based services. You acknowledge and agree that MS, Microsoft
Corporation, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, third party software and
service suppliers, their affiliates and/or their designated agent may
automatically check the version of the SOFTWARE and/or its
components that you are utilizing and may provide upgrades or
supplements to the SOFTWARE that may be automatically
downloaded to your DEVICE.
Additional Software/Services: The SOFTWARE may permit FORD
MOTOR COMPANY, third party software and service suppliers, MS,
Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent to
provide or make available to you SOFTWARE updates, supplements,
add-on components, or Internet-based services components of the
SOFTWARE after the date you obtain your initial copy of the
SOFTWARE (“Supplemental Components”).
If FORD MOTOR COMPANY or third party software and services
suppliers provide or make available to you Supplemental Components
and no other EULA terms are provided along with the Supplemental
Components, then the terms of this EULA shall apply.
470 Appendices
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
If MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent
make available Supplemental Components, and no other EULA terms are
provided, then the terms of this EULA shall apply, except that the MS,
Microsoft Corporation or affiliate entity providing the Supplemental
Component(s) shall be the licensor of the Supplemental Component(s).
FORD MOTOR COMPANY, MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates
and/or their designated agent reserve the right to discontinue without
liability any Internet-based services provided to you or made available to
you through the use of the SOFTWARE.
Links to Third Party Sites: The MS SOFTWARE may provide you
with the ability to link to third party sites through the use of the
SOFTWARE. The third party sites are not under the control of MS,
Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent.
Neither MS nor Microsoft Corporation nor their affiliates nor their
designated agent are responsible for (i) the contents of any third
party sites, any links contained in third party sites, or any changes or
updates to third party sites, or (ii) webcasting or any other form of
transmission received from any third party sites. If the SOFTWARE
provides links to third party sites, those links are provided to you only
as a convenience, and the inclusion of any link does not imply an
endorsement of the third party site by MS, Microsoft Corporation,
their affiliates and/or their designated agent.
Obligation to Drive Responsibly: You recognize your obligation to
drive responsibly and keep attention on the road. You will read and
abide with the DEVICE operating instructions particularly as they
pertain to safety and assumes any risk associated with the use of the
DEVICE.
UPGRADES AND RECOVERY MEDIA: If the SOFTWARE is provided
by FORD MOTOR COMPANY separate from the DEVICE on media such
as a ROM chip, CD ROM disk(s) or via web download or other means,
and is labeled “For Upgrade Purposes Only” or For Recovery Purposes
Only you may install one (1) copy of such SOFTWARE onto the
DEVICE as a replacement copy for the existing SOFTWARE, and use it
in accordance with this EULA, including any additional EULA terms
accompanying the upgrade SOFTWARE.
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS: All title and intellectual
property rights in and to the SOFTWARE (including but not limited to
any images, photographs, animations, video, audio, music, text and
“applets,” incorporated into the SOFTWARE), the accompanying printed
materials, and any copies of the SOFTWARE, are owned by MS,
Microsoft Corporation, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, or their affiliates or
Appendices 471
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
suppliers. The SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold. You may not copy the
printed materials accompanying the SOFTWARE. All title and intellectual
property rights in and to the content which may be accessed through use
of the SOFTWARE is the property of the respective content owner and
may be protected by applicable copyright or other intellectual property
laws and treaties. This EULA grants you no rights to use such content.
All rights not specifically granted under this EULA are reserved by MS,
Microsoft Corporation, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, third party software
and service providers, their affiliates and suppliers. Use of any on-line
services which may be accessed through the SOFTWARE may be
governed by the respective terms of use relating to such services. If this
SOFTWARE contains documentation that is provided only in electronic
form, you may print one copy of such electronic documentation.
EXPORT RESTRICTIONS: You acknowledge that the SOFTWARE is
subject to U.S. and European Union export jurisdiction. You agree to
comply with all applicable international and national laws that apply to
the SOFTWARE, including the U.S. Export Administration Regulations,
as well as end-user, end-use and destination restrictions issued by U.S.
and other governments. For additional information, see
http://www.microsoft.com/exporting/.
TRADEMARKS: This EULA does not grant you any rights in connection
with any trademarks or service marks of FORD MOTOR COMPANY, MS,
Microsoft Corporation, third party software or service providers, their
affiliates or suppliers.
PRODUCT SUPPORT: Product support for the SOFTWARE is not
provided by MS, its parent corporation Microsoft Corporation, or their
affiliates or subsidiaries. For product support, please refer to FORD
MOTOR COMPANY instructions provided in the documentation for the
DEVICE. Should you have any questions concerning this EULA, or if you
desire to contact FORD MOTOR COMPANY for any other reason, please
refer to the address provided in the documentation for the DEVICE.
No Liability for Certain Damages: EXCEPT AS PROHIBITED BY
LAW, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, ANY THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE OR
SERVICES SUPPLIERS, MS, MICROSOFT CORPORATION AND THEIR
AFFILIATES SHALL HAVE NO LIABILITY FOR ANY INDIRECT,
SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES ARISING
FROM OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF
THE SOFTWARE. THIS LIMITATION SHALL APPLY EVEN IF ANY
REMEDY FAILS OF ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT SHALL
MS, MICROSOFT CORPORATION AND/OR THEIR AFFILIATES BE
LIABLE FOR ANY AMOUNT IN EXCESS OF U.S. TWO HUNDRED
FIFTY DOLLARS (U.S.$250.00).
472 Appendices
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
THERE ARE NO WARRANTIES OTHER THAN THOSE THAT MAY
EXPRESSLY BE PROVIDED FOR YOUR NEW VEHICLE.
Adobe
Contains Adobe® [Flash® Player] or [AIR®] technology by Adobe
Systems Incorporated. This [Licensee Product] contains [Adobe® Flash®
Player] [Adobe® AIR®] software under license from Adobe Systems
Incorporated, Copyright 1995-2009 Adobe Macromedia Software LLC.
All rights reserved. Adobe, Flash and AIR are trademarks of Adobe
Systems Incorporated.
End user notice
Microsoft® Windows® Mobile for Automotive Important Safety
Information
This system Ford SYNC™ contains software that is licensed to
Manufacturer FORD MOTOR COMPANY by an affiliate of Microsoft
Corporation pursuant to a license agreement. Any removal, reproduction,
reverse engineering or other unauthorized use of the software from this
system in violation of the license agreement is strictly prohibited and
may subject you to legal action.
Read and follow instructions
Before using your Windows Automotive-based system, read and follow all
instructions and safety information provided in this end user manual
(“User’s Guide”). Not following precautions found in this User’s Guide
can lead to an accident or other serious consequences.
Keep User’s Guide in Vehicle
When kept in the vehicle, the User’s Guide will be a ready reference for
you and other users unfamiliar with the Windows Automotive-based
system. Please make certain that before using the system for the first
time, all persons have access to the User’s Guide and read its
instructions and safety information carefully.
WARNING: Operating certain parts of this system while driving
can distract your attention away from the road, and possibly
cause an accident or other serious consequences. Do not change
system settings or enter data non-verbally (using your hands) while
driving. Stop the vehicle in a safe and legal manner before attempting
these operations. This is important since while setting up or changing
some functions you might be required to distract your attention away
from the road and remove your hands from the wheel.
Appendices 473
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
General operation
Voice Command Control
Functions within the Windows Automotive-based system may be
accomplished using only voice commands. Using voice commands while
driving allows you to operate the system without removing your hands
from the wheel.
Prolonged Views of Screen
Do not access any function requiring a prolonged view of the screen
while you are driving. Pull over in a safe and legal manner before
attempting to access a function of the system requiring prolonged
attention. Even occasional short scans to the screen may be hazardous if
your attention has been diverted away from your driving task at a critical
time.
Volume Setting
Do not raise the volume excessively. Keep the volume at a level where
you can still hear outside traffic and emergency signals while driving.
Driving while unable to hear these sounds could cause an accident.
Use of Speech Recognition Functions
Speech recognition software is inherently a statistical process which is
subject to errors. It is your responsibility to monitor any speech
recognition functions included in the system and address any errors.
Navigation Features
Any navigation features included in the system are intended to provide
turn by turn instructions to get you to a desired destination. Please
make certain all persons using this system carefully read and follow
instructions and safety information fully.
Distraction Hazard
Any navigation features may require manual (non-verbal) setup.
Attempting to perform such set-up or insert data while driving can
seriously distract your attention and could cause an accident or other
serious consequences. Stop the vehicle in a safe and legal manner before
attempting these operations.
474 Appendices
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Let Your Judgment Prevail
Any navigation features are provided only as an aid. Make your driving
decisions based on your observations of local conditions and existing
traffic regulations. Any such feature is not a substitute for your personal
judgment. Any route suggestions made by this system should never
replace any local traffic regulations or your personal judgment or
knowledge of safe driving practices.
Route Safety
Do not follow the route suggestions if doing so would result in an unsafe
or illegal maneuver, if you would be placed in an unsafe situation, or if
you would be directed into an area that you consider unsafe. The driver
is ultimately responsible for the safe operation of the vehicle and
therefore, must evaluate whether it is safe to follow the suggested
directions.
Potential Map Inaccuracy
Maps used by this system may be inaccurate because of changes in
roads, traffic controls or driving conditions. Always use good judgment
and common sense when following the suggested routes.
Emergency Services
Do not rely on any navigation features included in the system to route
you to emergency services. Ask local authorities or an emergency
services operator for these locations. Not all emergency services such as
police, fire stations, hospitals and clinics are likely to be contained in the
map database for such navigation features.
Map Data DVD End User License Terms
The data (“Data”) is provided for your personal, internal use only and
not for resale. It is protected by copyright, and is subject to the following
terms and conditions which are agreed to by you, on the one hand, and
(Licensee). (“Licensee”) and its licensors (including their licensors and
suppliers) on the other hand. Such licensors include NAVTEQ North
America, LLC. Without limiting the foregoing, you agree that NAVTEQ
North America, LLC shall have the right to enforce these Terms directly
against you. 2013 NAVTEQ. All rights reserved. The Data for areas of
Canada includes information taken with permission from Canadian
authorities, including: Her Majesty the Queen in Right of Canada,
Queen’s Printer for Ontario, Canada Post Corporation, Geobase ®.
Appendices 475
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Terms and Conditions
Personal use only: You agree to use this Data together with your FLM
navigation system for solely personal, non commercial purposes for
which you were licensed, and not for service bureau, time-sharing or
other similar purposes. Accordingly, but subject to the restrictions set
forth in the following paragraphs, you may copy this Data only as
necessary for your personal use to (i) view it, and (ii) save it, provided
that you do not remove any copyright notices that appear and do not
modify the Data in any way. You agree not to otherwise reproduce copy,
modify, decompile, disassemble or reverse engineer any portion of this
Data, and may not transfer or distribute it in any form, for any purpose,
except to the extent permitted by mandatory laws.
Restrictions:
Except where you have been specifically licensed to do so by
(Licensee), and without limiting the preceding paragraph, you may not (a)
use this Data with any products, systems, or applications installed or
otherwise connected to or in communication with vehicles, capable of vehicle
navigation, positioning, dispatch, real time route guidance, fleet management
or similar applications; or (b) with or in communication with any positioning
devices or any mobile or wireless-connected electronic or computer devices,
including without limitation cellular phones, palmtop and handheld
computers, pagers, and personal digital assistants or PDAs.
No warranty: This Data is provided to you “as is,” and you agree to use
it at your own risk. (Licensee) and its licensors (and their licensors and
suppliers) make no guarantees, representations or warranties of any
kind, express or implied, arising by law or otherwise, including but not
limited to, content, quality, accuracy, completeness, effectiveness,
reliability, fitness for a particular purpose, usefulness, use or results to be
obtained from this Data, or that the Data or server will be uninterrupted
or error-free.
Disclaimer of warranty:(Licensee) and its licensors (including their
licensors and suppliers) disclaim any warranties, express or implied, of
quality, performance, merchantability, fitness for a particular purpose or
non infringement. Some States, Territories and Countries do not allow
certain warranty exclusions, so to that extent the above exclusion may
not apply to you.
476 Appendices
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Disclaimer of liability: (Licensee) and its licensors (including their
licensors and suppliers) shall not be liable to you: in respect of any
claim, demand or action, irrespective of the nature of the cause of the
claim, demand or action alleging any loss, injury or damages, direct or
indirect, which may result from the use or possession of the information;
or for any loss of profit, revenue, contracts or savings, or any other
direct, indirect, incidental, special or consequential damages arising out
of your use of or inability to use this information, any defect in the
information, or the breach of these terms or conditions, whether in an
action in contract or tort or based on a warranty, even if (Licensee) or
its licensors have been advised of the possibility of such damages. Some
States, Territories and Countries do not allow certain liability exclusions
or damages limitations, so to that extent the above may not apply to you.
Export control: You agree not to export from anywhere any part of the
Data provided to you or any direct product thereof except in compliance
with, and with all licenses and approvals required under, applicable
export laws, rules and regulations.
Termination for Breach or Bankruptcy: (Licensee) and its licensors,
including NAVTEQ, may terminate this Agreement if you breach any of
its terms. Upon any such termination, you shall immediately cease your
use of the Data and return all copies thereof to LICENSEE or NAVTEQ,
as instructed. (Licensee) and its licensors also may terminate this
Agreement in the event that you (i) fail to pay license fees due for the
Data, or (ii) if any of the following events occur affecting you: (a)
voluntary bankruptcy or application for bankruptcy; (b) involuntary
bankruptcy or application for bankruptcy not discharged within sixty
(60) days; (c) appointment of receiver for all or a portion of your assets;
or (d) any assignment for the benefit of creditors.
Entire agreement: These terms and conditions constitute the entire
agreement between (Licensee) (and its licensors, including their
licensors and suppliers) and you pertaining to the subject matter hereof,
and supersedes in their entirety any and all written or oral agreements
previously existing between us with respect to such subject matter.
Governing law: The above terms and conditions shall be governed by
the laws of the Illinois, without giving effect to (i) its conflict of laws
provisions, or (ii) the United Nations Convention for Contracts for the
International Sale of Goods, which is explicitly excluded. You agree to
submit to the jurisdiction of Illinois for any and all disputes, claims and
actions arising from or in connection with the Data provided to you
hereunder.
Appendices 477
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
FCC Compliance
Changes or modifications not approved by Ford could void user’s
authority to operate the equipment. This equipment has been tested and
found to comply with the limits with the Class B digital device, pursuant
to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide
reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential
installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the
instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications.
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a
particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference
to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the
equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to consult the dealer or an
experienced radio/TV technician for help.
Gracenote® Copyright
CD and music related data from Gracenote, Inc., copyright
2000–2007 Gracenote. Gracenote Software, copyright 2000–2007
Gracenote. This product and service may practice one or more of the
following U.S. Patents #5,987,525; #6,061,680; #6,154,773, #6,161,132,
#6,230,192, #6,230,207, #6,240,459, #6,330,593, and other patents issued
or pending. Some services supplied under license from Open Globe, Inc.
for U.S. Patent: #6,304,523.
Gracenote and CDDB are registered trademarks of Gracenote.
The Gracenote logo and logotype, and the Powered by Gracenote™
logo are trademarks of Gracenote.
Gracenote® End User License Agreement (EULA)
This device contains software from Gracenote, Inc. of 2000 Powell Street
Emeryville, California 94608 (“Gracenote”).
The software from Gracenote (the “Gracenote Software”) enables this
device to do disc and music file identification and obtain music-related
information, including name, artist, track, and title information
(“Gracenote Data”) from online servers (“Gracenote Servers”), and to
perform other functions. You may use Gracenote Data only by means
of the intended End User functions of this device
This device may contain content belonging to Gracenote’s providers.
If so, all of the restrictions set forth herein with respect to Gracenote
Data shall also apply to such content and such content providers shall be
entitled to all of the benefits and protections set forth herein that are
available to Gracenote.
478 Appendices
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
You agree that you will use the content from Gracenote (“Gracenote
Content”), Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote
Servers for your own personal, non-commercial use only. You agree not
to assign, copy, transfer or transmit the Gracenote Content, Gracenote
Software or any Gracenote Data (except in a Tag associated with a music
file) to any third party. YOU AGREE NOT TO USE OR EXPLOIT
GRACENOTE CONTENT, GRACENOTE DATA, THE GRACENOTE
SOFTWARE, OR GRACENOTE SERVERS, EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY
PERMITTED HEREIN.
You agree that your non-exclusive licenses to use the Gracenote Content,
Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote Servers will
terminate if you violate these restrictions. If your licenses terminate, you
agree to cease any and all use of the Gracenote Content, Gracenote Data,
the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote Servers. Gracenote, respectively,
reserve all rights in Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and the
Gracenote Servers and Gracenote Content, including all ownership rights.
Under no circumstances will either Gracenote become liable for any payment
to you for any information that you provide, including any copyrighted
material or music file information. You agree that Gracenote may enforce its
respective rights, collectively or separately, under this agreement against
you, directly in each company’s own name.
Gracenote uses a unique identifier to track queries for statistical
purposes. The purpose of a randomly assigned numeric identifier is to
allow Gracenote to count queries without knowing anything about who
you are. For more information, see the web page at www.gracenote.com
for the Gracenote Privacy Policy
Appendices 479
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE, EACH ITEM OF GRACENOTE DATA AND
THE GRACENOTE CONTENT ARE LICENSED TO YOU “AS IS.” NEITHER
GRACENOTE MAKES ANY REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, REGARDING THE ACCURACY OF ANY
GRACENOTE DATA FROM THE GRACENOTE SERVERS OR GRACENOTE
CONTENT. GRACENOTE COLLECTIVELY AND SEPARATELY RESERVE
THE RIGHT TO DELETE DATA AND/OR CONTENT FROM THE
COMPANIES’ RESPECTIVE SERVERS OR, IN THE CASE OF GRACENOTE,
CHANGE DATA CATEGORIES FOR ANY CAUSE THAT GRACENOTE
DEEMS SUFFICIENT. NO WARRANTY IS MADE THAT EITHER
GRACENOTE CONTENT OR THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE OR
GRACENOTE SERVERS ARE ERROR-FREE OR THAT THE FUNCTIONING
OF THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE OR GRACENOTE SERVERS WILL BE
UNINTERRUPTED. GRACENOTE IS NOT OBLIGATED TO PROVIDE YOU
WITH ANY ENHANCED OR ADDITIONAL DATA TYPES THAT GRACENOTE
MAY CHOOSE TO PROVIDE IN THE FUTURE AND IS FREE TO
DISCONTINUE ITS ONLINE SERVICES AT ANY TIME. GRACENOTE
DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE, AND
NON-INFRINGEMENT. NEITHER GRACENOTE WARRANTS THE RESULTS
THAT WILL BE OBTAINED BY YOUR USE OF THE GRACENOTE
SOFTWARE OR ANY GRACENOTE SERVER. IN NO CASE WILL
GRACENOTE BE LIABLE FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL
DAMAGES OR FOR ANY LOST PROFITS OR LOST REVENUES FOR ANY
REASON WHATSOEVER.
Gracenote 2007
480 Appendices
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
GENERAL MAINTENANCE INFORMATION
Why Maintain Your Vehicle?
Carefully following the maintenance schedule helps protect against major
repair expenses resulting from neglect or inadequate maintenance and
may help to increase the value of your vehicle when you sell or trade it.
Keep all receipts for completed maintenance with your vehicle.
We have established regular maintenance intervals for your vehicle based
upon rigorous testing. It is important that you have your vehicle serviced
at the proper times. These intervals serve two purposes; one is to
maintain the reliability of your vehicle and the second is to keep your
cost of owning your vehicle down.
It is your responsibility to have all scheduled maintenance performed and
to make sure that the materials used meet the specifications identified in
the Capacities and Specifications chapter of this owner’s manual.
Failure to perform scheduled maintenance invalidates warranty coverage
on parts affected by the lack of maintenance.
Why Maintain Your Vehicle at Your Dealership?
Factory-Trained Technicians
Service technicians participate in extensive factory-sponsored
certification training to help them become experts on the operation of
your vehicle. Ask your dealership about the training and certification
their technicians have received.
Genuine Ford and Motorcraft® Replacement Parts
Dealerships stock Ford, Motorcraft and Ford-authorized branded
re-manufactured replacement parts. These parts meet or exceed our
specifications. Parts installed at your dealership carry a nationwide
12-month or 12000-mile (20000 kilometers) parts and labor limited
warranty.
If you do not use Ford authorized parts they may not meet our
specifications and depending on the part, it could affect emissions
compliance.
Scheduled Maintenance 481
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Convenience
Many dealerships have extended evening and Saturday hours to make
your service visit more convenient and they offer one stop shopping.
They can perform any services that are required on your vehicle, from
general maintenance to collision repairs.
Note: Not all dealers have extended hours or body shops. Please contact
your dealer for details.
Protecting Your Investment
Maintenance is an investment that pays dividends in the form of
improved reliability, durability and resale value. To maintain the proper
performance of your vehicle and its emission control systems, make sure
you have scheduled maintenance performed at the designated intervals.
Your vehicle is very sophisticated and built with multiple, complex,
performance systems. Every manufacturer develops these systems using
different specifications and performance features. That is why it is
important to rely upon your dealership to properly diagnose and repair
your vehicle.
Ford Motor Company has recommended maintenance intervals for
various parts and component systems based upon engineering testing.
Ford Motor Company relies upon this testing to determine the most
appropriate mileage for replacement of oils and fluids to protect your
vehicle at the lowest overall cost to you and recommends against
maintenance schedules that deviate from the scheduled maintenance
information.
We strongly recommend the use of only genuine Ford, Motorcraft or
Ford-authorized re-manufactured replacement parts engineered for your
vehicle.
Additives and Chemicals
This owner’s manual and the Ford Workshop Manual list the
recommended additives and chemicals for your vehicle. We do not
recommend using chemicals or additives not approved by us as part
of your vehicle’s normal maintenance. Please consult your warranty
information.
482 Scheduled Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Oils, Fluids and Flushing
In many cases, fluid discoloration is a normal operating characteristic
and, by itself, does not necessarily indicate a concern or that the
fluid needs to be changed. However, a qualified expert, such as the
factory-trained technicians at your dealership, should inspect discolored
fluids that also show signs of overheating or foreign material
contamination immediately.
Make sure to change your vehicle’s oils and fluids at the specified intervals
or in conjunction with a repair. Flushing is a viable way to change fluid for
many vehicle sub-systems during scheduled maintenance. It is critical that
systems are flushed only with new fluid that is the same as that required to
fill and operate the system or using a Ford-approved flushing chemical.
Owner Checks and Services
Certain basic maintenance checks and inspections should be performed
every month or at six month intervals.
Check every month
Engine oil level.
Function of all interior and exterior lights.
Tires (including spare) for wear and proper pressure.
Windshield washer fluid level.
Check every six months
Battery connections. Clean if necessary.
Body and door drain holes for obstructions. Clean if necessary.
Cooling system fluid level and coolant strength.
Door weatherstrips for wear. Lubricate if necessary.
Hinges, latches and outside locks for proper operation. Lubricate if
necessary.
Parking brake for proper operation.
Safety belts and seat latches for wear and function.
Safety warning lamps (brake, ABS, airbag, safety belt) for operation.
Washer spray and wiper operation. Clean or replace blades as
necessary.
Scheduled Maintenance 483
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Multi-point Inspection
In order to keep your vehicle running right, it is important to have the
systems on your vehicle checked regularly. This can help identify
potential issues and prevent major problems. Ford Motor Company
recommends the following multi-point inspection be performed at every
scheduled maintenance interval to help make sure your vehicle keeps
running great.
Multi-point inspection
Accessory drive belt(s) Hazard warning system operation
Battery performance Horn operation
Engine air filter Radiator, cooler, heater and A/C hoses
Exhaust system Suspension components for leaks or
damage
Exterior lamps operation Steering and linkage
Fluid levels
*
; fill if necessary Tires (including spare) for wear and
proper pressure
**
For oil and fluid leaks Windshield for cracks, chips or pits
Half-shaft dust boots Washer spray and wiper operation
*
Brake, coolant recovery reservoir, automatic transmission, power
steering (if equipped) and window washer.
**
If your vehicle is equipped with a temporary mobility kit, check the tire
sealant expiration Use By date on the canister. Replace as needed.
Be sure to ask your dealership service advisor or technician about the
multi-point vehicle inspection. It is a comprehensive way to perform a
thorough inspection of your vehicle. It is your checklist that gives you
immediate feedback on the overall condition of your vehicle. You will
know what has been checked, what is okay, as well as those things that
may require future or immediate attention. The multi-point vehicle
inspection is one more way to keep your vehicle running great!
484 Scheduled Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Scheduled Maintenance 485
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
NORMAL SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE AND LOG
The following section contains the Normal Scheduled Maintenance.
This schedule is presented at specific mileage (kilometer) intervals with
exceptions as noted.
Normal scheduled maintenance
Every 7500 miles
(12000 km) or
six months (whichever
comes first)
Change engine oil and filter.
*
Rotate tires, inspect tire wear and measure
tread depth.
Inspect wheels and related components for
abnormal noise, wear, looseness or drag.
Perform multi-point inspection
(recommended).
Every 15000 miles
(24000 km) or
12 months (whichever
comes first)
Inspect automatic transmission fluid level.
Consult dealer for requirements.
Inspect brake pads, shoes, rotors, drums,
brake linings, hoses and parking brake.
Inspect engine cooling system strength and
hoses.
Inspect exhaust system and heat shields.
Inspect front axle and U-joints. Lubricate if
equipped with grease fittings (4WD vehicles).
Inspect half-shaft boots.
Inspect steering linkage, ball joints,
suspension, tie-rod ends, driveshaft and
U-joints. Lubricate if equipped with grease
fittings.
*
Reset your oil life monitoring system after each engine oil and filter
change. See the Instrument Cluster chapter.
486 Scheduled Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Other maintenance items
Every 30000 miles
(48000 km)
Replace climate-controlled (heated and
cooled) seat filter (if equipped).
Replace engine air filter.
Every 97500 miles
(156000 km)
Replace spark plugs.
Every 105000 miles
(168000 km)
Change engine coolant.
*
Inspect accessory drive belt(s).
**
Every 150000 miles
(240000 km)
Change automatic transmission fluid and filter.
Consult dealer for requirements.
Change front axle fluid (4WD vehicles).
Change rear axle fluid.
Change transfer case fluid (4WD vehicles).
Replace accessory drive belt(s) if not replaced
within the last 100000 miles (160000 km).
*
Initial replacement at six years or 105000 miles (168000 kilometers),
then every three years or 45000 miles (72000 kilometers).
**
If not replaced, inspect every 15000 miles (24000 kilometers).
Scheduled Maintenance 487
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Maintenance Schedule Log
DEALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
488 Scheduled Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
DEALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
Scheduled Maintenance 489
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
DEALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
490 Scheduled Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
SPECIAL OPERATING CONDITIONS
If you operate your vehicle primarily in any of the following conditions,
you need to perform additional maintenance as indicated. If you
occasionally operate your vehicle under any of these conditions, it is
not necessary to perform the additional maintenance. For specific
recommendations, see your dealership service advisor or technician.
Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier
Inspect frequently,
service as required
Inspect and lubricate U-joints, if equipped with
grease fittings.
See axle maintenance items under
Exceptions.
Every 5000 miles
(8000 km)
Inspect wheels and related components for
abnormal noise, wear, looseness or drag.
Rotate tires, inspect tires for wear and
measure tread depth.
Every 5000 miles
(8000 km) or
six months
Change engine oil and filter.
*
Inspect and lubricate U-joints, if equipped with
grease fittings.
Every 60000 miles
(96000 km)
Change transfer case fluid (4WD vehicles).
*
Reset your oil life monitoring system after each engine oil and filter
change. See the Instrument Cluster chapter.
Extensive idling or low-speed driving for long distances as in
heavy commercial use (such as delivery, taxi, patrol car or
livery)
Inspect frequently,
service as required
Replace engine air filter.
Every 5000 miles
(8000 km)
Inspect brake system.
Inspect wheels and related components for
abnormal noise, wear, looseness or drag.
Lubricate control arm and steering ball joints if
equipped with grease fittings.
Rotate tires, inspect tires for wear and
measure tread depth.
Scheduled Maintenance 491
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Extensive idling or low-speed driving for long distances as in
heavy commercial use (such as delivery, taxi, patrol car or
livery)
Every 5000 miles
(8000 km) or
six months
Change engine oil and filter.
*
Every 60000 miles
(96000 km)
Change transfer case fluid (4WD vehicles).
Replace spark plugs.
*
Reset your oil life monitoring system after each engine oil and filter
change. See the Instrument Cluster chapter.
Operating in dusty or sandy conditions such as unpaved or
dusty roads
Inspect frequently,
service as required
Replace engine air filter.
Every 5000 miles
(8000 km)
Inspect the wheels and related components for
abnormal noise, wear, looseness or drag.
Rotate tires, inspect tires for wear and
measure tread depth.
Every 5000 miles
(8000 km) or
six months
Change engine oil and filter.
*
Inspect and lubricate U-joints, if equipped with
grease fittings.
Every 60000 miles
(96000 km)
Change transfer case fluid (4WD vehicles).
*
Reset your oil life monitoring system after each engine oil and filter
change. See the Instrument Cluster chapter.
492 Scheduled Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Off-road operation
Inspect frequently,
service as required
Inspect steering linkage, ball joints and
U-joints. Lubricate if equipped with grease
fittings.
Replace engine air filter.
Every 5000 miles
(8000 km)
Change engine oil and filter.
*
Inspect the wheels and related components for
abnormal noise, wear, looseness or drag.
Rotate tires, inspect tires for wear and
measure tread depth.
Every 60000 miles
(96000 km)
Change transfer case fluid (4WD vehicles).
*
Reset your oil life monitoring system after each engine oil and filter
change. See the Instrument Cluster chapter.
Exclusive use of E85 (flex fuel vehicles only)
Every oil change If ran exclusively on E85, fill the fuel tank full
with regular unleaded fuel.
Scheduled Maintenance 493
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Special Operating Condition Log
DEALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
494 Scheduled Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
DEALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A CODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
Scheduled Maintenance 495
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
EXCEPTIONS
Normal vehicle axle maintenance: Rear axles and power take-off
units with synthetic fluid and light-duty trucks equipped with
Ford-design axles are lubricated for life; do not check or change fluid
unless a leak is suspected, service is required or the assembly has been
submerged in water. During long periods of trailer towing with outside
temperatures above 70°F (21°C) and at wide-open throttle for long
periods above 45 mph (72 km/h), non-synthetic rear axle fluids should
be changed every 3000 miles (4800 kilometers) or three months,
whichever comes first. This interval can be waived if the axle is
filled with 75W140 synthetic gear fluid meeting Ford specification
WSL-M2C192-A, part number F1TZ-19580-B or equivalent. Add friction
modifier XL-3 (EST-M2C118-A) or equivalent for complete refill of
Traction-Lok rear axles (see Technical specifications in the Capacities
and Specifications chapter for details).
Police/Taxi/Livery vehicle axle maintenance: Change rear axle fluid
every 100000 miles (160000 km). Rear axle fluid change may be waived
if the axle was filled with 75W140 synthetic gear fluid meeting Ford
specification WSL-M2C192-A, part number FITZ-19580-B or equivalent.
Add four ounces (118 mL) of additive friction modifier XL-3
(EST-M2C118-A) or equivalent for complete refill of Traction-Lok rear
axles. The axle fluid should be changed anytime the axle has been
submerged in water.
California fuel filter replacement: If the vehicle is registered in
California, the California Air Resources Board has determined that the
failure to perform this maintenance item will not nullify the emission
warranty or limit recall liability prior to the completion of the vehicle’s
useful life. Ford Motor Company, however, urges you to have all
recommended maintenance services performed at the specified intervals
and to record all vehicle service.
Hot climate oil change intervals: Vehicles operating in the Middle
East, North Africa, Sub-Saharan Africa or locations with similar climates
using an American Petroleum Institute (API) Certified for Gasoline
Engines (Certification mark) oil of SM or SN quality, the normal oil
change interval is 5000 miles (8000 kilometers).
If the available API SM or SN oils are not available, then the oil change
service interval is 3000 miles (4800 kilometers).
Engine air filter replacement: Engine air filter life is dependent
on exposure to dusty and dirty conditions. Vehicles operated in these
conditions require frequent inspection and replacement of the engine air
filter.
496 Scheduled Maintenance
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
ENGINE COOLANT CHANGE RECORD
Initial change Six years or 105000 miles (168000 km)
(whichever comes first)
After initial change Every three years or 45000 miles (72000 km)
Engine Coolant Change Log
DEALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
D
EALER VALIDATION:
P&A C
ODE:
RO#: H
OURS:
D
AT E:MILEAGE:
Scheduled Maintenance 497
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
911 Assist™ ..............................384
A
ABS (see Brakes) .....................190
Accessing call history/phone
book during active call .............373
Accessing the help screen .......447
Accessing the music in your
jukebox ......................................441
Accessing your media menu
features ......................................396
Accessing your phone menu
features ......................................375
Accessory delay ..........................95
Active call menu options .........373
Advanced menu options ...382, 402
Advanced menu options
(prompts, languages, defaults,
master reset, installing
applications) ..............................382
Airbag supplemental restraint
system ..........................................51
and child safety seats ..............52
description ................................51
disposal ......................................57
driver airbag ..............................51
passenger airbag .......................51
side airbag ...........................51, 53
Air cleaner filter .......268–269, 324
Air filter .............................269, 324
All Wheel Drive (AWD),
driving off road .........................182
Ambulance packages ..................16
AM/FM .......................................423
Antifreeze (see Engine
coolant) .....................................259
Anti-lock brake system
(see Brakes) ..............................190
Anti-theft system ..................80, 82
arming the system ..............80, 82
disarming a triggered system ..82
AppLink™ .................................392
Audio system
Single CD ................................334
Audio system (see Radio) .......334
Automatic transmission
driving an automatic
overdrive .................................176
fluid, adding ............................263
fluid, checking ........................263
fluid, refill capacities ..............320
fluid, specification ..................320
Auxiliary input jack (Line in) ..342
Auxiliary powerpoint ................155
Axle
lubricant specifications ..........320
refill capacities ........................320
B
Battery .......................................265
acid, treating emergencies .....265
jumping a disabled battery ....235
maintenance-free ....................265
replacement, specifications ...324
servicing ..................................265
Booster seats ...............................23
Brakes ........................................190
anti-lock ...................................190
anti-lock brake system (ABS)
warning light ...........................190
brake warning light ................190
fluid, checking and adding ....264
fluid, refill capacities ..............320
fluid, specifications .................320
498 Index
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
lubricant specifications ..........320
parking ....................................191
shift interlock ..........................179
trailer .......................................223
C
Capacities for refilling fluids ....320
Car2U® Home Automation
System .......................................145
Cargo management system ......213
CD ..............................................334
CD player ..................................332
CD voice
commands .................437, 439–440
Cell phone use ............................16
Changing a tire .........................310
Changing the air filter ..............269
Child safety seats
automatic locking mode
(retractor) .................................41
LATCH .......................................29
Child safety seats - booster
seats .............................................23
Cleaning the touchscreen ........417
Cleaning your vehicle ...............278
engine compartment ..............281
instrument panel ....................283
interior .....................................282
plastic parts ............................280
washing ....................................278
waxing .....................................280
wheels ......................................284
wiper blades ............................281
Clock ..................................118, 334
Console
overhead ......................98–99, 158
Controls
power seat ...............................129
Coolant ......................................259
checking and adding ..............259
refill capacities ........................320
specifications ..........................320
Creating a playlist .....................443
Cruise control ...........................201
Customer Assistance ................232
Ford Extended Service
Plan ..........................................329
Getting roadside assistance ...232
Getting the service
you need .................................238
Ordering additional owner’s
literature .................................244
Utilizing the
Mediation/Arbitration
Program ...................................242
Customizing your home
screen ........................................415
D
Daytime running lamps
(see Lamps) ................................91
Defrost ...............................119, 121
rear window ............................125
Dipstick
automatic transmission
fluid ..........................................263
engine oil .................................258
Driving under special
conditions ..................181, 186, 188
sand .........................................186
snow and ice ...........................188
through water .................187, 229
Index 499
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Dual automatic temperature
control (DATC) .................119, 121
DVD (if equipped) ....................344
DVD region coding ...................353
DVD system ...............................344
E
Electronic message center .......109
Electronic stability control ......194
Emergencies, roadside
jump-starting ..........................235
running out of fuel .................168
Emission control system ..........172
End user license agreement ....468
Engine ........................................319
cleaning ...................................281
coolant .....................................259
fail-safe cooling .......................262
idle speed control ...................265
lubrication specifications .......320
refill capacities ........................320
service points ..........................257
starting after a collision .........234
Engine block heater .................163
Engine oil
checking and adding ..............258
dipstick ....................................258
filter, specifications ................324
refill capacities ........................320
specifications ..........................320
Event data recording ..................12
Exhaust fumes ..........................162
F
Fail safe cooling ........................262
Fleet MyKey programming ........62
Floor mats .................................230
Fluid capacities .........................320
Fog lamps ....................................91
Forward and reverse sensing
system ........................................196
Four-Wheel Drive vehicles .......182
description ..............................183
driving off road .......................184
indicator light .........................182
Fuel
cap ...........................................170
capacity ...................................320
choosing the right fuel ...166–167
filler funnel .............................168
filling your vehicle with fuel ..170
filter, specifications ................264
fuel pump shut-off switch .....234
octane rating ...................167, 319
quality ......................................166
running out of fuel .................168
safety information relating to
automotive fuels .....................165
Fuel - flex fuel
vehicle (FFV) ....................166–167
Fuses ..........................246–247, 251
G
Garage door opener ..........145, 149
Gas cap (see Fuel cap) ............170
Gauges .......................................102
H
Hazard flashers .........................233
HD Radio™ ...............................426
Headlamps ...................................89
aiming ......................................271
autolamp system .......................90
500 Index
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
bulb specifications ..................276
checking alignment ................271
daytime running lights .............91
flash to pass ..............................89
high beam .................................89
replacing bulbs .......................273
turning on and off ....................89
Head restraints .........................127
Heating ..............................119, 121
Homelink wireless control
system ........................................149
Hood ..........................................256
I
Ignition ...............................160, 319
Illuminated visor mirror .....99–100
Information displays .................109
Inspection/maintenance (I/M)
testing ........................................175
Instrument panel
cleaning ...................................283
cluster ......................................103
J
Jack ............................................310
positioning ...............................310
storage .....................................310
Joining two calls
(multiparty/conference call) ....373
Jukebox features .......................441
Jump-starting your vehicle ......235
K
Keyless entry system
autolock .....................................71
keypad .......................................77
locking and unlocking doors ....79
programming entry code .........77
Keys .......................................58, 81
positions of the ignition .........160
L
Lamps ..........................................89
autolamp system .......................90
bulb replacement
specifications chart ................276
daytime running light ...............91
fog lamps ...................................91
headlamps .................................89
headlamps, flash to pass ..........89
interior lamps ...........................92
replacing bulbs ...............273, 276
Lane change indicator
(see Turn signal) ........................91
LATCH anchors ...........................29
Liftgate ............................70, 72–73
Lights, warning and indicator ..103
Loading instructions .................212
Loading pictures .......................416
Load limits .................................206
Locks
autolock .....................................71
childproof ..................................37
doors ..........................................69
Lubricant specifications ...........320
Lug nuts ....................................318
Index 501
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
M
MAP DVD - Loading and
Unloading ..................................353
Map icons ..................................462
Map mode ..................................461
Map updates ..............................465
Master lighting switch ................89
Media Bluetooth menu options
(adding, connecting, deleting,
turning on/off) ..........................401
Message center .........................109
warning messages ...................115
Mirrors ...................................95, 98
programmable memory ............60
side view mirrors (power) .......95
signal ...................................96–97
Moon roof ..................................100
Motorcraft® parts .............278, 324
MyKey ..........................................62
N
Navigation end user license
agreement ..................................475
Navigation features ...................448
O
Octane rating ............................167
P
Pairing other phones ................370
Pairing your phone for the first
time ............................................370
Parental MyKey programming ...62
Parking brake ............................191
Parts (see Motorcraft®
parts) .........................................324
Phone Bluetooth menu options
(adding, connecting, deleting,
turning on/off) ..........................381
Phone redial ..............................375
Playing a DVD in the system ...353
Playing music (by artist,
album, genre, playlist, tracks,
similar) ......................................398
POI categories ...........................456
Point of Interest (POI) .............456
Power deployable running
boards ........................................214
Power distribution box
(see Fuses) .......................247, 251
Power door locks ........................69
Power liftgate ..............................73
Power mirrors .............................95
Powerpoint ................................155
Power steering ..........................203
fluid, checking and adding ....264
fluid, refill capacity ................320
fluid, specifications .................320
Power Windows ...........................94
Privacy information ..................366
Putting a call on/off hold .........373
Q
Quick touch buttons .................464
502 Index
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
R
Radio ..........................................334
Single CD ................................334
Radio reception .........................332
Radio voice commands .....424, 430
Rear heated seats .....................141
Rear seat entertainment
system ........................................344
Rear view camera display ........198
Rear window defroster .....119, 121
Receiving a text message .........377
Recommendations for
attaching safety restraints for
children ........................................25
Relays ................................246–247
Remote entry system
illuminated entry ......................72
locking/unlocking doors ...........69
opening the trunk .....................70
replacing the batteries .............59
Roadside assistance ..................232
Roll stability control .................194
Roof rack ...................................205
S
Safety Belt Maintenance ............47
Safety belts (see Safety
restraints) ....................................40
Safety defects, reporting ..........245
Safety information ....................365
Safety restraints ..............40–41, 43
Belt-Minder® ............................44
extension assembly ..................42
for adults .............................40–41
for children ...............................25
safety belt maintenance ...........47
seat belt maintenance ..............47
warning light and chime ..........44
Safety restraints - LATCH
anchors ........................................29
Safety seats for children ............25
Safety Compliance
Certification Label ....................325
Satellite Radio ...........................434
Scheduled Maintenance Guide
Normal Scheduled
Maintenance and Log .............486
SD card ......................................448
Seat belts (see Safety
restraints) ....................................40
Seats
child safety seats ......................25
climate control ........................133
filter .........................................324
heated ......................................141
memory seat .....................60, 131
SecuriCode keyless entry
system ..........................................77
SecuriLock passive anti-theft
system ..........................................80
Selecting your media source
(USB, Line in, BT audio) .........396
Setting a destination ................448
Setting the clock .......................334
Side air curtain ...........................54
Side-curtain airbags system .......54
SIRIUS® satellite radio ....431, 448
SIRIUS satellite radio voice
commands .................................433
SIRIUS Travel Link ...................444
Index 503
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
Snowplowing ...............................16
SOS Post Crash Alert .................50
Spark plugs,
specifications .....................319, 324
Special notice
ambulance conversions ............16
Specification chart,
lubricants ...................................320
Stability system .........................194
Starting a flex fuel vehicle .......161
Starting your vehicle ........160–161
jump starting ..........................235
Status bars ................................415
Steering wheel ............................84
controls ......................................84
tilting .........................................84
Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) (see airbags) ....................51
Suspension ................................204
SYNC® AppLink™ ...................392
SYNC® customer support ........365
SYNC® Services ........................388
System overview .......................412
T
Temperature control
(see Climate control) .......119, 121
Text messaging .........................376
Text messaging (sending,
downloading, deleting) .....377, 379
Third-row power fold seat .......143
Tilt steering wheel ......................84
Tires ...........................289–290, 310
alignment ................................303
care ..........................................289
changing ..........................310, 312
checking the pressure ............299
inflating ...................................297
label .........................................296
replacing ..................................301
rotating ....................................303
safety practices .......................302
sidewall information ...............292
snow tires and chains ............304
spare tire .................................310
terminology .............................291
tire grades ...............................290
treadwear ........................290, 299
Towing .......................216, 226–227
recreational towing .................227
trailer towing ..........................216
wrecker ....................................226
Traction control ........................192
Traffic, Directions and
Information ................................388
Trailer sway control ..................217
Transmission
brake-shift interlock (BSI) ....179
fluid, checking and adding
(automatic) .............................263
fluid, refill capacities ..............320
lubricant specifications ..........320
Troubleshooting ................359, 466
Turn signal ..................................91
U
Universal garage door opener ..145
USB port ....................................344
Using privacy mode ..................373
504 Index
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)
background
V
Vehicle health report ................386
Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) ..........................................324
Vehicle loading ..........................206
Ventilating your vehicle ...........162
Voice commands in media
mode ..........................................394
Voice commands in phone
mode ..........................................371
Voice recognition ......................417
W
Warning lights (see Lights) .....103
Washer fluid ......................264–265
Water, Driving through .............229
Where am I? ..............................444
Windows
power .........................................94
rear wiper/washer .....................88
Windshield washer fluid and
wipers ..........................................87
checking and adding
fluid ..................................264–265
replacing wiper blades ...267–268
Wrecker towing .........................226
Index 505
2014 Navigator (nav)
Owners Guide gf, 1st Printing, June 2013
USA (fus)

Specifications

Lincoln LINCOLN 2014 NAVIGATOR Questions and Answers

Questions and Answers

Related Products